You can not select more than 25 topics Topics must start with a letter or number, can include dashes ('-') and can be up to 35 characters long.

25342 lines
675KB

  1. @chapter Filtering Introduction
  2. @c man begin FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  3. Filtering in FFmpeg is enabled through the libavfilter library.
  4. In libavfilter, a filter can have multiple inputs and multiple
  5. outputs.
  6. To illustrate the sorts of things that are possible, we consider the
  7. following filtergraph.
  8. @verbatim
  9. [main]
  10. input --> split ---------------------> overlay --> output
  11. | ^
  12. |[tmp] [flip]|
  13. +-----> crop --> vflip -------+
  14. @end verbatim
  15. This filtergraph splits the input stream in two streams, then sends one
  16. stream through the crop filter and the vflip filter, before merging it
  17. back with the other stream by overlaying it on top. You can use the
  18. following command to achieve this:
  19. @example
  20. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "split [main][tmp]; [tmp] crop=iw:ih/2:0:0, vflip [flip]; [main][flip] overlay=0:H/2" OUTPUT
  21. @end example
  22. The result will be that the top half of the video is mirrored
  23. onto the bottom half of the output video.
  24. Filters in the same linear chain are separated by commas, and distinct
  25. linear chains of filters are separated by semicolons. In our example,
  26. @var{crop,vflip} are in one linear chain, @var{split} and
  27. @var{overlay} are separately in another. The points where the linear
  28. chains join are labelled by names enclosed in square brackets. In the
  29. example, the split filter generates two outputs that are associated to
  30. the labels @var{[main]} and @var{[tmp]}.
  31. The stream sent to the second output of @var{split}, labelled as
  32. @var{[tmp]}, is processed through the @var{crop} filter, which crops
  33. away the lower half part of the video, and then vertically flipped. The
  34. @var{overlay} filter takes in input the first unchanged output of the
  35. split filter (which was labelled as @var{[main]}), and overlay on its
  36. lower half the output generated by the @var{crop,vflip} filterchain.
  37. Some filters take in input a list of parameters: they are specified
  38. after the filter name and an equal sign, and are separated from each other
  39. by a colon.
  40. There exist so-called @var{source filters} that do not have an
  41. audio/video input, and @var{sink filters} that will not have audio/video
  42. output.
  43. @c man end FILTERING INTRODUCTION
  44. @chapter graph2dot
  45. @c man begin GRAPH2DOT
  46. The @file{graph2dot} program included in the FFmpeg @file{tools}
  47. directory can be used to parse a filtergraph description and issue a
  48. corresponding textual representation in the dot language.
  49. Invoke the command:
  50. @example
  51. graph2dot -h
  52. @end example
  53. to see how to use @file{graph2dot}.
  54. You can then pass the dot description to the @file{dot} program (from
  55. the graphviz suite of programs) and obtain a graphical representation
  56. of the filtergraph.
  57. For example the sequence of commands:
  58. @example
  59. echo @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} | \
  60. tools/graph2dot -o graph.tmp && \
  61. dot -Tpng graph.tmp -o graph.png && \
  62. display graph.png
  63. @end example
  64. can be used to create and display an image representing the graph
  65. described by the @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string. Note that this string must be
  66. a complete self-contained graph, with its inputs and outputs explicitly defined.
  67. For example if your command line is of the form:
  68. @example
  69. ffmpeg -i infile -vf scale=640:360 outfile
  70. @end example
  71. your @var{GRAPH_DESCRIPTION} string will need to be of the form:
  72. @example
  73. nullsrc,scale=640:360,nullsink
  74. @end example
  75. you may also need to set the @var{nullsrc} parameters and add a @var{format}
  76. filter in order to simulate a specific input file.
  77. @c man end GRAPH2DOT
  78. @chapter Filtergraph description
  79. @c man begin FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  80. A filtergraph is a directed graph of connected filters. It can contain
  81. cycles, and there can be multiple links between a pair of
  82. filters. Each link has one input pad on one side connecting it to one
  83. filter from which it takes its input, and one output pad on the other
  84. side connecting it to one filter accepting its output.
  85. Each filter in a filtergraph is an instance of a filter class
  86. registered in the application, which defines the features and the
  87. number of input and output pads of the filter.
  88. A filter with no input pads is called a "source", and a filter with no
  89. output pads is called a "sink".
  90. @anchor{Filtergraph syntax}
  91. @section Filtergraph syntax
  92. A filtergraph has a textual representation, which is recognized by the
  93. @option{-filter}/@option{-vf}/@option{-af} and
  94. @option{-filter_complex} options in @command{ffmpeg} and
  95. @option{-vf}/@option{-af} in @command{ffplay}, and by the
  96. @code{avfilter_graph_parse_ptr()} function defined in
  97. @file{libavfilter/avfilter.h}.
  98. A filterchain consists of a sequence of connected filters, each one
  99. connected to the previous one in the sequence. A filterchain is
  100. represented by a list of ","-separated filter descriptions.
  101. A filtergraph consists of a sequence of filterchains. A sequence of
  102. filterchains is represented by a list of ";"-separated filterchain
  103. descriptions.
  104. A filter is represented by a string of the form:
  105. [@var{in_link_1}]...[@var{in_link_N}]@var{filter_name}@@@var{id}=@var{arguments}[@var{out_link_1}]...[@var{out_link_M}]
  106. @var{filter_name} is the name of the filter class of which the
  107. described filter is an instance of, and has to be the name of one of
  108. the filter classes registered in the program optionally followed by "@@@var{id}".
  109. The name of the filter class is optionally followed by a string
  110. "=@var{arguments}".
  111. @var{arguments} is a string which contains the parameters used to
  112. initialize the filter instance. It may have one of two forms:
  113. @itemize
  114. @item
  115. A ':'-separated list of @var{key=value} pairs.
  116. @item
  117. A ':'-separated list of @var{value}. In this case, the keys are assumed to be
  118. the option names in the order they are declared. E.g. the @code{fade} filter
  119. declares three options in this order -- @option{type}, @option{start_frame} and
  120. @option{nb_frames}. Then the parameter list @var{in:0:30} means that the value
  121. @var{in} is assigned to the option @option{type}, @var{0} to
  122. @option{start_frame} and @var{30} to @option{nb_frames}.
  123. @item
  124. A ':'-separated list of mixed direct @var{value} and long @var{key=value}
  125. pairs. The direct @var{value} must precede the @var{key=value} pairs, and
  126. follow the same constraints order of the previous point. The following
  127. @var{key=value} pairs can be set in any preferred order.
  128. @end itemize
  129. If the option value itself is a list of items (e.g. the @code{format} filter
  130. takes a list of pixel formats), the items in the list are usually separated by
  131. @samp{|}.
  132. The list of arguments can be quoted using the character @samp{'} as initial
  133. and ending mark, and the character @samp{\} for escaping the characters
  134. within the quoted text; otherwise the argument string is considered
  135. terminated when the next special character (belonging to the set
  136. @samp{[]=;,}) is encountered.
  137. The name and arguments of the filter are optionally preceded and
  138. followed by a list of link labels.
  139. A link label allows one to name a link and associate it to a filter output
  140. or input pad. The preceding labels @var{in_link_1}
  141. ... @var{in_link_N}, are associated to the filter input pads,
  142. the following labels @var{out_link_1} ... @var{out_link_M}, are
  143. associated to the output pads.
  144. When two link labels with the same name are found in the
  145. filtergraph, a link between the corresponding input and output pad is
  146. created.
  147. If an output pad is not labelled, it is linked by default to the first
  148. unlabelled input pad of the next filter in the filterchain.
  149. For example in the filterchain
  150. @example
  151. nullsrc, split[L1], [L2]overlay, nullsink
  152. @end example
  153. the split filter instance has two output pads, and the overlay filter
  154. instance two input pads. The first output pad of split is labelled
  155. "L1", the first input pad of overlay is labelled "L2", and the second
  156. output pad of split is linked to the second input pad of overlay,
  157. which are both unlabelled.
  158. In a filter description, if the input label of the first filter is not
  159. specified, "in" is assumed; if the output label of the last filter is not
  160. specified, "out" is assumed.
  161. In a complete filterchain all the unlabelled filter input and output
  162. pads must be connected. A filtergraph is considered valid if all the
  163. filter input and output pads of all the filterchains are connected.
  164. Libavfilter will automatically insert @ref{scale} filters where format
  165. conversion is required. It is possible to specify swscale flags
  166. for those automatically inserted scalers by prepending
  167. @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  168. to the filtergraph description.
  169. Here is a BNF description of the filtergraph syntax:
  170. @example
  171. @var{NAME} ::= sequence of alphanumeric characters and '_'
  172. @var{FILTER_NAME} ::= @var{NAME}["@@"@var{NAME}]
  173. @var{LINKLABEL} ::= "[" @var{NAME} "]"
  174. @var{LINKLABELS} ::= @var{LINKLABEL} [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  175. @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS} ::= sequence of chars (possibly quoted)
  176. @var{FILTER} ::= [@var{LINKLABELS}] @var{FILTER_NAME} ["=" @var{FILTER_ARGUMENTS}] [@var{LINKLABELS}]
  177. @var{FILTERCHAIN} ::= @var{FILTER} [,@var{FILTERCHAIN}]
  178. @var{FILTERGRAPH} ::= [sws_flags=@var{flags};] @var{FILTERCHAIN} [;@var{FILTERGRAPH}]
  179. @end example
  180. @anchor{filtergraph escaping}
  181. @section Notes on filtergraph escaping
  182. Filtergraph description composition entails several levels of
  183. escaping. See @ref{quoting_and_escaping,,the "Quoting and escaping"
  184. section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils} for more
  185. information about the employed escaping procedure.
  186. A first level escaping affects the content of each filter option
  187. value, which may contain the special character @code{:} used to
  188. separate values, or one of the escaping characters @code{\'}.
  189. A second level escaping affects the whole filter description, which
  190. may contain the escaping characters @code{\'} or the special
  191. characters @code{[],;} used by the filtergraph description.
  192. Finally, when you specify a filtergraph on a shell commandline, you
  193. need to perform a third level escaping for the shell special
  194. characters contained within it.
  195. For example, consider the following string to be embedded in
  196. the @ref{drawtext} filter description @option{text} value:
  197. @example
  198. this is a 'string': may contain one, or more, special characters
  199. @end example
  200. This string contains the @code{'} special escaping character, and the
  201. @code{:} special character, so it needs to be escaped in this way:
  202. @example
  203. text=this is a \'string\'\: may contain one, or more, special characters
  204. @end example
  205. A second level of escaping is required when embedding the filter
  206. description in a filtergraph description, in order to escape all the
  207. filtergraph special characters. Thus the example above becomes:
  208. @example
  209. drawtext=text=this is a \\\'string\\\'\\: may contain one\, or more\, special characters
  210. @end example
  211. (note that in addition to the @code{\'} escaping special characters,
  212. also @code{,} needs to be escaped).
  213. Finally an additional level of escaping is needed when writing the
  214. filtergraph description in a shell command, which depends on the
  215. escaping rules of the adopted shell. For example, assuming that
  216. @code{\} is special and needs to be escaped with another @code{\}, the
  217. previous string will finally result in:
  218. @example
  219. -vf "drawtext=text=this is a \\\\\\'string\\\\\\'\\\\: may contain one\\, or more\\, special characters"
  220. @end example
  221. @chapter Timeline editing
  222. Some filters support a generic @option{enable} option. For the filters
  223. supporting timeline editing, this option can be set to an expression which is
  224. evaluated before sending a frame to the filter. If the evaluation is non-zero,
  225. the filter will be enabled, otherwise the frame will be sent unchanged to the
  226. next filter in the filtergraph.
  227. The expression accepts the following values:
  228. @table @samp
  229. @item t
  230. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  231. @item n
  232. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0
  233. @item pos
  234. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  235. @item w
  236. @item h
  237. width and height of the input frame if video
  238. @end table
  239. Additionally, these filters support an @option{enable} command that can be used
  240. to re-define the expression.
  241. Like any other filtering option, the @option{enable} option follows the same
  242. rules.
  243. For example, to enable a blur filter (@ref{smartblur}) from 10 seconds to 3
  244. minutes, and a @ref{curves} filter starting at 3 seconds:
  245. @example
  246. smartblur = enable='between(t,10,3*60)',
  247. curves = enable='gte(t,3)' : preset=cross_process
  248. @end example
  249. See @code{ffmpeg -filters} to view which filters have timeline support.
  250. @c man end FILTERGRAPH DESCRIPTION
  251. @anchor{commands}
  252. @chapter Changing options at runtime with a command
  253. Some options can be changed during the operation of the filter using
  254. a command. These options are marked 'T' on the output of
  255. @command{ffmpeg} @option{-h filter=<name of filter>}.
  256. The name of the command is the name of the option and the argument is
  257. the new value.
  258. @anchor{framesync}
  259. @chapter Options for filters with several inputs (framesync)
  260. @c man begin OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  261. Some filters with several inputs support a common set of options.
  262. These options can only be set by name, not with the short notation.
  263. @table @option
  264. @item eof_action
  265. The action to take when EOF is encountered on the secondary input; it accepts
  266. one of the following values:
  267. @table @option
  268. @item repeat
  269. Repeat the last frame (the default).
  270. @item endall
  271. End both streams.
  272. @item pass
  273. Pass the main input through.
  274. @end table
  275. @item shortest
  276. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  277. terminates. Default value is 0.
  278. @item repeatlast
  279. If set to 1, force the filter to extend the last frame of secondary streams
  280. until the end of the primary stream. A value of 0 disables this behavior.
  281. Default value is 1.
  282. @end table
  283. @c man end OPTIONS FOR FILTERS WITH SEVERAL INPUTS
  284. @chapter Audio Filters
  285. @c man begin AUDIO FILTERS
  286. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  287. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  288. The configure output will show the audio filters included in your
  289. build.
  290. Below is a description of the currently available audio filters.
  291. @section acompressor
  292. A compressor is mainly used to reduce the dynamic range of a signal.
  293. Especially modern music is mostly compressed at a high ratio to
  294. improve the overall loudness. It's done to get the highest attention
  295. of a listener, "fatten" the sound and bring more "power" to the track.
  296. If a signal is compressed too much it may sound dull or "dead"
  297. afterwards or it may start to "pump" (which could be a powerful effect
  298. but can also destroy a track completely).
  299. The right compression is the key to reach a professional sound and is
  300. the high art of mixing and mastering. Because of its complex settings
  301. it may take a long time to get the right feeling for this kind of effect.
  302. Compression is done by detecting the volume above a chosen level
  303. @code{threshold} and dividing it by the factor set with @code{ratio}.
  304. So if you set the threshold to -12dB and your signal reaches -6dB a ratio
  305. of 2:1 will result in a signal at -9dB. Because an exact manipulation of
  306. the signal would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be
  307. levelled over the time. This is done by setting "Attack" and "Release".
  308. @code{attack} determines how long the signal has to rise above the threshold
  309. before any reduction will occur and @code{release} sets the time the signal
  310. has to fall below the threshold to reduce the reduction again. Shorter signals
  311. than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  312. The overall reduction of the signal can be made up afterwards with the
  313. @code{makeup} setting. So compressing the peaks of a signal about 6dB and
  314. raising the makeup to this level results in a signal twice as loud than the
  315. source. To gain a softer entry in the compression the @code{knee} flattens the
  316. hard edge at the threshold in the range of the chosen decibels.
  317. The filter accepts the following options:
  318. @table @option
  319. @item level_in
  320. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  321. @item mode
  322. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  323. Default is @code{downward}.
  324. @item threshold
  325. If a signal of stream rises above this level it will affect the gain
  326. reduction.
  327. By default it is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  328. @item ratio
  329. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  330. rose 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  331. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  332. @item attack
  333. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  334. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  335. @item release
  336. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  337. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  338. @item makeup
  339. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  340. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  341. @item knee
  342. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  343. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  344. @item link
  345. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of input stream
  346. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of input stream affects the
  347. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  348. @item detection
  349. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  350. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mostly smoother.
  351. @item mix
  352. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  353. Range is between 0 and 1.
  354. @end table
  355. @subsection Commands
  356. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  357. @section acontrast
  358. Simple audio dynamic range compression/expansion filter.
  359. The filter accepts the following options:
  360. @table @option
  361. @item contrast
  362. Set contrast. Default is 33. Allowed range is between 0 and 100.
  363. @end table
  364. @section acopy
  365. Copy the input audio source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  366. testing purposes.
  367. @section acrossfade
  368. Apply cross fade from one input audio stream to another input audio stream.
  369. The cross fade is applied for specified duration near the end of first stream.
  370. The filter accepts the following options:
  371. @table @option
  372. @item nb_samples, ns
  373. Specify the number of samples for which the cross fade effect has to last.
  374. At the end of the cross fade effect the first input audio will be completely
  375. silent. Default is 44100.
  376. @item duration, d
  377. Specify the duration of the cross fade effect. See
  378. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  379. for the accepted syntax.
  380. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  381. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  382. @item overlap, o
  383. Should first stream end overlap with second stream start. Default is enabled.
  384. @item curve1
  385. Set curve for cross fade transition for first stream.
  386. @item curve2
  387. Set curve for cross fade transition for second stream.
  388. For description of available curve types see @ref{afade} filter description.
  389. @end table
  390. @subsection Examples
  391. @itemize
  392. @item
  393. Cross fade from one input to another:
  394. @example
  395. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  396. @end example
  397. @item
  398. Cross fade from one input to another but without overlapping:
  399. @example
  400. ffmpeg -i first.flac -i second.flac -filter_complex acrossfade=d=10:o=0:c1=exp:c2=exp output.flac
  401. @end example
  402. @end itemize
  403. @section acrossover
  404. Split audio stream into several bands.
  405. This filter splits audio stream into two or more frequency ranges.
  406. Summing all streams back will give flat output.
  407. The filter accepts the following options:
  408. @table @option
  409. @item split
  410. Set split frequencies. Those must be positive and increasing.
  411. @item order
  412. Set filter order, can be @var{2nd}, @var{4th} or @var{8th}.
  413. Default is @var{4th}.
  414. @end table
  415. @section acrusher
  416. Reduce audio bit resolution.
  417. This filter is bit crusher with enhanced functionality. A bit crusher
  418. is used to audibly reduce number of bits an audio signal is sampled
  419. with. This doesn't change the bit depth at all, it just produces the
  420. effect. Material reduced in bit depth sounds more harsh and "digital".
  421. This filter is able to even round to continuous values instead of discrete
  422. bit depths.
  423. Additionally it has a D/C offset which results in different crushing of
  424. the lower and the upper half of the signal.
  425. An Anti-Aliasing setting is able to produce "softer" crushing sounds.
  426. Another feature of this filter is the logarithmic mode.
  427. This setting switches from linear distances between bits to logarithmic ones.
  428. The result is a much more "natural" sounding crusher which doesn't gate low
  429. signals for example. The human ear has a logarithmic perception,
  430. so this kind of crushing is much more pleasant.
  431. Logarithmic crushing is also able to get anti-aliased.
  432. The filter accepts the following options:
  433. @table @option
  434. @item level_in
  435. Set level in.
  436. @item level_out
  437. Set level out.
  438. @item bits
  439. Set bit reduction.
  440. @item mix
  441. Set mixing amount.
  442. @item mode
  443. Can be linear: @code{lin} or logarithmic: @code{log}.
  444. @item dc
  445. Set DC.
  446. @item aa
  447. Set anti-aliasing.
  448. @item samples
  449. Set sample reduction.
  450. @item lfo
  451. Enable LFO. By default disabled.
  452. @item lforange
  453. Set LFO range.
  454. @item lforate
  455. Set LFO rate.
  456. @end table
  457. @section acue
  458. Delay audio filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. See the @ref{cue}
  459. filter.
  460. @section adeclick
  461. Remove impulsive noise from input audio.
  462. Samples detected as impulsive noise are replaced by interpolated samples using
  463. autoregressive modelling.
  464. @table @option
  465. @item w
  466. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to
  467. @code{100}. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  468. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  469. @item o
  470. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  471. @code{50} to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  472. Setting this to a very high value increases impulsive noise removal but makes
  473. whole process much slower.
  474. @item a
  475. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  476. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{2} percent. This option also
  477. controls quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  478. @item t
  479. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  480. Default value is @code{2}.
  481. This controls the strength of impulsive noise which is going to be removed.
  482. The lower value, the more samples will be detected as impulsive noise.
  483. @item b
  484. Set burst fusion, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is @code{0} to
  485. @code{10}. Default value is @code{2}.
  486. If any two samples detected as noise are spaced less than this value then any
  487. sample between those two samples will be also detected as noise.
  488. @item m
  489. Set overlap method.
  490. It accepts the following values:
  491. @table @option
  492. @item a
  493. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly
  494. changed with this method.
  495. @item s
  496. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  497. @end table
  498. Default value is @code{a}.
  499. @end table
  500. @section adeclip
  501. Remove clipped samples from input audio.
  502. Samples detected as clipped are replaced by interpolated samples using
  503. autoregressive modelling.
  504. @table @option
  505. @item w
  506. Set window size, in milliseconds. Allowed range is from @code{10} to @code{100}.
  507. Default value is @code{55} milliseconds.
  508. This sets size of window which will be processed at once.
  509. @item o
  510. Set window overlap, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from @code{50}
  511. to @code{95}. Default value is @code{75} percent.
  512. @item a
  513. Set autoregression order, in percentage of window size. Allowed range is from
  514. @code{0} to @code{25}. Default value is @code{8} percent. This option also controls
  515. quality of interpolated samples using neighbour good samples.
  516. @item t
  517. Set threshold value. Allowed range is from @code{1} to @code{100}.
  518. Default value is @code{10}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  519. @item n
  520. Set size of histogram used to detect clips. Allowed range is from @code{100} to @code{9999}.
  521. Default value is @code{1000}. Higher values make clip detection less aggressive.
  522. @item m
  523. Set overlap method.
  524. It accepts the following values:
  525. @table @option
  526. @item a
  527. Select overlap-add method. Even not interpolated samples are slightly changed
  528. with this method.
  529. @item s
  530. Select overlap-save method. Not interpolated samples remain unchanged.
  531. @end table
  532. Default value is @code{a}.
  533. @end table
  534. @section adelay
  535. Delay one or more audio channels.
  536. Samples in delayed channel are filled with silence.
  537. The filter accepts the following option:
  538. @table @option
  539. @item delays
  540. Set list of delays in milliseconds for each channel separated by '|'.
  541. Unused delays will be silently ignored. If number of given delays is
  542. smaller than number of channels all remaining channels will not be delayed.
  543. If you want to delay exact number of samples, append 'S' to number.
  544. If you want instead to delay in seconds, append 's' to number.
  545. @item all
  546. Use last set delay for all remaining channels. By default is disabled.
  547. This option if enabled changes how option @code{delays} is interpreted.
  548. @end table
  549. @subsection Examples
  550. @itemize
  551. @item
  552. Delay first channel by 1.5 seconds, the third channel by 0.5 seconds and leave
  553. the second channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  554. @example
  555. adelay=1500|0|500
  556. @end example
  557. @item
  558. Delay second channel by 500 samples, the third channel by 700 samples and leave
  559. the first channel (and any other channels that may be present) unchanged.
  560. @example
  561. adelay=0|500S|700S
  562. @end example
  563. @item
  564. Delay all channels by same number of samples:
  565. @example
  566. adelay=delays=64S:all=1
  567. @end example
  568. @end itemize
  569. @section aderivative, aintegral
  570. Compute derivative/integral of audio stream.
  571. Applying both filters one after another produces original audio.
  572. @section aecho
  573. Apply echoing to the input audio.
  574. Echoes are reflected sound and can occur naturally amongst mountains
  575. (and sometimes large buildings) when talking or shouting; digital echo
  576. effects emulate this behaviour and are often used to help fill out the
  577. sound of a single instrument or vocal. The time difference between the
  578. original signal and the reflection is the @code{delay}, and the
  579. loudness of the reflected signal is the @code{decay}.
  580. Multiple echoes can have different delays and decays.
  581. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  582. @table @option
  583. @item in_gain
  584. Set input gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.6}.
  585. @item out_gain
  586. Set output gain of reflected signal. Default is @code{0.3}.
  587. @item delays
  588. Set list of time intervals in milliseconds between original signal and reflections
  589. separated by '|'. Allowed range for each @code{delay} is @code{(0 - 90000.0]}.
  590. Default is @code{1000}.
  591. @item decays
  592. Set list of loudness of reflected signals separated by '|'.
  593. Allowed range for each @code{decay} is @code{(0 - 1.0]}.
  594. Default is @code{0.5}.
  595. @end table
  596. @subsection Examples
  597. @itemize
  598. @item
  599. Make it sound as if there are twice as many instruments as are actually playing:
  600. @example
  601. aecho=0.8:0.88:60:0.4
  602. @end example
  603. @item
  604. If delay is very short, then it sounds like a (metallic) robot playing music:
  605. @example
  606. aecho=0.8:0.88:6:0.4
  607. @end example
  608. @item
  609. A longer delay will sound like an open air concert in the mountains:
  610. @example
  611. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000:0.3
  612. @end example
  613. @item
  614. Same as above but with one more mountain:
  615. @example
  616. aecho=0.8:0.9:1000|1800:0.3|0.25
  617. @end example
  618. @end itemize
  619. @section aemphasis
  620. Audio emphasis filter creates or restores material directly taken from LPs or
  621. emphased CDs with different filter curves. E.g. to store music on vinyl the
  622. signal has to be altered by a filter first to even out the disadvantages of
  623. this recording medium.
  624. Once the material is played back the inverse filter has to be applied to
  625. restore the distortion of the frequency response.
  626. The filter accepts the following options:
  627. @table @option
  628. @item level_in
  629. Set input gain.
  630. @item level_out
  631. Set output gain.
  632. @item mode
  633. Set filter mode. For restoring material use @code{reproduction} mode, otherwise
  634. use @code{production} mode. Default is @code{reproduction} mode.
  635. @item type
  636. Set filter type. Selects medium. Can be one of the following:
  637. @table @option
  638. @item col
  639. select Columbia.
  640. @item emi
  641. select EMI.
  642. @item bsi
  643. select BSI (78RPM).
  644. @item riaa
  645. select RIAA.
  646. @item cd
  647. select Compact Disc (CD).
  648. @item 50fm
  649. select 50µs (FM).
  650. @item 75fm
  651. select 75µs (FM).
  652. @item 50kf
  653. select 50µs (FM-KF).
  654. @item 75kf
  655. select 75µs (FM-KF).
  656. @end table
  657. @end table
  658. @section aeval
  659. Modify an audio signal according to the specified expressions.
  660. This filter accepts one or more expressions (one for each channel),
  661. which are evaluated and used to modify a corresponding audio signal.
  662. It accepts the following parameters:
  663. @table @option
  664. @item exprs
  665. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. If
  666. the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  667. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  668. output channels.
  669. @item channel_layout, c
  670. Set output channel layout. If not specified, the channel layout is
  671. specified by the number of expressions. If set to @samp{same}, it will
  672. use by default the same input channel layout.
  673. @end table
  674. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants and functions:
  675. @table @option
  676. @item ch
  677. channel number of the current expression
  678. @item n
  679. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  680. @item s
  681. sample rate
  682. @item t
  683. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds
  684. @item nb_in_channels
  685. @item nb_out_channels
  686. input and output number of channels
  687. @item val(CH)
  688. the value of input channel with number @var{CH}
  689. @end table
  690. Note: this filter is slow. For faster processing you should use a
  691. dedicated filter.
  692. @subsection Examples
  693. @itemize
  694. @item
  695. Half volume:
  696. @example
  697. aeval=val(ch)/2:c=same
  698. @end example
  699. @item
  700. Invert phase of the second channel:
  701. @example
  702. aeval=val(0)|-val(1)
  703. @end example
  704. @end itemize
  705. @anchor{afade}
  706. @section afade
  707. Apply fade-in/out effect to input audio.
  708. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  709. @table @option
  710. @item type, t
  711. Specify the effect type, can be either @code{in} for fade-in, or
  712. @code{out} for a fade-out effect. Default is @code{in}.
  713. @item start_sample, ss
  714. Specify the number of the start sample for starting to apply the fade
  715. effect. Default is 0.
  716. @item nb_samples, ns
  717. Specify the number of samples for which the fade effect has to last. At
  718. the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  719. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  720. the output audio will be silence. Default is 44100.
  721. @item start_time, st
  722. Specify the start time of the fade effect. Default is 0.
  723. The value must be specified as a time duration; see
  724. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  725. for the accepted syntax.
  726. If set this option is used instead of @var{start_sample}.
  727. @item duration, d
  728. Specify the duration of the fade effect. See
  729. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  730. for the accepted syntax.
  731. At the end of the fade-in effect the output audio will have the same
  732. volume as the input audio, at the end of the fade-out transition
  733. the output audio will be silence.
  734. By default the duration is determined by @var{nb_samples}.
  735. If set this option is used instead of @var{nb_samples}.
  736. @item curve
  737. Set curve for fade transition.
  738. It accepts the following values:
  739. @table @option
  740. @item tri
  741. select triangular, linear slope (default)
  742. @item qsin
  743. select quarter of sine wave
  744. @item hsin
  745. select half of sine wave
  746. @item esin
  747. select exponential sine wave
  748. @item log
  749. select logarithmic
  750. @item ipar
  751. select inverted parabola
  752. @item qua
  753. select quadratic
  754. @item cub
  755. select cubic
  756. @item squ
  757. select square root
  758. @item cbr
  759. select cubic root
  760. @item par
  761. select parabola
  762. @item exp
  763. select exponential
  764. @item iqsin
  765. select inverted quarter of sine wave
  766. @item ihsin
  767. select inverted half of sine wave
  768. @item dese
  769. select double-exponential seat
  770. @item desi
  771. select double-exponential sigmoid
  772. @item losi
  773. select logistic sigmoid
  774. @item nofade
  775. no fade applied
  776. @end table
  777. @end table
  778. @subsection Examples
  779. @itemize
  780. @item
  781. Fade in first 15 seconds of audio:
  782. @example
  783. afade=t=in:ss=0:d=15
  784. @end example
  785. @item
  786. Fade out last 25 seconds of a 900 seconds audio:
  787. @example
  788. afade=t=out:st=875:d=25
  789. @end example
  790. @end itemize
  791. @section afftdn
  792. Denoise audio samples with FFT.
  793. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  794. @table @option
  795. @item nr
  796. Set the noise reduction in dB, allowed range is 0.01 to 97.
  797. Default value is 12 dB.
  798. @item nf
  799. Set the noise floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  800. Default value is -50 dB.
  801. @item nt
  802. Set the noise type.
  803. It accepts the following values:
  804. @table @option
  805. @item w
  806. Select white noise.
  807. @item v
  808. Select vinyl noise.
  809. @item s
  810. Select shellac noise.
  811. @item c
  812. Select custom noise, defined in @code{bn} option.
  813. Default value is white noise.
  814. @end table
  815. @item bn
  816. Set custom band noise for every one of 15 bands.
  817. Bands are separated by ' ' or '|'.
  818. @item rf
  819. Set the residual floor in dB, allowed range is -80 to -20.
  820. Default value is -38 dB.
  821. @item tn
  822. Enable noise tracking. By default is disabled.
  823. With this enabled, noise floor is automatically adjusted.
  824. @item tr
  825. Enable residual tracking. By default is disabled.
  826. @item om
  827. Set the output mode.
  828. It accepts the following values:
  829. @table @option
  830. @item i
  831. Pass input unchanged.
  832. @item o
  833. Pass noise filtered out.
  834. @item n
  835. Pass only noise.
  836. Default value is @var{o}.
  837. @end table
  838. @end table
  839. @subsection Commands
  840. This filter supports the following commands:
  841. @table @option
  842. @item sample_noise, sn
  843. Start or stop measuring noise profile.
  844. Syntax for the command is : "start" or "stop" string.
  845. After measuring noise profile is stopped it will be
  846. automatically applied in filtering.
  847. @item noise_reduction, nr
  848. Change noise reduction. Argument is single float number.
  849. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_reduction}"
  850. @item noise_floor, nf
  851. Change noise floor. Argument is single float number.
  852. Syntax for the command is : "@var{noise_floor}"
  853. @item output_mode, om
  854. Change output mode operation.
  855. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  856. @end table
  857. @section afftfilt
  858. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain.
  859. @table @option
  860. @item real
  861. Set frequency domain real expression for each separate channel separated
  862. by '|'. Default is "re".
  863. If the number of input channels is greater than the number of
  864. expressions, the last specified expression is used for the remaining
  865. output channels.
  866. @item imag
  867. Set frequency domain imaginary expression for each separate channel
  868. separated by '|'. Default is "im".
  869. Each expression in @var{real} and @var{imag} can contain the following
  870. constants and functions:
  871. @table @option
  872. @item sr
  873. sample rate
  874. @item b
  875. current frequency bin number
  876. @item nb
  877. number of available bins
  878. @item ch
  879. channel number of the current expression
  880. @item chs
  881. number of channels
  882. @item pts
  883. current frame pts
  884. @item re
  885. current real part of frequency bin of current channel
  886. @item im
  887. current imaginary part of frequency bin of current channel
  888. @item real(b, ch)
  889. Return the value of real part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  890. @item imag(b, ch)
  891. Return the value of imaginary part of frequency bin at location (@var{bin},@var{channel})
  892. @end table
  893. @item win_size
  894. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 131072.
  895. Default is @code{4096}
  896. @item win_func
  897. Set window function. Default is @code{hann}.
  898. @item overlap
  899. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  900. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.75}.
  901. @end table
  902. @subsection Examples
  903. @itemize
  904. @item
  905. Leave almost only low frequencies in audio:
  906. @example
  907. afftfilt="'real=re * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))':imag='im * (1-clip((b/nb)*b,0,1))'"
  908. @end example
  909. @item
  910. Apply robotize effect:
  911. @example
  912. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*sin(0)':imag='hypot(re,im)*cos(0)':win_size=512:overlap=0.75"
  913. @end example
  914. @item
  915. Apply whisper effect:
  916. @example
  917. afftfilt="real='hypot(re,im)*cos((random(0)*2-1)*2*3.14)':imag='hypot(re,im)*sin((random(1)*2-1)*2*3.14)':win_size=128:overlap=0.8"
  918. @end example
  919. @end itemize
  920. @anchor{afir}
  921. @section afir
  922. Apply an arbitrary Finite Impulse Response filter.
  923. This filter is designed for applying long FIR filters,
  924. up to 60 seconds long.
  925. It can be used as component for digital crossover filters,
  926. room equalization, cross talk cancellation, wavefield synthesis,
  927. auralization, ambiophonics, ambisonics and spatialization.
  928. This filter uses the streams higher than first one as FIR coefficients.
  929. If the non-first stream holds a single channel, it will be used
  930. for all input channels in the first stream, otherwise
  931. the number of channels in the non-first stream must be same as
  932. the number of channels in the first stream.
  933. It accepts the following parameters:
  934. @table @option
  935. @item dry
  936. Set dry gain. This sets input gain.
  937. @item wet
  938. Set wet gain. This sets final output gain.
  939. @item length
  940. Set Impulse Response filter length. Default is 1, which means whole IR is processed.
  941. @item gtype
  942. Enable applying gain measured from power of IR.
  943. Set which approach to use for auto gain measurement.
  944. @table @option
  945. @item none
  946. Do not apply any gain.
  947. @item peak
  948. select peak gain, very conservative approach. This is default value.
  949. @item dc
  950. select DC gain, limited application.
  951. @item gn
  952. select gain to noise approach, this is most popular one.
  953. @end table
  954. @item irgain
  955. Set gain to be applied to IR coefficients before filtering.
  956. Allowed range is 0 to 1. This gain is applied after any gain applied with @var{gtype} option.
  957. @item irfmt
  958. Set format of IR stream. Can be @code{mono} or @code{input}.
  959. Default is @code{input}.
  960. @item maxir
  961. Set max allowed Impulse Response filter duration in seconds. Default is 30 seconds.
  962. Allowed range is 0.1 to 60 seconds.
  963. @item response
  964. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  965. By default it is disabled.
  966. @item channel
  967. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  968. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  969. @item size
  970. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  971. @item rate
  972. Set video stream frame rate. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  973. @item minp
  974. Set minimal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  975. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32768}.
  976. Lower values decreases latency at cost of higher CPU usage.
  977. @item maxp
  978. Set maximal partition size used for convolution. Default is @var{8192}.
  979. Allowed range is from @var{8} to @var{32768}.
  980. Lower values may increase CPU usage.
  981. @item nbirs
  982. Set number of input impulse responses streams which will be switchable at runtime.
  983. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{32}. Default is @var{1}.
  984. @item ir
  985. Set IR stream which will be used for convolution, starting from @var{0}, should always be
  986. lower than supplied value by @code{nbirs} option. Default is @var{0}.
  987. This option can be changed at runtime via @ref{commands}.
  988. @end table
  989. @subsection Examples
  990. @itemize
  991. @item
  992. Apply reverb to stream using mono IR file as second input, complete command using ffmpeg:
  993. @example
  994. ffmpeg -i input.wav -i middle_tunnel_1way_mono.wav -lavfi afir output.wav
  995. @end example
  996. @end itemize
  997. @anchor{aformat}
  998. @section aformat
  999. Set output format constraints for the input audio. The framework will
  1000. negotiate the most appropriate format to minimize conversions.
  1001. It accepts the following parameters:
  1002. @table @option
  1003. @item sample_fmts, f
  1004. A '|'-separated list of requested sample formats.
  1005. @item sample_rates, r
  1006. A '|'-separated list of requested sample rates.
  1007. @item channel_layouts, cl
  1008. A '|'-separated list of requested channel layouts.
  1009. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1010. for the required syntax.
  1011. @end table
  1012. If a parameter is omitted, all values are allowed.
  1013. Force the output to either unsigned 8-bit or signed 16-bit stereo
  1014. @example
  1015. aformat=sample_fmts=u8|s16:channel_layouts=stereo
  1016. @end example
  1017. @section agate
  1018. A gate is mainly used to reduce lower parts of a signal. This kind of signal
  1019. processing reduces disturbing noise between useful signals.
  1020. Gating is done by detecting the volume below a chosen level @var{threshold}
  1021. and dividing it by the factor set with @var{ratio}. The bottom of the noise
  1022. floor is set via @var{range}. Because an exact manipulation of the signal
  1023. would cause distortion of the waveform the reduction can be levelled over
  1024. time. This is done by setting @var{attack} and @var{release}.
  1025. @var{attack} determines how long the signal has to fall below the threshold
  1026. before any reduction will occur and @var{release} sets the time the signal
  1027. has to rise above the threshold to reduce the reduction again.
  1028. Shorter signals than the chosen attack time will be left untouched.
  1029. @table @option
  1030. @item level_in
  1031. Set input level before filtering.
  1032. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  1033. @item mode
  1034. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  1035. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  1036. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  1037. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  1038. @item range
  1039. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  1040. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1041. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  1042. @item threshold
  1043. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  1044. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  1045. @item ratio
  1046. Set a ratio by which the signal is reduced.
  1047. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  1048. @item attack
  1049. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  1050. reduction stops.
  1051. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1052. @item release
  1053. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  1054. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  1055. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  1056. @item makeup
  1057. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  1058. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  1059. @item knee
  1060. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  1061. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  1062. @item detection
  1063. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  1064. Default is @code{rms}. Can be @code{peak} or @code{rms}.
  1065. @item link
  1066. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  1067. the reduction.
  1068. Default is @code{average}. Can be @code{average} or @code{maximum}.
  1069. @end table
  1070. @section aiir
  1071. Apply an arbitrary Infinite Impulse Response filter.
  1072. It accepts the following parameters:
  1073. @table @option
  1074. @item z
  1075. Set numerator/zeros coefficients.
  1076. @item p
  1077. Set denominator/poles coefficients.
  1078. @item k
  1079. Set channels gains.
  1080. @item dry_gain
  1081. Set input gain.
  1082. @item wet_gain
  1083. Set output gain.
  1084. @item f
  1085. Set coefficients format.
  1086. @table @samp
  1087. @item tf
  1088. transfer function
  1089. @item zp
  1090. Z-plane zeros/poles, cartesian (default)
  1091. @item pr
  1092. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar radians
  1093. @item pd
  1094. Z-plane zeros/poles, polar degrees
  1095. @end table
  1096. @item r
  1097. Set kind of processing.
  1098. Can be @code{d} - direct or @code{s} - serial cascading. Default is @code{s}.
  1099. @item e
  1100. Set filtering precision.
  1101. @table @samp
  1102. @item dbl
  1103. double-precision floating-point (default)
  1104. @item flt
  1105. single-precision floating-point
  1106. @item i32
  1107. 32-bit integers
  1108. @item i16
  1109. 16-bit integers
  1110. @end table
  1111. @item mix
  1112. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1113. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1114. @item response
  1115. Show IR frequency response, magnitude(magenta), phase(green) and group delay(yellow) in additional video stream.
  1116. By default it is disabled.
  1117. @item channel
  1118. Set for which IR channel to display frequency response. By default is first channel
  1119. displayed. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1120. @item size
  1121. Set video stream size. This option is used only when @var{response} is enabled.
  1122. @end table
  1123. Coefficients in @code{tf} format are separated by spaces and are in ascending
  1124. order.
  1125. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are separated by spaces and order of coefficients
  1126. doesn't matter. Coefficients in @code{zp} format are complex numbers with @var{i}
  1127. imaginary unit.
  1128. Different coefficients and gains can be provided for every channel, in such case
  1129. use '|' to separate coefficients or gains. Last provided coefficients will be
  1130. used for all remaining channels.
  1131. @subsection Examples
  1132. @itemize
  1133. @item
  1134. Apply 2 pole elliptic notch at around 5000Hz for 48000 Hz sample rate:
  1135. @example
  1136. aiir=k=1:z=7.957584807809675810E-1 -2.575128568908332300 3.674839853930788710 -2.57512875289799137 7.957586296317130880E-1:p=1 -2.86950072432325953 3.63022088054647218 -2.28075678147272232 6.361362326477423500E-1:f=tf:r=d
  1137. @end example
  1138. @item
  1139. Same as above but in @code{zp} format:
  1140. @example
  1141. aiir=k=0.79575848078096756:z=0.80918701+0.58773007i 0.80918701-0.58773007i 0.80884700+0.58784055i 0.80884700-0.58784055i:p=0.63892345+0.59951235i 0.63892345-0.59951235i 0.79582691+0.44198673i 0.79582691-0.44198673i:f=zp:r=s
  1142. @end example
  1143. @end itemize
  1144. @section alimiter
  1145. The limiter prevents an input signal from rising over a desired threshold.
  1146. This limiter uses lookahead technology to prevent your signal from distorting.
  1147. It means that there is a small delay after the signal is processed. Keep in mind
  1148. that the delay it produces is the attack time you set.
  1149. The filter accepts the following options:
  1150. @table @option
  1151. @item level_in
  1152. Set input gain. Default is 1.
  1153. @item level_out
  1154. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  1155. @item limit
  1156. Don't let signals above this level pass the limiter. Default is 1.
  1157. @item attack
  1158. The limiter will reach its attenuation level in this amount of time in
  1159. milliseconds. Default is 5 milliseconds.
  1160. @item release
  1161. Come back from limiting to attenuation 1.0 in this amount of milliseconds.
  1162. Default is 50 milliseconds.
  1163. @item asc
  1164. When gain reduction is always needed ASC takes care of releasing to an
  1165. average reduction level rather than reaching a reduction of 0 in the release
  1166. time.
  1167. @item asc_level
  1168. Select how much the release time is affected by ASC, 0 means nearly no changes
  1169. in release time while 1 produces higher release times.
  1170. @item level
  1171. Auto level output signal. Default is enabled.
  1172. This normalizes audio back to 0dB if enabled.
  1173. @end table
  1174. Depending on picked setting it is recommended to upsample input 2x or 4x times
  1175. with @ref{aresample} before applying this filter.
  1176. @section allpass
  1177. Apply a two-pole all-pass filter with central frequency (in Hz)
  1178. @var{frequency}, and filter-width @var{width}.
  1179. An all-pass filter changes the audio's frequency to phase relationship
  1180. without changing its frequency to amplitude relationship.
  1181. The filter accepts the following options:
  1182. @table @option
  1183. @item frequency, f
  1184. Set frequency in Hz.
  1185. @item width_type, t
  1186. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1187. @table @option
  1188. @item h
  1189. Hz
  1190. @item q
  1191. Q-Factor
  1192. @item o
  1193. octave
  1194. @item s
  1195. slope
  1196. @item k
  1197. kHz
  1198. @end table
  1199. @item width, w
  1200. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1201. @item mix, m
  1202. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1203. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1204. @item channels, c
  1205. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1206. @item normalize, n
  1207. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  1208. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  1209. @end table
  1210. @subsection Commands
  1211. This filter supports the following commands:
  1212. @table @option
  1213. @item frequency, f
  1214. Change allpass frequency.
  1215. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  1216. @item width_type, t
  1217. Change allpass width_type.
  1218. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  1219. @item width, w
  1220. Change allpass width.
  1221. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  1222. @item mix, m
  1223. Change allpass mix.
  1224. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  1225. @end table
  1226. @section aloop
  1227. Loop audio samples.
  1228. The filter accepts the following options:
  1229. @table @option
  1230. @item loop
  1231. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  1232. Default is 0.
  1233. @item size
  1234. Set maximal number of samples. Default is 0.
  1235. @item start
  1236. Set first sample of loop. Default is 0.
  1237. @end table
  1238. @anchor{amerge}
  1239. @section amerge
  1240. Merge two or more audio streams into a single multi-channel stream.
  1241. The filter accepts the following options:
  1242. @table @option
  1243. @item inputs
  1244. Set the number of inputs. Default is 2.
  1245. @end table
  1246. If the channel layouts of the inputs are disjoint, and therefore compatible,
  1247. the channel layout of the output will be set accordingly and the channels
  1248. will be reordered as necessary. If the channel layouts of the inputs are not
  1249. disjoint, the output will have all the channels of the first input then all
  1250. the channels of the second input, in that order, and the channel layout of
  1251. the output will be the default value corresponding to the total number of
  1252. channels.
  1253. For example, if the first input is in 2.1 (FL+FR+LF) and the second input
  1254. is FC+BL+BR, then the output will be in 5.1, with the channels in the
  1255. following order: a1, a2, b1, a3, b2, b3 (a1 is the first channel of the
  1256. first input, b1 is the first channel of the second input).
  1257. On the other hand, if both input are in stereo, the output channels will be
  1258. in the default order: a1, a2, b1, b2, and the channel layout will be
  1259. arbitrarily set to 4.0, which may or may not be the expected value.
  1260. All inputs must have the same sample rate, and format.
  1261. If inputs do not have the same duration, the output will stop with the
  1262. shortest.
  1263. @subsection Examples
  1264. @itemize
  1265. @item
  1266. Merge two mono files into a stereo stream:
  1267. @example
  1268. amovie=left.wav [l] ; amovie=right.mp3 [r] ; [l] [r] amerge
  1269. @end example
  1270. @item
  1271. Multiple merges assuming 1 video stream and 6 audio streams in @file{input.mkv}:
  1272. @example
  1273. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -filter_complex "[0:1][0:2][0:3][0:4][0:5][0:6] amerge=inputs=6" -c:a pcm_s16le output.mkv
  1274. @end example
  1275. @end itemize
  1276. @section amix
  1277. Mixes multiple audio inputs into a single output.
  1278. Note that this filter only supports float samples (the @var{amerge}
  1279. and @var{pan} audio filters support many formats). If the @var{amix}
  1280. input has integer samples then @ref{aresample} will be automatically
  1281. inserted to perform the conversion to float samples.
  1282. For example
  1283. @example
  1284. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex amix=inputs=3:duration=first:dropout_transition=3 OUTPUT
  1285. @end example
  1286. will mix 3 input audio streams to a single output with the same duration as the
  1287. first input and a dropout transition time of 3 seconds.
  1288. It accepts the following parameters:
  1289. @table @option
  1290. @item inputs
  1291. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  1292. @item duration
  1293. How to determine the end-of-stream.
  1294. @table @option
  1295. @item longest
  1296. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  1297. @item shortest
  1298. The duration of the shortest input.
  1299. @item first
  1300. The duration of the first input.
  1301. @end table
  1302. @item dropout_transition
  1303. The transition time, in seconds, for volume renormalization when an input
  1304. stream ends. The default value is 2 seconds.
  1305. @item weights
  1306. Specify weight of each input audio stream as sequence.
  1307. Each weight is separated by space. By default all inputs have same weight.
  1308. @end table
  1309. @section amultiply
  1310. Multiply first audio stream with second audio stream and store result
  1311. in output audio stream. Multiplication is done by multiplying each
  1312. sample from first stream with sample at same position from second stream.
  1313. With this element-wise multiplication one can create amplitude fades and
  1314. amplitude modulations.
  1315. @section anequalizer
  1316. High-order parametric multiband equalizer for each channel.
  1317. It accepts the following parameters:
  1318. @table @option
  1319. @item params
  1320. This option string is in format:
  1321. "c@var{chn} f=@var{cf} w=@var{w} g=@var{g} t=@var{f} | ..."
  1322. Each equalizer band is separated by '|'.
  1323. @table @option
  1324. @item chn
  1325. Set channel number to which equalization will be applied.
  1326. If input doesn't have that channel the entry is ignored.
  1327. @item f
  1328. Set central frequency for band.
  1329. If input doesn't have that frequency the entry is ignored.
  1330. @item w
  1331. Set band width in hertz.
  1332. @item g
  1333. Set band gain in dB.
  1334. @item t
  1335. Set filter type for band, optional, can be:
  1336. @table @samp
  1337. @item 0
  1338. Butterworth, this is default.
  1339. @item 1
  1340. Chebyshev type 1.
  1341. @item 2
  1342. Chebyshev type 2.
  1343. @end table
  1344. @end table
  1345. @item curves
  1346. With this option activated frequency response of anequalizer is displayed
  1347. in video stream.
  1348. @item size
  1349. Set video stream size. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1350. @item mgain
  1351. Set max gain that will be displayed. Only useful if curves option is activated.
  1352. Setting this to a reasonable value makes it possible to display gain which is derived from
  1353. neighbour bands which are too close to each other and thus produce higher gain
  1354. when both are activated.
  1355. @item fscale
  1356. Set frequency scale used to draw frequency response in video output.
  1357. Can be linear or logarithmic. Default is logarithmic.
  1358. @item colors
  1359. Set color for each channel curve which is going to be displayed in video stream.
  1360. This is list of color names separated by space or by '|'.
  1361. Unrecognised or missing colors will be replaced by white color.
  1362. @end table
  1363. @subsection Examples
  1364. @itemize
  1365. @item
  1366. Lower gain by 10 of central frequency 200Hz and width 100 Hz
  1367. for first 2 channels using Chebyshev type 1 filter:
  1368. @example
  1369. anequalizer=c0 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1|c1 f=200 w=100 g=-10 t=1
  1370. @end example
  1371. @end itemize
  1372. @subsection Commands
  1373. This filter supports the following commands:
  1374. @table @option
  1375. @item change
  1376. Alter existing filter parameters.
  1377. Syntax for the commands is : "@var{fN}|f=@var{freq}|w=@var{width}|g=@var{gain}"
  1378. @var{fN} is existing filter number, starting from 0, if no such filter is available
  1379. error is returned.
  1380. @var{freq} set new frequency parameter.
  1381. @var{width} set new width parameter in herz.
  1382. @var{gain} set new gain parameter in dB.
  1383. Full filter invocation with asendcmd may look like this:
  1384. asendcmd=c='4.0 anequalizer change 0|f=200|w=50|g=1',anequalizer=...
  1385. @end table
  1386. @section anlmdn
  1387. Reduce broadband noise in audio samples using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  1388. Each sample is adjusted by looking for other samples with similar contexts. This
  1389. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  1390. @option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r} around the sample.
  1391. The filter accepts the following options:
  1392. @table @option
  1393. @item s
  1394. Set denoising strength. Allowed range is from 0.00001 to 10. Default value is 0.00001.
  1395. @item p
  1396. Set patch radius duration. Allowed range is from 1 to 100 milliseconds.
  1397. Default value is 2 milliseconds.
  1398. @item r
  1399. Set research radius duration. Allowed range is from 2 to 300 milliseconds.
  1400. Default value is 6 milliseconds.
  1401. @item o
  1402. Set the output mode.
  1403. It accepts the following values:
  1404. @table @option
  1405. @item i
  1406. Pass input unchanged.
  1407. @item o
  1408. Pass noise filtered out.
  1409. @item n
  1410. Pass only noise.
  1411. Default value is @var{o}.
  1412. @end table
  1413. @item m
  1414. Set smooth factor. Default value is @var{11}. Allowed range is from @var{1} to @var{15}.
  1415. @end table
  1416. @subsection Commands
  1417. This filter supports the following commands:
  1418. @table @option
  1419. @item s
  1420. Change denoise strength. Argument is single float number.
  1421. Syntax for the command is : "@var{s}"
  1422. @item o
  1423. Change output mode.
  1424. Syntax for the command is : "i", "o" or "n" string.
  1425. @end table
  1426. @section anlms
  1427. Apply Normalized Least-Mean-Squares algorithm to the first audio stream using the second audio stream.
  1428. This adaptive filter is used to mimic a desired filter by finding the filter coefficients that
  1429. relate to producing the least mean square of the error signal (difference between the desired,
  1430. 2nd input audio stream and the actual signal, the 1st input audio stream).
  1431. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1432. @table @option
  1433. @item order
  1434. Set filter order.
  1435. @item mu
  1436. Set filter mu.
  1437. @item eps
  1438. Set the filter eps.
  1439. @item leakage
  1440. Set the filter leakage.
  1441. @item out_mode
  1442. It accepts the following values:
  1443. @table @option
  1444. @item i
  1445. Pass the 1st input.
  1446. @item d
  1447. Pass the 2nd input.
  1448. @item o
  1449. Pass filtered samples.
  1450. @item n
  1451. Pass difference between desired and filtered samples.
  1452. Default value is @var{o}.
  1453. @end table
  1454. @end table
  1455. @subsection Examples
  1456. @itemize
  1457. @item
  1458. One of many usages of this filter is noise reduction, input audio is filtered
  1459. with same samples that are delayed by fixed amount, one such example for stereo audio is:
  1460. @example
  1461. asplit[a][b],[a]adelay=32S|32S[a],[b][a]anlms=order=128:leakage=0.0005:mu=.5:out_mode=o
  1462. @end example
  1463. @end itemize
  1464. @subsection Commands
  1465. This filter supports the same commands as options, excluding option @code{order}.
  1466. @section anull
  1467. Pass the audio source unchanged to the output.
  1468. @section apad
  1469. Pad the end of an audio stream with silence.
  1470. This can be used together with @command{ffmpeg} @option{-shortest} to
  1471. extend audio streams to the same length as the video stream.
  1472. A description of the accepted options follows.
  1473. @table @option
  1474. @item packet_size
  1475. Set silence packet size. Default value is 4096.
  1476. @item pad_len
  1477. Set the number of samples of silence to add to the end. After the
  1478. value is reached, the stream is terminated. This option is mutually
  1479. exclusive with @option{whole_len}.
  1480. @item whole_len
  1481. Set the minimum total number of samples in the output audio stream. If
  1482. the value is longer than the input audio length, silence is added to
  1483. the end, until the value is reached. This option is mutually exclusive
  1484. with @option{pad_len}.
  1485. @item pad_dur
  1486. Specify the duration of samples of silence to add. See
  1487. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1488. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value.
  1489. @item whole_dur
  1490. Specify the minimum total duration in the output audio stream. See
  1491. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  1492. for the accepted syntax. Used only if set to non-zero value. If the value is longer than
  1493. the input audio length, silence is added to the end, until the value is reached.
  1494. This option is mutually exclusive with @option{pad_dur}
  1495. @end table
  1496. If neither the @option{pad_len} nor the @option{whole_len} nor @option{pad_dur}
  1497. nor @option{whole_dur} option is set, the filter will add silence to the end of
  1498. the input stream indefinitely.
  1499. @subsection Examples
  1500. @itemize
  1501. @item
  1502. Add 1024 samples of silence to the end of the input:
  1503. @example
  1504. apad=pad_len=1024
  1505. @end example
  1506. @item
  1507. Make sure the audio output will contain at least 10000 samples, pad
  1508. the input with silence if required:
  1509. @example
  1510. apad=whole_len=10000
  1511. @end example
  1512. @item
  1513. Use @command{ffmpeg} to pad the audio input with silence, so that the
  1514. video stream will always result the shortest and will be converted
  1515. until the end in the output file when using the @option{shortest}
  1516. option:
  1517. @example
  1518. ffmpeg -i VIDEO -i AUDIO -filter_complex "[1:0]apad" -shortest OUTPUT
  1519. @end example
  1520. @end itemize
  1521. @section aphaser
  1522. Add a phasing effect to the input audio.
  1523. A phaser filter creates series of peaks and troughs in the frequency spectrum.
  1524. The position of the peaks and troughs are modulated so that they vary over time, creating a sweeping effect.
  1525. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  1526. @table @option
  1527. @item in_gain
  1528. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  1529. @item out_gain
  1530. Set output gain. Default is 0.74
  1531. @item delay
  1532. Set delay in milliseconds. Default is 3.0.
  1533. @item decay
  1534. Set decay. Default is 0.4.
  1535. @item speed
  1536. Set modulation speed in Hz. Default is 0.5.
  1537. @item type
  1538. Set modulation type. Default is triangular.
  1539. It accepts the following values:
  1540. @table @samp
  1541. @item triangular, t
  1542. @item sinusoidal, s
  1543. @end table
  1544. @end table
  1545. @section apulsator
  1546. Audio pulsator is something between an autopanner and a tremolo.
  1547. But it can produce funny stereo effects as well. Pulsator changes the volume
  1548. of the left and right channel based on a LFO (low frequency oscillator) with
  1549. different waveforms and shifted phases.
  1550. This filter have the ability to define an offset between left and right
  1551. channel. An offset of 0 means that both LFO shapes match each other.
  1552. The left and right channel are altered equally - a conventional tremolo.
  1553. An offset of 50% means that the shape of the right channel is exactly shifted
  1554. in phase (or moved backwards about half of the frequency) - pulsator acts as
  1555. an autopanner. At 1 both curves match again. Every setting in between moves the
  1556. phase shift gapless between all stages and produces some "bypassing" sounds with
  1557. sine and triangle waveforms. The more you set the offset near 1 (starting from
  1558. the 0.5) the faster the signal passes from the left to the right speaker.
  1559. The filter accepts the following options:
  1560. @table @option
  1561. @item level_in
  1562. Set input gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1563. @item level_out
  1564. Set output gain. By default it is 1. Range is [0.015625 - 64].
  1565. @item mode
  1566. Set waveform shape the LFO will use. Can be one of: sine, triangle, square,
  1567. sawup or sawdown. Default is sine.
  1568. @item amount
  1569. Set modulation. Define how much of original signal is affected by the LFO.
  1570. @item offset_l
  1571. Set left channel offset. Default is 0. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1572. @item offset_r
  1573. Set right channel offset. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is [0 - 1].
  1574. @item width
  1575. Set pulse width. Default is 1. Allowed range is [0 - 2].
  1576. @item timing
  1577. Set possible timing mode. Can be one of: bpm, ms or hz. Default is hz.
  1578. @item bpm
  1579. Set bpm. Default is 120. Allowed range is [30 - 300]. Only used if timing
  1580. is set to bpm.
  1581. @item ms
  1582. Set ms. Default is 500. Allowed range is [10 - 2000]. Only used if timing
  1583. is set to ms.
  1584. @item hz
  1585. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 2. Allowed range is [0.01 - 100]. Only used
  1586. if timing is set to hz.
  1587. @end table
  1588. @anchor{aresample}
  1589. @section aresample
  1590. Resample the input audio to the specified parameters, using the
  1591. libswresample library. If none are specified then the filter will
  1592. automatically convert between its input and output.
  1593. This filter is also able to stretch/squeeze the audio data to make it match
  1594. the timestamps or to inject silence / cut out audio to make it match the
  1595. timestamps, do a combination of both or do neither.
  1596. The filter accepts the syntax
  1597. [@var{sample_rate}:]@var{resampler_options}, where @var{sample_rate}
  1598. expresses a sample rate and @var{resampler_options} is a list of
  1599. @var{key}=@var{value} pairs, separated by ":". See the
  1600. @ref{Resampler Options,,"Resampler Options" section in the
  1601. ffmpeg-resampler(1) manual,ffmpeg-resampler}
  1602. for the complete list of supported options.
  1603. @subsection Examples
  1604. @itemize
  1605. @item
  1606. Resample the input audio to 44100Hz:
  1607. @example
  1608. aresample=44100
  1609. @end example
  1610. @item
  1611. Stretch/squeeze samples to the given timestamps, with a maximum of 1000
  1612. samples per second compensation:
  1613. @example
  1614. aresample=async=1000
  1615. @end example
  1616. @end itemize
  1617. @section areverse
  1618. Reverse an audio clip.
  1619. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  1620. is suggested.
  1621. @subsection Examples
  1622. @itemize
  1623. @item
  1624. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  1625. @example
  1626. atrim=end=5,areverse
  1627. @end example
  1628. @end itemize
  1629. @section arnndn
  1630. Reduce noise from speech using Recurrent Neural Networks.
  1631. This filter accepts the following options:
  1632. @table @option
  1633. @item model, m
  1634. Set train model file to load. This option is always required.
  1635. @end table
  1636. @section asetnsamples
  1637. Set the number of samples per each output audio frame.
  1638. The last output packet may contain a different number of samples, as
  1639. the filter will flush all the remaining samples when the input audio
  1640. signals its end.
  1641. The filter accepts the following options:
  1642. @table @option
  1643. @item nb_out_samples, n
  1644. Set the number of frames per each output audio frame. The number is
  1645. intended as the number of samples @emph{per each channel}.
  1646. Default value is 1024.
  1647. @item pad, p
  1648. If set to 1, the filter will pad the last audio frame with zeroes, so
  1649. that the last frame will contain the same number of samples as the
  1650. previous ones. Default value is 1.
  1651. @end table
  1652. For example, to set the number of per-frame samples to 1234 and
  1653. disable padding for the last frame, use:
  1654. @example
  1655. asetnsamples=n=1234:p=0
  1656. @end example
  1657. @section asetrate
  1658. Set the sample rate without altering the PCM data.
  1659. This will result in a change of speed and pitch.
  1660. The filter accepts the following options:
  1661. @table @option
  1662. @item sample_rate, r
  1663. Set the output sample rate. Default is 44100 Hz.
  1664. @end table
  1665. @section ashowinfo
  1666. Show a line containing various information for each input audio frame.
  1667. The input audio is not modified.
  1668. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  1669. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  1670. The following values are shown in the output:
  1671. @table @option
  1672. @item n
  1673. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  1674. @item pts
  1675. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, in time base units; the time base
  1676. depends on the filter input pad, and is usually 1/@var{sample_rate}.
  1677. @item pts_time
  1678. The presentation timestamp of the input frame in seconds.
  1679. @item pos
  1680. position of the frame in the input stream, -1 if this information in
  1681. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic audio)
  1682. @item fmt
  1683. The sample format.
  1684. @item chlayout
  1685. The channel layout.
  1686. @item rate
  1687. The sample rate for the audio frame.
  1688. @item nb_samples
  1689. The number of samples (per channel) in the frame.
  1690. @item checksum
  1691. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of the audio data. For planar
  1692. audio, the data is treated as if all the planes were concatenated.
  1693. @item plane_checksums
  1694. A list of Adler-32 checksums for each data plane.
  1695. @end table
  1696. @section asoftclip
  1697. Apply audio soft clipping.
  1698. Soft clipping is a type of distortion effect where the amplitude of a signal is saturated
  1699. along a smooth curve, rather than the abrupt shape of hard-clipping.
  1700. This filter accepts the following options:
  1701. @table @option
  1702. @item type
  1703. Set type of soft-clipping.
  1704. It accepts the following values:
  1705. @table @option
  1706. @item tanh
  1707. @item atan
  1708. @item cubic
  1709. @item exp
  1710. @item alg
  1711. @item quintic
  1712. @item sin
  1713. @end table
  1714. @item param
  1715. Set additional parameter which controls sigmoid function.
  1716. @end table
  1717. @subsection Commands
  1718. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  1719. @section asr
  1720. Automatic Speech Recognition
  1721. This filter uses PocketSphinx for speech recognition. To enable
  1722. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  1723. @code{--enable-pocketsphinx}.
  1724. It accepts the following options:
  1725. @table @option
  1726. @item rate
  1727. Set sampling rate of input audio. Defaults is @code{16000}.
  1728. This need to match speech models, otherwise one will get poor results.
  1729. @item hmm
  1730. Set dictionary containing acoustic model files.
  1731. @item dict
  1732. Set pronunciation dictionary.
  1733. @item lm
  1734. Set language model file.
  1735. @item lmctl
  1736. Set language model set.
  1737. @item lmname
  1738. Set which language model to use.
  1739. @item logfn
  1740. Set output for log messages.
  1741. @end table
  1742. The filter exports recognized speech as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.asr.text}.
  1743. @anchor{astats}
  1744. @section astats
  1745. Display time domain statistical information about the audio channels.
  1746. Statistics are calculated and displayed for each audio channel and,
  1747. where applicable, an overall figure is also given.
  1748. It accepts the following option:
  1749. @table @option
  1750. @item length
  1751. Short window length in seconds, used for peak and trough RMS measurement.
  1752. Default is @code{0.05} (50 milliseconds). Allowed range is @code{[0.01 - 10]}.
  1753. @item metadata
  1754. Set metadata injection. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.astats.X},
  1755. where @code{X} is channel number starting from 1 or string @code{Overall}. Default is
  1756. disabled.
  1757. Available keys for each channel are:
  1758. DC_offset
  1759. Min_level
  1760. Max_level
  1761. Min_difference
  1762. Max_difference
  1763. Mean_difference
  1764. RMS_difference
  1765. Peak_level
  1766. RMS_peak
  1767. RMS_trough
  1768. Crest_factor
  1769. Flat_factor
  1770. Peak_count
  1771. Bit_depth
  1772. Dynamic_range
  1773. Zero_crossings
  1774. Zero_crossings_rate
  1775. Number_of_NaNs
  1776. Number_of_Infs
  1777. Number_of_denormals
  1778. and for Overall:
  1779. DC_offset
  1780. Min_level
  1781. Max_level
  1782. Min_difference
  1783. Max_difference
  1784. Mean_difference
  1785. RMS_difference
  1786. Peak_level
  1787. RMS_level
  1788. RMS_peak
  1789. RMS_trough
  1790. Flat_factor
  1791. Peak_count
  1792. Bit_depth
  1793. Number_of_samples
  1794. Number_of_NaNs
  1795. Number_of_Infs
  1796. Number_of_denormals
  1797. For example full key look like this @code{lavfi.astats.1.DC_offset} or
  1798. this @code{lavfi.astats.Overall.Peak_count}.
  1799. For description what each key means read below.
  1800. @item reset
  1801. Set number of frame after which stats are going to be recalculated.
  1802. Default is disabled.
  1803. @item measure_perchannel
  1804. Select the entries which need to be measured per channel. The metadata keys can
  1805. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1806. @option{none} disables all per channel measurement.
  1807. @item measure_overall
  1808. Select the entries which need to be measured overall. The metadata keys can
  1809. be used as flags, default is @option{all} which measures everything.
  1810. @option{none} disables all overall measurement.
  1811. @end table
  1812. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  1813. @table @option
  1814. @item DC offset
  1815. Mean amplitude displacement from zero.
  1816. @item Min level
  1817. Minimal sample level.
  1818. @item Max level
  1819. Maximal sample level.
  1820. @item Min difference
  1821. Minimal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1822. @item Max difference
  1823. Maximal difference between two consecutive samples.
  1824. @item Mean difference
  1825. Mean difference between two consecutive samples.
  1826. The average of each difference between two consecutive samples.
  1827. @item RMS difference
  1828. Root Mean Square difference between two consecutive samples.
  1829. @item Peak level dB
  1830. @item RMS level dB
  1831. Standard peak and RMS level measured in dBFS.
  1832. @item RMS peak dB
  1833. @item RMS trough dB
  1834. Peak and trough values for RMS level measured over a short window.
  1835. @item Crest factor
  1836. Standard ratio of peak to RMS level (note: not in dB).
  1837. @item Flat factor
  1838. Flatness (i.e. consecutive samples with the same value) of the signal at its peak levels
  1839. (i.e. either @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}).
  1840. @item Peak count
  1841. Number of occasions (not the number of samples) that the signal attained either
  1842. @var{Min level} or @var{Max level}.
  1843. @item Bit depth
  1844. Overall bit depth of audio. Number of bits used for each sample.
  1845. @item Dynamic range
  1846. Measured dynamic range of audio in dB.
  1847. @item Zero crossings
  1848. Number of points where the waveform crosses the zero level axis.
  1849. @item Zero crossings rate
  1850. Rate of Zero crossings and number of audio samples.
  1851. @end table
  1852. @section atempo
  1853. Adjust audio tempo.
  1854. The filter accepts exactly one parameter, the audio tempo. If not
  1855. specified then the filter will assume nominal 1.0 tempo. Tempo must
  1856. be in the [0.5, 100.0] range.
  1857. Note that tempo greater than 2 will skip some samples rather than
  1858. blend them in. If for any reason this is a concern it is always
  1859. possible to daisy-chain several instances of atempo to achieve the
  1860. desired product tempo.
  1861. @subsection Examples
  1862. @itemize
  1863. @item
  1864. Slow down audio to 80% tempo:
  1865. @example
  1866. atempo=0.8
  1867. @end example
  1868. @item
  1869. To speed up audio to 300% tempo:
  1870. @example
  1871. atempo=3
  1872. @end example
  1873. @item
  1874. To speed up audio to 300% tempo by daisy-chaining two atempo instances:
  1875. @example
  1876. atempo=sqrt(3),atempo=sqrt(3)
  1877. @end example
  1878. @end itemize
  1879. @subsection Commands
  1880. This filter supports the following commands:
  1881. @table @option
  1882. @item tempo
  1883. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  1884. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  1885. @end table
  1886. @section atrim
  1887. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  1888. It accepts the following parameters:
  1889. @table @option
  1890. @item start
  1891. Timestamp (in seconds) of the start of the section to keep. I.e. the audio
  1892. sample with the timestamp @var{start} will be the first sample in the output.
  1893. @item end
  1894. Specify time of the first audio sample that will be dropped, i.e. the
  1895. audio sample immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be
  1896. the last sample in the output.
  1897. @item start_pts
  1898. Same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp in samples
  1899. instead of seconds.
  1900. @item end_pts
  1901. Same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp in samples instead
  1902. of seconds.
  1903. @item duration
  1904. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  1905. @item start_sample
  1906. The number of the first sample that should be output.
  1907. @item end_sample
  1908. The number of the first sample that should be dropped.
  1909. @end table
  1910. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  1911. duration specifications; see
  1912. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  1913. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  1914. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _sample options simply count the
  1915. samples that pass through the filter. So start/end_pts and start/end_sample will
  1916. give different results when the timestamps are wrong, inexact or do not start at
  1917. zero. Also note that this filter does not modify the timestamps. If you wish
  1918. to have the output timestamps start at zero, insert the asetpts filter after the
  1919. atrim filter.
  1920. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  1921. keep all samples that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  1922. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple atrim
  1923. filters.
  1924. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  1925. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  1926. Examples:
  1927. @itemize
  1928. @item
  1929. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  1930. @example
  1931. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=60:120
  1932. @end example
  1933. @item
  1934. Keep only the first 1000 samples:
  1935. @example
  1936. ffmpeg -i INPUT -af atrim=end_sample=1000
  1937. @end example
  1938. @end itemize
  1939. @section axcorrelate
  1940. Calculate normalized cross-correlation between two input audio streams.
  1941. Resulted samples are always between -1 and 1 inclusive.
  1942. If result is 1 it means two input samples are highly correlated in that selected segment.
  1943. Result 0 means they are not correlated at all.
  1944. If result is -1 it means two input samples are out of phase, which means they cancel each
  1945. other.
  1946. The filter accepts the following options:
  1947. @table @option
  1948. @item size
  1949. Set size of segment over which cross-correlation is calculated.
  1950. Default is 256. Allowed range is from 2 to 131072.
  1951. @item algo
  1952. Set algorithm for cross-correlation. Can be @code{slow} or @code{fast}.
  1953. Default is @code{slow}. Fast algorithm assumes mean values over any given segment
  1954. are always zero and thus need much less calculations to make.
  1955. This is generally not true, but is valid for typical audio streams.
  1956. @end table
  1957. @subsection Examples
  1958. @itemize
  1959. @item
  1960. Calculate correlation between channels in stereo audio stream:
  1961. @example
  1962. ffmpeg -i stereo.wav -af channelsplit,axcorrelate=size=1024:algo=fast correlation.wav
  1963. @end example
  1964. @end itemize
  1965. @section bandpass
  1966. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-pass filter with central
  1967. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width width.
  1968. The @var{csg} option selects a constant skirt gain (peak gain = Q)
  1969. instead of the default: constant 0dB peak gain.
  1970. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  1971. The filter accepts the following options:
  1972. @table @option
  1973. @item frequency, f
  1974. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  1975. @item csg
  1976. Constant skirt gain if set to 1. Defaults to 0.
  1977. @item width_type, t
  1978. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  1979. @table @option
  1980. @item h
  1981. Hz
  1982. @item q
  1983. Q-Factor
  1984. @item o
  1985. octave
  1986. @item s
  1987. slope
  1988. @item k
  1989. kHz
  1990. @end table
  1991. @item width, w
  1992. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  1993. @item mix, m
  1994. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  1995. Range is between 0 and 1.
  1996. @item channels, c
  1997. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  1998. @item normalize, n
  1999. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2000. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2001. @end table
  2002. @subsection Commands
  2003. This filter supports the following commands:
  2004. @table @option
  2005. @item frequency, f
  2006. Change bandpass frequency.
  2007. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2008. @item width_type, t
  2009. Change bandpass width_type.
  2010. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2011. @item width, w
  2012. Change bandpass width.
  2013. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2014. @item mix, m
  2015. Change bandpass mix.
  2016. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2017. @end table
  2018. @section bandreject
  2019. Apply a two-pole Butterworth band-reject filter with central
  2020. frequency @var{frequency}, and (3dB-point) band-width @var{width}.
  2021. The filter roll off at 6dB per octave (20dB per decade).
  2022. The filter accepts the following options:
  2023. @table @option
  2024. @item frequency, f
  2025. Set the filter's central frequency. Default is @code{3000}.
  2026. @item width_type, t
  2027. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2028. @table @option
  2029. @item h
  2030. Hz
  2031. @item q
  2032. Q-Factor
  2033. @item o
  2034. octave
  2035. @item s
  2036. slope
  2037. @item k
  2038. kHz
  2039. @end table
  2040. @item width, w
  2041. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2042. @item mix, m
  2043. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2044. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2045. @item channels, c
  2046. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2047. @item normalize, n
  2048. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2049. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2050. @end table
  2051. @subsection Commands
  2052. This filter supports the following commands:
  2053. @table @option
  2054. @item frequency, f
  2055. Change bandreject frequency.
  2056. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2057. @item width_type, t
  2058. Change bandreject width_type.
  2059. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2060. @item width, w
  2061. Change bandreject width.
  2062. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2063. @item mix, m
  2064. Change bandreject mix.
  2065. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2066. @end table
  2067. @section bass, lowshelf
  2068. Boost or cut the bass (lower) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  2069. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  2070. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  2071. The filter accepts the following options:
  2072. @table @option
  2073. @item gain, g
  2074. Give the gain at 0 Hz. Its useful range is about -20
  2075. (for a large cut) to +20 (for a large boost).
  2076. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2077. @item frequency, f
  2078. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  2079. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  2080. The default value is @code{100} Hz.
  2081. @item width_type, t
  2082. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2083. @table @option
  2084. @item h
  2085. Hz
  2086. @item q
  2087. Q-Factor
  2088. @item o
  2089. octave
  2090. @item s
  2091. slope
  2092. @item k
  2093. kHz
  2094. @end table
  2095. @item width, w
  2096. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  2097. @item mix, m
  2098. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2099. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2100. @item channels, c
  2101. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2102. @item normalize, n
  2103. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2104. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2105. @end table
  2106. @subsection Commands
  2107. This filter supports the following commands:
  2108. @table @option
  2109. @item frequency, f
  2110. Change bass frequency.
  2111. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2112. @item width_type, t
  2113. Change bass width_type.
  2114. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2115. @item width, w
  2116. Change bass width.
  2117. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2118. @item gain, g
  2119. Change bass gain.
  2120. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2121. @item mix, m
  2122. Change bass mix.
  2123. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2124. @end table
  2125. @section biquad
  2126. Apply a biquad IIR filter with the given coefficients.
  2127. Where @var{b0}, @var{b1}, @var{b2} and @var{a0}, @var{a1}, @var{a2}
  2128. are the numerator and denominator coefficients respectively.
  2129. and @var{channels}, @var{c} specify which channels to filter, by default all
  2130. available are filtered.
  2131. @subsection Commands
  2132. This filter supports the following commands:
  2133. @table @option
  2134. @item a0
  2135. @item a1
  2136. @item a2
  2137. @item b0
  2138. @item b1
  2139. @item b2
  2140. Change biquad parameter.
  2141. Syntax for the command is : "@var{value}"
  2142. @item mix, m
  2143. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2144. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2145. @item channels, c
  2146. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2147. @item normalize, n
  2148. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2149. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2150. @end table
  2151. @section bs2b
  2152. Bauer stereo to binaural transformation, which improves headphone listening of
  2153. stereo audio records.
  2154. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  2155. @code{--enable-libbs2b}.
  2156. It accepts the following parameters:
  2157. @table @option
  2158. @item profile
  2159. Pre-defined crossfeed level.
  2160. @table @option
  2161. @item default
  2162. Default level (fcut=700, feed=50).
  2163. @item cmoy
  2164. Chu Moy circuit (fcut=700, feed=60).
  2165. @item jmeier
  2166. Jan Meier circuit (fcut=650, feed=95).
  2167. @end table
  2168. @item fcut
  2169. Cut frequency (in Hz).
  2170. @item feed
  2171. Feed level (in Hz).
  2172. @end table
  2173. @section channelmap
  2174. Remap input channels to new locations.
  2175. It accepts the following parameters:
  2176. @table @option
  2177. @item map
  2178. Map channels from input to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  2179. mappings, each in the @code{@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}} or
  2180. @var{in_channel} form. @var{in_channel} can be either the name of the input
  2181. channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its index in the input channel layout.
  2182. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output channel or its index in the output
  2183. channel layout. If @var{out_channel} is not given then it is implicitly an
  2184. index, starting with zero and increasing by one for each mapping.
  2185. @item channel_layout
  2186. The channel layout of the output stream.
  2187. @end table
  2188. If no mapping is present, the filter will implicitly map input channels to
  2189. output channels, preserving indices.
  2190. @subsection Examples
  2191. @itemize
  2192. @item
  2193. For example, assuming a 5.1+downmix input MOV file,
  2194. @example
  2195. ffmpeg -i in.mov -filter 'channelmap=map=DL-FL|DR-FR' out.wav
  2196. @end example
  2197. will create an output WAV file tagged as stereo from the downmix channels of
  2198. the input.
  2199. @item
  2200. To fix a 5.1 WAV improperly encoded in AAC's native channel order
  2201. @example
  2202. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter 'channelmap=1|2|0|5|3|4:5.1' out.wav
  2203. @end example
  2204. @end itemize
  2205. @section channelsplit
  2206. Split each channel from an input audio stream into a separate output stream.
  2207. It accepts the following parameters:
  2208. @table @option
  2209. @item channel_layout
  2210. The channel layout of the input stream. The default is "stereo".
  2211. @item channels
  2212. A channel layout describing the channels to be extracted as separate output streams
  2213. or "all" to extract each input channel as a separate stream. The default is "all".
  2214. Choosing channels not present in channel layout in the input will result in an error.
  2215. @end table
  2216. @subsection Examples
  2217. @itemize
  2218. @item
  2219. For example, assuming a stereo input MP3 file,
  2220. @example
  2221. ffmpeg -i in.mp3 -filter_complex channelsplit out.mkv
  2222. @end example
  2223. will create an output Matroska file with two audio streams, one containing only
  2224. the left channel and the other the right channel.
  2225. @item
  2226. Split a 5.1 WAV file into per-channel files:
  2227. @example
  2228. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex
  2229. 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1[FL][FR][FC][LFE][SL][SR]'
  2230. -map '[FL]' front_left.wav -map '[FR]' front_right.wav -map '[FC]'
  2231. front_center.wav -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav -map '[SL]' side_left.wav -map '[SR]'
  2232. side_right.wav
  2233. @end example
  2234. @item
  2235. Extract only LFE from a 5.1 WAV file:
  2236. @example
  2237. ffmpeg -i in.wav -filter_complex 'channelsplit=channel_layout=5.1:channels=LFE[LFE]'
  2238. -map '[LFE]' lfe.wav
  2239. @end example
  2240. @end itemize
  2241. @section chorus
  2242. Add a chorus effect to the audio.
  2243. Can make a single vocal sound like a chorus, but can also be applied to instrumentation.
  2244. Chorus resembles an echo effect with a short delay, but whereas with echo the delay is
  2245. constant, with chorus, it is varied using using sinusoidal or triangular modulation.
  2246. The modulation depth defines the range the modulated delay is played before or after
  2247. the delay. Hence the delayed sound will sound slower or faster, that is the delayed
  2248. sound tuned around the original one, like in a chorus where some vocals are slightly
  2249. off key.
  2250. It accepts the following parameters:
  2251. @table @option
  2252. @item in_gain
  2253. Set input gain. Default is 0.4.
  2254. @item out_gain
  2255. Set output gain. Default is 0.4.
  2256. @item delays
  2257. Set delays. A typical delay is around 40ms to 60ms.
  2258. @item decays
  2259. Set decays.
  2260. @item speeds
  2261. Set speeds.
  2262. @item depths
  2263. Set depths.
  2264. @end table
  2265. @subsection Examples
  2266. @itemize
  2267. @item
  2268. A single delay:
  2269. @example
  2270. chorus=0.7:0.9:55:0.4:0.25:2
  2271. @end example
  2272. @item
  2273. Two delays:
  2274. @example
  2275. chorus=0.6:0.9:50|60:0.4|0.32:0.25|0.4:2|1.3
  2276. @end example
  2277. @item
  2278. Fuller sounding chorus with three delays:
  2279. @example
  2280. chorus=0.5:0.9:50|60|40:0.4|0.32|0.3:0.25|0.4|0.3:2|2.3|1.3
  2281. @end example
  2282. @end itemize
  2283. @section compand
  2284. Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  2285. It accepts the following parameters:
  2286. @table @option
  2287. @item attacks
  2288. @item decays
  2289. A list of times in seconds for each channel over which the instantaneous level
  2290. of the input signal is averaged to determine its volume. @var{attacks} refers to
  2291. increase of volume and @var{decays} refers to decrease of volume. For most
  2292. situations, the attack time (response to the audio getting louder) should be
  2293. shorter than the decay time, because the human ear is more sensitive to sudden
  2294. loud audio than sudden soft audio. A typical value for attack is 0.3 seconds and
  2295. a typical value for decay is 0.8 seconds.
  2296. If specified number of attacks & decays is lower than number of channels, the last
  2297. set attack/decay will be used for all remaining channels.
  2298. @item points
  2299. A list of points for the transfer function, specified in dB relative to the
  2300. maximum possible signal amplitude. Each key points list must be defined using
  2301. the following syntax: @code{x0/y0|x1/y1|x2/y2|....} or
  2302. @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ....}
  2303. The input values must be in strictly increasing order but the transfer function
  2304. does not have to be monotonically rising. The point @code{0/0} is assumed but
  2305. may be overridden (by @code{0/out-dBn}). Typical values for the transfer
  2306. function are @code{-70/-70|-60/-20|1/0}.
  2307. @item soft-knee
  2308. Set the curve radius in dB for all joints. It defaults to 0.01.
  2309. @item gain
  2310. Set the additional gain in dB to be applied at all points on the transfer
  2311. function. This allows for easy adjustment of the overall gain.
  2312. It defaults to 0.
  2313. @item volume
  2314. Set an initial volume, in dB, to be assumed for each channel when filtering
  2315. starts. This permits the user to supply a nominal level initially, so that, for
  2316. example, a very large gain is not applied to initial signal levels before the
  2317. companding has begun to operate. A typical value for audio which is initially
  2318. quiet is -90 dB. It defaults to 0.
  2319. @item delay
  2320. Set a delay, in seconds. The input audio is analyzed immediately, but audio is
  2321. delayed before being fed to the volume adjuster. Specifying a delay
  2322. approximately equal to the attack/decay times allows the filter to effectively
  2323. operate in predictive rather than reactive mode. It defaults to 0.
  2324. @end table
  2325. @subsection Examples
  2326. @itemize
  2327. @item
  2328. Make music with both quiet and loud passages suitable for listening to in a
  2329. noisy environment:
  2330. @example
  2331. compand=.3|.3:1|1:-90/-60|-60/-40|-40/-30|-20/-20:6:0:-90:0.2
  2332. @end example
  2333. Another example for audio with whisper and explosion parts:
  2334. @example
  2335. compand=0|0:1|1:-90/-900|-70/-70|-30/-9|0/-3:6:0:0:0
  2336. @end example
  2337. @item
  2338. A noise gate for when the noise is at a lower level than the signal:
  2339. @example
  2340. compand=.1|.1:.2|.2:-900/-900|-50.1/-900|-50/-50:.01:0:-90:.1
  2341. @end example
  2342. @item
  2343. Here is another noise gate, this time for when the noise is at a higher level
  2344. than the signal (making it, in some ways, similar to squelch):
  2345. @example
  2346. compand=.1|.1:.1|.1:-45.1/-45.1|-45/-900|0/-900:.01:45:-90:.1
  2347. @end example
  2348. @item
  2349. 2:1 compression starting at -6dB:
  2350. @example
  2351. compand=points=-80/-80|-6/-6|0/-3.8|20/3.5
  2352. @end example
  2353. @item
  2354. 2:1 compression starting at -9dB:
  2355. @example
  2356. compand=points=-80/-80|-9/-9|0/-5.3|20/2.9
  2357. @end example
  2358. @item
  2359. 2:1 compression starting at -12dB:
  2360. @example
  2361. compand=points=-80/-80|-12/-12|0/-6.8|20/1.9
  2362. @end example
  2363. @item
  2364. 2:1 compression starting at -18dB:
  2365. @example
  2366. compand=points=-80/-80|-18/-18|0/-9.8|20/0.7
  2367. @end example
  2368. @item
  2369. 3:1 compression starting at -15dB:
  2370. @example
  2371. compand=points=-80/-80|-15/-15|0/-10.8|20/-5.2
  2372. @end example
  2373. @item
  2374. Compressor/Gate:
  2375. @example
  2376. compand=points=-80/-105|-62/-80|-15.4/-15.4|0/-12|20/-7.6
  2377. @end example
  2378. @item
  2379. Expander:
  2380. @example
  2381. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-169|-54/-80|-49.5/-64.6|-41.1/-41.1|-25.8/-15|-10.8/-4.5|0/0|20/8.3
  2382. @end example
  2383. @item
  2384. Hard limiter at -6dB:
  2385. @example
  2386. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-6/-6|20/-6
  2387. @end example
  2388. @item
  2389. Hard limiter at -12dB:
  2390. @example
  2391. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12/-12|20/-12
  2392. @end example
  2393. @item
  2394. Hard noise gate at -35 dB:
  2395. @example
  2396. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-115|-35.1/-80|-35/-35|20/20
  2397. @end example
  2398. @item
  2399. Soft limiter:
  2400. @example
  2401. compand=attacks=0:points=-80/-80|-12.4/-12.4|-6/-8|0/-6.8|20/-2.8
  2402. @end example
  2403. @end itemize
  2404. @section compensationdelay
  2405. Compensation Delay Line is a metric based delay to compensate differing
  2406. positions of microphones or speakers.
  2407. For example, you have recorded guitar with two microphones placed in
  2408. different locations. Because the front of sound wave has fixed speed in
  2409. normal conditions, the phasing of microphones can vary and depends on
  2410. their location and interposition. The best sound mix can be achieved when
  2411. these microphones are in phase (synchronized). Note that a distance of
  2412. ~30 cm between microphones makes one microphone capture the signal in
  2413. antiphase to the other microphone. That makes the final mix sound moody.
  2414. This filter helps to solve phasing problems by adding different delays
  2415. to each microphone track and make them synchronized.
  2416. The best result can be reached when you take one track as base and
  2417. synchronize other tracks one by one with it.
  2418. Remember that synchronization/delay tolerance depends on sample rate, too.
  2419. Higher sample rates will give more tolerance.
  2420. The filter accepts the following parameters:
  2421. @table @option
  2422. @item mm
  2423. Set millimeters distance. This is compensation distance for fine tuning.
  2424. Default is 0.
  2425. @item cm
  2426. Set cm distance. This is compensation distance for tightening distance setup.
  2427. Default is 0.
  2428. @item m
  2429. Set meters distance. This is compensation distance for hard distance setup.
  2430. Default is 0.
  2431. @item dry
  2432. Set dry amount. Amount of unprocessed (dry) signal.
  2433. Default is 0.
  2434. @item wet
  2435. Set wet amount. Amount of processed (wet) signal.
  2436. Default is 1.
  2437. @item temp
  2438. Set temperature in degrees Celsius. This is the temperature of the environment.
  2439. Default is 20.
  2440. @end table
  2441. @section crossfeed
  2442. Apply headphone crossfeed filter.
  2443. Crossfeed is the process of blending the left and right channels of stereo
  2444. audio recording.
  2445. It is mainly used to reduce extreme stereo separation of low frequencies.
  2446. The intent is to produce more speaker like sound to the listener.
  2447. The filter accepts the following options:
  2448. @table @option
  2449. @item strength
  2450. Set strength of crossfeed. Default is 0.2. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2451. This sets gain of low shelf filter for side part of stereo image.
  2452. Default is -6dB. Max allowed is -30db when strength is set to 1.
  2453. @item range
  2454. Set soundstage wideness. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2455. This sets cut off frequency of low shelf filter. Default is cut off near
  2456. 1550 Hz. With range set to 1 cut off frequency is set to 2100 Hz.
  2457. @item level_in
  2458. Set input gain. Default is 0.9.
  2459. @item level_out
  2460. Set output gain. Default is 1.
  2461. @end table
  2462. @section crystalizer
  2463. Simple algorithm to expand audio dynamic range.
  2464. The filter accepts the following options:
  2465. @table @option
  2466. @item i
  2467. Sets the intensity of effect (default: 2.0). Must be in range between 0.0
  2468. (unchanged sound) to 10.0 (maximum effect).
  2469. @item c
  2470. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2471. @end table
  2472. @subsection Commands
  2473. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2474. @section dcshift
  2475. Apply a DC shift to the audio.
  2476. This can be useful to remove a DC offset (caused perhaps by a hardware problem
  2477. in the recording chain) from the audio. The effect of a DC offset is reduced
  2478. headroom and hence volume. The @ref{astats} filter can be used to determine if
  2479. a signal has a DC offset.
  2480. @table @option
  2481. @item shift
  2482. Set the DC shift, allowed range is [-1, 1]. It indicates the amount to shift
  2483. the audio.
  2484. @item limitergain
  2485. Optional. It should have a value much less than 1 (e.g. 0.05 or 0.02) and is
  2486. used to prevent clipping.
  2487. @end table
  2488. @section deesser
  2489. Apply de-essing to the audio samples.
  2490. @table @option
  2491. @item i
  2492. Set intensity for triggering de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2493. Default is 0.
  2494. @item m
  2495. Set amount of ducking on treble part of sound. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2496. Default is 0.5.
  2497. @item f
  2498. How much of original frequency content to keep when de-essing. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  2499. Default is 0.5.
  2500. @item s
  2501. Set the output mode.
  2502. It accepts the following values:
  2503. @table @option
  2504. @item i
  2505. Pass input unchanged.
  2506. @item o
  2507. Pass ess filtered out.
  2508. @item e
  2509. Pass only ess.
  2510. Default value is @var{o}.
  2511. @end table
  2512. @end table
  2513. @section drmeter
  2514. Measure audio dynamic range.
  2515. DR values of 14 and higher is found in very dynamic material. DR of 8 to 13
  2516. is found in transition material. And anything less that 8 have very poor dynamics
  2517. and is very compressed.
  2518. The filter accepts the following options:
  2519. @table @option
  2520. @item length
  2521. Set window length in seconds used to split audio into segments of equal length.
  2522. Default is 3 seconds.
  2523. @end table
  2524. @section dynaudnorm
  2525. Dynamic Audio Normalizer.
  2526. This filter applies a certain amount of gain to the input audio in order
  2527. to bring its peak magnitude to a target level (e.g. 0 dBFS). However, in
  2528. contrast to more "simple" normalization algorithms, the Dynamic Audio
  2529. Normalizer *dynamically* re-adjusts the gain factor to the input audio.
  2530. This allows for applying extra gain to the "quiet" sections of the audio
  2531. while avoiding distortions or clipping the "loud" sections. In other words:
  2532. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer will "even out" the volume of quiet and loud
  2533. sections, in the sense that the volume of each section is brought to the
  2534. same target level. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer achieves
  2535. this goal *without* applying "dynamic range compressing". It will retain 100%
  2536. of the dynamic range *within* each section of the audio file.
  2537. @table @option
  2538. @item framelen, f
  2539. Set the frame length in milliseconds. In range from 10 to 8000 milliseconds.
  2540. Default is 500 milliseconds.
  2541. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer processes the input audio in small chunks,
  2542. referred to as frames. This is required, because a peak magnitude has no
  2543. meaning for just a single sample value. Instead, we need to determine the
  2544. peak magnitude for a contiguous sequence of sample values. While a "standard"
  2545. normalizer would simply use the peak magnitude of the complete file, the
  2546. Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the peak magnitude individually for each
  2547. frame. The length of a frame is specified in milliseconds. By default, the
  2548. Dynamic Audio Normalizer uses a frame length of 500 milliseconds, which has
  2549. been found to give good results with most files.
  2550. Note that the exact frame length, in number of samples, will be determined
  2551. automatically, based on the sampling rate of the individual input audio file.
  2552. @item gausssize, g
  2553. Set the Gaussian filter window size. In range from 3 to 301, must be odd
  2554. number. Default is 31.
  2555. Probably the most important parameter of the Dynamic Audio Normalizer is the
  2556. @code{window size} of the Gaussian smoothing filter. The filter's window size
  2557. is specified in frames, centered around the current frame. For the sake of
  2558. simplicity, this must be an odd number. Consequently, the default value of 31
  2559. takes into account the current frame, as well as the 15 preceding frames and
  2560. the 15 subsequent frames. Using a larger window results in a stronger
  2561. smoothing effect and thus in less gain variation, i.e. slower gain
  2562. adaptation. Conversely, using a smaller window results in a weaker smoothing
  2563. effect and thus in more gain variation, i.e. faster gain adaptation.
  2564. In other words, the more you increase this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2565. Normalizer will behave like a "traditional" normalization filter. On the
  2566. contrary, the more you decrease this value, the more the Dynamic Audio
  2567. Normalizer will behave like a dynamic range compressor.
  2568. @item peak, p
  2569. Set the target peak value. This specifies the highest permissible magnitude
  2570. level for the normalized audio input. This filter will try to approach the
  2571. target peak magnitude as closely as possible, but at the same time it also
  2572. makes sure that the normalized signal will never exceed the peak magnitude.
  2573. A frame's maximum local gain factor is imposed directly by the target peak
  2574. magnitude. The default value is 0.95 and thus leaves a headroom of 5%*.
  2575. It is not recommended to go above this value.
  2576. @item maxgain, m
  2577. Set the maximum gain factor. In range from 1.0 to 100.0. Default is 10.0.
  2578. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer determines the maximum possible (local) gain
  2579. factor for each input frame, i.e. the maximum gain factor that does not
  2580. result in clipping or distortion. The maximum gain factor is determined by
  2581. the frame's highest magnitude sample. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer
  2582. additionally bounds the frame's maximum gain factor by a predetermined
  2583. (global) maximum gain factor. This is done in order to avoid excessive gain
  2584. factors in "silent" or almost silent frames. By default, the maximum gain
  2585. factor is 10.0, For most inputs the default value should be sufficient and
  2586. it usually is not recommended to increase this value. Though, for input
  2587. with an extremely low overall volume level, it may be necessary to allow even
  2588. higher gain factors. Note, however, that the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does
  2589. not simply apply a "hard" threshold (i.e. cut off values above the threshold).
  2590. Instead, a "sigmoid" threshold function will be applied. This way, the
  2591. gain factors will smoothly approach the threshold value, but never exceed that
  2592. value.
  2593. @item targetrms, r
  2594. Set the target RMS. In range from 0.0 to 1.0. Default is 0.0 - disabled.
  2595. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer performs "peak" normalization.
  2596. This means that the maximum local gain factor for each frame is defined
  2597. (only) by the frame's highest magnitude sample. This way, the samples can
  2598. be amplified as much as possible without exceeding the maximum signal
  2599. level, i.e. without clipping. Optionally, however, the Dynamic Audio
  2600. Normalizer can also take into account the frame's root mean square,
  2601. abbreviated RMS. In electrical engineering, the RMS is commonly used to
  2602. determine the power of a time-varying signal. It is therefore considered
  2603. that the RMS is a better approximation of the "perceived loudness" than
  2604. just looking at the signal's peak magnitude. Consequently, by adjusting all
  2605. frames to a constant RMS value, a uniform "perceived loudness" can be
  2606. established. If a target RMS value has been specified, a frame's local gain
  2607. factor is defined as the factor that would result in exactly that RMS value.
  2608. Note, however, that the maximum local gain factor is still restricted by the
  2609. frame's highest magnitude sample, in order to prevent clipping.
  2610. @item coupling, n
  2611. Enable channels coupling. By default is enabled.
  2612. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will amplify all channels by the same
  2613. amount. This means the same gain factor will be applied to all channels, i.e.
  2614. the maximum possible gain factor is determined by the "loudest" channel.
  2615. However, in some recordings, it may happen that the volume of the different
  2616. channels is uneven, e.g. one channel may be "quieter" than the other one(s).
  2617. In this case, this option can be used to disable the channel coupling. This way,
  2618. the gain factor will be determined independently for each channel, depending
  2619. only on the individual channel's highest magnitude sample. This allows for
  2620. harmonizing the volume of the different channels.
  2621. @item correctdc, c
  2622. Enable DC bias correction. By default is disabled.
  2623. An audio signal (in the time domain) is a sequence of sample values.
  2624. In the Dynamic Audio Normalizer these sample values are represented in the
  2625. -1.0 to 1.0 range, regardless of the original input format. Normally, the
  2626. audio signal, or "waveform", should be centered around the zero point.
  2627. That means if we calculate the mean value of all samples in a file, or in a
  2628. single frame, then the result should be 0.0 or at least very close to that
  2629. value. If, however, there is a significant deviation of the mean value from
  2630. 0.0, in either positive or negative direction, this is referred to as a
  2631. DC bias or DC offset. Since a DC bias is clearly undesirable, the Dynamic
  2632. Audio Normalizer provides optional DC bias correction.
  2633. With DC bias correction enabled, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer will determine
  2634. the mean value, or "DC correction" offset, of each input frame and subtract
  2635. that value from all of the frame's sample values which ensures those samples
  2636. are centered around 0.0 again. Also, in order to avoid "gaps" at the frame
  2637. boundaries, the DC correction offset values will be interpolated smoothly
  2638. between neighbouring frames.
  2639. @item altboundary, b
  2640. Enable alternative boundary mode. By default is disabled.
  2641. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer takes into account a certain neighbourhood
  2642. around each frame. This includes the preceding frames as well as the
  2643. subsequent frames. However, for the "boundary" frames, located at the very
  2644. beginning and at the very end of the audio file, not all neighbouring
  2645. frames are available. In particular, for the first few frames in the audio
  2646. file, the preceding frames are not known. And, similarly, for the last few
  2647. frames in the audio file, the subsequent frames are not known. Thus, the
  2648. question arises which gain factors should be assumed for the missing frames
  2649. in the "boundary" region. The Dynamic Audio Normalizer implements two modes
  2650. to deal with this situation. The default boundary mode assumes a gain factor
  2651. of exactly 1.0 for the missing frames, resulting in a smooth "fade in" and
  2652. "fade out" at the beginning and at the end of the input, respectively.
  2653. @item compress, s
  2654. Set the compress factor. In range from 0.0 to 30.0. Default is 0.0.
  2655. By default, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not apply "traditional"
  2656. compression. This means that signal peaks will not be pruned and thus the
  2657. full dynamic range will be retained within each local neighbourhood. However,
  2658. in some cases it may be desirable to combine the Dynamic Audio Normalizer's
  2659. normalization algorithm with a more "traditional" compression.
  2660. For this purpose, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer provides an optional compression
  2661. (thresholding) function. If (and only if) the compression feature is enabled,
  2662. all input frames will be processed by a soft knee thresholding function prior
  2663. to the actual normalization process. Put simply, the thresholding function is
  2664. going to prune all samples whose magnitude exceeds a certain threshold value.
  2665. However, the Dynamic Audio Normalizer does not simply apply a fixed threshold
  2666. value. Instead, the threshold value will be adjusted for each individual
  2667. frame.
  2668. In general, smaller parameters result in stronger compression, and vice versa.
  2669. Values below 3.0 are not recommended, because audible distortion may appear.
  2670. @item threshold, t
  2671. Set the target threshold value. This specifies the lowest permissible
  2672. magnitude level for the audio input which will be normalized.
  2673. If input frame volume is above this value frame will be normalized.
  2674. Otherwise frame may not be normalized at all. The default value is set
  2675. to 0, which means all input frames will be normalized.
  2676. This option is mostly useful if digital noise is not wanted to be amplified.
  2677. @end table
  2678. @subsection Commands
  2679. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2680. @section earwax
  2681. Make audio easier to listen to on headphones.
  2682. This filter adds `cues' to 44.1kHz stereo (i.e. audio CD format) audio
  2683. so that when listened to on headphones the stereo image is moved from
  2684. inside your head (standard for headphones) to outside and in front of
  2685. the listener (standard for speakers).
  2686. Ported from SoX.
  2687. @section equalizer
  2688. Apply a two-pole peaking equalisation (EQ) filter. With this
  2689. filter, the signal-level at and around a selected frequency can
  2690. be increased or decreased, whilst (unlike bandpass and bandreject
  2691. filters) that at all other frequencies is unchanged.
  2692. In order to produce complex equalisation curves, this filter can
  2693. be given several times, each with a different central frequency.
  2694. The filter accepts the following options:
  2695. @table @option
  2696. @item frequency, f
  2697. Set the filter's central frequency in Hz.
  2698. @item width_type, t
  2699. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  2700. @table @option
  2701. @item h
  2702. Hz
  2703. @item q
  2704. Q-Factor
  2705. @item o
  2706. octave
  2707. @item s
  2708. slope
  2709. @item k
  2710. kHz
  2711. @end table
  2712. @item width, w
  2713. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  2714. @item gain, g
  2715. Set the required gain or attenuation in dB.
  2716. Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  2717. @item mix, m
  2718. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  2719. Range is between 0 and 1.
  2720. @item channels, c
  2721. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  2722. @item normalize, n
  2723. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  2724. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  2725. @end table
  2726. @subsection Examples
  2727. @itemize
  2728. @item
  2729. Attenuate 10 dB at 1000 Hz, with a bandwidth of 200 Hz:
  2730. @example
  2731. equalizer=f=1000:t=h:width=200:g=-10
  2732. @end example
  2733. @item
  2734. Apply 2 dB gain at 1000 Hz with Q 1 and attenuate 5 dB at 100 Hz with Q 2:
  2735. @example
  2736. equalizer=f=1000:t=q:w=1:g=2,equalizer=f=100:t=q:w=2:g=-5
  2737. @end example
  2738. @end itemize
  2739. @subsection Commands
  2740. This filter supports the following commands:
  2741. @table @option
  2742. @item frequency, f
  2743. Change equalizer frequency.
  2744. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  2745. @item width_type, t
  2746. Change equalizer width_type.
  2747. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  2748. @item width, w
  2749. Change equalizer width.
  2750. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  2751. @item gain, g
  2752. Change equalizer gain.
  2753. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  2754. @item mix, m
  2755. Change equalizer mix.
  2756. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  2757. @end table
  2758. @section extrastereo
  2759. Linearly increases the difference between left and right channels which
  2760. adds some sort of "live" effect to playback.
  2761. The filter accepts the following options:
  2762. @table @option
  2763. @item m
  2764. Sets the difference coefficient (default: 2.5). 0.0 means mono sound
  2765. (average of both channels), with 1.0 sound will be unchanged, with
  2766. -1.0 left and right channels will be swapped.
  2767. @item c
  2768. Enable clipping. By default is enabled.
  2769. @end table
  2770. @subsection Commands
  2771. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  2772. @section firequalizer
  2773. Apply FIR Equalization using arbitrary frequency response.
  2774. The filter accepts the following option:
  2775. @table @option
  2776. @item gain
  2777. Set gain curve equation (in dB). The expression can contain variables:
  2778. @table @option
  2779. @item f
  2780. the evaluated frequency
  2781. @item sr
  2782. sample rate
  2783. @item ch
  2784. channel number, set to 0 when multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2785. @item chid
  2786. channel id, see libavutil/channel_layout.h, set to the first channel id when
  2787. multichannels evaluation is disabled
  2788. @item chs
  2789. number of channels
  2790. @item chlayout
  2791. channel_layout, see libavutil/channel_layout.h
  2792. @end table
  2793. and functions:
  2794. @table @option
  2795. @item gain_interpolate(f)
  2796. interpolate gain on frequency f based on gain_entry
  2797. @item cubic_interpolate(f)
  2798. same as gain_interpolate, but smoother
  2799. @end table
  2800. This option is also available as command. Default is @code{gain_interpolate(f)}.
  2801. @item gain_entry
  2802. Set gain entry for gain_interpolate function. The expression can
  2803. contain functions:
  2804. @table @option
  2805. @item entry(f, g)
  2806. store gain entry at frequency f with value g
  2807. @end table
  2808. This option is also available as command.
  2809. @item delay
  2810. Set filter delay in seconds. Higher value means more accurate.
  2811. Default is @code{0.01}.
  2812. @item accuracy
  2813. Set filter accuracy in Hz. Lower value means more accurate.
  2814. Default is @code{5}.
  2815. @item wfunc
  2816. Set window function. Acceptable values are:
  2817. @table @option
  2818. @item rectangular
  2819. rectangular window, useful when gain curve is already smooth
  2820. @item hann
  2821. hann window (default)
  2822. @item hamming
  2823. hamming window
  2824. @item blackman
  2825. blackman window
  2826. @item nuttall3
  2827. 3-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2828. @item mnuttall3
  2829. minimum 3-terms discontinuous nuttall window
  2830. @item nuttall
  2831. 4-terms continuous 1st derivative nuttall window
  2832. @item bnuttall
  2833. minimum 4-terms discontinuous nuttall (blackman-nuttall) window
  2834. @item bharris
  2835. blackman-harris window
  2836. @item tukey
  2837. tukey window
  2838. @end table
  2839. @item fixed
  2840. If enabled, use fixed number of audio samples. This improves speed when
  2841. filtering with large delay. Default is disabled.
  2842. @item multi
  2843. Enable multichannels evaluation on gain. Default is disabled.
  2844. @item zero_phase
  2845. Enable zero phase mode by subtracting timestamp to compensate delay.
  2846. Default is disabled.
  2847. @item scale
  2848. Set scale used by gain. Acceptable values are:
  2849. @table @option
  2850. @item linlin
  2851. linear frequency, linear gain
  2852. @item linlog
  2853. linear frequency, logarithmic (in dB) gain (default)
  2854. @item loglin
  2855. logarithmic (in octave scale where 20 Hz is 0) frequency, linear gain
  2856. @item loglog
  2857. logarithmic frequency, logarithmic gain
  2858. @end table
  2859. @item dumpfile
  2860. Set file for dumping, suitable for gnuplot.
  2861. @item dumpscale
  2862. Set scale for dumpfile. Acceptable values are same with scale option.
  2863. Default is linlog.
  2864. @item fft2
  2865. Enable 2-channel convolution using complex FFT. This improves speed significantly.
  2866. Default is disabled.
  2867. @item min_phase
  2868. Enable minimum phase impulse response. Default is disabled.
  2869. @end table
  2870. @subsection Examples
  2871. @itemize
  2872. @item
  2873. lowpass at 1000 Hz:
  2874. @example
  2875. firequalizer=gain='if(lt(f,1000), 0, -INF)'
  2876. @end example
  2877. @item
  2878. lowpass at 1000 Hz with gain_entry:
  2879. @example
  2880. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(1000,0); entry(1001, -INF)'
  2881. @end example
  2882. @item
  2883. custom equalization:
  2884. @example
  2885. firequalizer=gain_entry='entry(100,0); entry(400, -4); entry(1000, -6); entry(2000, 0)'
  2886. @end example
  2887. @item
  2888. higher delay with zero phase to compensate delay:
  2889. @example
  2890. firequalizer=delay=0.1:fixed=on:zero_phase=on
  2891. @end example
  2892. @item
  2893. lowpass on left channel, highpass on right channel:
  2894. @example
  2895. firequalizer=gain='if(eq(chid,1), gain_interpolate(f), if(eq(chid,2), gain_interpolate(1e6+f), 0))'
  2896. :gain_entry='entry(1000, 0); entry(1001,-INF); entry(1e6+1000,0)':multi=on
  2897. @end example
  2898. @end itemize
  2899. @section flanger
  2900. Apply a flanging effect to the audio.
  2901. The filter accepts the following options:
  2902. @table @option
  2903. @item delay
  2904. Set base delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 30. Default value is 0.
  2905. @item depth
  2906. Set added sweep delay in milliseconds. Range from 0 to 10. Default value is 2.
  2907. @item regen
  2908. Set percentage regeneration (delayed signal feedback). Range from -95 to 95.
  2909. Default value is 0.
  2910. @item width
  2911. Set percentage of delayed signal mixed with original. Range from 0 to 100.
  2912. Default value is 71.
  2913. @item speed
  2914. Set sweeps per second (Hz). Range from 0.1 to 10. Default value is 0.5.
  2915. @item shape
  2916. Set swept wave shape, can be @var{triangular} or @var{sinusoidal}.
  2917. Default value is @var{sinusoidal}.
  2918. @item phase
  2919. Set swept wave percentage-shift for multi channel. Range from 0 to 100.
  2920. Default value is 25.
  2921. @item interp
  2922. Set delay-line interpolation, @var{linear} or @var{quadratic}.
  2923. Default is @var{linear}.
  2924. @end table
  2925. @section haas
  2926. Apply Haas effect to audio.
  2927. Note that this makes most sense to apply on mono signals.
  2928. With this filter applied to mono signals it give some directionality and
  2929. stretches its stereo image.
  2930. The filter accepts the following options:
  2931. @table @option
  2932. @item level_in
  2933. Set input level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB
  2934. @item level_out
  2935. Set output level. By default is @var{1}, or 0dB.
  2936. @item side_gain
  2937. Set gain applied to side part of signal. By default is @var{1}.
  2938. @item middle_source
  2939. Set kind of middle source. Can be one of the following:
  2940. @table @samp
  2941. @item left
  2942. Pick left channel.
  2943. @item right
  2944. Pick right channel.
  2945. @item mid
  2946. Pick middle part signal of stereo image.
  2947. @item side
  2948. Pick side part signal of stereo image.
  2949. @end table
  2950. @item middle_phase
  2951. Change middle phase. By default is disabled.
  2952. @item left_delay
  2953. Set left channel delay. By default is @var{2.05} milliseconds.
  2954. @item left_balance
  2955. Set left channel balance. By default is @var{-1}.
  2956. @item left_gain
  2957. Set left channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2958. @item left_phase
  2959. Change left phase. By default is disabled.
  2960. @item right_delay
  2961. Set right channel delay. By defaults is @var{2.12} milliseconds.
  2962. @item right_balance
  2963. Set right channel balance. By default is @var{1}.
  2964. @item right_gain
  2965. Set right channel gain. By default is @var{1}.
  2966. @item right_phase
  2967. Change right phase. By default is enabled.
  2968. @end table
  2969. @section hdcd
  2970. Decodes High Definition Compatible Digital (HDCD) data. A 16-bit PCM stream with
  2971. embedded HDCD codes is expanded into a 20-bit PCM stream.
  2972. The filter supports the Peak Extend and Low-level Gain Adjustment features
  2973. of HDCD, and detects the Transient Filter flag.
  2974. @example
  2975. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.flac -af hdcd OUT24.flac
  2976. @end example
  2977. When using the filter with wav, note the default encoding for wav is 16-bit,
  2978. so the resulting 20-bit stream will be truncated back to 16-bit. Use something
  2979. like @command{-acodec pcm_s24le} after the filter to get 24-bit PCM output.
  2980. @example
  2981. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd OUT16.wav
  2982. ffmpeg -i HDCD16.wav -af hdcd -c:a pcm_s24le OUT24.wav
  2983. @end example
  2984. The filter accepts the following options:
  2985. @table @option
  2986. @item disable_autoconvert
  2987. Disable any automatic format conversion or resampling in the filter graph.
  2988. @item process_stereo
  2989. Process the stereo channels together. If target_gain does not match between
  2990. channels, consider it invalid and use the last valid target_gain.
  2991. @item cdt_ms
  2992. Set the code detect timer period in ms.
  2993. @item force_pe
  2994. Always extend peaks above -3dBFS even if PE isn't signaled.
  2995. @item analyze_mode
  2996. Replace audio with a solid tone and adjust the amplitude to signal some
  2997. specific aspect of the decoding process. The output file can be loaded in
  2998. an audio editor alongside the original to aid analysis.
  2999. @code{analyze_mode=pe:force_pe=true} can be used to see all samples above the PE level.
  3000. Modes are:
  3001. @table @samp
  3002. @item 0, off
  3003. Disabled
  3004. @item 1, lle
  3005. Gain adjustment level at each sample
  3006. @item 2, pe
  3007. Samples where peak extend occurs
  3008. @item 3, cdt
  3009. Samples where the code detect timer is active
  3010. @item 4, tgm
  3011. Samples where the target gain does not match between channels
  3012. @end table
  3013. @end table
  3014. @section headphone
  3015. Apply head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3016. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones.
  3017. The HRIRs are provided via additional streams, for each channel
  3018. one stereo input stream is needed.
  3019. The filter accepts the following options:
  3020. @table @option
  3021. @item map
  3022. Set mapping of input streams for convolution.
  3023. The argument is a '|'-separated list of channel names in order as they
  3024. are given as additional stream inputs for filter.
  3025. This also specify number of input streams. Number of input streams
  3026. must be not less than number of channels in first stream plus one.
  3027. @item gain
  3028. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3029. @item type
  3030. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3031. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3032. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3033. Default is @var{freq}.
  3034. @item lfe
  3035. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3036. @item size
  3037. Set size of frame in number of samples which will be processed at once.
  3038. Default value is @var{1024}. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000.
  3039. @item hrir
  3040. Set format of hrir stream.
  3041. Default value is @var{stereo}. Alternative value is @var{multich}.
  3042. If value is set to @var{stereo}, number of additional streams should
  3043. be greater or equal to number of input channels in first input stream.
  3044. Also each additional stream should have stereo number of channels.
  3045. If value is set to @var{multich}, number of additional streams should
  3046. be exactly one. Also number of input channels of additional stream
  3047. should be equal or greater than twice number of channels of first input
  3048. stream.
  3049. @end table
  3050. @subsection Examples
  3051. @itemize
  3052. @item
  3053. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3054. each amovie filter use stereo file with IR coefficients as input.
  3055. The files give coefficients for each position of virtual loudspeaker:
  3056. @example
  3057. ffmpeg -i input.wav
  3058. -filter_complex "amovie=azi_270_ele_0_DFC.wav[sr];amovie=azi_90_ele_0_DFC.wav[sl];amovie=azi_225_ele_0_DFC.wav[br];amovie=azi_135_ele_0_DFC.wav[bl];amovie=azi_0_ele_0_DFC.wav,asplit[fc][lfe];amovie=azi_35_ele_0_DFC.wav[fl];amovie=azi_325_ele_0_DFC.wav[fr];[0:a][fl][fr][fc][lfe][bl][br][sl][sr]headphone=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR"
  3059. output.wav
  3060. @end example
  3061. @item
  3062. Full example using wav files as coefficients with amovie filters for 7.1 downmix,
  3063. but now in @var{multich} @var{hrir} format.
  3064. @example
  3065. ffmpeg -i input.wav -filter_complex "amovie=minp.wav[hrirs];[0:a][hrirs]headphone=map=FL|FR|FC|LFE|BL|BR|SL|SR:hrir=multich"
  3066. output.wav
  3067. @end example
  3068. @end itemize
  3069. @section highpass
  3070. Apply a high-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3071. The filter can be either single-pole, or double-pole (the default).
  3072. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3073. The filter accepts the following options:
  3074. @table @option
  3075. @item frequency, f
  3076. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 3000.
  3077. @item poles, p
  3078. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3079. @item width_type, t
  3080. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3081. @table @option
  3082. @item h
  3083. Hz
  3084. @item q
  3085. Q-Factor
  3086. @item o
  3087. octave
  3088. @item s
  3089. slope
  3090. @item k
  3091. kHz
  3092. @end table
  3093. @item width, w
  3094. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3095. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3096. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3097. @item mix, m
  3098. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3099. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3100. @item channels, c
  3101. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3102. @item normalize, n
  3103. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3104. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3105. @end table
  3106. @subsection Commands
  3107. This filter supports the following commands:
  3108. @table @option
  3109. @item frequency, f
  3110. Change highpass frequency.
  3111. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3112. @item width_type, t
  3113. Change highpass width_type.
  3114. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3115. @item width, w
  3116. Change highpass width.
  3117. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3118. @item mix, m
  3119. Change highpass mix.
  3120. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3121. @end table
  3122. @section join
  3123. Join multiple input streams into one multi-channel stream.
  3124. It accepts the following parameters:
  3125. @table @option
  3126. @item inputs
  3127. The number of input streams. It defaults to 2.
  3128. @item channel_layout
  3129. The desired output channel layout. It defaults to stereo.
  3130. @item map
  3131. Map channels from inputs to output. The argument is a '|'-separated list of
  3132. mappings, each in the @code{@var{input_idx}.@var{in_channel}-@var{out_channel}}
  3133. form. @var{input_idx} is the 0-based index of the input stream. @var{in_channel}
  3134. can be either the name of the input channel (e.g. FL for front left) or its
  3135. index in the specified input stream. @var{out_channel} is the name of the output
  3136. channel.
  3137. @end table
  3138. The filter will attempt to guess the mappings when they are not specified
  3139. explicitly. It does so by first trying to find an unused matching input channel
  3140. and if that fails it picks the first unused input channel.
  3141. Join 3 inputs (with properly set channel layouts):
  3142. @example
  3143. ffmpeg -i INPUT1 -i INPUT2 -i INPUT3 -filter_complex join=inputs=3 OUTPUT
  3144. @end example
  3145. Build a 5.1 output from 6 single-channel streams:
  3146. @example
  3147. ffmpeg -i fl -i fr -i fc -i sl -i sr -i lfe -filter_complex
  3148. 'join=inputs=6:channel_layout=5.1:map=0.0-FL|1.0-FR|2.0-FC|3.0-SL|4.0-SR|5.0-LFE'
  3149. out
  3150. @end example
  3151. @section ladspa
  3152. Load a LADSPA (Linux Audio Developer's Simple Plugin API) plugin.
  3153. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3154. @code{--enable-ladspa}.
  3155. @table @option
  3156. @item file, f
  3157. Specifies the name of LADSPA plugin library to load. If the environment
  3158. variable @env{LADSPA_PATH} is defined, the LADSPA plugin is searched in
  3159. each one of the directories specified by the colon separated list in
  3160. @env{LADSPA_PATH}, otherwise in the standard LADSPA paths, which are in
  3161. this order: @file{HOME/.ladspa/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/ladspa/},
  3162. @file{/usr/lib/ladspa/}.
  3163. @item plugin, p
  3164. Specifies the plugin within the library. Some libraries contain only
  3165. one plugin, but others contain many of them. If this is not set filter
  3166. will list all available plugins within the specified library.
  3167. @item controls, c
  3168. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3169. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3170. threshold or gain).
  3171. Controls need to be defined using the following syntax:
  3172. c0=@var{value0}|c1=@var{value1}|c2=@var{value2}|..., where
  3173. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3174. Alternatively they can be also defined using the following syntax:
  3175. @var{value0}|@var{value1}|@var{value2}|..., where
  3176. @var{valuei} is the value set on the @var{i}-th control.
  3177. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3178. their valid ranges are printed.
  3179. @item sample_rate, s
  3180. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3181. zero inputs.
  3182. @item nb_samples, n
  3183. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3184. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3185. @item duration, d
  3186. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3187. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3188. for the accepted syntax.
  3189. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3190. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3191. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3192. supposed to be generated forever.
  3193. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3194. @end table
  3195. @subsection Examples
  3196. @itemize
  3197. @item
  3198. List all available plugins within amp (LADSPA example plugin) library:
  3199. @example
  3200. ladspa=file=amp
  3201. @end example
  3202. @item
  3203. List all available controls and their valid ranges for @code{vcf_notch}
  3204. plugin from @code{VCF} library:
  3205. @example
  3206. ladspa=f=vcf:p=vcf_notch:c=help
  3207. @end example
  3208. @item
  3209. Simulate low quality audio equipment using @code{Computer Music Toolkit} (CMT)
  3210. plugin library:
  3211. @example
  3212. ladspa=file=cmt:plugin=lofi:controls=c0=22|c1=12|c2=12
  3213. @end example
  3214. @item
  3215. Add reverberation to the audio using TAP-plugins
  3216. (Tom's Audio Processing plugins):
  3217. @example
  3218. ladspa=file=tap_reverb:tap_reverb
  3219. @end example
  3220. @item
  3221. Generate white noise, with 0.2 amplitude:
  3222. @example
  3223. ladspa=file=cmt:noise_source_white:c=c0=.2
  3224. @end example
  3225. @item
  3226. Generate 20 bpm clicks using plugin @code{C* Click - Metronome} from the
  3227. @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3228. @example
  3229. ladspa=file=caps:Click:c=c1=20'
  3230. @end example
  3231. @item
  3232. Apply @code{C* Eq10X2 - Stereo 10-band equaliser} effect:
  3233. @example
  3234. ladspa=caps:Eq10X2:c=c0=-48|c9=-24|c3=12|c4=2
  3235. @end example
  3236. @item
  3237. Increase volume by 20dB using fast lookahead limiter from Steve Harris
  3238. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3239. @example
  3240. ladspa=fast_lookahead_limiter_1913:fastLookaheadLimiter:20|0|2
  3241. @end example
  3242. @item
  3243. Attenuate low frequencies using Multiband EQ from Steve Harris
  3244. @code{SWH Plugins} collection:
  3245. @example
  3246. ladspa=mbeq_1197:mbeq:-24|-24|-24|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0|0
  3247. @end example
  3248. @item
  3249. Reduce stereo image using @code{Narrower} from the @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite}
  3250. (CAPS) library:
  3251. @example
  3252. ladspa=caps:Narrower
  3253. @end example
  3254. @item
  3255. Another white noise, now using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3256. @example
  3257. ladspa=caps:White:.2
  3258. @end example
  3259. @item
  3260. Some fractal noise, using @code{C* Audio Plugin Suite} (CAPS) library:
  3261. @example
  3262. ladspa=caps:Fractal:c=c1=1
  3263. @end example
  3264. @item
  3265. Dynamic volume normalization using @code{VLevel} plugin:
  3266. @example
  3267. ladspa=vlevel-ladspa:vlevel_mono
  3268. @end example
  3269. @end itemize
  3270. @subsection Commands
  3271. This filter supports the following commands:
  3272. @table @option
  3273. @item cN
  3274. Modify the @var{N}-th control value.
  3275. If the specified value is not valid, it is ignored and prior one is kept.
  3276. @end table
  3277. @section loudnorm
  3278. EBU R128 loudness normalization. Includes both dynamic and linear normalization modes.
  3279. Support for both single pass (livestreams, files) and double pass (files) modes.
  3280. This algorithm can target IL, LRA, and maximum true peak. In dynamic mode, to accurately
  3281. detect true peaks, the audio stream will be upsampled to 192 kHz.
  3282. Use the @code{-ar} option or @code{aresample} filter to explicitly set an output sample rate.
  3283. The filter accepts the following options:
  3284. @table @option
  3285. @item I, i
  3286. Set integrated loudness target.
  3287. Range is -70.0 - -5.0. Default value is -24.0.
  3288. @item LRA, lra
  3289. Set loudness range target.
  3290. Range is 1.0 - 20.0. Default value is 7.0.
  3291. @item TP, tp
  3292. Set maximum true peak.
  3293. Range is -9.0 - +0.0. Default value is -2.0.
  3294. @item measured_I, measured_i
  3295. Measured IL of input file.
  3296. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3297. @item measured_LRA, measured_lra
  3298. Measured LRA of input file.
  3299. Range is 0.0 - 99.0.
  3300. @item measured_TP, measured_tp
  3301. Measured true peak of input file.
  3302. Range is -99.0 - +99.0.
  3303. @item measured_thresh
  3304. Measured threshold of input file.
  3305. Range is -99.0 - +0.0.
  3306. @item offset
  3307. Set offset gain. Gain is applied before the true-peak limiter.
  3308. Range is -99.0 - +99.0. Default is +0.0.
  3309. @item linear
  3310. Normalize by linearly scaling the source audio.
  3311. @code{measured_I}, @code{measured_LRA}, @code{measured_TP},
  3312. and @code{measured_thresh} must all be specified. Target LRA shouldn't
  3313. be lower than source LRA and the change in integrated loudness shouldn't
  3314. result in a true peak which exceeds the target TP. If any of these
  3315. conditions aren't met, normalization mode will revert to @var{dynamic}.
  3316. Options are @code{true} or @code{false}. Default is @code{true}.
  3317. @item dual_mono
  3318. Treat mono input files as "dual-mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  3319. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  3320. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  3321. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  3322. Options are true or false. Default is false.
  3323. @item print_format
  3324. Set print format for stats. Options are summary, json, or none.
  3325. Default value is none.
  3326. @end table
  3327. @section lowpass
  3328. Apply a low-pass filter with 3dB point frequency.
  3329. The filter can be either single-pole or double-pole (the default).
  3330. The filter roll off at 6dB per pole per octave (20dB per pole per decade).
  3331. The filter accepts the following options:
  3332. @table @option
  3333. @item frequency, f
  3334. Set frequency in Hz. Default is 500.
  3335. @item poles, p
  3336. Set number of poles. Default is 2.
  3337. @item width_type, t
  3338. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  3339. @table @option
  3340. @item h
  3341. Hz
  3342. @item q
  3343. Q-Factor
  3344. @item o
  3345. octave
  3346. @item s
  3347. slope
  3348. @item k
  3349. kHz
  3350. @end table
  3351. @item width, w
  3352. Specify the band-width of a filter in width_type units.
  3353. Applies only to double-pole filter.
  3354. The default is 0.707q and gives a Butterworth response.
  3355. @item mix, m
  3356. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  3357. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3358. @item channels, c
  3359. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  3360. @item normalize, n
  3361. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  3362. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  3363. @end table
  3364. @subsection Examples
  3365. @itemize
  3366. @item
  3367. Lowpass only LFE channel, it LFE is not present it does nothing:
  3368. @example
  3369. lowpass=c=LFE
  3370. @end example
  3371. @end itemize
  3372. @subsection Commands
  3373. This filter supports the following commands:
  3374. @table @option
  3375. @item frequency, f
  3376. Change lowpass frequency.
  3377. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  3378. @item width_type, t
  3379. Change lowpass width_type.
  3380. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  3381. @item width, w
  3382. Change lowpass width.
  3383. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  3384. @item mix, m
  3385. Change lowpass mix.
  3386. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  3387. @end table
  3388. @section lv2
  3389. Load a LV2 (LADSPA Version 2) plugin.
  3390. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3391. @code{--enable-lv2}.
  3392. @table @option
  3393. @item plugin, p
  3394. Specifies the plugin URI. You may need to escape ':'.
  3395. @item controls, c
  3396. Set the '|' separated list of controls which are zero or more floating point
  3397. values that determine the behavior of the loaded plugin (for example delay,
  3398. threshold or gain).
  3399. If @option{controls} is set to @code{help}, all available controls and
  3400. their valid ranges are printed.
  3401. @item sample_rate, s
  3402. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100. Only used if plugin have
  3403. zero inputs.
  3404. @item nb_samples, n
  3405. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame, default
  3406. is 1024. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3407. @item duration, d
  3408. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  3409. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3410. for the accepted syntax.
  3411. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified duration,
  3412. as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a complete frame.
  3413. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  3414. supposed to be generated forever.
  3415. Only used if plugin have zero inputs.
  3416. @end table
  3417. @subsection Examples
  3418. @itemize
  3419. @item
  3420. Apply bass enhancer plugin from Calf:
  3421. @example
  3422. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/BassEnhancer:c=amount=2
  3423. @end example
  3424. @item
  3425. Apply vinyl plugin from Calf:
  3426. @example
  3427. lv2=p=http\\\\://calf.sourceforge.net/plugins/Vinyl:c=drone=0.2|aging=0.5
  3428. @end example
  3429. @item
  3430. Apply bit crusher plugin from ArtyFX:
  3431. @example
  3432. lv2=p=http\\\\://www.openavproductions.com/artyfx#bitta:c=crush=0.3
  3433. @end example
  3434. @end itemize
  3435. @section mcompand
  3436. Multiband Compress or expand the audio's dynamic range.
  3437. The input audio is divided into bands using 4th order Linkwitz-Riley IIRs.
  3438. This is akin to the crossover of a loudspeaker, and results in flat frequency
  3439. response when absent compander action.
  3440. It accepts the following parameters:
  3441. @table @option
  3442. @item args
  3443. This option syntax is:
  3444. attack,decay,[attack,decay..] soft-knee points crossover_frequency [delay [initial_volume [gain]]] | attack,decay ...
  3445. For explanation of each item refer to compand filter documentation.
  3446. @end table
  3447. @anchor{pan}
  3448. @section pan
  3449. Mix channels with specific gain levels. The filter accepts the output
  3450. channel layout followed by a set of channels definitions.
  3451. This filter is also designed to efficiently remap the channels of an audio
  3452. stream.
  3453. The filter accepts parameters of the form:
  3454. "@var{l}|@var{outdef}|@var{outdef}|..."
  3455. @table @option
  3456. @item l
  3457. output channel layout or number of channels
  3458. @item outdef
  3459. output channel specification, of the form:
  3460. "@var{out_name}=[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}[(+-)[@var{gain}*]@var{in_name}...]"
  3461. @item out_name
  3462. output channel to define, either a channel name (FL, FR, etc.) or a channel
  3463. number (c0, c1, etc.)
  3464. @item gain
  3465. multiplicative coefficient for the channel, 1 leaving the volume unchanged
  3466. @item in_name
  3467. input channel to use, see out_name for details; it is not possible to mix
  3468. named and numbered input channels
  3469. @end table
  3470. If the `=' in a channel specification is replaced by `<', then the gains for
  3471. that specification will be renormalized so that the total is 1, thus
  3472. avoiding clipping noise.
  3473. @subsection Mixing examples
  3474. For example, if you want to down-mix from stereo to mono, but with a bigger
  3475. factor for the left channel:
  3476. @example
  3477. pan=1c|c0=0.9*c0+0.1*c1
  3478. @end example
  3479. A customized down-mix to stereo that works automatically for 3-, 4-, 5- and
  3480. 7-channels surround:
  3481. @example
  3482. pan=stereo| FL < FL + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BL + 0.6*SL | FR < FR + 0.5*FC + 0.6*BR + 0.6*SR
  3483. @end example
  3484. Note that @command{ffmpeg} integrates a default down-mix (and up-mix) system
  3485. that should be preferred (see "-ac" option) unless you have very specific
  3486. needs.
  3487. @subsection Remapping examples
  3488. The channel remapping will be effective if, and only if:
  3489. @itemize
  3490. @item gain coefficients are zeroes or ones,
  3491. @item only one input per channel output,
  3492. @end itemize
  3493. If all these conditions are satisfied, the filter will notify the user ("Pure
  3494. channel mapping detected"), and use an optimized and lossless method to do the
  3495. remapping.
  3496. For example, if you have a 5.1 source and want a stereo audio stream by
  3497. dropping the extra channels:
  3498. @example
  3499. pan="stereo| c0=FL | c1=FR"
  3500. @end example
  3501. Given the same source, you can also switch front left and front right channels
  3502. and keep the input channel layout:
  3503. @example
  3504. pan="5.1| c0=c1 | c1=c0 | c2=c2 | c3=c3 | c4=c4 | c5=c5"
  3505. @end example
  3506. If the input is a stereo audio stream, you can mute the front left channel (and
  3507. still keep the stereo channel layout) with:
  3508. @example
  3509. pan="stereo|c1=c1"
  3510. @end example
  3511. Still with a stereo audio stream input, you can copy the right channel in both
  3512. front left and right:
  3513. @example
  3514. pan="stereo| c0=FR | c1=FR"
  3515. @end example
  3516. @section replaygain
  3517. ReplayGain scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream as an input and
  3518. outputs it unchanged.
  3519. At end of filtering it displays @code{track_gain} and @code{track_peak}.
  3520. @section resample
  3521. Convert the audio sample format, sample rate and channel layout. It is
  3522. not meant to be used directly.
  3523. @section rubberband
  3524. Apply time-stretching and pitch-shifting with librubberband.
  3525. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3526. @code{--enable-librubberband}.
  3527. The filter accepts the following options:
  3528. @table @option
  3529. @item tempo
  3530. Set tempo scale factor.
  3531. @item pitch
  3532. Set pitch scale factor.
  3533. @item transients
  3534. Set transients detector.
  3535. Possible values are:
  3536. @table @var
  3537. @item crisp
  3538. @item mixed
  3539. @item smooth
  3540. @end table
  3541. @item detector
  3542. Set detector.
  3543. Possible values are:
  3544. @table @var
  3545. @item compound
  3546. @item percussive
  3547. @item soft
  3548. @end table
  3549. @item phase
  3550. Set phase.
  3551. Possible values are:
  3552. @table @var
  3553. @item laminar
  3554. @item independent
  3555. @end table
  3556. @item window
  3557. Set processing window size.
  3558. Possible values are:
  3559. @table @var
  3560. @item standard
  3561. @item short
  3562. @item long
  3563. @end table
  3564. @item smoothing
  3565. Set smoothing.
  3566. Possible values are:
  3567. @table @var
  3568. @item off
  3569. @item on
  3570. @end table
  3571. @item formant
  3572. Enable formant preservation when shift pitching.
  3573. Possible values are:
  3574. @table @var
  3575. @item shifted
  3576. @item preserved
  3577. @end table
  3578. @item pitchq
  3579. Set pitch quality.
  3580. Possible values are:
  3581. @table @var
  3582. @item quality
  3583. @item speed
  3584. @item consistency
  3585. @end table
  3586. @item channels
  3587. Set channels.
  3588. Possible values are:
  3589. @table @var
  3590. @item apart
  3591. @item together
  3592. @end table
  3593. @end table
  3594. @subsection Commands
  3595. This filter supports the following commands:
  3596. @table @option
  3597. @item tempo
  3598. Change filter tempo scale factor.
  3599. Syntax for the command is : "@var{tempo}"
  3600. @item pitch
  3601. Change filter pitch scale factor.
  3602. Syntax for the command is : "@var{pitch}"
  3603. @end table
  3604. @section sidechaincompress
  3605. This filter acts like normal compressor but has the ability to compress
  3606. detected signal using second input signal.
  3607. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3608. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3609. The filtered signal then can be filtered with other filters in later stages of
  3610. processing. See @ref{pan} and @ref{amerge} filter.
  3611. The filter accepts the following options:
  3612. @table @option
  3613. @item level_in
  3614. Set input gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3615. @item mode
  3616. Set mode of compressor operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3617. Default is @code{downward}.
  3618. @item threshold
  3619. If a signal of second stream raises above this level it will affect the gain
  3620. reduction of first stream.
  3621. By default is 0.125. Range is between 0.00097563 and 1.
  3622. @item ratio
  3623. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced. 1:2 means that if the level
  3624. raised 4dB above the threshold, it will be only 2dB above after the reduction.
  3625. Default is 2. Range is between 1 and 20.
  3626. @item attack
  3627. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3628. reduction starts. Default is 20. Range is between 0.01 and 2000.
  3629. @item release
  3630. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before
  3631. reduction is decreased again. Default is 250. Range is between 0.01 and 9000.
  3632. @item makeup
  3633. Set the amount by how much signal will be amplified after processing.
  3634. Default is 1. Range is from 1 to 64.
  3635. @item knee
  3636. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3637. Default is 2.82843. Range is between 1 and 8.
  3638. @item link
  3639. Choose if the @code{average} level between all channels of side-chain stream
  3640. or the louder(@code{maximum}) channel of side-chain stream affects the
  3641. reduction. Default is @code{average}.
  3642. @item detection
  3643. Should the exact signal be taken in case of @code{peak} or an RMS one in case
  3644. of @code{rms}. Default is @code{rms} which is mainly smoother.
  3645. @item level_sc
  3646. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is between 0.015625 and 64.
  3647. @item mix
  3648. How much to use compressed signal in output. Default is 1.
  3649. Range is between 0 and 1.
  3650. @end table
  3651. @subsection Commands
  3652. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  3653. @subsection Examples
  3654. @itemize
  3655. @item
  3656. Full ffmpeg example taking 2 audio inputs, 1st input to be compressed
  3657. depending on the signal of 2nd input and later compressed signal to be
  3658. merged with 2nd input:
  3659. @example
  3660. ffmpeg -i main.flac -i sidechain.flac -filter_complex "[1:a]asplit=2[sc][mix];[0:a][sc]sidechaincompress[compr];[compr][mix]amerge"
  3661. @end example
  3662. @end itemize
  3663. @section sidechaingate
  3664. A sidechain gate acts like a normal (wideband) gate but has the ability to
  3665. filter the detected signal before sending it to the gain reduction stage.
  3666. Normally a gate uses the full range signal to detect a level above the
  3667. threshold.
  3668. For example: If you cut all lower frequencies from your sidechain signal
  3669. the gate will decrease the volume of your track only if not enough highs
  3670. appear. With this technique you are able to reduce the resonation of a
  3671. natural drum or remove "rumbling" of muted strokes from a heavily distorted
  3672. guitar.
  3673. It needs two input streams and returns one output stream.
  3674. First input stream will be processed depending on second stream signal.
  3675. The filter accepts the following options:
  3676. @table @option
  3677. @item level_in
  3678. Set input level before filtering.
  3679. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3680. @item mode
  3681. Set the mode of operation. Can be @code{upward} or @code{downward}.
  3682. Default is @code{downward}. If set to @code{upward} mode, higher parts of signal
  3683. will be amplified, expanding dynamic range in upward direction.
  3684. Otherwise, in case of @code{downward} lower parts of signal will be reduced.
  3685. @item range
  3686. Set the level of gain reduction when the signal is below the threshold.
  3687. Default is 0.06125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3688. Setting this to 0 disables reduction and then filter behaves like expander.
  3689. @item threshold
  3690. If a signal rises above this level the gain reduction is released.
  3691. Default is 0.125. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  3692. @item ratio
  3693. Set a ratio about which the signal is reduced.
  3694. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 9000.
  3695. @item attack
  3696. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to rise above the threshold before gain
  3697. reduction stops.
  3698. Default is 20 milliseconds. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3699. @item release
  3700. Amount of milliseconds the signal has to fall below the threshold before the
  3701. reduction is increased again. Default is 250 milliseconds.
  3702. Allowed range is from 0.01 to 9000.
  3703. @item makeup
  3704. Set amount of amplification of signal after processing.
  3705. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  3706. @item knee
  3707. Curve the sharp knee around the threshold to enter gain reduction more softly.
  3708. Default is 2.828427125. Allowed range is from 1 to 8.
  3709. @item detection
  3710. Choose if exact signal should be taken for detection or an RMS like one.
  3711. Default is rms. Can be peak or rms.
  3712. @item link
  3713. Choose if the average level between all channels or the louder channel affects
  3714. the reduction.
  3715. Default is average. Can be average or maximum.
  3716. @item level_sc
  3717. Set sidechain gain. Default is 1. Range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3718. @end table
  3719. @section silencedetect
  3720. Detect silence in an audio stream.
  3721. This filter logs a message when it detects that the input audio volume is less
  3722. or equal to a noise tolerance value for a duration greater or equal to the
  3723. minimum detected noise duration.
  3724. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  3725. @code{lavfi.silence_start} or @code{lavfi.silence_start.X} metadata key
  3726. is set on the first frame whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection
  3727. duration and it contains the timestamp of the first frame of the silence.
  3728. The @code{lavfi.silence_duration} or @code{lavfi.silence_duration.X}
  3729. and @code{lavfi.silence_end} or @code{lavfi.silence_end.X} metadata
  3730. keys are set on the first frame after the silence. If @option{mono} is
  3731. enabled, and each channel is evaluated separately, the @code{.X}
  3732. suffixed keys are used, and @code{X} corresponds to the channel number.
  3733. The filter accepts the following options:
  3734. @table @option
  3735. @item noise, n
  3736. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  3737. specified value) or amplitude ratio. Default is -60dB, or 0.001.
  3738. @item duration, d
  3739. Set silence duration until notification (default is 2 seconds). See
  3740. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  3741. for the accepted syntax.
  3742. @item mono, m
  3743. Process each channel separately, instead of combined. By default is disabled.
  3744. @end table
  3745. @subsection Examples
  3746. @itemize
  3747. @item
  3748. Detect 5 seconds of silence with -50dB noise tolerance:
  3749. @example
  3750. silencedetect=n=-50dB:d=5
  3751. @end example
  3752. @item
  3753. Complete example with @command{ffmpeg} to detect silence with 0.0001 noise
  3754. tolerance in @file{silence.mp3}:
  3755. @example
  3756. ffmpeg -i silence.mp3 -af silencedetect=noise=0.0001 -f null -
  3757. @end example
  3758. @end itemize
  3759. @section silenceremove
  3760. Remove silence from the beginning, middle or end of the audio.
  3761. The filter accepts the following options:
  3762. @table @option
  3763. @item start_periods
  3764. This value is used to indicate if audio should be trimmed at beginning of
  3765. the audio. A value of zero indicates no silence should be trimmed from the
  3766. beginning. When specifying a non-zero value, it trims audio up until it
  3767. finds non-silence. Normally, when trimming silence from beginning of audio
  3768. the @var{start_periods} will be @code{1} but it can be increased to higher
  3769. values to trim all audio up to specific count of non-silence periods.
  3770. Default value is @code{0}.
  3771. @item start_duration
  3772. Specify the amount of time that non-silence must be detected before it stops
  3773. trimming audio. By increasing the duration, bursts of noises can be treated
  3774. as silence and trimmed off. Default value is @code{0}.
  3775. @item start_threshold
  3776. This indicates what sample value should be treated as silence. For digital
  3777. audio, a value of @code{0} may be fine but for audio recorded from analog,
  3778. you may wish to increase the value to account for background noise.
  3779. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3780. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3781. @item start_silence
  3782. Specify max duration of silence at beginning that will be kept after
  3783. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3784. as silence.
  3785. @item start_mode
  3786. Specify mode of detection of silence end in start of multi-channel audio.
  3787. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3788. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3789. stopped trimming of silence.
  3790. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3791. stopped trimming of silence.
  3792. @item stop_periods
  3793. Set the count for trimming silence from the end of audio.
  3794. To remove silence from the middle of a file, specify a @var{stop_periods}
  3795. that is negative. This value is then treated as a positive value and is
  3796. used to indicate the effect should restart processing as specified by
  3797. @var{start_periods}, making it suitable for removing periods of silence
  3798. in the middle of the audio.
  3799. Default value is @code{0}.
  3800. @item stop_duration
  3801. Specify a duration of silence that must exist before audio is not copied any
  3802. more. By specifying a higher duration, silence that is wanted can be left in
  3803. the audio.
  3804. Default value is @code{0}.
  3805. @item stop_threshold
  3806. This is the same as @option{start_threshold} but for trimming silence from
  3807. the end of audio.
  3808. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the specified value)
  3809. or amplitude ratio. Default value is @code{0}.
  3810. @item stop_silence
  3811. Specify max duration of silence at end that will be kept after
  3812. trimming. Default is 0, which is equal to trimming all samples detected
  3813. as silence.
  3814. @item stop_mode
  3815. Specify mode of detection of silence start in end of multi-channel audio.
  3816. Can be @var{any} or @var{all}. Default is @var{any}.
  3817. With @var{any}, any sample that is detected as non-silence will cause
  3818. stopped trimming of silence.
  3819. With @var{all}, only if all channels are detected as non-silence will cause
  3820. stopped trimming of silence.
  3821. @item detection
  3822. Set how is silence detected. Can be @code{rms} or @code{peak}. Second is faster
  3823. and works better with digital silence which is exactly 0.
  3824. Default value is @code{rms}.
  3825. @item window
  3826. Set duration in number of seconds used to calculate size of window in number
  3827. of samples for detecting silence.
  3828. Default value is @code{0.02}. Allowed range is from @code{0} to @code{10}.
  3829. @end table
  3830. @subsection Examples
  3831. @itemize
  3832. @item
  3833. The following example shows how this filter can be used to start a recording
  3834. that does not contain the delay at the start which usually occurs between
  3835. pressing the record button and the start of the performance:
  3836. @example
  3837. silenceremove=start_periods=1:start_duration=5:start_threshold=0.02
  3838. @end example
  3839. @item
  3840. Trim all silence encountered from beginning to end where there is more than 1
  3841. second of silence in audio:
  3842. @example
  3843. silenceremove=stop_periods=-1:stop_duration=1:stop_threshold=-90dB
  3844. @end example
  3845. @item
  3846. Trim all digital silence samples, using peak detection, from beginning to end
  3847. where there is more than 0 samples of digital silence in audio and digital
  3848. silence is detected in all channels at same positions in stream:
  3849. @example
  3850. silenceremove=window=0:detection=peak:stop_mode=all:start_mode=all:stop_periods=-1:stop_threshold=0
  3851. @end example
  3852. @end itemize
  3853. @section sofalizer
  3854. SOFAlizer uses head-related transfer functions (HRTFs) to create virtual
  3855. loudspeakers around the user for binaural listening via headphones (audio
  3856. formats up to 9 channels supported).
  3857. The HRTFs are stored in SOFA files (see @url{http://www.sofacoustics.org/} for a database).
  3858. SOFAlizer is developed at the Acoustics Research Institute (ARI) of the
  3859. Austrian Academy of Sciences.
  3860. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  3861. @code{--enable-libmysofa}.
  3862. The filter accepts the following options:
  3863. @table @option
  3864. @item sofa
  3865. Set the SOFA file used for rendering.
  3866. @item gain
  3867. Set gain applied to audio. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3868. @item rotation
  3869. Set rotation of virtual loudspeakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3870. @item elevation
  3871. Set elevation of virtual speakers in deg. Default is 0.
  3872. @item radius
  3873. Set distance in meters between loudspeakers and the listener with near-field
  3874. HRTFs. Default is 1.
  3875. @item type
  3876. Set processing type. Can be @var{time} or @var{freq}. @var{time} is
  3877. processing audio in time domain which is slow.
  3878. @var{freq} is processing audio in frequency domain which is fast.
  3879. Default is @var{freq}.
  3880. @item speakers
  3881. Set custom positions of virtual loudspeakers. Syntax for this option is:
  3882. <CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>[|<CH> <AZIM> <ELEV>|...].
  3883. Each virtual loudspeaker is described with short channel name following with
  3884. azimuth and elevation in degrees.
  3885. Each virtual loudspeaker description is separated by '|'.
  3886. For example to override front left and front right channel positions use:
  3887. 'speakers=FL 45 15|FR 345 15'.
  3888. Descriptions with unrecognised channel names are ignored.
  3889. @item lfegain
  3890. Set custom gain for LFE channels. Value is in dB. Default is 0.
  3891. @item framesize
  3892. Set custom frame size in number of samples. Default is 1024.
  3893. Allowed range is from 1024 to 96000. Only used if option @samp{type}
  3894. is set to @var{freq}.
  3895. @item normalize
  3896. Should all IRs be normalized upon importing SOFA file.
  3897. By default is enabled.
  3898. @item interpolate
  3899. Should nearest IRs be interpolated with neighbor IRs if exact position
  3900. does not match. By default is disabled.
  3901. @item minphase
  3902. Minphase all IRs upon loading of SOFA file. By default is disabled.
  3903. @item anglestep
  3904. Set neighbor search angle step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3905. @item radstep
  3906. Set neighbor search radius step. Only used if option @var{interpolate} is enabled.
  3907. @end table
  3908. @subsection Examples
  3909. @itemize
  3910. @item
  3911. Using ClubFritz6 sofa file:
  3912. @example
  3913. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=1
  3914. @end example
  3915. @item
  3916. Using ClubFritz12 sofa file and bigger radius with small rotation:
  3917. @example
  3918. sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz12.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:rotation=5
  3919. @end example
  3920. @item
  3921. Similar as above but with custom speaker positions for front left, front right, back left and back right
  3922. and also with custom gain:
  3923. @example
  3924. "sofalizer=sofa=/path/to/ClubFritz6.sofa:type=freq:radius=2:speakers=FL 45|FR 315|BL 135|BR 225:gain=28"
  3925. @end example
  3926. @end itemize
  3927. @section stereotools
  3928. This filter has some handy utilities to manage stereo signals, for converting
  3929. M/S stereo recordings to L/R signal while having control over the parameters
  3930. or spreading the stereo image of master track.
  3931. The filter accepts the following options:
  3932. @table @option
  3933. @item level_in
  3934. Set input level before filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3935. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3936. @item level_out
  3937. Set output level after filtering for both channels. Defaults is 1.
  3938. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3939. @item balance_in
  3940. Set input balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3941. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3942. @item balance_out
  3943. Set output balance between both channels. Default is 0.
  3944. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3945. @item softclip
  3946. Enable softclipping. Results in analog distortion instead of harsh digital 0dB
  3947. clipping. Disabled by default.
  3948. @item mutel
  3949. Mute the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3950. @item muter
  3951. Mute the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3952. @item phasel
  3953. Change the phase of the left channel. Disabled by default.
  3954. @item phaser
  3955. Change the phase of the right channel. Disabled by default.
  3956. @item mode
  3957. Set stereo mode. Available values are:
  3958. @table @samp
  3959. @item lr>lr
  3960. Left/Right to Left/Right, this is default.
  3961. @item lr>ms
  3962. Left/Right to Mid/Side.
  3963. @item ms>lr
  3964. Mid/Side to Left/Right.
  3965. @item lr>ll
  3966. Left/Right to Left/Left.
  3967. @item lr>rr
  3968. Left/Right to Right/Right.
  3969. @item lr>l+r
  3970. Left/Right to Left + Right.
  3971. @item lr>rl
  3972. Left/Right to Right/Left.
  3973. @item ms>ll
  3974. Mid/Side to Left/Left.
  3975. @item ms>rr
  3976. Mid/Side to Right/Right.
  3977. @end table
  3978. @item slev
  3979. Set level of side signal. Default is 1.
  3980. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3981. @item sbal
  3982. Set balance of side signal. Default is 0.
  3983. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3984. @item mlev
  3985. Set level of the middle signal. Default is 1.
  3986. Allowed range is from 0.015625 to 64.
  3987. @item mpan
  3988. Set middle signal pan. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3989. @item base
  3990. Set stereo base between mono and inversed channels. Default is 0.
  3991. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  3992. @item delay
  3993. Set delay in milliseconds how much to delay left from right channel and
  3994. vice versa. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -20 to 20.
  3995. @item sclevel
  3996. Set S/C level. Default is 1. Allowed range is from 1 to 100.
  3997. @item phase
  3998. Set the stereo phase in degrees. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 360.
  3999. @item bmode_in, bmode_out
  4000. Set balance mode for balance_in/balance_out option.
  4001. Can be one of the following:
  4002. @table @samp
  4003. @item balance
  4004. Classic balance mode. Attenuate one channel at time.
  4005. Gain is raised up to 1.
  4006. @item amplitude
  4007. Similar as classic mode above but gain is raised up to 2.
  4008. @item power
  4009. Equal power distribution, from -6dB to +6dB range.
  4010. @end table
  4011. @end table
  4012. @subsection Examples
  4013. @itemize
  4014. @item
  4015. Apply karaoke like effect:
  4016. @example
  4017. stereotools=mlev=0.015625
  4018. @end example
  4019. @item
  4020. Convert M/S signal to L/R:
  4021. @example
  4022. "stereotools=mode=ms>lr"
  4023. @end example
  4024. @end itemize
  4025. @section stereowiden
  4026. This filter enhance the stereo effect by suppressing signal common to both
  4027. channels and by delaying the signal of left into right and vice versa,
  4028. thereby widening the stereo effect.
  4029. The filter accepts the following options:
  4030. @table @option
  4031. @item delay
  4032. Time in milliseconds of the delay of left signal into right and vice versa.
  4033. Default is 20 milliseconds.
  4034. @item feedback
  4035. Amount of gain in delayed signal into right and vice versa. Gives a delay
  4036. effect of left signal in right output and vice versa which gives widening
  4037. effect. Default is 0.3.
  4038. @item crossfeed
  4039. Cross feed of left into right with inverted phase. This helps in suppressing
  4040. the mono. If the value is 1 it will cancel all the signal common to both
  4041. channels. Default is 0.3.
  4042. @item drymix
  4043. Set level of input signal of original channel. Default is 0.8.
  4044. @end table
  4045. @subsection Commands
  4046. This filter supports the all above options except @code{delay} as @ref{commands}.
  4047. @section superequalizer
  4048. Apply 18 band equalizer.
  4049. The filter accepts the following options:
  4050. @table @option
  4051. @item 1b
  4052. Set 65Hz band gain.
  4053. @item 2b
  4054. Set 92Hz band gain.
  4055. @item 3b
  4056. Set 131Hz band gain.
  4057. @item 4b
  4058. Set 185Hz band gain.
  4059. @item 5b
  4060. Set 262Hz band gain.
  4061. @item 6b
  4062. Set 370Hz band gain.
  4063. @item 7b
  4064. Set 523Hz band gain.
  4065. @item 8b
  4066. Set 740Hz band gain.
  4067. @item 9b
  4068. Set 1047Hz band gain.
  4069. @item 10b
  4070. Set 1480Hz band gain.
  4071. @item 11b
  4072. Set 2093Hz band gain.
  4073. @item 12b
  4074. Set 2960Hz band gain.
  4075. @item 13b
  4076. Set 4186Hz band gain.
  4077. @item 14b
  4078. Set 5920Hz band gain.
  4079. @item 15b
  4080. Set 8372Hz band gain.
  4081. @item 16b
  4082. Set 11840Hz band gain.
  4083. @item 17b
  4084. Set 16744Hz band gain.
  4085. @item 18b
  4086. Set 20000Hz band gain.
  4087. @end table
  4088. @section surround
  4089. Apply audio surround upmix filter.
  4090. This filter allows to produce multichannel output from audio stream.
  4091. The filter accepts the following options:
  4092. @table @option
  4093. @item chl_out
  4094. Set output channel layout. By default, this is @var{5.1}.
  4095. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4096. for the required syntax.
  4097. @item chl_in
  4098. Set input channel layout. By default, this is @var{stereo}.
  4099. See @ref{channel layout syntax,,the Channel Layout section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4100. for the required syntax.
  4101. @item level_in
  4102. Set input volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4103. @item level_out
  4104. Set output volume level. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4105. @item lfe
  4106. Enable LFE channel output if output channel layout has it. By default, this is enabled.
  4107. @item lfe_low
  4108. Set LFE low cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{128} Hz.
  4109. @item lfe_high
  4110. Set LFE high cut off frequency. By default, this is @var{256} Hz.
  4111. @item lfe_mode
  4112. Set LFE mode, can be @var{add} or @var{sub}. Default is @var{add}.
  4113. In @var{add} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output.
  4114. In @var{sub} mode, LFE channel is created from input audio and added to output but
  4115. also all non-LFE output channels are subtracted with output LFE channel.
  4116. @item angle
  4117. Set angle of stereo surround transform, Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{360}.
  4118. Default is @var{90}.
  4119. @item fc_in
  4120. Set front center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4121. @item fc_out
  4122. Set front center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4123. @item fl_in
  4124. Set front left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4125. @item fl_out
  4126. Set front left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4127. @item fr_in
  4128. Set front right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4129. @item fr_out
  4130. Set front right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4131. @item sl_in
  4132. Set side left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4133. @item sl_out
  4134. Set side left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4135. @item sr_in
  4136. Set side right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4137. @item sr_out
  4138. Set side right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4139. @item bl_in
  4140. Set back left input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4141. @item bl_out
  4142. Set back left output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4143. @item br_in
  4144. Set back right input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4145. @item br_out
  4146. Set back right output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4147. @item bc_in
  4148. Set back center input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4149. @item bc_out
  4150. Set back center output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4151. @item lfe_in
  4152. Set LFE input volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4153. @item lfe_out
  4154. Set LFE output volume. By default, this is @var{1}.
  4155. @item allx
  4156. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for all channels.
  4157. @item ally
  4158. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for all channels.
  4159. @item fcx, flx, frx, blx, brx, slx, srx, bcx
  4160. Set spread usage of stereo image across X axis for each channel.
  4161. @item fcy, fly, fry, bly, bry, sly, sry, bcy
  4162. Set spread usage of stereo image across Y axis for each channel.
  4163. @item win_size
  4164. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  4165. @item win_func
  4166. Set window function.
  4167. It accepts the following values:
  4168. @table @samp
  4169. @item rect
  4170. @item bartlett
  4171. @item hann, hanning
  4172. @item hamming
  4173. @item blackman
  4174. @item welch
  4175. @item flattop
  4176. @item bharris
  4177. @item bnuttall
  4178. @item bhann
  4179. @item sine
  4180. @item nuttall
  4181. @item lanczos
  4182. @item gauss
  4183. @item tukey
  4184. @item dolph
  4185. @item cauchy
  4186. @item parzen
  4187. @item poisson
  4188. @item bohman
  4189. @end table
  4190. Default is @code{hann}.
  4191. @item overlap
  4192. Set window overlap. If set to 1, the recommended overlap for selected
  4193. window function will be picked. Default is @code{0.5}.
  4194. @end table
  4195. @section treble, highshelf
  4196. Boost or cut treble (upper) frequencies of the audio using a two-pole
  4197. shelving filter with a response similar to that of a standard
  4198. hi-fi's tone-controls. This is also known as shelving equalisation (EQ).
  4199. The filter accepts the following options:
  4200. @table @option
  4201. @item gain, g
  4202. Give the gain at whichever is the lower of ~22 kHz and the
  4203. Nyquist frequency. Its useful range is about -20 (for a large cut)
  4204. to +20 (for a large boost). Beware of clipping when using a positive gain.
  4205. @item frequency, f
  4206. Set the filter's central frequency and so can be used
  4207. to extend or reduce the frequency range to be boosted or cut.
  4208. The default value is @code{3000} Hz.
  4209. @item width_type, t
  4210. Set method to specify band-width of filter.
  4211. @table @option
  4212. @item h
  4213. Hz
  4214. @item q
  4215. Q-Factor
  4216. @item o
  4217. octave
  4218. @item s
  4219. slope
  4220. @item k
  4221. kHz
  4222. @end table
  4223. @item width, w
  4224. Determine how steep is the filter's shelf transition.
  4225. @item mix, m
  4226. How much to use filtered signal in output. Default is 1.
  4227. Range is between 0 and 1.
  4228. @item channels, c
  4229. Specify which channels to filter, by default all available are filtered.
  4230. @item normalize, n
  4231. Normalize biquad coefficients, by default is disabled.
  4232. Enabling it will normalize magnitude response at DC to 0dB.
  4233. @end table
  4234. @subsection Commands
  4235. This filter supports the following commands:
  4236. @table @option
  4237. @item frequency, f
  4238. Change treble frequency.
  4239. Syntax for the command is : "@var{frequency}"
  4240. @item width_type, t
  4241. Change treble width_type.
  4242. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width_type}"
  4243. @item width, w
  4244. Change treble width.
  4245. Syntax for the command is : "@var{width}"
  4246. @item gain, g
  4247. Change treble gain.
  4248. Syntax for the command is : "@var{gain}"
  4249. @item mix, m
  4250. Change treble mix.
  4251. Syntax for the command is : "@var{mix}"
  4252. @end table
  4253. @section tremolo
  4254. Sinusoidal amplitude modulation.
  4255. The filter accepts the following options:
  4256. @table @option
  4257. @item f
  4258. Modulation frequency in Hertz. Modulation frequencies in the subharmonic range
  4259. (20 Hz or lower) will result in a tremolo effect.
  4260. This filter may also be used as a ring modulator by specifying
  4261. a modulation frequency higher than 20 Hz.
  4262. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4263. @item d
  4264. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4265. Default value is 0.5.
  4266. @end table
  4267. @section vibrato
  4268. Sinusoidal phase modulation.
  4269. The filter accepts the following options:
  4270. @table @option
  4271. @item f
  4272. Modulation frequency in Hertz.
  4273. Range is 0.1 - 20000.0. Default value is 5.0 Hz.
  4274. @item d
  4275. Depth of modulation as a percentage. Range is 0.0 - 1.0.
  4276. Default value is 0.5.
  4277. @end table
  4278. @section volume
  4279. Adjust the input audio volume.
  4280. It accepts the following parameters:
  4281. @table @option
  4282. @item volume
  4283. Set audio volume expression.
  4284. Output values are clipped to the maximum value.
  4285. The output audio volume is given by the relation:
  4286. @example
  4287. @var{output_volume} = @var{volume} * @var{input_volume}
  4288. @end example
  4289. The default value for @var{volume} is "1.0".
  4290. @item precision
  4291. This parameter represents the mathematical precision.
  4292. It determines which input sample formats will be allowed, which affects the
  4293. precision of the volume scaling.
  4294. @table @option
  4295. @item fixed
  4296. 8-bit fixed-point; this limits input sample format to U8, S16, and S32.
  4297. @item float
  4298. 32-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to FLT. (default)
  4299. @item double
  4300. 64-bit floating-point; this limits input sample format to DBL.
  4301. @end table
  4302. @item replaygain
  4303. Choose the behaviour on encountering ReplayGain side data in input frames.
  4304. @table @option
  4305. @item drop
  4306. Remove ReplayGain side data, ignoring its contents (the default).
  4307. @item ignore
  4308. Ignore ReplayGain side data, but leave it in the frame.
  4309. @item track
  4310. Prefer the track gain, if present.
  4311. @item album
  4312. Prefer the album gain, if present.
  4313. @end table
  4314. @item replaygain_preamp
  4315. Pre-amplification gain in dB to apply to the selected replaygain gain.
  4316. Default value for @var{replaygain_preamp} is 0.0.
  4317. @item replaygain_noclip
  4318. Prevent clipping by limiting the gain applied.
  4319. Default value for @var{replaygain_noclip} is 1.
  4320. @item eval
  4321. Set when the volume expression is evaluated.
  4322. It accepts the following values:
  4323. @table @samp
  4324. @item once
  4325. only evaluate expression once during the filter initialization, or
  4326. when the @samp{volume} command is sent
  4327. @item frame
  4328. evaluate expression for each incoming frame
  4329. @end table
  4330. Default value is @samp{once}.
  4331. @end table
  4332. The volume expression can contain the following parameters.
  4333. @table @option
  4334. @item n
  4335. frame number (starting at zero)
  4336. @item nb_channels
  4337. number of channels
  4338. @item nb_consumed_samples
  4339. number of samples consumed by the filter
  4340. @item nb_samples
  4341. number of samples in the current frame
  4342. @item pos
  4343. original frame position in the file
  4344. @item pts
  4345. frame PTS
  4346. @item sample_rate
  4347. sample rate
  4348. @item startpts
  4349. PTS at start of stream
  4350. @item startt
  4351. time at start of stream
  4352. @item t
  4353. frame time
  4354. @item tb
  4355. timestamp timebase
  4356. @item volume
  4357. last set volume value
  4358. @end table
  4359. Note that when @option{eval} is set to @samp{once} only the
  4360. @var{sample_rate} and @var{tb} variables are available, all other
  4361. variables will evaluate to NAN.
  4362. @subsection Commands
  4363. This filter supports the following commands:
  4364. @table @option
  4365. @item volume
  4366. Modify the volume expression.
  4367. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4368. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4369. value.
  4370. @end table
  4371. @subsection Examples
  4372. @itemize
  4373. @item
  4374. Halve the input audio volume:
  4375. @example
  4376. volume=volume=0.5
  4377. volume=volume=1/2
  4378. volume=volume=-6.0206dB
  4379. @end example
  4380. In all the above example the named key for @option{volume} can be
  4381. omitted, for example like in:
  4382. @example
  4383. volume=0.5
  4384. @end example
  4385. @item
  4386. Increase input audio power by 6 decibels using fixed-point precision:
  4387. @example
  4388. volume=volume=6dB:precision=fixed
  4389. @end example
  4390. @item
  4391. Fade volume after time 10 with an annihilation period of 5 seconds:
  4392. @example
  4393. volume='if(lt(t,10),1,max(1-(t-10)/5,0))':eval=frame
  4394. @end example
  4395. @end itemize
  4396. @section volumedetect
  4397. Detect the volume of the input video.
  4398. The filter has no parameters. The input is not modified. Statistics about
  4399. the volume will be printed in the log when the input stream end is reached.
  4400. In particular it will show the mean volume (root mean square), maximum
  4401. volume (on a per-sample basis), and the beginning of a histogram of the
  4402. registered volume values (from the maximum value to a cumulated 1/1000 of
  4403. the samples).
  4404. All volumes are in decibels relative to the maximum PCM value.
  4405. @subsection Examples
  4406. Here is an excerpt of the output:
  4407. @example
  4408. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] mean_volume: -27 dB
  4409. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] max_volume: -4 dB
  4410. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_4db: 6
  4411. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_5db: 62
  4412. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_6db: 286
  4413. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_7db: 1042
  4414. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_8db: 2551
  4415. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_9db: 4609
  4416. [Parsed_volumedetect_0 @ 0xa23120] histogram_10db: 8409
  4417. @end example
  4418. It means that:
  4419. @itemize
  4420. @item
  4421. The mean square energy is approximately -27 dB, or 10^-2.7.
  4422. @item
  4423. The largest sample is at -4 dB, or more precisely between -4 dB and -5 dB.
  4424. @item
  4425. There are 6 samples at -4 dB, 62 at -5 dB, 286 at -6 dB, etc.
  4426. @end itemize
  4427. In other words, raising the volume by +4 dB does not cause any clipping,
  4428. raising it by +5 dB causes clipping for 6 samples, etc.
  4429. @c man end AUDIO FILTERS
  4430. @chapter Audio Sources
  4431. @c man begin AUDIO SOURCES
  4432. Below is a description of the currently available audio sources.
  4433. @section abuffer
  4434. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  4435. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  4436. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/asrc_abuffer.h}.
  4437. It accepts the following parameters:
  4438. @table @option
  4439. @item time_base
  4440. The timebase which will be used for timestamps of submitted frames. It must be
  4441. either a floating-point number or in @var{numerator}/@var{denominator} form.
  4442. @item sample_rate
  4443. The sample rate of the incoming audio buffers.
  4444. @item sample_fmt
  4445. The sample format of the incoming audio buffers.
  4446. Either a sample format name or its corresponding integer representation from
  4447. the enum AVSampleFormat in @file{libavutil/samplefmt.h}
  4448. @item channel_layout
  4449. The channel layout of the incoming audio buffers.
  4450. Either a channel layout name from channel_layout_map in
  4451. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} or its corresponding integer representation
  4452. from the AV_CH_LAYOUT_* macros in @file{libavutil/channel_layout.h}
  4453. @item channels
  4454. The number of channels of the incoming audio buffers.
  4455. If both @var{channels} and @var{channel_layout} are specified, then they
  4456. must be consistent.
  4457. @end table
  4458. @subsection Examples
  4459. @example
  4460. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=s16p:channel_layout=stereo
  4461. @end example
  4462. will instruct the source to accept planar 16bit signed stereo at 44100Hz.
  4463. Since the sample format with name "s16p" corresponds to the number
  4464. 6 and the "stereo" channel layout corresponds to the value 0x3, this is
  4465. equivalent to:
  4466. @example
  4467. abuffer=sample_rate=44100:sample_fmt=6:channel_layout=0x3
  4468. @end example
  4469. @section aevalsrc
  4470. Generate an audio signal specified by an expression.
  4471. This source accepts in input one or more expressions (one for each
  4472. channel), which are evaluated and used to generate a corresponding
  4473. audio signal.
  4474. This source accepts the following options:
  4475. @table @option
  4476. @item exprs
  4477. Set the '|'-separated expressions list for each separate channel. In case the
  4478. @option{channel_layout} option is not specified, the selected channel layout
  4479. depends on the number of provided expressions. Otherwise the last
  4480. specified expression is applied to the remaining output channels.
  4481. @item channel_layout, c
  4482. Set the channel layout. The number of channels in the specified layout
  4483. must be equal to the number of specified expressions.
  4484. @item duration, d
  4485. Set the minimum duration of the sourced audio. See
  4486. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  4487. for the accepted syntax.
  4488. Note that the resulting duration may be greater than the specified
  4489. duration, as the generated audio is always cut at the end of a
  4490. complete frame.
  4491. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the audio is
  4492. supposed to be generated forever.
  4493. @item nb_samples, n
  4494. Set the number of samples per channel per each output frame,
  4495. default to 1024.
  4496. @item sample_rate, s
  4497. Specify the sample rate, default to 44100.
  4498. @end table
  4499. Each expression in @var{exprs} can contain the following constants:
  4500. @table @option
  4501. @item n
  4502. number of the evaluated sample, starting from 0
  4503. @item t
  4504. time of the evaluated sample expressed in seconds, starting from 0
  4505. @item s
  4506. sample rate
  4507. @end table
  4508. @subsection Examples
  4509. @itemize
  4510. @item
  4511. Generate silence:
  4512. @example
  4513. aevalsrc=0
  4514. @end example
  4515. @item
  4516. Generate a sin signal with frequency of 440 Hz, set sample rate to
  4517. 8000 Hz:
  4518. @example
  4519. aevalsrc="sin(440*2*PI*t):s=8000"
  4520. @end example
  4521. @item
  4522. Generate a two channels signal, specify the channel layout (Front
  4523. Center + Back Center) explicitly:
  4524. @example
  4525. aevalsrc="sin(420*2*PI*t)|cos(430*2*PI*t):c=FC|BC"
  4526. @end example
  4527. @item
  4528. Generate white noise:
  4529. @example
  4530. aevalsrc="-2+random(0)"
  4531. @end example
  4532. @item
  4533. Generate an amplitude modulated signal:
  4534. @example
  4535. aevalsrc="sin(10*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t)"
  4536. @end example
  4537. @item
  4538. Generate 2.5 Hz binaural beats on a 360 Hz carrier:
  4539. @example
  4540. aevalsrc="0.1*sin(2*PI*(360-2.5/2)*t) | 0.1*sin(2*PI*(360+2.5/2)*t)"
  4541. @end example
  4542. @end itemize
  4543. @section afirsrc
  4544. Generate a FIR coefficients using frequency sampling method.
  4545. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4546. The filter accepts the following options:
  4547. @table @option
  4548. @item taps, t
  4549. Set number of filter coefficents in output audio stream.
  4550. Default value is 1025.
  4551. @item frequency, f
  4552. Set frequency points from where magnitude and phase are set.
  4553. This must be in non decreasing order, and first element must be 0, while last element
  4554. must be 1. Elements are separated by white spaces.
  4555. @item magnitude, m
  4556. Set magnitude value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4557. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4558. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4559. @item phase, p
  4560. Set phase value for every frequency point set by @option{frequency}.
  4561. Number of values must be same as number of frequency points.
  4562. Values are separated by white spaces.
  4563. @item sample_rate, r
  4564. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4565. @item nb_samples, n
  4566. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4567. @item win_func, w
  4568. Set window function. Default is blackman.
  4569. @end table
  4570. @section anullsrc
  4571. The null audio source, return unprocessed audio frames. It is mainly useful
  4572. as a template and to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as
  4573. the source for filters which ignore the input data (for example the sox
  4574. synth filter).
  4575. This source accepts the following options:
  4576. @table @option
  4577. @item channel_layout, cl
  4578. Specifies the channel layout, and can be either an integer or a string
  4579. representing a channel layout. The default value of @var{channel_layout}
  4580. is "stereo".
  4581. Check the channel_layout_map definition in
  4582. @file{libavutil/channel_layout.c} for the mapping between strings and
  4583. channel layout values.
  4584. @item sample_rate, r
  4585. Specifies the sample rate, and defaults to 44100.
  4586. @item nb_samples, n
  4587. Set the number of samples per requested frames.
  4588. @end table
  4589. @subsection Examples
  4590. @itemize
  4591. @item
  4592. Set the sample rate to 48000 Hz and the channel layout to AV_CH_LAYOUT_MONO.
  4593. @example
  4594. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=4
  4595. @end example
  4596. @item
  4597. Do the same operation with a more obvious syntax:
  4598. @example
  4599. anullsrc=r=48000:cl=mono
  4600. @end example
  4601. @end itemize
  4602. All the parameters need to be explicitly defined.
  4603. @section flite
  4604. Synthesize a voice utterance using the libflite library.
  4605. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  4606. @code{--enable-libflite}.
  4607. Note that versions of the flite library prior to 2.0 are not thread-safe.
  4608. The filter accepts the following options:
  4609. @table @option
  4610. @item list_voices
  4611. If set to 1, list the names of the available voices and exit
  4612. immediately. Default value is 0.
  4613. @item nb_samples, n
  4614. Set the maximum number of samples per frame. Default value is 512.
  4615. @item textfile
  4616. Set the filename containing the text to speak.
  4617. @item text
  4618. Set the text to speak.
  4619. @item voice, v
  4620. Set the voice to use for the speech synthesis. Default value is
  4621. @code{kal}. See also the @var{list_voices} option.
  4622. @end table
  4623. @subsection Examples
  4624. @itemize
  4625. @item
  4626. Read from file @file{speech.txt}, and synthesize the text using the
  4627. standard flite voice:
  4628. @example
  4629. flite=textfile=speech.txt
  4630. @end example
  4631. @item
  4632. Read the specified text selecting the @code{slt} voice:
  4633. @example
  4634. flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4635. @end example
  4636. @item
  4637. Input text to ffmpeg:
  4638. @example
  4639. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i flite=text='So fare thee well, poor devil of a Sub-Sub, whose commentator I am':voice=slt
  4640. @end example
  4641. @item
  4642. Make @file{ffplay} speak the specified text, using @code{flite} and
  4643. the @code{lavfi} device:
  4644. @example
  4645. ffplay -f lavfi flite=text='No more be grieved for which that thou hast done.'
  4646. @end example
  4647. @end itemize
  4648. For more information about libflite, check:
  4649. @url{http://www.festvox.org/flite/}
  4650. @section anoisesrc
  4651. Generate a noise audio signal.
  4652. The filter accepts the following options:
  4653. @table @option
  4654. @item sample_rate, r
  4655. Specify the sample rate. Default value is 48000 Hz.
  4656. @item amplitude, a
  4657. Specify the amplitude (0.0 - 1.0) of the generated audio stream. Default value
  4658. is 1.0.
  4659. @item duration, d
  4660. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream. Not specifying this option
  4661. results in noise with an infinite length.
  4662. @item color, colour, c
  4663. Specify the color of noise. Available noise colors are white, pink, brown,
  4664. blue, violet and velvet. Default color is white.
  4665. @item seed, s
  4666. Specify a value used to seed the PRNG.
  4667. @item nb_samples, n
  4668. Set the number of samples per each output frame, default is 1024.
  4669. @end table
  4670. @subsection Examples
  4671. @itemize
  4672. @item
  4673. Generate 60 seconds of pink noise, with a 44.1 kHz sampling rate and an amplitude of 0.5:
  4674. @example
  4675. anoisesrc=d=60:c=pink:r=44100:a=0.5
  4676. @end example
  4677. @end itemize
  4678. @section hilbert
  4679. Generate odd-tap Hilbert transform FIR coefficients.
  4680. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for phase-shifting
  4681. the signal by 90 degrees.
  4682. This is used in many matrix coding schemes and for analytic signal generation.
  4683. The process is often written as a multiplication by i (or j), the imaginary unit.
  4684. The filter accepts the following options:
  4685. @table @option
  4686. @item sample_rate, s
  4687. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4688. @item taps, t
  4689. Set length of FIR filter, default is 22051.
  4690. @item nb_samples, n
  4691. Set number of samples per each frame.
  4692. @item win_func, w
  4693. Set window function to be used when generating FIR coefficients.
  4694. @end table
  4695. @section sinc
  4696. Generate a sinc kaiser-windowed low-pass, high-pass, band-pass, or band-reject FIR coefficients.
  4697. The resulting stream can be used with @ref{afir} filter for filtering the audio signal.
  4698. The filter accepts the following options:
  4699. @table @option
  4700. @item sample_rate, r
  4701. Set sample rate, default is 44100.
  4702. @item nb_samples, n
  4703. Set number of samples per each frame. Default is 1024.
  4704. @item hp
  4705. Set high-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4706. @item lp
  4707. Set low-pass frequency. Default is 0.
  4708. If high-pass frequency is lower than low-pass frequency and low-pass frequency
  4709. is higher than 0 then filter will create band-pass filter coefficients,
  4710. otherwise band-reject filter coefficients.
  4711. @item phase
  4712. Set filter phase response. Default is 50. Allowed range is from 0 to 100.
  4713. @item beta
  4714. Set Kaiser window beta.
  4715. @item att
  4716. Set stop-band attenuation. Default is 120dB, allowed range is from 40 to 180 dB.
  4717. @item round
  4718. Enable rounding, by default is disabled.
  4719. @item hptaps
  4720. Set number of taps for high-pass filter.
  4721. @item lptaps
  4722. Set number of taps for low-pass filter.
  4723. @end table
  4724. @section sine
  4725. Generate an audio signal made of a sine wave with amplitude 1/8.
  4726. The audio signal is bit-exact.
  4727. The filter accepts the following options:
  4728. @table @option
  4729. @item frequency, f
  4730. Set the carrier frequency. Default is 440 Hz.
  4731. @item beep_factor, b
  4732. Enable a periodic beep every second with frequency @var{beep_factor} times
  4733. the carrier frequency. Default is 0, meaning the beep is disabled.
  4734. @item sample_rate, r
  4735. Specify the sample rate, default is 44100.
  4736. @item duration, d
  4737. Specify the duration of the generated audio stream.
  4738. @item samples_per_frame
  4739. Set the number of samples per output frame.
  4740. The expression can contain the following constants:
  4741. @table @option
  4742. @item n
  4743. The (sequential) number of the output audio frame, starting from 0.
  4744. @item pts
  4745. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the output audio frame,
  4746. expressed in @var{TB} units.
  4747. @item t
  4748. The PTS of the output audio frame, expressed in seconds.
  4749. @item TB
  4750. The timebase of the output audio frames.
  4751. @end table
  4752. Default is @code{1024}.
  4753. @end table
  4754. @subsection Examples
  4755. @itemize
  4756. @item
  4757. Generate a simple 440 Hz sine wave:
  4758. @example
  4759. sine
  4760. @end example
  4761. @item
  4762. Generate a 220 Hz sine wave with a 880 Hz beep each second, for 5 seconds:
  4763. @example
  4764. sine=220:4:d=5
  4765. sine=f=220:b=4:d=5
  4766. sine=frequency=220:beep_factor=4:duration=5
  4767. @end example
  4768. @item
  4769. Generate a 1 kHz sine wave following @code{1602,1601,1602,1601,1602} NTSC
  4770. pattern:
  4771. @example
  4772. sine=1000:samples_per_frame='st(0,mod(n,5)); 1602-not(not(eq(ld(0),1)+eq(ld(0),3)))'
  4773. @end example
  4774. @end itemize
  4775. @c man end AUDIO SOURCES
  4776. @chapter Audio Sinks
  4777. @c man begin AUDIO SINKS
  4778. Below is a description of the currently available audio sinks.
  4779. @section abuffersink
  4780. Buffer audio frames, and make them available to the end of filter chain.
  4781. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  4782. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  4783. or the options system.
  4784. It accepts a pointer to an AVABufferSinkContext structure, which
  4785. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  4786. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  4787. @section anullsink
  4788. Null audio sink; do absolutely nothing with the input audio. It is
  4789. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  4790. tools.
  4791. @c man end AUDIO SINKS
  4792. @chapter Video Filters
  4793. @c man begin VIDEO FILTERS
  4794. When you configure your FFmpeg build, you can disable any of the
  4795. existing filters using @code{--disable-filters}.
  4796. The configure output will show the video filters included in your
  4797. build.
  4798. Below is a description of the currently available video filters.
  4799. @section addroi
  4800. Mark a region of interest in a video frame.
  4801. The frame data is passed through unchanged, but metadata is attached
  4802. to the frame indicating regions of interest which can affect the
  4803. behaviour of later encoding. Multiple regions can be marked by
  4804. applying the filter multiple times.
  4805. @table @option
  4806. @item x
  4807. Region distance in pixels from the left edge of the frame.
  4808. @item y
  4809. Region distance in pixels from the top edge of the frame.
  4810. @item w
  4811. Region width in pixels.
  4812. @item h
  4813. Region height in pixels.
  4814. The parameters @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are expressions,
  4815. and may contain the following variables:
  4816. @table @option
  4817. @item iw
  4818. Width of the input frame.
  4819. @item ih
  4820. Height of the input frame.
  4821. @end table
  4822. @item qoffset
  4823. Quantisation offset to apply within the region.
  4824. This must be a real value in the range -1 to +1. A value of zero
  4825. indicates no quality change. A negative value asks for better quality
  4826. (less quantisation), while a positive value asks for worse quality
  4827. (greater quantisation).
  4828. The range is calibrated so that the extreme values indicate the
  4829. largest possible offset - if the rest of the frame is encoded with the
  4830. worst possible quality, an offset of -1 indicates that this region
  4831. should be encoded with the best possible quality anyway. Intermediate
  4832. values are then interpolated in some codec-dependent way.
  4833. For example, in 10-bit H.264 the quantisation parameter varies between
  4834. -12 and 51. A typical qoffset value of -1/10 therefore indicates that
  4835. this region should be encoded with a QP around one-tenth of the full
  4836. range better than the rest of the frame. So, if most of the frame
  4837. were to be encoded with a QP of around 30, this region would get a QP
  4838. of around 24 (an offset of approximately -1/10 * (51 - -12) = -6.3).
  4839. An extreme value of -1 would indicate that this region should be
  4840. encoded with the best possible quality regardless of the treatment of
  4841. the rest of the frame - that is, should be encoded at a QP of -12.
  4842. @item clear
  4843. If set to true, remove any existing regions of interest marked on the
  4844. frame before adding the new one.
  4845. @end table
  4846. @subsection Examples
  4847. @itemize
  4848. @item
  4849. Mark the centre quarter of the frame as interesting.
  4850. @example
  4851. addroi=iw/4:ih/4:iw/2:ih/2:-1/10
  4852. @end example
  4853. @item
  4854. Mark the 100-pixel-wide region on the left edge of the frame as very
  4855. uninteresting (to be encoded at much lower quality than the rest of
  4856. the frame).
  4857. @example
  4858. addroi=0:0:100:ih:+1/5
  4859. @end example
  4860. @end itemize
  4861. @section alphaextract
  4862. Extract the alpha component from the input as a grayscale video. This
  4863. is especially useful with the @var{alphamerge} filter.
  4864. @section alphamerge
  4865. Add or replace the alpha component of the primary input with the
  4866. grayscale value of a second input. This is intended for use with
  4867. @var{alphaextract} to allow the transmission or storage of frame
  4868. sequences that have alpha in a format that doesn't support an alpha
  4869. channel.
  4870. For example, to reconstruct full frames from a normal YUV-encoded video
  4871. and a separate video created with @var{alphaextract}, you might use:
  4872. @example
  4873. movie=in_alpha.mkv [alpha]; [in][alpha] alphamerge [out]
  4874. @end example
  4875. Since this filter is designed for reconstruction, it operates on frame
  4876. sequences without considering timestamps, and terminates when either
  4877. input reaches end of stream. This will cause problems if your encoding
  4878. pipeline drops frames. If you're trying to apply an image as an
  4879. overlay to a video stream, consider the @var{overlay} filter instead.
  4880. @section amplify
  4881. Amplify differences between current pixel and pixels of adjacent frames in
  4882. same pixel location.
  4883. This filter accepts the following options:
  4884. @table @option
  4885. @item radius
  4886. Set frame radius. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 1 to 63.
  4887. For example radius of 3 will instruct filter to calculate average of 7 frames.
  4888. @item factor
  4889. Set factor to amplify difference. Default is 2. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4890. @item threshold
  4891. Set threshold for difference amplification. Any difference greater or equal to
  4892. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 10.
  4893. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4894. @item tolerance
  4895. Set tolerance for difference amplification. Any difference lower to
  4896. this value will not alter source pixel. Default is 0.
  4897. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4898. @item low
  4899. Set lower limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4900. This option controls maximum possible value that will decrease source pixel value.
  4901. @item high
  4902. Set high limit for changing source pixel. Default is 65535. Allowed range is from 0 to 65535.
  4903. This option controls maximum possible value that will increase source pixel value.
  4904. @item planes
  4905. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  4906. @end table
  4907. @subsection Commands
  4908. This filter supports the following @ref{commands} that corresponds to option of same name:
  4909. @table @option
  4910. @item factor
  4911. @item threshold
  4912. @item tolerance
  4913. @item low
  4914. @item high
  4915. @item planes
  4916. @end table
  4917. @section ass
  4918. Same as the @ref{subtitles} filter, except that it doesn't require libavcodec
  4919. and libavformat to work. On the other hand, it is limited to ASS (Advanced
  4920. Substation Alpha) subtitles files.
  4921. This filter accepts the following option in addition to the common options from
  4922. the @ref{subtitles} filter:
  4923. @table @option
  4924. @item shaping
  4925. Set the shaping engine
  4926. Available values are:
  4927. @table @samp
  4928. @item auto
  4929. The default libass shaping engine, which is the best available.
  4930. @item simple
  4931. Fast, font-agnostic shaper that can do only substitutions
  4932. @item complex
  4933. Slower shaper using OpenType for substitutions and positioning
  4934. @end table
  4935. The default is @code{auto}.
  4936. @end table
  4937. @section atadenoise
  4938. Apply an Adaptive Temporal Averaging Denoiser to the video input.
  4939. The filter accepts the following options:
  4940. @table @option
  4941. @item 0a
  4942. Set threshold A for 1st plane. Default is 0.02.
  4943. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4944. @item 0b
  4945. Set threshold B for 1st plane. Default is 0.04.
  4946. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4947. @item 1a
  4948. Set threshold A for 2nd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4949. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4950. @item 1b
  4951. Set threshold B for 2nd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4952. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4953. @item 2a
  4954. Set threshold A for 3rd plane. Default is 0.02.
  4955. Valid range is 0 to 0.3.
  4956. @item 2b
  4957. Set threshold B for 3rd plane. Default is 0.04.
  4958. Valid range is 0 to 5.
  4959. Threshold A is designed to react on abrupt changes in the input signal and
  4960. threshold B is designed to react on continuous changes in the input signal.
  4961. @item s
  4962. Set number of frames filter will use for averaging. Default is 9. Must be odd
  4963. number in range [5, 129].
  4964. @item p
  4965. Set what planes of frame filter will use for averaging. Default is all.
  4966. @item a
  4967. Set what variant of algorithm filter will use for averaging. Default is @code{p} parallel.
  4968. Alternatively can be set to @code{s} serial.
  4969. Parallel can be faster then serial, while other way around is never true.
  4970. Parallel will abort early on first change being greater then thresholds, while serial
  4971. will continue processing other side of frames if they are equal or bellow thresholds.
  4972. @end table
  4973. @subsection Commands
  4974. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options except option @code{s}.
  4975. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4976. @section avgblur
  4977. Apply average blur filter.
  4978. The filter accepts the following options:
  4979. @table @option
  4980. @item sizeX
  4981. Set horizontal radius size.
  4982. @item planes
  4983. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  4984. @item sizeY
  4985. Set vertical radius size, if zero it will be same as @code{sizeX}.
  4986. Default is @code{0}.
  4987. @end table
  4988. @subsection Commands
  4989. This filter supports same commands as options.
  4990. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  4991. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  4992. value.
  4993. @section bbox
  4994. Compute the bounding box for the non-black pixels in the input frame
  4995. luminance plane.
  4996. This filter computes the bounding box containing all the pixels with a
  4997. luminance value greater than the minimum allowed value.
  4998. The parameters describing the bounding box are printed on the filter
  4999. log.
  5000. The filter accepts the following option:
  5001. @table @option
  5002. @item min_val
  5003. Set the minimal luminance value. Default is @code{16}.
  5004. @end table
  5005. @section bilateral
  5006. Apply bilateral filter, spatial smoothing while preserving edges.
  5007. The filter accepts the following options:
  5008. @table @option
  5009. @item sigmaS
  5010. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate spatial weight.
  5011. Allowed range is 0 to 10. Default is 0.1.
  5012. @item sigmaR
  5013. Set sigma of gaussian function to calculate range weight.
  5014. Allowed range is 0 to 1. Default is 0.1.
  5015. @item planes
  5016. Set planes to filter. Default is first only.
  5017. @end table
  5018. @section bitplanenoise
  5019. Show and measure bit plane noise.
  5020. The filter accepts the following options:
  5021. @table @option
  5022. @item bitplane
  5023. Set which plane to analyze. Default is @code{1}.
  5024. @item filter
  5025. Filter out noisy pixels from @code{bitplane} set above.
  5026. Default is disabled.
  5027. @end table
  5028. @section blackdetect
  5029. Detect video intervals that are (almost) completely black. Can be
  5030. useful to detect chapter transitions, commercials, or invalid
  5031. recordings. Output lines contains the time for the start, end and
  5032. duration of the detected black interval expressed in seconds.
  5033. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5034. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5035. The filter accepts the following options:
  5036. @table @option
  5037. @item black_min_duration, d
  5038. Set the minimum detected black duration expressed in seconds. It must
  5039. be a non-negative floating point number.
  5040. Default value is 2.0.
  5041. @item picture_black_ratio_th, pic_th
  5042. Set the threshold for considering a picture "black".
  5043. Express the minimum value for the ratio:
  5044. @example
  5045. @var{nb_black_pixels} / @var{nb_pixels}
  5046. @end example
  5047. for which a picture is considered black.
  5048. Default value is 0.98.
  5049. @item pixel_black_th, pix_th
  5050. Set the threshold for considering a pixel "black".
  5051. The threshold expresses the maximum pixel luminance value for which a
  5052. pixel is considered "black". The provided value is scaled according to
  5053. the following equation:
  5054. @example
  5055. @var{absolute_threshold} = @var{luminance_minimum_value} + @var{pixel_black_th} * @var{luminance_range_size}
  5056. @end example
  5057. @var{luminance_range_size} and @var{luminance_minimum_value} depend on
  5058. the input video format, the range is [0-255] for YUV full-range
  5059. formats and [16-235] for YUV non full-range formats.
  5060. Default value is 0.10.
  5061. @end table
  5062. The following example sets the maximum pixel threshold to the minimum
  5063. value, and detects only black intervals of 2 or more seconds:
  5064. @example
  5065. blackdetect=d=2:pix_th=0.00
  5066. @end example
  5067. @section blackframe
  5068. Detect frames that are (almost) completely black. Can be useful to
  5069. detect chapter transitions or commercials. Output lines consist of
  5070. the frame number of the detected frame, the percentage of blackness,
  5071. the position in the file if known or -1 and the timestamp in seconds.
  5072. In order to display the output lines, you need to set the loglevel at
  5073. least to the AV_LOG_INFO value.
  5074. This filter exports frame metadata @code{lavfi.blackframe.pblack}.
  5075. The value represents the percentage of pixels in the picture that
  5076. are below the threshold value.
  5077. It accepts the following parameters:
  5078. @table @option
  5079. @item amount
  5080. The percentage of the pixels that have to be below the threshold; it defaults to
  5081. @code{98}.
  5082. @item threshold, thresh
  5083. The threshold below which a pixel value is considered black; it defaults to
  5084. @code{32}.
  5085. @end table
  5086. @section blend, tblend
  5087. Blend two video frames into each other.
  5088. The @code{blend} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  5089. stream, the first input is the "top" layer and second input is
  5090. "bottom" layer. By default, the output terminates when the longest input terminates.
  5091. The @code{tblend} (time blend) filter takes two consecutive frames
  5092. from one single stream, and outputs the result obtained by blending
  5093. the new frame on top of the old frame.
  5094. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5095. @table @option
  5096. @item c0_mode
  5097. @item c1_mode
  5098. @item c2_mode
  5099. @item c3_mode
  5100. @item all_mode
  5101. Set blend mode for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5102. of @var{all_mode}. Default value is @code{normal}.
  5103. Available values for component modes are:
  5104. @table @samp
  5105. @item addition
  5106. @item grainmerge
  5107. @item and
  5108. @item average
  5109. @item burn
  5110. @item darken
  5111. @item difference
  5112. @item grainextract
  5113. @item divide
  5114. @item dodge
  5115. @item freeze
  5116. @item exclusion
  5117. @item extremity
  5118. @item glow
  5119. @item hardlight
  5120. @item hardmix
  5121. @item heat
  5122. @item lighten
  5123. @item linearlight
  5124. @item multiply
  5125. @item multiply128
  5126. @item negation
  5127. @item normal
  5128. @item or
  5129. @item overlay
  5130. @item phoenix
  5131. @item pinlight
  5132. @item reflect
  5133. @item screen
  5134. @item softlight
  5135. @item subtract
  5136. @item vividlight
  5137. @item xor
  5138. @end table
  5139. @item c0_opacity
  5140. @item c1_opacity
  5141. @item c2_opacity
  5142. @item c3_opacity
  5143. @item all_opacity
  5144. Set blend opacity for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5145. of @var{all_opacity}. Only used in combination with pixel component blend modes.
  5146. @item c0_expr
  5147. @item c1_expr
  5148. @item c2_expr
  5149. @item c3_expr
  5150. @item all_expr
  5151. Set blend expression for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  5152. of @var{all_expr}. Note that related mode options will be ignored if those are set.
  5153. The expressions can use the following variables:
  5154. @table @option
  5155. @item N
  5156. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  5157. @item X
  5158. @item Y
  5159. the coordinates of the current sample
  5160. @item W
  5161. @item H
  5162. the width and height of currently filtered plane
  5163. @item SW
  5164. @item SH
  5165. Width and height scale for the plane being filtered. It is the
  5166. ratio between the dimensions of the current plane to the luma plane,
  5167. e.g. for a @code{yuv420p} frame, the values are @code{1,1} for
  5168. the luma plane and @code{0.5,0.5} for the chroma planes.
  5169. @item T
  5170. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  5171. @item TOP, A
  5172. Value of pixel component at current location for first video frame (top layer).
  5173. @item BOTTOM, B
  5174. Value of pixel component at current location for second video frame (bottom layer).
  5175. @end table
  5176. @end table
  5177. The @code{blend} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  5178. @subsection Examples
  5179. @itemize
  5180. @item
  5181. Apply transition from bottom layer to top layer in first 10 seconds:
  5182. @example
  5183. blend=all_expr='A*(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10))+B*(1-(if(gte(T,10),1,T/10)))'
  5184. @end example
  5185. @item
  5186. Apply linear horizontal transition from top layer to bottom layer:
  5187. @example
  5188. blend=all_expr='A*(X/W)+B*(1-X/W)'
  5189. @end example
  5190. @item
  5191. Apply 1x1 checkerboard effect:
  5192. @example
  5193. blend=all_expr='if(eq(mod(X,2),mod(Y,2)),A,B)'
  5194. @end example
  5195. @item
  5196. Apply uncover left effect:
  5197. @example
  5198. blend=all_expr='if(gte(N*SW+X,W),A,B)'
  5199. @end example
  5200. @item
  5201. Apply uncover down effect:
  5202. @example
  5203. blend=all_expr='if(gte(Y-N*SH,0),A,B)'
  5204. @end example
  5205. @item
  5206. Apply uncover up-left effect:
  5207. @example
  5208. blend=all_expr='if(gte(T*SH*40+Y,H)*gte((T*40*SW+X)*W/H,W),A,B)'
  5209. @end example
  5210. @item
  5211. Split diagonally video and shows top and bottom layer on each side:
  5212. @example
  5213. blend=all_expr='if(gt(X,Y*(W/H)),A,B)'
  5214. @end example
  5215. @item
  5216. Display differences between the current and the previous frame:
  5217. @example
  5218. tblend=all_mode=grainextract
  5219. @end example
  5220. @end itemize
  5221. @section bm3d
  5222. Denoise frames using Block-Matching 3D algorithm.
  5223. The filter accepts the following options.
  5224. @table @option
  5225. @item sigma
  5226. Set denoising strength. Default value is 1.
  5227. Allowed range is from 0 to 999.9.
  5228. The denoising algorithm is very sensitive to sigma, so adjust it
  5229. according to the source.
  5230. @item block
  5231. Set local patch size. This sets dimensions in 2D.
  5232. @item bstep
  5233. Set sliding step for processing blocks. Default value is 4.
  5234. Allowed range is from 1 to 64.
  5235. Smaller values allows processing more reference blocks and is slower.
  5236. @item group
  5237. Set maximal number of similar blocks for 3rd dimension. Default value is 1.
  5238. When set to 1, no block matching is done. Larger values allows more blocks
  5239. in single group.
  5240. Allowed range is from 1 to 256.
  5241. @item range
  5242. Set radius for search block matching. Default is 9.
  5243. Allowed range is from 1 to INT32_MAX.
  5244. @item mstep
  5245. Set step between two search locations for block matching. Default is 1.
  5246. Allowed range is from 1 to 64. Smaller is slower.
  5247. @item thmse
  5248. Set threshold of mean square error for block matching. Valid range is 0 to
  5249. INT32_MAX.
  5250. @item hdthr
  5251. Set thresholding parameter for hard thresholding in 3D transformed domain.
  5252. Larger values results in stronger hard-thresholding filtering in frequency
  5253. domain.
  5254. @item estim
  5255. Set filtering estimation mode. Can be @code{basic} or @code{final}.
  5256. Default is @code{basic}.
  5257. @item ref
  5258. If enabled, filter will use 2nd stream for block matching.
  5259. Default is disabled for @code{basic} value of @var{estim} option,
  5260. and always enabled if value of @var{estim} is @code{final}.
  5261. @item planes
  5262. Set planes to filter. Default is all available except alpha.
  5263. @end table
  5264. @subsection Examples
  5265. @itemize
  5266. @item
  5267. Basic filtering with bm3d:
  5268. @example
  5269. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic
  5270. @end example
  5271. @item
  5272. Same as above, but filtering only luma:
  5273. @example
  5274. bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic:planes=1
  5275. @end example
  5276. @item
  5277. Same as above, but with both estimation modes:
  5278. @example
  5279. split[a][b],[a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=1:estim=basic[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5280. @end example
  5281. @item
  5282. Same as above, but prefilter with @ref{nlmeans} filter instead:
  5283. @example
  5284. split[a][b],[a]nlmeans=s=3:r=7:p=3[a],[b][a]bm3d=sigma=3:block=4:bstep=2:group=16:estim=final:ref=1
  5285. @end example
  5286. @end itemize
  5287. @section boxblur
  5288. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  5289. It accepts the following parameters:
  5290. @table @option
  5291. @item luma_radius, lr
  5292. @item luma_power, lp
  5293. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5294. @item chroma_power, cp
  5295. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5296. @item alpha_power, ap
  5297. @end table
  5298. A description of the accepted options follows.
  5299. @table @option
  5300. @item luma_radius, lr
  5301. @item chroma_radius, cr
  5302. @item alpha_radius, ar
  5303. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  5304. corresponding input plane.
  5305. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  5306. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  5307. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  5308. planes.
  5309. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  5310. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  5311. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  5312. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  5313. @table @option
  5314. @item w
  5315. @item h
  5316. The input width and height in pixels.
  5317. @item cw
  5318. @item ch
  5319. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  5320. @item hsub
  5321. @item vsub
  5322. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  5323. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  5324. @end table
  5325. @item luma_power, lp
  5326. @item chroma_power, cp
  5327. @item alpha_power, ap
  5328. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  5329. corresponding plane.
  5330. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  5331. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  5332. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  5333. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  5334. @end table
  5335. @subsection Examples
  5336. @itemize
  5337. @item
  5338. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radii
  5339. set to 2:
  5340. @example
  5341. boxblur=luma_radius=2:luma_power=1
  5342. boxblur=2:1
  5343. @end example
  5344. @item
  5345. Set the luma radius to 2, and alpha and chroma radius to 0:
  5346. @example
  5347. boxblur=2:1:cr=0:ar=0
  5348. @end example
  5349. @item
  5350. Set the luma and chroma radii to a fraction of the video dimension:
  5351. @example
  5352. boxblur=luma_radius=min(h\,w)/10:luma_power=1:chroma_radius=min(cw\,ch)/10:chroma_power=1
  5353. @end example
  5354. @end itemize
  5355. @section bwdif
  5356. Deinterlace the input video ("bwdif" stands for "Bob Weaver
  5357. Deinterlacing Filter").
  5358. Motion adaptive deinterlacing based on yadif with the use of w3fdif and cubic
  5359. interpolation algorithms.
  5360. It accepts the following parameters:
  5361. @table @option
  5362. @item mode
  5363. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  5364. @table @option
  5365. @item 0, send_frame
  5366. Output one frame for each frame.
  5367. @item 1, send_field
  5368. Output one frame for each field.
  5369. @end table
  5370. The default value is @code{send_field}.
  5371. @item parity
  5372. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  5373. of the following values:
  5374. @table @option
  5375. @item 0, tff
  5376. Assume the top field is first.
  5377. @item 1, bff
  5378. Assume the bottom field is first.
  5379. @item -1, auto
  5380. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  5381. @end table
  5382. The default value is @code{auto}.
  5383. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  5384. top field first will be assumed.
  5385. @item deint
  5386. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  5387. values:
  5388. @table @option
  5389. @item 0, all
  5390. Deinterlace all frames.
  5391. @item 1, interlaced
  5392. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  5393. @end table
  5394. The default value is @code{all}.
  5395. @end table
  5396. @section cas
  5397. Apply Contrast Adaptive Sharpen filter to video stream.
  5398. The filter accepts the following options:
  5399. @table @option
  5400. @item strength
  5401. Set the sharpening strength. Default value is 0.
  5402. @item planes
  5403. Set planes to filter. Default value is to filter all
  5404. planes except alpha plane.
  5405. @end table
  5406. @section chromahold
  5407. Remove all color information for all colors except for certain one.
  5408. The filter accepts the following options:
  5409. @table @option
  5410. @item color
  5411. The color which will not be replaced with neutral chroma.
  5412. @item similarity
  5413. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5414. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5415. @item blend
  5416. Blend percentage.
  5417. 0.0 makes pixels either fully gray, or not gray at all.
  5418. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5419. @item yuv
  5420. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5421. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5422. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5423. @end table
  5424. @subsection Commands
  5425. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5426. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5427. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5428. value.
  5429. @section chromakey
  5430. YUV colorspace color/chroma keying.
  5431. The filter accepts the following options:
  5432. @table @option
  5433. @item color
  5434. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5435. @item similarity
  5436. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5437. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5438. @item blend
  5439. Blend percentage.
  5440. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5441. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5442. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5443. @item yuv
  5444. Signals that the color passed is already in YUV instead of RGB.
  5445. Literal colors like "green" or "red" don't make sense with this enabled anymore.
  5446. This can be used to pass exact YUV values as hexadecimal numbers.
  5447. @end table
  5448. @subsection Commands
  5449. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5450. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5451. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5452. value.
  5453. @subsection Examples
  5454. @itemize
  5455. @item
  5456. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5457. @example
  5458. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf chromakey=green out.png
  5459. @end example
  5460. @item
  5461. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static black background.
  5462. @example
  5463. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color=c=black:s=1280x720 -i video.mp4 -shortest -filter_complex "[1:v]chromakey=0x70de77:0.1:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.mkv
  5464. @end example
  5465. @end itemize
  5466. @section chromashift
  5467. Shift chroma pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  5468. The filter accepts the following options:
  5469. @table @option
  5470. @item cbh
  5471. Set amount to shift chroma-blue horizontally.
  5472. @item cbv
  5473. Set amount to shift chroma-blue vertically.
  5474. @item crh
  5475. Set amount to shift chroma-red horizontally.
  5476. @item crv
  5477. Set amount to shift chroma-red vertically.
  5478. @item edge
  5479. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  5480. @end table
  5481. @subsection Commands
  5482. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5483. @section ciescope
  5484. Display CIE color diagram with pixels overlaid onto it.
  5485. The filter accepts the following options:
  5486. @table @option
  5487. @item system
  5488. Set color system.
  5489. @table @samp
  5490. @item ntsc, 470m
  5491. @item ebu, 470bg
  5492. @item smpte
  5493. @item 240m
  5494. @item apple
  5495. @item widergb
  5496. @item cie1931
  5497. @item rec709, hdtv
  5498. @item uhdtv, rec2020
  5499. @item dcip3
  5500. @end table
  5501. @item cie
  5502. Set CIE system.
  5503. @table @samp
  5504. @item xyy
  5505. @item ucs
  5506. @item luv
  5507. @end table
  5508. @item gamuts
  5509. Set what gamuts to draw.
  5510. See @code{system} option for available values.
  5511. @item size, s
  5512. Set ciescope size, by default set to 512.
  5513. @item intensity, i
  5514. Set intensity used to map input pixel values to CIE diagram.
  5515. @item contrast
  5516. Set contrast used to draw tongue colors that are out of active color system gamut.
  5517. @item corrgamma
  5518. Correct gamma displayed on scope, by default enabled.
  5519. @item showwhite
  5520. Show white point on CIE diagram, by default disabled.
  5521. @item gamma
  5522. Set input gamma. Used only with XYZ input color space.
  5523. @end table
  5524. @section codecview
  5525. Visualize information exported by some codecs.
  5526. Some codecs can export information through frames using side-data or other
  5527. means. For example, some MPEG based codecs export motion vectors through the
  5528. @var{export_mvs} flag in the codec @option{flags2} option.
  5529. The filter accepts the following option:
  5530. @table @option
  5531. @item mv
  5532. Set motion vectors to visualize.
  5533. Available flags for @var{mv} are:
  5534. @table @samp
  5535. @item pf
  5536. forward predicted MVs of P-frames
  5537. @item bf
  5538. forward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5539. @item bb
  5540. backward predicted MVs of B-frames
  5541. @end table
  5542. @item qp
  5543. Display quantization parameters using the chroma planes.
  5544. @item mv_type, mvt
  5545. Set motion vectors type to visualize. Includes MVs from all frames unless specified by @var{frame_type} option.
  5546. Available flags for @var{mv_type} are:
  5547. @table @samp
  5548. @item fp
  5549. forward predicted MVs
  5550. @item bp
  5551. backward predicted MVs
  5552. @end table
  5553. @item frame_type, ft
  5554. Set frame type to visualize motion vectors of.
  5555. Available flags for @var{frame_type} are:
  5556. @table @samp
  5557. @item if
  5558. intra-coded frames (I-frames)
  5559. @item pf
  5560. predicted frames (P-frames)
  5561. @item bf
  5562. bi-directionally predicted frames (B-frames)
  5563. @end table
  5564. @end table
  5565. @subsection Examples
  5566. @itemize
  5567. @item
  5568. Visualize forward predicted MVs of all frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5569. @example
  5570. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv_type=fp
  5571. @end example
  5572. @item
  5573. Visualize multi-directionals MVs of P and B-Frames using @command{ffplay}:
  5574. @example
  5575. ffplay -flags2 +export_mvs input.mp4 -vf codecview=mv=pf+bf+bb
  5576. @end example
  5577. @end itemize
  5578. @section colorbalance
  5579. Modify intensity of primary colors (red, green and blue) of input frames.
  5580. The filter allows an input frame to be adjusted in the shadows, midtones or highlights
  5581. regions for the red-cyan, green-magenta or blue-yellow balance.
  5582. A positive adjustment value shifts the balance towards the primary color, a negative
  5583. value towards the complementary color.
  5584. The filter accepts the following options:
  5585. @table @option
  5586. @item rs
  5587. @item gs
  5588. @item bs
  5589. Adjust red, green and blue shadows (darkest pixels).
  5590. @item rm
  5591. @item gm
  5592. @item bm
  5593. Adjust red, green and blue midtones (medium pixels).
  5594. @item rh
  5595. @item gh
  5596. @item bh
  5597. Adjust red, green and blue highlights (brightest pixels).
  5598. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5599. @item pl
  5600. Preserve lightness when changing color balance. Default is disabled.
  5601. @end table
  5602. @subsection Examples
  5603. @itemize
  5604. @item
  5605. Add red color cast to shadows:
  5606. @example
  5607. colorbalance=rs=.3
  5608. @end example
  5609. @end itemize
  5610. @subsection Commands
  5611. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5612. @section colorchannelmixer
  5613. Adjust video input frames by re-mixing color channels.
  5614. This filter modifies a color channel by adding the values associated to
  5615. the other channels of the same pixels. For example if the value to
  5616. modify is red, the output value will be:
  5617. @example
  5618. @var{red}=@var{red}*@var{rr} + @var{blue}*@var{rb} + @var{green}*@var{rg} + @var{alpha}*@var{ra}
  5619. @end example
  5620. The filter accepts the following options:
  5621. @table @option
  5622. @item rr
  5623. @item rg
  5624. @item rb
  5625. @item ra
  5626. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output red channel.
  5627. Default is @code{1} for @var{rr}, and @code{0} for @var{rg}, @var{rb} and @var{ra}.
  5628. @item gr
  5629. @item gg
  5630. @item gb
  5631. @item ga
  5632. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output green channel.
  5633. Default is @code{1} for @var{gg}, and @code{0} for @var{gr}, @var{gb} and @var{ga}.
  5634. @item br
  5635. @item bg
  5636. @item bb
  5637. @item ba
  5638. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output blue channel.
  5639. Default is @code{1} for @var{bb}, and @code{0} for @var{br}, @var{bg} and @var{ba}.
  5640. @item ar
  5641. @item ag
  5642. @item ab
  5643. @item aa
  5644. Adjust contribution of input red, green, blue and alpha channels for output alpha channel.
  5645. Default is @code{1} for @var{aa}, and @code{0} for @var{ar}, @var{ag} and @var{ab}.
  5646. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-2.0, 2.0]}.
  5647. @end table
  5648. @subsection Examples
  5649. @itemize
  5650. @item
  5651. Convert source to grayscale:
  5652. @example
  5653. colorchannelmixer=.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3:0:.3:.4:.3
  5654. @end example
  5655. @item
  5656. Simulate sepia tones:
  5657. @example
  5658. colorchannelmixer=.393:.769:.189:0:.349:.686:.168:0:.272:.534:.131
  5659. @end example
  5660. @end itemize
  5661. @subsection Commands
  5662. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5663. @section colorkey
  5664. RGB colorspace color keying.
  5665. The filter accepts the following options:
  5666. @table @option
  5667. @item color
  5668. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  5669. @item similarity
  5670. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  5671. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5672. @item blend
  5673. Blend percentage.
  5674. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  5675. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  5676. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  5677. @end table
  5678. @subsection Examples
  5679. @itemize
  5680. @item
  5681. Make every green pixel in the input image transparent:
  5682. @example
  5683. ffmpeg -i input.png -vf colorkey=green out.png
  5684. @end example
  5685. @item
  5686. Overlay a greenscreen-video on top of a static background image.
  5687. @example
  5688. ffmpeg -i background.png -i video.mp4 -filter_complex "[1:v]colorkey=0x3BBD1E:0.3:0.2[ckout];[0:v][ckout]overlay[out]" -map "[out]" output.flv
  5689. @end example
  5690. @end itemize
  5691. @subsection Commands
  5692. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5693. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5694. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5695. value.
  5696. @section colorhold
  5697. Remove all color information for all RGB colors except for certain one.
  5698. The filter accepts the following options:
  5699. @table @option
  5700. @item color
  5701. The color which will not be replaced with neutral gray.
  5702. @item similarity
  5703. Similarity percentage with the above color.
  5704. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  5705. @item blend
  5706. Blend percentage. 0.0 makes pixels fully gray.
  5707. Higher values result in more preserved color.
  5708. @end table
  5709. @subsection Commands
  5710. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  5711. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  5712. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  5713. value.
  5714. @section colorlevels
  5715. Adjust video input frames using levels.
  5716. The filter accepts the following options:
  5717. @table @option
  5718. @item rimin
  5719. @item gimin
  5720. @item bimin
  5721. @item aimin
  5722. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input black point.
  5723. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5724. @item rimax
  5725. @item gimax
  5726. @item bimax
  5727. @item aimax
  5728. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha input white point.
  5729. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[-1.0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5730. Input levels are used to lighten highlights (bright tones), darken shadows
  5731. (dark tones), change the balance of bright and dark tones.
  5732. @item romin
  5733. @item gomin
  5734. @item bomin
  5735. @item aomin
  5736. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output black point.
  5737. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{0}.
  5738. @item romax
  5739. @item gomax
  5740. @item bomax
  5741. @item aomax
  5742. Adjust red, green, blue and alpha output white point.
  5743. Allowed ranges for options are @code{[0, 1.0]}. Defaults are @code{1}.
  5744. Output levels allows manual selection of a constrained output level range.
  5745. @end table
  5746. @subsection Examples
  5747. @itemize
  5748. @item
  5749. Make video output darker:
  5750. @example
  5751. colorlevels=rimin=0.058:gimin=0.058:bimin=0.058
  5752. @end example
  5753. @item
  5754. Increase contrast:
  5755. @example
  5756. colorlevels=rimin=0.039:gimin=0.039:bimin=0.039:rimax=0.96:gimax=0.96:bimax=0.96
  5757. @end example
  5758. @item
  5759. Make video output lighter:
  5760. @example
  5761. colorlevels=rimax=0.902:gimax=0.902:bimax=0.902
  5762. @end example
  5763. @item
  5764. Increase brightness:
  5765. @example
  5766. colorlevels=romin=0.5:gomin=0.5:bomin=0.5
  5767. @end example
  5768. @end itemize
  5769. @subsection Commands
  5770. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  5771. @section colormatrix
  5772. Convert color matrix.
  5773. The filter accepts the following options:
  5774. @table @option
  5775. @item src
  5776. @item dst
  5777. Specify the source and destination color matrix. Both values must be
  5778. specified.
  5779. The accepted values are:
  5780. @table @samp
  5781. @item bt709
  5782. BT.709
  5783. @item fcc
  5784. FCC
  5785. @item bt601
  5786. BT.601
  5787. @item bt470
  5788. BT.470
  5789. @item bt470bg
  5790. BT.470BG
  5791. @item smpte170m
  5792. SMPTE-170M
  5793. @item smpte240m
  5794. SMPTE-240M
  5795. @item bt2020
  5796. BT.2020
  5797. @end table
  5798. @end table
  5799. For example to convert from BT.601 to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5800. @example
  5801. colormatrix=bt601:smpte240m
  5802. @end example
  5803. @section colorspace
  5804. Convert colorspace, transfer characteristics or color primaries.
  5805. Input video needs to have an even size.
  5806. The filter accepts the following options:
  5807. @table @option
  5808. @anchor{all}
  5809. @item all
  5810. Specify all color properties at once.
  5811. The accepted values are:
  5812. @table @samp
  5813. @item bt470m
  5814. BT.470M
  5815. @item bt470bg
  5816. BT.470BG
  5817. @item bt601-6-525
  5818. BT.601-6 525
  5819. @item bt601-6-625
  5820. BT.601-6 625
  5821. @item bt709
  5822. BT.709
  5823. @item smpte170m
  5824. SMPTE-170M
  5825. @item smpte240m
  5826. SMPTE-240M
  5827. @item bt2020
  5828. BT.2020
  5829. @end table
  5830. @anchor{space}
  5831. @item space
  5832. Specify output colorspace.
  5833. The accepted values are:
  5834. @table @samp
  5835. @item bt709
  5836. BT.709
  5837. @item fcc
  5838. FCC
  5839. @item bt470bg
  5840. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5841. @item smpte170m
  5842. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5843. @item smpte240m
  5844. SMPTE-240M
  5845. @item ycgco
  5846. YCgCo
  5847. @item bt2020ncl
  5848. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  5849. @end table
  5850. @anchor{trc}
  5851. @item trc
  5852. Specify output transfer characteristics.
  5853. The accepted values are:
  5854. @table @samp
  5855. @item bt709
  5856. BT.709
  5857. @item bt470m
  5858. BT.470M
  5859. @item bt470bg
  5860. BT.470BG
  5861. @item gamma22
  5862. Constant gamma of 2.2
  5863. @item gamma28
  5864. Constant gamma of 2.8
  5865. @item smpte170m
  5866. SMPTE-170M, BT.601-6 625 or BT.601-6 525
  5867. @item smpte240m
  5868. SMPTE-240M
  5869. @item srgb
  5870. SRGB
  5871. @item iec61966-2-1
  5872. iec61966-2-1
  5873. @item iec61966-2-4
  5874. iec61966-2-4
  5875. @item xvycc
  5876. xvycc
  5877. @item bt2020-10
  5878. BT.2020 for 10-bits content
  5879. @item bt2020-12
  5880. BT.2020 for 12-bits content
  5881. @end table
  5882. @anchor{primaries}
  5883. @item primaries
  5884. Specify output color primaries.
  5885. The accepted values are:
  5886. @table @samp
  5887. @item bt709
  5888. BT.709
  5889. @item bt470m
  5890. BT.470M
  5891. @item bt470bg
  5892. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  5893. @item smpte170m
  5894. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  5895. @item smpte240m
  5896. SMPTE-240M
  5897. @item film
  5898. film
  5899. @item smpte431
  5900. SMPTE-431
  5901. @item smpte432
  5902. SMPTE-432
  5903. @item bt2020
  5904. BT.2020
  5905. @item jedec-p22
  5906. JEDEC P22 phosphors
  5907. @end table
  5908. @anchor{range}
  5909. @item range
  5910. Specify output color range.
  5911. The accepted values are:
  5912. @table @samp
  5913. @item tv
  5914. TV (restricted) range
  5915. @item mpeg
  5916. MPEG (restricted) range
  5917. @item pc
  5918. PC (full) range
  5919. @item jpeg
  5920. JPEG (full) range
  5921. @end table
  5922. @item format
  5923. Specify output color format.
  5924. The accepted values are:
  5925. @table @samp
  5926. @item yuv420p
  5927. YUV 4:2:0 planar 8-bits
  5928. @item yuv420p10
  5929. YUV 4:2:0 planar 10-bits
  5930. @item yuv420p12
  5931. YUV 4:2:0 planar 12-bits
  5932. @item yuv422p
  5933. YUV 4:2:2 planar 8-bits
  5934. @item yuv422p10
  5935. YUV 4:2:2 planar 10-bits
  5936. @item yuv422p12
  5937. YUV 4:2:2 planar 12-bits
  5938. @item yuv444p
  5939. YUV 4:4:4 planar 8-bits
  5940. @item yuv444p10
  5941. YUV 4:4:4 planar 10-bits
  5942. @item yuv444p12
  5943. YUV 4:4:4 planar 12-bits
  5944. @end table
  5945. @item fast
  5946. Do a fast conversion, which skips gamma/primary correction. This will take
  5947. significantly less CPU, but will be mathematically incorrect. To get output
  5948. compatible with that produced by the colormatrix filter, use fast=1.
  5949. @item dither
  5950. Specify dithering mode.
  5951. The accepted values are:
  5952. @table @samp
  5953. @item none
  5954. No dithering
  5955. @item fsb
  5956. Floyd-Steinberg dithering
  5957. @end table
  5958. @item wpadapt
  5959. Whitepoint adaptation mode.
  5960. The accepted values are:
  5961. @table @samp
  5962. @item bradford
  5963. Bradford whitepoint adaptation
  5964. @item vonkries
  5965. von Kries whitepoint adaptation
  5966. @item identity
  5967. identity whitepoint adaptation (i.e. no whitepoint adaptation)
  5968. @end table
  5969. @item iall
  5970. Override all input properties at once. Same accepted values as @ref{all}.
  5971. @item ispace
  5972. Override input colorspace. Same accepted values as @ref{space}.
  5973. @item iprimaries
  5974. Override input color primaries. Same accepted values as @ref{primaries}.
  5975. @item itrc
  5976. Override input transfer characteristics. Same accepted values as @ref{trc}.
  5977. @item irange
  5978. Override input color range. Same accepted values as @ref{range}.
  5979. @end table
  5980. The filter converts the transfer characteristics, color space and color
  5981. primaries to the specified user values. The output value, if not specified,
  5982. is set to a default value based on the "all" property. If that property is
  5983. also not specified, the filter will log an error. The output color range and
  5984. format default to the same value as the input color range and format. The
  5985. input transfer characteristics, color space, color primaries and color range
  5986. should be set on the input data. If any of these are missing, the filter will
  5987. log an error and no conversion will take place.
  5988. For example to convert the input to SMPTE-240M, use the command:
  5989. @example
  5990. colorspace=smpte240m
  5991. @end example
  5992. @section convolution
  5993. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 or horizontal/vertical up to 49 elements.
  5994. The filter accepts the following options:
  5995. @table @option
  5996. @item 0m
  5997. @item 1m
  5998. @item 2m
  5999. @item 3m
  6000. Set matrix for each plane.
  6001. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed integers in @var{square} mode,
  6002. and from 1 to 49 odd number of signed integers in @var{row} mode.
  6003. @item 0rdiv
  6004. @item 1rdiv
  6005. @item 2rdiv
  6006. @item 3rdiv
  6007. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  6008. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  6009. @item 0bias
  6010. @item 1bias
  6011. @item 2bias
  6012. @item 3bias
  6013. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  6014. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker. Default is 0.0.
  6015. @item 0mode
  6016. @item 1mode
  6017. @item 2mode
  6018. @item 3mode
  6019. Set matrix mode for each plane. Can be @var{square}, @var{row} or @var{column}.
  6020. Default is @var{square}.
  6021. @end table
  6022. @subsection Examples
  6023. @itemize
  6024. @item
  6025. Apply sharpen:
  6026. @example
  6027. convolution="0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0"
  6028. @end example
  6029. @item
  6030. Apply blur:
  6031. @example
  6032. convolution="1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9"
  6033. @end example
  6034. @item
  6035. Apply edge enhance:
  6036. @example
  6037. convolution="0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128"
  6038. @end example
  6039. @item
  6040. Apply edge detect:
  6041. @example
  6042. convolution="0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128"
  6043. @end example
  6044. @item
  6045. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  6046. @example
  6047. convolution="1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0"
  6048. @end example
  6049. @item
  6050. Apply emboss:
  6051. @example
  6052. convolution="-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2"
  6053. @end example
  6054. @end itemize
  6055. @section convolve
  6056. Apply 2D convolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6057. as impulse.
  6058. The filter accepts the following options:
  6059. @table @option
  6060. @item planes
  6061. Set which planes to process.
  6062. @item impulse
  6063. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6064. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6065. @end table
  6066. The @code{convolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6067. @section copy
  6068. Copy the input video source unchanged to the output. This is mainly useful for
  6069. testing purposes.
  6070. @anchor{coreimage}
  6071. @section coreimage
  6072. Video filtering on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  6073. Hardware acceleration is based on an OpenGL context. Usually, this means it is
  6074. processed by video hardware. However, software-based OpenGL implementations
  6075. exist which means there is no guarantee for hardware processing. It depends on
  6076. the respective OSX.
  6077. There are many filters and image generators provided by Apple that come with a
  6078. large variety of options. The filter has to be referenced by its name along
  6079. with its options.
  6080. The coreimage filter accepts the following options:
  6081. @table @option
  6082. @item list_filters
  6083. List all available filters and generators along with all their respective
  6084. options as well as possible minimum and maximum values along with the default
  6085. values.
  6086. @example
  6087. list_filters=true
  6088. @end example
  6089. @item filter
  6090. Specify all filters by their respective name and options.
  6091. Use @var{list_filters} to determine all valid filter names and options.
  6092. Numerical options are specified by a float value and are automatically clamped
  6093. to their respective value range. Vector and color options have to be specified
  6094. by a list of space separated float values. Character escaping has to be done.
  6095. A special option name @code{default} is available to use default options for a
  6096. filter.
  6097. It is required to specify either @code{default} or at least one of the filter options.
  6098. All omitted options are used with their default values.
  6099. The syntax of the filter string is as follows:
  6100. @example
  6101. filter=<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...][#<NAME>@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>[@@<OPTION>=<VALUE>][@@...]][#...]
  6102. @end example
  6103. @item output_rect
  6104. Specify a rectangle where the output of the filter chain is copied into the
  6105. input image. It is given by a list of space separated float values:
  6106. @example
  6107. output_rect=x\ y\ width\ height
  6108. @end example
  6109. If not given, the output rectangle equals the dimensions of the input image.
  6110. The output rectangle is automatically cropped at the borders of the input
  6111. image. Negative values are valid for each component.
  6112. @example
  6113. output_rect=25\ 25\ 100\ 100
  6114. @end example
  6115. @end table
  6116. Several filters can be chained for successive processing without GPU-HOST
  6117. transfers allowing for fast processing of complex filter chains.
  6118. Currently, only filters with zero (generators) or exactly one (filters) input
  6119. image and one output image are supported. Also, transition filters are not yet
  6120. usable as intended.
  6121. Some filters generate output images with additional padding depending on the
  6122. respective filter kernel. The padding is automatically removed to ensure the
  6123. filter output has the same size as the input image.
  6124. For image generators, the size of the output image is determined by the
  6125. previous output image of the filter chain or the input image of the whole
  6126. filterchain, respectively. The generators do not use the pixel information of
  6127. this image to generate their output. However, the generated output is
  6128. blended onto this image, resulting in partial or complete coverage of the
  6129. output image.
  6130. The @ref{coreimagesrc} video source can be used for generating input images
  6131. which are directly fed into the filter chain. By using it, providing input
  6132. images by another video source or an input video is not required.
  6133. @subsection Examples
  6134. @itemize
  6135. @item
  6136. List all filters available:
  6137. @example
  6138. coreimage=list_filters=true
  6139. @end example
  6140. @item
  6141. Use the CIBoxBlur filter with default options to blur an image:
  6142. @example
  6143. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default
  6144. @end example
  6145. @item
  6146. Use a filter chain with CISepiaTone at default values and CIVignetteEffect with
  6147. its center at 100x100 and a radius of 50 pixels:
  6148. @example
  6149. coreimage=filter=CIBoxBlur@@default#CIVignetteEffect@@inputCenter=100\ 100@@inputRadius=50
  6150. @end example
  6151. @item
  6152. Use nullsrc and CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  6153. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  6154. @example
  6155. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=100x100,coreimage=filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  6156. @end example
  6157. @end itemize
  6158. @section cover_rect
  6159. Cover a rectangular object
  6160. It accepts the following options:
  6161. @table @option
  6162. @item cover
  6163. Filepath of the optional cover image, needs to be in yuv420.
  6164. @item mode
  6165. Set covering mode.
  6166. It accepts the following values:
  6167. @table @samp
  6168. @item cover
  6169. cover it by the supplied image
  6170. @item blur
  6171. cover it by interpolating the surrounding pixels
  6172. @end table
  6173. Default value is @var{blur}.
  6174. @end table
  6175. @subsection Examples
  6176. @itemize
  6177. @item
  6178. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  6179. @example
  6180. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  6181. @end example
  6182. @end itemize
  6183. @section crop
  6184. Crop the input video to given dimensions.
  6185. It accepts the following parameters:
  6186. @table @option
  6187. @item w, out_w
  6188. The width of the output video. It defaults to @code{iw}.
  6189. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6190. configuration, or when the @samp{w} or @samp{out_w} command is sent.
  6191. @item h, out_h
  6192. The height of the output video. It defaults to @code{ih}.
  6193. This expression is evaluated only once during the filter
  6194. configuration, or when the @samp{h} or @samp{out_h} command is sent.
  6195. @item x
  6196. The horizontal position, in the input video, of the left edge of the output
  6197. video. It defaults to @code{(in_w-out_w)/2}.
  6198. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6199. @item y
  6200. The vertical position, in the input video, of the top edge of the output video.
  6201. It defaults to @code{(in_h-out_h)/2}.
  6202. This expression is evaluated per-frame.
  6203. @item keep_aspect
  6204. If set to 1 will force the output display aspect ratio
  6205. to be the same of the input, by changing the output sample aspect
  6206. ratio. It defaults to 0.
  6207. @item exact
  6208. Enable exact cropping. If enabled, subsampled videos will be cropped at exact
  6209. width/height/x/y as specified and will not be rounded to nearest smaller value.
  6210. It defaults to 0.
  6211. @end table
  6212. The @var{out_w}, @var{out_h}, @var{x}, @var{y} parameters are
  6213. expressions containing the following constants:
  6214. @table @option
  6215. @item x
  6216. @item y
  6217. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  6218. each new frame.
  6219. @item in_w
  6220. @item in_h
  6221. The input width and height.
  6222. @item iw
  6223. @item ih
  6224. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  6225. @item out_w
  6226. @item out_h
  6227. The output (cropped) width and height.
  6228. @item ow
  6229. @item oh
  6230. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6231. @item a
  6232. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  6233. @item sar
  6234. input sample aspect ratio
  6235. @item dar
  6236. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  6237. @item hsub
  6238. @item vsub
  6239. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  6240. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  6241. @item n
  6242. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  6243. @item pos
  6244. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  6245. @item t
  6246. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  6247. @end table
  6248. The expression for @var{out_w} may depend on the value of @var{out_h},
  6249. and the expression for @var{out_h} may depend on @var{out_w}, but they
  6250. cannot depend on @var{x} and @var{y}, as @var{x} and @var{y} are
  6251. evaluated after @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  6252. The @var{x} and @var{y} parameters specify the expressions for the
  6253. position of the top-left corner of the output (non-cropped) area. They
  6254. are evaluated for each frame. If the evaluated value is not valid, it
  6255. is approximated to the nearest valid value.
  6256. The expression for @var{x} may depend on @var{y}, and the expression
  6257. for @var{y} may depend on @var{x}.
  6258. @subsection Examples
  6259. @itemize
  6260. @item
  6261. Crop area with size 100x100 at position (12,34).
  6262. @example
  6263. crop=100:100:12:34
  6264. @end example
  6265. Using named options, the example above becomes:
  6266. @example
  6267. crop=w=100:h=100:x=12:y=34
  6268. @end example
  6269. @item
  6270. Crop the central input area with size 100x100:
  6271. @example
  6272. crop=100:100
  6273. @end example
  6274. @item
  6275. Crop the central input area with size 2/3 of the input video:
  6276. @example
  6277. crop=2/3*in_w:2/3*in_h
  6278. @end example
  6279. @item
  6280. Crop the input video central square:
  6281. @example
  6282. crop=out_w=in_h
  6283. crop=in_h
  6284. @end example
  6285. @item
  6286. Delimit the rectangle with the top-left corner placed at position
  6287. 100:100 and the right-bottom corner corresponding to the right-bottom
  6288. corner of the input image.
  6289. @example
  6290. crop=in_w-100:in_h-100:100:100
  6291. @end example
  6292. @item
  6293. Crop 10 pixels from the left and right borders, and 20 pixels from
  6294. the top and bottom borders
  6295. @example
  6296. crop=in_w-2*10:in_h-2*20
  6297. @end example
  6298. @item
  6299. Keep only the bottom right quarter of the input image:
  6300. @example
  6301. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:in_w/2:in_h/2
  6302. @end example
  6303. @item
  6304. Crop height for getting Greek harmony:
  6305. @example
  6306. crop=in_w:1/PHI*in_w
  6307. @end example
  6308. @item
  6309. Apply trembling effect:
  6310. @example
  6311. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(n/10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(n/7)
  6312. @end example
  6313. @item
  6314. Apply erratic camera effect depending on timestamp:
  6315. @example
  6316. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:(in_w-out_w)/2+((in_w-out_w)/2)*sin(t*10):(in_h-out_h)/2 +((in_h-out_h)/2)*sin(t*13)"
  6317. @end example
  6318. @item
  6319. Set x depending on the value of y:
  6320. @example
  6321. crop=in_w/2:in_h/2:y:10+10*sin(n/10)
  6322. @end example
  6323. @end itemize
  6324. @subsection Commands
  6325. This filter supports the following commands:
  6326. @table @option
  6327. @item w, out_w
  6328. @item h, out_h
  6329. @item x
  6330. @item y
  6331. Set width/height of the output video and the horizontal/vertical position
  6332. in the input video.
  6333. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  6334. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  6335. value.
  6336. @end table
  6337. @section cropdetect
  6338. Auto-detect the crop size.
  6339. It calculates the necessary cropping parameters and prints the
  6340. recommended parameters via the logging system. The detected dimensions
  6341. correspond to the non-black area of the input video.
  6342. It accepts the following parameters:
  6343. @table @option
  6344. @item limit
  6345. Set higher black value threshold, which can be optionally specified
  6346. from nothing (0) to everything (255 for 8-bit based formats). An intensity
  6347. value greater to the set value is considered non-black. It defaults to 24.
  6348. You can also specify a value between 0.0 and 1.0 which will be scaled depending
  6349. on the bitdepth of the pixel format.
  6350. @item round
  6351. The value which the width/height should be divisible by. It defaults to
  6352. 16. The offset is automatically adjusted to center the video. Use 2 to
  6353. get only even dimensions (needed for 4:2:2 video). 16 is best when
  6354. encoding to most video codecs.
  6355. @item reset_count, reset
  6356. Set the counter that determines after how many frames cropdetect will
  6357. reset the previously detected largest video area and start over to
  6358. detect the current optimal crop area. Default value is 0.
  6359. This can be useful when channel logos distort the video area. 0
  6360. indicates 'never reset', and returns the largest area encountered during
  6361. playback.
  6362. @end table
  6363. @anchor{cue}
  6364. @section cue
  6365. Delay video filtering until a given wallclock timestamp. The filter first
  6366. passes on @option{preroll} amount of frames, then it buffers at most
  6367. @option{buffer} amount of frames and waits for the cue. After reaching the cue
  6368. it forwards the buffered frames and also any subsequent frames coming in its
  6369. input.
  6370. The filter can be used synchronize the output of multiple ffmpeg processes for
  6371. realtime output devices like decklink. By putting the delay in the filtering
  6372. chain and pre-buffering frames the process can pass on data to output almost
  6373. immediately after the target wallclock timestamp is reached.
  6374. Perfect frame accuracy cannot be guaranteed, but the result is good enough for
  6375. some use cases.
  6376. @table @option
  6377. @item cue
  6378. The cue timestamp expressed in a UNIX timestamp in microseconds. Default is 0.
  6379. @item preroll
  6380. The duration of content to pass on as preroll expressed in seconds. Default is 0.
  6381. @item buffer
  6382. The maximum duration of content to buffer before waiting for the cue expressed
  6383. in seconds. Default is 0.
  6384. @end table
  6385. @anchor{curves}
  6386. @section curves
  6387. Apply color adjustments using curves.
  6388. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop and GIMP curves tools. Each
  6389. component (red, green and blue) has its values defined by @var{N} key points
  6390. tied from each other using a smooth curve. The x-axis represents the pixel
  6391. values from the input frame, and the y-axis the new pixel values to be set for
  6392. the output frame.
  6393. By default, a component curve is defined by the two points @var{(0;0)} and
  6394. @var{(1;1)}. This creates a straight line where each original pixel value is
  6395. "adjusted" to its own value, which means no change to the image.
  6396. The filter allows you to redefine these two points and add some more. A new
  6397. curve (using a natural cubic spline interpolation) will be define to pass
  6398. smoothly through all these new coordinates. The new defined points needs to be
  6399. strictly increasing over the x-axis, and their @var{x} and @var{y} values must
  6400. be in the @var{[0;1]} interval. If the computed curves happened to go outside
  6401. the vector spaces, the values will be clipped accordingly.
  6402. The filter accepts the following options:
  6403. @table @option
  6404. @item preset
  6405. Select one of the available color presets. This option can be used in addition
  6406. to the @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} parameters; in this case, the later
  6407. options takes priority on the preset values.
  6408. Available presets are:
  6409. @table @samp
  6410. @item none
  6411. @item color_negative
  6412. @item cross_process
  6413. @item darker
  6414. @item increase_contrast
  6415. @item lighter
  6416. @item linear_contrast
  6417. @item medium_contrast
  6418. @item negative
  6419. @item strong_contrast
  6420. @item vintage
  6421. @end table
  6422. Default is @code{none}.
  6423. @item master, m
  6424. Set the master key points. These points will define a second pass mapping. It
  6425. is sometimes called a "luminance" or "value" mapping. It can be used with
  6426. @option{r}, @option{g}, @option{b} or @option{all} since it acts like a
  6427. post-processing LUT.
  6428. @item red, r
  6429. Set the key points for the red component.
  6430. @item green, g
  6431. Set the key points for the green component.
  6432. @item blue, b
  6433. Set the key points for the blue component.
  6434. @item all
  6435. Set the key points for all components (not including master).
  6436. Can be used in addition to the other key points component
  6437. options. In this case, the unset component(s) will fallback on this
  6438. @option{all} setting.
  6439. @item psfile
  6440. Specify a Photoshop curves file (@code{.acv}) to import the settings from.
  6441. @item plot
  6442. Save Gnuplot script of the curves in specified file.
  6443. @end table
  6444. To avoid some filtergraph syntax conflicts, each key points list need to be
  6445. defined using the following syntax: @code{x0/y0 x1/y1 x2/y2 ...}.
  6446. @subsection Examples
  6447. @itemize
  6448. @item
  6449. Increase slightly the middle level of blue:
  6450. @example
  6451. curves=blue='0/0 0.5/0.58 1/1'
  6452. @end example
  6453. @item
  6454. Vintage effect:
  6455. @example
  6456. curves=r='0/0.11 .42/.51 1/0.95':g='0/0 0.50/0.48 1/1':b='0/0.22 .49/.44 1/0.8'
  6457. @end example
  6458. Here we obtain the following coordinates for each components:
  6459. @table @var
  6460. @item red
  6461. @code{(0;0.11) (0.42;0.51) (1;0.95)}
  6462. @item green
  6463. @code{(0;0) (0.50;0.48) (1;1)}
  6464. @item blue
  6465. @code{(0;0.22) (0.49;0.44) (1;0.80)}
  6466. @end table
  6467. @item
  6468. The previous example can also be achieved with the associated built-in preset:
  6469. @example
  6470. curves=preset=vintage
  6471. @end example
  6472. @item
  6473. Or simply:
  6474. @example
  6475. curves=vintage
  6476. @end example
  6477. @item
  6478. Use a Photoshop preset and redefine the points of the green component:
  6479. @example
  6480. curves=psfile='MyCurvesPresets/purple.acv':green='0/0 0.45/0.53 1/1'
  6481. @end example
  6482. @item
  6483. Check out the curves of the @code{cross_process} profile using @command{ffmpeg}
  6484. and @command{gnuplot}:
  6485. @example
  6486. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i color -vf curves=cross_process:plot=/tmp/curves.plt -frames:v 1 -f null -
  6487. gnuplot -p /tmp/curves.plt
  6488. @end example
  6489. @end itemize
  6490. @section datascope
  6491. Video data analysis filter.
  6492. This filter shows hexadecimal pixel values of part of video.
  6493. The filter accepts the following options:
  6494. @table @option
  6495. @item size, s
  6496. Set output video size.
  6497. @item x
  6498. Set x offset from where to pick pixels.
  6499. @item y
  6500. Set y offset from where to pick pixels.
  6501. @item mode
  6502. Set scope mode, can be one of the following:
  6503. @table @samp
  6504. @item mono
  6505. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with white color on black background.
  6506. @item color
  6507. Draw hexadecimal pixel values with input video pixel color on black
  6508. background.
  6509. @item color2
  6510. Draw hexadecimal pixel values on color background picked from input video,
  6511. the text color is picked in such way so its always visible.
  6512. @end table
  6513. @item axis
  6514. Draw rows and columns numbers on left and top of video.
  6515. @item opacity
  6516. Set background opacity.
  6517. @item format
  6518. Set display number format. Can be @code{hex}, or @code{dec}. Default is @code{hex}.
  6519. @end table
  6520. @section dctdnoiz
  6521. Denoise frames using 2D DCT (frequency domain filtering).
  6522. This filter is not designed for real time.
  6523. The filter accepts the following options:
  6524. @table @option
  6525. @item sigma, s
  6526. Set the noise sigma constant.
  6527. This @var{sigma} defines a hard threshold of @code{3 * sigma}; every DCT
  6528. coefficient (absolute value) below this threshold with be dropped.
  6529. If you need a more advanced filtering, see @option{expr}.
  6530. Default is @code{0}.
  6531. @item overlap
  6532. Set number overlapping pixels for each block. Since the filter can be slow, you
  6533. may want to reduce this value, at the cost of a less effective filter and the
  6534. risk of various artefacts.
  6535. If the overlapping value doesn't permit processing the whole input width or
  6536. height, a warning will be displayed and according borders won't be denoised.
  6537. Default value is @var{blocksize}-1, which is the best possible setting.
  6538. @item expr, e
  6539. Set the coefficient factor expression.
  6540. For each coefficient of a DCT block, this expression will be evaluated as a
  6541. multiplier value for the coefficient.
  6542. If this is option is set, the @option{sigma} option will be ignored.
  6543. The absolute value of the coefficient can be accessed through the @var{c}
  6544. variable.
  6545. @item n
  6546. Set the @var{blocksize} using the number of bits. @code{1<<@var{n}} defines the
  6547. @var{blocksize}, which is the width and height of the processed blocks.
  6548. The default value is @var{3} (8x8) and can be raised to @var{4} for a
  6549. @var{blocksize} of 16x16. Note that changing this setting has huge consequences
  6550. on the speed processing. Also, a larger block size does not necessarily means a
  6551. better de-noising.
  6552. @end table
  6553. @subsection Examples
  6554. Apply a denoise with a @option{sigma} of @code{4.5}:
  6555. @example
  6556. dctdnoiz=4.5
  6557. @end example
  6558. The same operation can be achieved using the expression system:
  6559. @example
  6560. dctdnoiz=e='gte(c, 4.5*3)'
  6561. @end example
  6562. Violent denoise using a block size of @code{16x16}:
  6563. @example
  6564. dctdnoiz=15:n=4
  6565. @end example
  6566. @section deband
  6567. Remove banding artifacts from input video.
  6568. It works by replacing banded pixels with average value of referenced pixels.
  6569. The filter accepts the following options:
  6570. @table @option
  6571. @item 1thr
  6572. @item 2thr
  6573. @item 3thr
  6574. @item 4thr
  6575. Set banding detection threshold for each plane. Default is 0.02.
  6576. Valid range is 0.00003 to 0.5.
  6577. If difference between current pixel and reference pixel is less than threshold,
  6578. it will be considered as banded.
  6579. @item range, r
  6580. Banding detection range in pixels. Default is 16. If positive, random number
  6581. in range 0 to set value will be used. If negative, exact absolute value
  6582. will be used.
  6583. The range defines square of four pixels around current pixel.
  6584. @item direction, d
  6585. Set direction in radians from which four pixel will be compared. If positive,
  6586. random direction from 0 to set direction will be picked. If negative, exact of
  6587. absolute value will be picked. For example direction 0, -PI or -2*PI radians
  6588. will pick only pixels on same row and -PI/2 will pick only pixels on same
  6589. column.
  6590. @item blur, b
  6591. If enabled, current pixel is compared with average value of all four
  6592. surrounding pixels. The default is enabled. If disabled current pixel is
  6593. compared with all four surrounding pixels. The pixel is considered banded
  6594. if only all four differences with surrounding pixels are less than threshold.
  6595. @item coupling, c
  6596. If enabled, current pixel is changed if and only if all pixel components are banded,
  6597. e.g. banding detection threshold is triggered for all color components.
  6598. The default is disabled.
  6599. @end table
  6600. @section deblock
  6601. Remove blocking artifacts from input video.
  6602. The filter accepts the following options:
  6603. @table @option
  6604. @item filter
  6605. Set filter type, can be @var{weak} or @var{strong}. Default is @var{strong}.
  6606. This controls what kind of deblocking is applied.
  6607. @item block
  6608. Set size of block, allowed range is from 4 to 512. Default is @var{8}.
  6609. @item alpha
  6610. @item beta
  6611. @item gamma
  6612. @item delta
  6613. Set blocking detection thresholds. Allowed range is 0 to 1.
  6614. Defaults are: @var{0.098} for @var{alpha} and @var{0.05} for the rest.
  6615. Using higher threshold gives more deblocking strength.
  6616. Setting @var{alpha} controls threshold detection at exact edge of block.
  6617. Remaining options controls threshold detection near the edge. Each one for
  6618. below/above or left/right. Setting any of those to @var{0} disables
  6619. deblocking.
  6620. @item planes
  6621. Set planes to filter. Default is to filter all available planes.
  6622. @end table
  6623. @subsection Examples
  6624. @itemize
  6625. @item
  6626. Deblock using weak filter and block size of 4 pixels.
  6627. @example
  6628. deblock=filter=weak:block=4
  6629. @end example
  6630. @item
  6631. Deblock using strong filter, block size of 4 pixels and custom thresholds for
  6632. deblocking more edges.
  6633. @example
  6634. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05
  6635. @end example
  6636. @item
  6637. Similar as above, but filter only first plane.
  6638. @example
  6639. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=1
  6640. @end example
  6641. @item
  6642. Similar as above, but filter only second and third plane.
  6643. @example
  6644. deblock=filter=strong:block=4:alpha=0.12:beta=0.07:gamma=0.06:delta=0.05:planes=6
  6645. @end example
  6646. @end itemize
  6647. @anchor{decimate}
  6648. @section decimate
  6649. Drop duplicated frames at regular intervals.
  6650. The filter accepts the following options:
  6651. @table @option
  6652. @item cycle
  6653. Set the number of frames from which one will be dropped. Setting this to
  6654. @var{N} means one frame in every batch of @var{N} frames will be dropped.
  6655. Default is @code{5}.
  6656. @item dupthresh
  6657. Set the threshold for duplicate detection. If the difference metric for a frame
  6658. is less than or equal to this value, then it is declared as duplicate. Default
  6659. is @code{1.1}
  6660. @item scthresh
  6661. Set scene change threshold. Default is @code{15}.
  6662. @item blockx
  6663. @item blocky
  6664. Set the size of the x and y-axis blocks used during metric calculations.
  6665. Larger blocks give better noise suppression, but also give worse detection of
  6666. small movements. Must be a power of two. Default is @code{32}.
  6667. @item ppsrc
  6668. Mark main input as a pre-processed input and activate clean source input
  6669. stream. This allows the input to be pre-processed with various filters to help
  6670. the metrics calculation while keeping the frame selection lossless. When set to
  6671. @code{1}, the first stream is for the pre-processed input, and the second
  6672. stream is the clean source from where the kept frames are chosen. Default is
  6673. @code{0}.
  6674. @item chroma
  6675. Set whether or not chroma is considered in the metric calculations. Default is
  6676. @code{1}.
  6677. @end table
  6678. @section deconvolve
  6679. Apply 2D deconvolution of video stream in frequency domain using second stream
  6680. as impulse.
  6681. The filter accepts the following options:
  6682. @table @option
  6683. @item planes
  6684. Set which planes to process.
  6685. @item impulse
  6686. Set which impulse video frames will be processed, can be @var{first}
  6687. or @var{all}. Default is @var{all}.
  6688. @item noise
  6689. Set noise when doing divisions. Default is @var{0.0000001}. Useful when width
  6690. and height are not same and not power of 2 or if stream prior to convolving
  6691. had noise.
  6692. @end table
  6693. The @code{deconvolve} filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  6694. @section dedot
  6695. Reduce cross-luminance (dot-crawl) and cross-color (rainbows) from video.
  6696. It accepts the following options:
  6697. @table @option
  6698. @item m
  6699. Set mode of operation. Can be combination of @var{dotcrawl} for cross-luminance reduction and/or
  6700. @var{rainbows} for cross-color reduction.
  6701. @item lt
  6702. Set spatial luma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6703. @item tl
  6704. Set tolerance for temporal luma. Higher values increases reduction of cross-luminance.
  6705. @item tc
  6706. Set tolerance for chroma temporal variation. Higher values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6707. @item ct
  6708. Set temporal chroma threshold. Lower values increases reduction of cross-color.
  6709. @end table
  6710. @section deflate
  6711. Apply deflate effect to the video.
  6712. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  6713. only values lower than the pixel.
  6714. It accepts the following options:
  6715. @table @option
  6716. @item threshold0
  6717. @item threshold1
  6718. @item threshold2
  6719. @item threshold3
  6720. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6721. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6722. @end table
  6723. @subsection Commands
  6724. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6725. @section deflicker
  6726. Remove temporal frame luminance variations.
  6727. It accepts the following options:
  6728. @table @option
  6729. @item size, s
  6730. Set moving-average filter size in frames. Default is 5. Allowed range is 2 - 129.
  6731. @item mode, m
  6732. Set averaging mode to smooth temporal luminance variations.
  6733. Available values are:
  6734. @table @samp
  6735. @item am
  6736. Arithmetic mean
  6737. @item gm
  6738. Geometric mean
  6739. @item hm
  6740. Harmonic mean
  6741. @item qm
  6742. Quadratic mean
  6743. @item cm
  6744. Cubic mean
  6745. @item pm
  6746. Power mean
  6747. @item median
  6748. Median
  6749. @end table
  6750. @item bypass
  6751. Do not actually modify frame. Useful when one only wants metadata.
  6752. @end table
  6753. @section dejudder
  6754. Remove judder produced by partially interlaced telecined content.
  6755. Judder can be introduced, for instance, by @ref{pullup} filter. If the original
  6756. source was partially telecined content then the output of @code{pullup,dejudder}
  6757. will have a variable frame rate. May change the recorded frame rate of the
  6758. container. Aside from that change, this filter will not affect constant frame
  6759. rate video.
  6760. The option available in this filter is:
  6761. @table @option
  6762. @item cycle
  6763. Specify the length of the window over which the judder repeats.
  6764. Accepts any integer greater than 1. Useful values are:
  6765. @table @samp
  6766. @item 4
  6767. If the original was telecined from 24 to 30 fps (Film to NTSC).
  6768. @item 5
  6769. If the original was telecined from 25 to 30 fps (PAL to NTSC).
  6770. @item 20
  6771. If a mixture of the two.
  6772. @end table
  6773. The default is @samp{4}.
  6774. @end table
  6775. @section delogo
  6776. Suppress a TV station logo by a simple interpolation of the surrounding
  6777. pixels. Just set a rectangle covering the logo and watch it disappear
  6778. (and sometimes something even uglier appear - your mileage may vary).
  6779. It accepts the following parameters:
  6780. @table @option
  6781. @item x
  6782. @item y
  6783. Specify the top left corner coordinates of the logo. They must be
  6784. specified.
  6785. @item w
  6786. @item h
  6787. Specify the width and height of the logo to clear. They must be
  6788. specified.
  6789. @item band, t
  6790. Specify the thickness of the fuzzy edge of the rectangle (added to
  6791. @var{w} and @var{h}). The default value is 1. This option is
  6792. deprecated, setting higher values should no longer be necessary and
  6793. is not recommended.
  6794. @item show
  6795. When set to 1, a green rectangle is drawn on the screen to simplify
  6796. finding the right @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, and @var{h} parameters.
  6797. The default value is 0.
  6798. The rectangle is drawn on the outermost pixels which will be (partly)
  6799. replaced with interpolated values. The values of the next pixels
  6800. immediately outside this rectangle in each direction will be used to
  6801. compute the interpolated pixel values inside the rectangle.
  6802. @end table
  6803. @subsection Examples
  6804. @itemize
  6805. @item
  6806. Set a rectangle covering the area with top left corner coordinates 0,0
  6807. and size 100x77, and a band of size 10:
  6808. @example
  6809. delogo=x=0:y=0:w=100:h=77:band=10
  6810. @end example
  6811. @end itemize
  6812. @section derain
  6813. Remove the rain in the input image/video by applying the derain methods based on
  6814. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  6815. @itemize
  6816. @item
  6817. Recurrent Squeeze-and-Excitation Context Aggregation Net (RESCAN).
  6818. See @url{http://openaccess.thecvf.com/content_ECCV_2018/papers/Xia_Li_Recurrent_Squeeze-and-Excitation_Context_ECCV_2018_paper.pdf}.
  6819. @end itemize
  6820. Training as well as model generation scripts are provided in
  6821. the repository at @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/derain_filter.git}.
  6822. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  6823. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  6824. The filter accepts the following options:
  6825. @table @option
  6826. @item filter_type
  6827. Specify which filter to use. This option accepts the following values:
  6828. @table @samp
  6829. @item derain
  6830. Derain filter. To conduct derain filter, you need to use a derain model.
  6831. @item dehaze
  6832. Dehaze filter. To conduct dehaze filter, you need to use a dehaze model.
  6833. @end table
  6834. Default value is @samp{derain}.
  6835. @item dnn_backend
  6836. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  6837. the following values:
  6838. @table @samp
  6839. @item native
  6840. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  6841. @item tensorflow
  6842. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  6843. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  6844. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  6845. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  6846. @end table
  6847. Default value is @samp{native}.
  6848. @item model
  6849. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  6850. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  6851. backend can load files for only its format.
  6852. @end table
  6853. @section deshake
  6854. Attempt to fix small changes in horizontal and/or vertical shift. This
  6855. filter helps remove camera shake from hand-holding a camera, bumping a
  6856. tripod, moving on a vehicle, etc.
  6857. The filter accepts the following options:
  6858. @table @option
  6859. @item x
  6860. @item y
  6861. @item w
  6862. @item h
  6863. Specify a rectangular area where to limit the search for motion
  6864. vectors.
  6865. If desired the search for motion vectors can be limited to a
  6866. rectangular area of the frame defined by its top left corner, width
  6867. and height. These parameters have the same meaning as the drawbox
  6868. filter which can be used to visualise the position of the bounding
  6869. box.
  6870. This is useful when simultaneous movement of subjects within the frame
  6871. might be confused for camera motion by the motion vector search.
  6872. If any or all of @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} are set to -1
  6873. then the full frame is used. This allows later options to be set
  6874. without specifying the bounding box for the motion vector search.
  6875. Default - search the whole frame.
  6876. @item rx
  6877. @item ry
  6878. Specify the maximum extent of movement in x and y directions in the
  6879. range 0-64 pixels. Default 16.
  6880. @item edge
  6881. Specify how to generate pixels to fill blanks at the edge of the
  6882. frame. Available values are:
  6883. @table @samp
  6884. @item blank, 0
  6885. Fill zeroes at blank locations
  6886. @item original, 1
  6887. Original image at blank locations
  6888. @item clamp, 2
  6889. Extruded edge value at blank locations
  6890. @item mirror, 3
  6891. Mirrored edge at blank locations
  6892. @end table
  6893. Default value is @samp{mirror}.
  6894. @item blocksize
  6895. Specify the blocksize to use for motion search. Range 4-128 pixels,
  6896. default 8.
  6897. @item contrast
  6898. Specify the contrast threshold for blocks. Only blocks with more than
  6899. the specified contrast (difference between darkest and lightest
  6900. pixels) will be considered. Range 1-255, default 125.
  6901. @item search
  6902. Specify the search strategy. Available values are:
  6903. @table @samp
  6904. @item exhaustive, 0
  6905. Set exhaustive search
  6906. @item less, 1
  6907. Set less exhaustive search.
  6908. @end table
  6909. Default value is @samp{exhaustive}.
  6910. @item filename
  6911. If set then a detailed log of the motion search is written to the
  6912. specified file.
  6913. @end table
  6914. @section despill
  6915. Remove unwanted contamination of foreground colors, caused by reflected color of
  6916. greenscreen or bluescreen.
  6917. This filter accepts the following options:
  6918. @table @option
  6919. @item type
  6920. Set what type of despill to use.
  6921. @item mix
  6922. Set how spillmap will be generated.
  6923. @item expand
  6924. Set how much to get rid of still remaining spill.
  6925. @item red
  6926. Controls amount of red in spill area.
  6927. @item green
  6928. Controls amount of green in spill area.
  6929. Should be -1 for greenscreen.
  6930. @item blue
  6931. Controls amount of blue in spill area.
  6932. Should be -1 for bluescreen.
  6933. @item brightness
  6934. Controls brightness of spill area, preserving colors.
  6935. @item alpha
  6936. Modify alpha from generated spillmap.
  6937. @end table
  6938. @section detelecine
  6939. Apply an exact inverse of the telecine operation. It requires a predefined
  6940. pattern specified using the pattern option which must be the same as that passed
  6941. to the telecine filter.
  6942. This filter accepts the following options:
  6943. @table @option
  6944. @item first_field
  6945. @table @samp
  6946. @item top, t
  6947. top field first
  6948. @item bottom, b
  6949. bottom field first
  6950. The default value is @code{top}.
  6951. @end table
  6952. @item pattern
  6953. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  6954. The default value is @code{23}.
  6955. @item start_frame
  6956. A number representing position of the first frame with respect to the telecine
  6957. pattern. This is to be used if the stream is cut. The default value is @code{0}.
  6958. @end table
  6959. @section dilation
  6960. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  6961. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  6962. It accepts the following options:
  6963. @table @option
  6964. @item threshold0
  6965. @item threshold1
  6966. @item threshold2
  6967. @item threshold3
  6968. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  6969. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  6970. @item coordinates
  6971. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  6972. pixels are used.
  6973. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  6974. 1 2 3
  6975. 4 5
  6976. 6 7 8
  6977. @end table
  6978. @subsection Commands
  6979. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  6980. @section displace
  6981. Displace pixels as indicated by second and third input stream.
  6982. It takes three input streams and outputs one stream, the first input is the
  6983. source, and second and third input are displacement maps.
  6984. The second input specifies how much to displace pixels along the
  6985. x-axis, while the third input specifies how much to displace pixels
  6986. along the y-axis.
  6987. If one of displacement map streams terminates, last frame from that
  6988. displacement map will be used.
  6989. Note that once generated, displacements maps can be reused over and over again.
  6990. A description of the accepted options follows.
  6991. @table @option
  6992. @item edge
  6993. Set displace behavior for pixels that are out of range.
  6994. Available values are:
  6995. @table @samp
  6996. @item blank
  6997. Missing pixels are replaced by black pixels.
  6998. @item smear
  6999. Adjacent pixels will spread out to replace missing pixels.
  7000. @item wrap
  7001. Out of range pixels are wrapped so they point to pixels of other side.
  7002. @item mirror
  7003. Out of range pixels will be replaced with mirrored pixels.
  7004. @end table
  7005. Default is @samp{smear}.
  7006. @end table
  7007. @subsection Examples
  7008. @itemize
  7009. @item
  7010. Add ripple effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7011. @example
  7012. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,lutrgb=128:128:128 -f lavfi -i nullsrc=s=hd720,geq='r=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):g=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T):b=128+30*sin(2*PI*X/400+T)' -lavfi '[0][1][2]displace' OUTPUT
  7013. @end example
  7014. @item
  7015. Add wave effect to rgb input of video size hd720:
  7016. @example
  7017. ffmpeg -i INPUT -f lavfi -i nullsrc=hd720,geq='r=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):g=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T)):b=128+80*(sin(sqrt((X-W/2)*(X-W/2)+(Y-H/2)*(Y-H/2))/220*2*PI+T))' -lavfi '[1]split[x][y],[0][x][y]displace' OUTPUT
  7018. @end example
  7019. @end itemize
  7020. @section dnn_processing
  7021. Do image processing with deep neural networks. It works together with another filter
  7022. which converts the pixel format of the Frame to what the dnn network requires.
  7023. The filter accepts the following options:
  7024. @table @option
  7025. @item dnn_backend
  7026. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  7027. the following values:
  7028. @table @samp
  7029. @item native
  7030. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  7031. @item tensorflow
  7032. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  7033. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  7034. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  7035. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  7036. @end table
  7037. Default value is @samp{native}.
  7038. @item model
  7039. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  7040. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow and native
  7041. backend can load files for only its format.
  7042. Native model file (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model file (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  7043. @item input
  7044. Set the input name of the dnn network.
  7045. @item output
  7046. Set the output name of the dnn network.
  7047. @end table
  7048. @itemize
  7049. @item
  7050. Halve the red channle of the frame with format rgb24:
  7051. @example
  7052. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=rgb24,dnn_processing=model=halve_first_channel.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native out.native.png
  7053. @end example
  7054. @item
  7055. Halve the pixel value of the frame with format gray32f:
  7056. @example
  7057. ffmpeg -i input.jpg -vf format=grayf32,dnn_processing=model=halve_gray_float.model:input=dnn_in:output=dnn_out:dnn_backend=native -y out.native.png
  7058. @end example
  7059. @end itemize
  7060. @section drawbox
  7061. Draw a colored box on the input image.
  7062. It accepts the following parameters:
  7063. @table @option
  7064. @item x
  7065. @item y
  7066. The expressions which specify the top left corner coordinates of the box. It defaults to 0.
  7067. @item width, w
  7068. @item height, h
  7069. The expressions which specify the width and height of the box; if 0 they are interpreted as
  7070. the input width and height. It defaults to 0.
  7071. @item color, c
  7072. Specify the color of the box to write. For the general syntax of this option,
  7073. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7074. value @code{invert} is used, the box edge color is the same as the
  7075. video with inverted luma.
  7076. @item thickness, t
  7077. The expression which sets the thickness of the box edge.
  7078. A value of @code{fill} will create a filled box. Default value is @code{3}.
  7079. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7080. @item replace
  7081. Applicable if the input has alpha. With value @code{1}, the pixels of the painted box
  7082. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7083. Default is @code{0}, which composites the box onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7084. @end table
  7085. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7086. following constants:
  7087. @table @option
  7088. @item dar
  7089. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7090. @item hsub
  7091. @item vsub
  7092. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7093. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7094. @item in_h, ih
  7095. @item in_w, iw
  7096. The input width and height.
  7097. @item sar
  7098. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7099. @item x
  7100. @item y
  7101. The x and y offset coordinates where the box is drawn.
  7102. @item w
  7103. @item h
  7104. The width and height of the drawn box.
  7105. @item t
  7106. The thickness of the drawn box.
  7107. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7108. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7109. @end table
  7110. @subsection Examples
  7111. @itemize
  7112. @item
  7113. Draw a black box around the edge of the input image:
  7114. @example
  7115. drawbox
  7116. @end example
  7117. @item
  7118. Draw a box with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7119. @example
  7120. drawbox=10:20:200:60:red@@0.5
  7121. @end example
  7122. The previous example can be specified as:
  7123. @example
  7124. drawbox=x=10:y=20:w=200:h=60:color=red@@0.5
  7125. @end example
  7126. @item
  7127. Fill the box with pink color:
  7128. @example
  7129. drawbox=x=10:y=10:w=100:h=100:color=pink@@0.5:t=fill
  7130. @end example
  7131. @item
  7132. Draw a 2-pixel red 2.40:1 mask:
  7133. @example
  7134. drawbox=x=-t:y=0.5*(ih-iw/2.4)-t:w=iw+t*2:h=iw/2.4+t*2:t=2:c=red
  7135. @end example
  7136. @end itemize
  7137. @subsection Commands
  7138. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7139. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7140. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7141. value.
  7142. @anchor{drawgraph}
  7143. @section drawgraph
  7144. Draw a graph using input video metadata.
  7145. It accepts the following parameters:
  7146. @table @option
  7147. @item m1
  7148. Set 1st frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7149. @item fg1
  7150. Set 1st foreground color expression.
  7151. @item m2
  7152. Set 2nd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7153. @item fg2
  7154. Set 2nd foreground color expression.
  7155. @item m3
  7156. Set 3rd frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7157. @item fg3
  7158. Set 3rd foreground color expression.
  7159. @item m4
  7160. Set 4th frame metadata key from which metadata values will be used to draw a graph.
  7161. @item fg4
  7162. Set 4th foreground color expression.
  7163. @item min
  7164. Set minimal value of metadata value.
  7165. @item max
  7166. Set maximal value of metadata value.
  7167. @item bg
  7168. Set graph background color. Default is white.
  7169. @item mode
  7170. Set graph mode.
  7171. Available values for mode is:
  7172. @table @samp
  7173. @item bar
  7174. @item dot
  7175. @item line
  7176. @end table
  7177. Default is @code{line}.
  7178. @item slide
  7179. Set slide mode.
  7180. Available values for slide is:
  7181. @table @samp
  7182. @item frame
  7183. Draw new frame when right border is reached.
  7184. @item replace
  7185. Replace old columns with new ones.
  7186. @item scroll
  7187. Scroll from right to left.
  7188. @item rscroll
  7189. Scroll from left to right.
  7190. @item picture
  7191. Draw single picture.
  7192. @end table
  7193. Default is @code{frame}.
  7194. @item size
  7195. Set size of graph video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  7196. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7197. The default value is @code{900x256}.
  7198. @item rate, r
  7199. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  7200. The foreground color expressions can use the following variables:
  7201. @table @option
  7202. @item MIN
  7203. Minimal value of metadata value.
  7204. @item MAX
  7205. Maximal value of metadata value.
  7206. @item VAL
  7207. Current metadata key value.
  7208. @end table
  7209. The color is defined as 0xAABBGGRR.
  7210. @end table
  7211. Example using metadata from @ref{signalstats} filter:
  7212. @example
  7213. signalstats,drawgraph=lavfi.signalstats.YAVG:min=0:max=255
  7214. @end example
  7215. Example using metadata from @ref{ebur128} filter:
  7216. @example
  7217. ebur128=metadata=1,adrawgraph=lavfi.r128.M:min=-120:max=5
  7218. @end example
  7219. @section drawgrid
  7220. Draw a grid on the input image.
  7221. It accepts the following parameters:
  7222. @table @option
  7223. @item x
  7224. @item y
  7225. The expressions which specify the coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset). Both default to 0.
  7226. @item width, w
  7227. @item height, h
  7228. The expressions which specify the width and height of the grid cell, if 0 they are interpreted as the
  7229. input width and height, respectively, minus @code{thickness}, so image gets
  7230. framed. Default to 0.
  7231. @item color, c
  7232. Specify the color of the grid. For the general syntax of this option,
  7233. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. If the special
  7234. value @code{invert} is used, the grid color is the same as the
  7235. video with inverted luma.
  7236. @item thickness, t
  7237. The expression which sets the thickness of the grid line. Default value is @code{1}.
  7238. See below for the list of accepted constants.
  7239. @item replace
  7240. Applicable if the input has alpha. With @code{1} the pixels of the painted grid
  7241. will overwrite the video's color and alpha pixels.
  7242. Default is @code{0}, which composites the grid onto the input, leaving the video's alpha intact.
  7243. @end table
  7244. The parameters for @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w} and @var{h} and @var{t} are expressions containing the
  7245. following constants:
  7246. @table @option
  7247. @item dar
  7248. The input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  7249. @item hsub
  7250. @item vsub
  7251. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7252. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7253. @item in_h, ih
  7254. @item in_w, iw
  7255. The input grid cell width and height.
  7256. @item sar
  7257. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7258. @item x
  7259. @item y
  7260. The x and y coordinates of some point of grid intersection (meant to configure offset).
  7261. @item w
  7262. @item h
  7263. The width and height of the drawn cell.
  7264. @item t
  7265. The thickness of the drawn cell.
  7266. These constants allow the @var{x}, @var{y}, @var{w}, @var{h} and @var{t} expressions to refer to
  7267. each other, so you may for example specify @code{y=x/dar} or @code{h=w/dar}.
  7268. @end table
  7269. @subsection Examples
  7270. @itemize
  7271. @item
  7272. Draw a grid with cell 100x100 pixels, thickness 2 pixels, with color red and an opacity of 50%:
  7273. @example
  7274. drawgrid=width=100:height=100:thickness=2:color=red@@0.5
  7275. @end example
  7276. @item
  7277. Draw a white 3x3 grid with an opacity of 50%:
  7278. @example
  7279. drawgrid=w=iw/3:h=ih/3:t=2:c=white@@0.5
  7280. @end example
  7281. @end itemize
  7282. @subsection Commands
  7283. This filter supports same commands as options.
  7284. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7285. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7286. value.
  7287. @anchor{drawtext}
  7288. @section drawtext
  7289. Draw a text string or text from a specified file on top of a video, using the
  7290. libfreetype library.
  7291. To enable compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7292. @code{--enable-libfreetype}.
  7293. To enable default font fallback and the @var{font} option you need to
  7294. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libfontconfig}.
  7295. To enable the @var{text_shaping} option, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  7296. @code{--enable-libfribidi}.
  7297. @subsection Syntax
  7298. It accepts the following parameters:
  7299. @table @option
  7300. @item box
  7301. Used to draw a box around text using the background color.
  7302. The value must be either 1 (enable) or 0 (disable).
  7303. The default value of @var{box} is 0.
  7304. @item boxborderw
  7305. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{boxcolor}.
  7306. The default value of @var{boxborderw} is 0.
  7307. @item boxcolor
  7308. The color to be used for drawing box around text. For the syntax of this
  7309. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7310. The default value of @var{boxcolor} is "white".
  7311. @item line_spacing
  7312. Set the line spacing in pixels of the border to be drawn around the box using @var{box}.
  7313. The default value of @var{line_spacing} is 0.
  7314. @item borderw
  7315. Set the width of the border to be drawn around the text using @var{bordercolor}.
  7316. The default value of @var{borderw} is 0.
  7317. @item bordercolor
  7318. Set the color to be used for drawing border around text. For the syntax of this
  7319. option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7320. The default value of @var{bordercolor} is "black".
  7321. @item expansion
  7322. Select how the @var{text} is expanded. Can be either @code{none},
  7323. @code{strftime} (deprecated) or
  7324. @code{normal} (default). See the @ref{drawtext_expansion, Text expansion} section
  7325. below for details.
  7326. @item basetime
  7327. Set a start time for the count. Value is in microseconds. Only applied
  7328. in the deprecated strftime expansion mode. To emulate in normal expansion
  7329. mode use the @code{pts} function, supplying the start time (in seconds)
  7330. as the second argument.
  7331. @item fix_bounds
  7332. If true, check and fix text coords to avoid clipping.
  7333. @item fontcolor
  7334. The color to be used for drawing fonts. For the syntax of this option, check
  7335. the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7336. The default value of @var{fontcolor} is "black".
  7337. @item fontcolor_expr
  7338. String which is expanded the same way as @var{text} to obtain dynamic
  7339. @var{fontcolor} value. By default this option has empty value and is not
  7340. processed. When this option is set, it overrides @var{fontcolor} option.
  7341. @item font
  7342. The font family to be used for drawing text. By default Sans.
  7343. @item fontfile
  7344. The font file to be used for drawing text. The path must be included.
  7345. This parameter is mandatory if the fontconfig support is disabled.
  7346. @item alpha
  7347. Draw the text applying alpha blending. The value can
  7348. be a number between 0.0 and 1.0.
  7349. The expression accepts the same variables @var{x, y} as well.
  7350. The default value is 1.
  7351. Please see @var{fontcolor_expr}.
  7352. @item fontsize
  7353. The font size to be used for drawing text.
  7354. The default value of @var{fontsize} is 16.
  7355. @item text_shaping
  7356. If set to 1, attempt to shape the text (for example, reverse the order of
  7357. right-to-left text and join Arabic characters) before drawing it.
  7358. Otherwise, just draw the text exactly as given.
  7359. By default 1 (if supported).
  7360. @item ft_load_flags
  7361. The flags to be used for loading the fonts.
  7362. The flags map the corresponding flags supported by libfreetype, and are
  7363. a combination of the following values:
  7364. @table @var
  7365. @item default
  7366. @item no_scale
  7367. @item no_hinting
  7368. @item render
  7369. @item no_bitmap
  7370. @item vertical_layout
  7371. @item force_autohint
  7372. @item crop_bitmap
  7373. @item pedantic
  7374. @item ignore_global_advance_width
  7375. @item no_recurse
  7376. @item ignore_transform
  7377. @item monochrome
  7378. @item linear_design
  7379. @item no_autohint
  7380. @end table
  7381. Default value is "default".
  7382. For more information consult the documentation for the FT_LOAD_*
  7383. libfreetype flags.
  7384. @item shadowcolor
  7385. The color to be used for drawing a shadow behind the drawn text. For the
  7386. syntax of this option, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  7387. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  7388. The default value of @var{shadowcolor} is "black".
  7389. @item shadowx
  7390. @item shadowy
  7391. The x and y offsets for the text shadow position with respect to the
  7392. position of the text. They can be either positive or negative
  7393. values. The default value for both is "0".
  7394. @item start_number
  7395. The starting frame number for the n/frame_num variable. The default value
  7396. is "0".
  7397. @item tabsize
  7398. The size in number of spaces to use for rendering the tab.
  7399. Default value is 4.
  7400. @item timecode
  7401. Set the initial timecode representation in "hh:mm:ss[:;.]ff"
  7402. format. It can be used with or without text parameter. @var{timecode_rate}
  7403. option must be specified.
  7404. @item timecode_rate, rate, r
  7405. Set the timecode frame rate (timecode only). Value will be rounded to nearest
  7406. integer. Minimum value is "1".
  7407. Drop-frame timecode is supported for frame rates 30 & 60.
  7408. @item tc24hmax
  7409. If set to 1, the output of the timecode option will wrap around at 24 hours.
  7410. Default is 0 (disabled).
  7411. @item text
  7412. The text string to be drawn. The text must be a sequence of UTF-8
  7413. encoded characters.
  7414. This parameter is mandatory if no file is specified with the parameter
  7415. @var{textfile}.
  7416. @item textfile
  7417. A text file containing text to be drawn. The text must be a sequence
  7418. of UTF-8 encoded characters.
  7419. This parameter is mandatory if no text string is specified with the
  7420. parameter @var{text}.
  7421. If both @var{text} and @var{textfile} are specified, an error is thrown.
  7422. @item reload
  7423. If set to 1, the @var{textfile} will be reloaded before each frame.
  7424. Be sure to update it atomically, or it may be read partially, or even fail.
  7425. @item x
  7426. @item y
  7427. The expressions which specify the offsets where text will be drawn
  7428. within the video frame. They are relative to the top/left border of the
  7429. output image.
  7430. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is "0".
  7431. See below for the list of accepted constants and functions.
  7432. @end table
  7433. The parameters for @var{x} and @var{y} are expressions containing the
  7434. following constants and functions:
  7435. @table @option
  7436. @item dar
  7437. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  7438. @item hsub
  7439. @item vsub
  7440. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  7441. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  7442. @item line_h, lh
  7443. the height of each text line
  7444. @item main_h, h, H
  7445. the input height
  7446. @item main_w, w, W
  7447. the input width
  7448. @item max_glyph_a, ascent
  7449. the maximum distance from the baseline to the highest/upper grid
  7450. coordinate used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered
  7451. glyphs.
  7452. It is a positive value, due to the grid's orientation with the Y axis
  7453. upwards.
  7454. @item max_glyph_d, descent
  7455. the maximum distance from the baseline to the lowest grid coordinate
  7456. used to place a glyph outline point, for all the rendered glyphs.
  7457. This is a negative value, due to the grid's orientation, with the Y axis
  7458. upwards.
  7459. @item max_glyph_h
  7460. maximum glyph height, that is the maximum height for all the glyphs
  7461. contained in the rendered text, it is equivalent to @var{ascent} -
  7462. @var{descent}.
  7463. @item max_glyph_w
  7464. maximum glyph width, that is the maximum width for all the glyphs
  7465. contained in the rendered text
  7466. @item n
  7467. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  7468. @item rand(min, max)
  7469. return a random number included between @var{min} and @var{max}
  7470. @item sar
  7471. The input sample aspect ratio.
  7472. @item t
  7473. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7474. @item text_h, th
  7475. the height of the rendered text
  7476. @item text_w, tw
  7477. the width of the rendered text
  7478. @item x
  7479. @item y
  7480. the x and y offset coordinates where the text is drawn.
  7481. These parameters allow the @var{x} and @var{y} expressions to refer
  7482. to each other, so you can for example specify @code{y=x/dar}.
  7483. @item pict_type
  7484. A one character description of the current frame's picture type.
  7485. @item pkt_pos
  7486. The current packet's position in the input file or stream
  7487. (in bytes, from the start of the input). A value of -1 indicates
  7488. this info is not available.
  7489. @item pkt_duration
  7490. The current packet's duration, in seconds.
  7491. @item pkt_size
  7492. The current packet's size (in bytes).
  7493. @end table
  7494. @anchor{drawtext_expansion}
  7495. @subsection Text expansion
  7496. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{strftime},
  7497. the filter recognizes strftime() sequences in the provided text and
  7498. expands them accordingly. Check the documentation of strftime(). This
  7499. feature is deprecated.
  7500. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{none}, the text is printed verbatim.
  7501. If @option{expansion} is set to @code{normal} (which is the default),
  7502. the following expansion mechanism is used.
  7503. The backslash character @samp{\}, followed by any character, always expands to
  7504. the second character.
  7505. Sequences of the form @code{%@{...@}} are expanded. The text between the
  7506. braces is a function name, possibly followed by arguments separated by ':'.
  7507. If the arguments contain special characters or delimiters (':' or '@}'),
  7508. they should be escaped.
  7509. Note that they probably must also be escaped as the value for the
  7510. @option{text} option in the filter argument string and as the filter
  7511. argument in the filtergraph description, and possibly also for the shell,
  7512. that makes up to four levels of escaping; using a text file avoids these
  7513. problems.
  7514. The following functions are available:
  7515. @table @command
  7516. @item expr, e
  7517. The expression evaluation result.
  7518. It must take one argument specifying the expression to be evaluated,
  7519. which accepts the same constants and functions as the @var{x} and
  7520. @var{y} values. Note that not all constants should be used, for
  7521. example the text size is not known when evaluating the expression, so
  7522. the constants @var{text_w} and @var{text_h} will have an undefined
  7523. value.
  7524. @item expr_int_format, eif
  7525. Evaluate the expression's value and output as formatted integer.
  7526. The first argument is the expression to be evaluated, just as for the @var{expr} function.
  7527. The second argument specifies the output format. Allowed values are @samp{x},
  7528. @samp{X}, @samp{d} and @samp{u}. They are treated exactly as in the
  7529. @code{printf} function.
  7530. The third parameter is optional and sets the number of positions taken by the output.
  7531. It can be used to add padding with zeros from the left.
  7532. @item gmtime
  7533. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in UTC.
  7534. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7535. @item localtime
  7536. The time at which the filter is running, expressed in the local time zone.
  7537. It can accept an argument: a strftime() format string.
  7538. @item metadata
  7539. Frame metadata. Takes one or two arguments.
  7540. The first argument is mandatory and specifies the metadata key.
  7541. The second argument is optional and specifies a default value, used when the
  7542. metadata key is not found or empty.
  7543. Available metadata can be identified by inspecting entries
  7544. starting with TAG included within each frame section
  7545. printed by running @code{ffprobe -show_frames}.
  7546. String metadata generated in filters leading to
  7547. the drawtext filter are also available.
  7548. @item n, frame_num
  7549. The frame number, starting from 0.
  7550. @item pict_type
  7551. A one character description of the current picture type.
  7552. @item pts
  7553. The timestamp of the current frame.
  7554. It can take up to three arguments.
  7555. The first argument is the format of the timestamp; it defaults to @code{flt}
  7556. for seconds as a decimal number with microsecond accuracy; @code{hms} stands
  7557. for a formatted @var{[-]HH:MM:SS.mmm} timestamp with millisecond accuracy.
  7558. @code{gmtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as UTC time;
  7559. @code{localtime} stands for the timestamp of the frame formatted as
  7560. local time zone time.
  7561. The second argument is an offset added to the timestamp.
  7562. If the format is set to @code{hms}, a third argument @code{24HH} may be
  7563. supplied to present the hour part of the formatted timestamp in 24h format
  7564. (00-23).
  7565. If the format is set to @code{localtime} or @code{gmtime},
  7566. a third argument may be supplied: a strftime() format string.
  7567. By default, @var{YYYY-MM-DD HH:MM:SS} format will be used.
  7568. @end table
  7569. @subsection Commands
  7570. This filter supports altering parameters via commands:
  7571. @table @option
  7572. @item reinit
  7573. Alter existing filter parameters.
  7574. Syntax for the argument is the same as for filter invocation, e.g.
  7575. @example
  7576. fontsize=56:fontcolor=green:text='Hello World'
  7577. @end example
  7578. Full filter invocation with sendcmd would look like this:
  7579. @example
  7580. sendcmd=c='56.0 drawtext reinit fontsize=56\:fontcolor=green\:text=Hello\\ World'
  7581. @end example
  7582. @end table
  7583. If the entire argument can't be parsed or applied as valid values then the filter will
  7584. continue with its existing parameters.
  7585. @subsection Examples
  7586. @itemize
  7587. @item
  7588. Draw "Test Text" with font FreeSerif, using the default values for the
  7589. optional parameters.
  7590. @example
  7591. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text'"
  7592. @end example
  7593. @item
  7594. Draw 'Test Text' with font FreeSerif of size 24 at position x=100
  7595. and y=50 (counting from the top-left corner of the screen), text is
  7596. yellow with a red box around it. Both the text and the box have an
  7597. opacity of 20%.
  7598. @example
  7599. drawtext="fontfile=/usr/share/fonts/truetype/freefont/FreeSerif.ttf: text='Test Text':\
  7600. x=100: y=50: fontsize=24: fontcolor=yellow@@0.2: box=1: boxcolor=red@@0.2"
  7601. @end example
  7602. Note that the double quotes are not necessary if spaces are not used
  7603. within the parameter list.
  7604. @item
  7605. Show the text at the center of the video frame:
  7606. @example
  7607. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=(w-text_w)/2:y=(h-text_h)/2"
  7608. @end example
  7609. @item
  7610. Show the text at a random position, switching to a new position every 30 seconds:
  7611. @example
  7612. drawtext="fontsize=30:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='hello world':x=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(w-text_w))\,x):y=if(eq(mod(t\,30)\,0)\,rand(0\,(h-text_h))\,y)"
  7613. @end example
  7614. @item
  7615. Show a text line sliding from right to left in the last row of the video
  7616. frame. The file @file{LONG_LINE} is assumed to contain a single line
  7617. with no newlines.
  7618. @example
  7619. drawtext="fontsize=15:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=LONG_LINE:y=h-line_h:x=-50*t"
  7620. @end example
  7621. @item
  7622. Show the content of file @file{CREDITS} off the bottom of the frame and scroll up.
  7623. @example
  7624. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=CREDITS:y=h-20*t"
  7625. @end example
  7626. @item
  7627. Draw a single green letter "g", at the center of the input video.
  7628. The glyph baseline is placed at half screen height.
  7629. @example
  7630. drawtext="fontsize=60:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=green:text=g:x=(w-max_glyph_w)/2:y=h/2-ascent"
  7631. @end example
  7632. @item
  7633. Show text for 1 second every 3 seconds:
  7634. @example
  7635. drawtext="fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor=white:x=100:y=x/dar:enable=lt(mod(t\,3)\,1):text='blink'"
  7636. @end example
  7637. @item
  7638. Use fontconfig to set the font. Note that the colons need to be escaped.
  7639. @example
  7640. drawtext='fontfile=Linux Libertine O-40\:style=Semibold:text=FFmpeg'
  7641. @end example
  7642. @item
  7643. Print the date of a real-time encoding (see strftime(3)):
  7644. @example
  7645. drawtext='fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=%@{localtime\:%a %b %d %Y@}'
  7646. @end example
  7647. @item
  7648. Show text fading in and out (appearing/disappearing):
  7649. @example
  7650. #!/bin/sh
  7651. DS=1.0 # display start
  7652. DE=10.0 # display end
  7653. FID=1.5 # fade in duration
  7654. FOD=5 # fade out duration
  7655. ffplay -f lavfi "color,drawtext=text=TEST:fontsize=50:fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:fontcolor_expr=ff0000%@{eif\\\\: clip(255*(1*between(t\\, $DS + $FID\\, $DE - $FOD) + ((t - $DS)/$FID)*between(t\\, $DS\\, $DS + $FID) + (-(t - $DE)/$FOD)*between(t\\, $DE - $FOD\\, $DE) )\\, 0\\, 255) \\\\: x\\\\: 2 @}"
  7656. @end example
  7657. @item
  7658. Horizontally align multiple separate texts. Note that @option{max_glyph_a}
  7659. and the @option{fontsize} value are included in the @option{y} offset.
  7660. @example
  7661. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=DOG:fontsize=24:x=10:y=20+24-max_glyph_a,
  7662. drawtext=fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text=cow:fontsize=24:x=80:y=20+24-max_glyph_a
  7663. @end example
  7664. @item
  7665. Plot special @var{lavf.image2dec.source_basename} metadata onto each frame if
  7666. such metadata exists. Otherwise, plot the string "NA". Note that image2 demuxer
  7667. must have option @option{-export_path_metadata 1} for the special metadata fields
  7668. to be available for filters.
  7669. @example
  7670. drawtext="fontsize=20:fontcolor=white:fontfile=FreeSans.ttf:text='%@{metadata\:lavf.image2dec.source_basename\:NA@}':x=10:y=10"
  7671. @end example
  7672. @end itemize
  7673. For more information about libfreetype, check:
  7674. @url{http://www.freetype.org/}.
  7675. For more information about fontconfig, check:
  7676. @url{http://freedesktop.org/software/fontconfig/fontconfig-user.html}.
  7677. For more information about libfribidi, check:
  7678. @url{http://fribidi.org/}.
  7679. @section edgedetect
  7680. Detect and draw edges. The filter uses the Canny Edge Detection algorithm.
  7681. The filter accepts the following options:
  7682. @table @option
  7683. @item low
  7684. @item high
  7685. Set low and high threshold values used by the Canny thresholding
  7686. algorithm.
  7687. The high threshold selects the "strong" edge pixels, which are then
  7688. connected through 8-connectivity with the "weak" edge pixels selected
  7689. by the low threshold.
  7690. @var{low} and @var{high} threshold values must be chosen in the range
  7691. [0,1], and @var{low} should be lesser or equal to @var{high}.
  7692. Default value for @var{low} is @code{20/255}, and default value for @var{high}
  7693. is @code{50/255}.
  7694. @item mode
  7695. Define the drawing mode.
  7696. @table @samp
  7697. @item wires
  7698. Draw white/gray wires on black background.
  7699. @item colormix
  7700. Mix the colors to create a paint/cartoon effect.
  7701. @item canny
  7702. Apply Canny edge detector on all selected planes.
  7703. @end table
  7704. Default value is @var{wires}.
  7705. @item planes
  7706. Select planes for filtering. By default all available planes are filtered.
  7707. @end table
  7708. @subsection Examples
  7709. @itemize
  7710. @item
  7711. Standard edge detection with custom values for the hysteresis thresholding:
  7712. @example
  7713. edgedetect=low=0.1:high=0.4
  7714. @end example
  7715. @item
  7716. Painting effect without thresholding:
  7717. @example
  7718. edgedetect=mode=colormix:high=0
  7719. @end example
  7720. @end itemize
  7721. @section elbg
  7722. Apply a posterize effect using the ELBG (Enhanced LBG) algorithm.
  7723. For each input image, the filter will compute the optimal mapping from
  7724. the input to the output given the codebook length, that is the number
  7725. of distinct output colors.
  7726. This filter accepts the following options.
  7727. @table @option
  7728. @item codebook_length, l
  7729. Set codebook length. The value must be a positive integer, and
  7730. represents the number of distinct output colors. Default value is 256.
  7731. @item nb_steps, n
  7732. Set the maximum number of iterations to apply for computing the optimal
  7733. mapping. The higher the value the better the result and the higher the
  7734. computation time. Default value is 1.
  7735. @item seed, s
  7736. Set a random seed, must be an integer included between 0 and
  7737. UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly set to -1, the filter
  7738. will try to use a good random seed on a best effort basis.
  7739. @item pal8
  7740. Set pal8 output pixel format. This option does not work with codebook
  7741. length greater than 256.
  7742. @end table
  7743. @section entropy
  7744. Measure graylevel entropy in histogram of color channels of video frames.
  7745. It accepts the following parameters:
  7746. @table @option
  7747. @item mode
  7748. Can be either @var{normal} or @var{diff}. Default is @var{normal}.
  7749. @var{diff} mode measures entropy of histogram delta values, absolute differences
  7750. between neighbour histogram values.
  7751. @end table
  7752. @section eq
  7753. Set brightness, contrast, saturation and approximate gamma adjustment.
  7754. The filter accepts the following options:
  7755. @table @option
  7756. @item contrast
  7757. Set the contrast expression. The value must be a float value in range
  7758. @code{-1000.0} to @code{1000.0}. The default value is "1".
  7759. @item brightness
  7760. Set the brightness expression. The value must be a float value in
  7761. range @code{-1.0} to @code{1.0}. The default value is "0".
  7762. @item saturation
  7763. Set the saturation expression. The value must be a float in
  7764. range @code{0.0} to @code{3.0}. The default value is "1".
  7765. @item gamma
  7766. Set the gamma expression. The value must be a float in range
  7767. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7768. @item gamma_r
  7769. Set the gamma expression for red. The value must be a float in
  7770. range @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7771. @item gamma_g
  7772. Set the gamma expression for green. The value must be a float in range
  7773. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7774. @item gamma_b
  7775. Set the gamma expression for blue. The value must be a float in range
  7776. @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}. The default value is "1".
  7777. @item gamma_weight
  7778. Set the gamma weight expression. It can be used to reduce the effect
  7779. of a high gamma value on bright image areas, e.g. keep them from
  7780. getting overamplified and just plain white. The value must be a float
  7781. in range @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}. A value of @code{0.0} turns the
  7782. gamma correction all the way down while @code{1.0} leaves it at its
  7783. full strength. Default is "1".
  7784. @item eval
  7785. Set when the expressions for brightness, contrast, saturation and
  7786. gamma expressions are evaluated.
  7787. It accepts the following values:
  7788. @table @samp
  7789. @item init
  7790. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  7791. when a command is processed
  7792. @item frame
  7793. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  7794. @end table
  7795. Default value is @samp{init}.
  7796. @end table
  7797. The expressions accept the following parameters:
  7798. @table @option
  7799. @item n
  7800. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  7801. @item pos
  7802. byte position of the corresponding packet in the input file, NAN if
  7803. unspecified
  7804. @item r
  7805. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  7806. @item t
  7807. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  7808. @end table
  7809. @subsection Commands
  7810. The filter supports the following commands:
  7811. @table @option
  7812. @item contrast
  7813. Set the contrast expression.
  7814. @item brightness
  7815. Set the brightness expression.
  7816. @item saturation
  7817. Set the saturation expression.
  7818. @item gamma
  7819. Set the gamma expression.
  7820. @item gamma_r
  7821. Set the gamma_r expression.
  7822. @item gamma_g
  7823. Set gamma_g expression.
  7824. @item gamma_b
  7825. Set gamma_b expression.
  7826. @item gamma_weight
  7827. Set gamma_weight expression.
  7828. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  7829. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  7830. value.
  7831. @end table
  7832. @section erosion
  7833. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  7834. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  7835. It accepts the following options:
  7836. @table @option
  7837. @item threshold0
  7838. @item threshold1
  7839. @item threshold2
  7840. @item threshold3
  7841. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  7842. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  7843. @item coordinates
  7844. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to. Default is 255 i.e. all eight
  7845. pixels are used.
  7846. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates maps like this:
  7847. 1 2 3
  7848. 4 5
  7849. 6 7 8
  7850. @end table
  7851. @subsection Commands
  7852. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  7853. @section extractplanes
  7854. Extract color channel components from input video stream into
  7855. separate grayscale video streams.
  7856. The filter accepts the following option:
  7857. @table @option
  7858. @item planes
  7859. Set plane(s) to extract.
  7860. Available values for planes are:
  7861. @table @samp
  7862. @item y
  7863. @item u
  7864. @item v
  7865. @item a
  7866. @item r
  7867. @item g
  7868. @item b
  7869. @end table
  7870. Choosing planes not available in the input will result in an error.
  7871. That means you cannot select @code{r}, @code{g}, @code{b} planes
  7872. with @code{y}, @code{u}, @code{v} planes at same time.
  7873. @end table
  7874. @subsection Examples
  7875. @itemize
  7876. @item
  7877. Extract luma, u and v color channel component from input video frame
  7878. into 3 grayscale outputs:
  7879. @example
  7880. ffmpeg -i video.avi -filter_complex 'extractplanes=y+u+v[y][u][v]' -map '[y]' y.avi -map '[u]' u.avi -map '[v]' v.avi
  7881. @end example
  7882. @end itemize
  7883. @section fade
  7884. Apply a fade-in/out effect to the input video.
  7885. It accepts the following parameters:
  7886. @table @option
  7887. @item type, t
  7888. The effect type can be either "in" for a fade-in, or "out" for a fade-out
  7889. effect.
  7890. Default is @code{in}.
  7891. @item start_frame, s
  7892. Specify the number of the frame to start applying the fade
  7893. effect at. Default is 0.
  7894. @item nb_frames, n
  7895. The number of frames that the fade effect lasts. At the end of the
  7896. fade-in effect, the output video will have the same intensity as the input video.
  7897. At the end of the fade-out transition, the output video will be filled with the
  7898. selected @option{color}.
  7899. Default is 25.
  7900. @item alpha
  7901. If set to 1, fade only alpha channel, if one exists on the input.
  7902. Default value is 0.
  7903. @item start_time, st
  7904. Specify the timestamp (in seconds) of the frame to start to apply the fade
  7905. effect. If both start_frame and start_time are specified, the fade will start at
  7906. whichever comes last. Default is 0.
  7907. @item duration, d
  7908. The number of seconds for which the fade effect has to last. At the end of the
  7909. fade-in effect the output video will have the same intensity as the input video,
  7910. at the end of the fade-out transition the output video will be filled with the
  7911. selected @option{color}.
  7912. If both duration and nb_frames are specified, duration is used. Default is 0
  7913. (nb_frames is used by default).
  7914. @item color, c
  7915. Specify the color of the fade. Default is "black".
  7916. @end table
  7917. @subsection Examples
  7918. @itemize
  7919. @item
  7920. Fade in the first 30 frames of video:
  7921. @example
  7922. fade=in:0:30
  7923. @end example
  7924. The command above is equivalent to:
  7925. @example
  7926. fade=t=in:s=0:n=30
  7927. @end example
  7928. @item
  7929. Fade out the last 45 frames of a 200-frame video:
  7930. @example
  7931. fade=out:155:45
  7932. fade=type=out:start_frame=155:nb_frames=45
  7933. @end example
  7934. @item
  7935. Fade in the first 25 frames and fade out the last 25 frames of a 1000-frame video:
  7936. @example
  7937. fade=in:0:25, fade=out:975:25
  7938. @end example
  7939. @item
  7940. Make the first 5 frames yellow, then fade in from frame 5-24:
  7941. @example
  7942. fade=in:5:20:color=yellow
  7943. @end example
  7944. @item
  7945. Fade in alpha over first 25 frames of video:
  7946. @example
  7947. fade=in:0:25:alpha=1
  7948. @end example
  7949. @item
  7950. Make the first 5.5 seconds black, then fade in for 0.5 seconds:
  7951. @example
  7952. fade=t=in:st=5.5:d=0.5
  7953. @end example
  7954. @end itemize
  7955. @section fftdnoiz
  7956. Denoise frames using 3D FFT (frequency domain filtering).
  7957. The filter accepts the following options:
  7958. @table @option
  7959. @item sigma
  7960. Set the noise sigma constant. This sets denoising strength.
  7961. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 30.
  7962. Using very high sigma with low overlap may give blocking artifacts.
  7963. @item amount
  7964. Set amount of denoising. By default all detected noise is reduced.
  7965. Default value is 1. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  7966. @item block
  7967. Set size of block, Default is 4, can be 3, 4, 5 or 6.
  7968. Actual size of block in pixels is 2 to power of @var{block}, so by default
  7969. block size in pixels is 2^4 which is 16.
  7970. @item overlap
  7971. Set block overlap. Default is 0.5. Allowed range is from 0.2 to 0.8.
  7972. @item prev
  7973. Set number of previous frames to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7974. @item next
  7975. Set number of next frames to to use for denoising. By default is set to 0.
  7976. @item planes
  7977. Set planes which will be filtered, by default are all available filtered
  7978. except alpha.
  7979. @end table
  7980. @section fftfilt
  7981. Apply arbitrary expressions to samples in frequency domain
  7982. @table @option
  7983. @item dc_Y
  7984. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the luma plane of the image. The filter
  7985. accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The default
  7986. value is set to @code{0}.
  7987. @item dc_U
  7988. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 1st chroma plane of the image. The
  7989. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7990. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7991. @item dc_V
  7992. Adjust the dc value (gain) of the 2nd chroma plane of the image. The
  7993. filter accepts an integer value in range @code{0} to @code{1000}. The
  7994. default value is set to @code{0}.
  7995. @item weight_Y
  7996. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the luma plane.
  7997. @item weight_U
  7998. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 1st chroma plane.
  7999. @item weight_V
  8000. Set the frequency domain weight expression for the 2nd chroma plane.
  8001. @item eval
  8002. Set when the expressions are evaluated.
  8003. It accepts the following values:
  8004. @table @samp
  8005. @item init
  8006. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization.
  8007. @item frame
  8008. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  8009. @end table
  8010. Default value is @samp{init}.
  8011. The filter accepts the following variables:
  8012. @item X
  8013. @item Y
  8014. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8015. @item W
  8016. @item H
  8017. The width and height of the image.
  8018. @item N
  8019. The number of input frame, starting from 0.
  8020. @end table
  8021. @subsection Examples
  8022. @itemize
  8023. @item
  8024. High-pass:
  8025. @example
  8026. fftfilt=dc_Y=128:weight_Y='squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8027. @end example
  8028. @item
  8029. Low-pass:
  8030. @example
  8031. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='squish((Y+X)/100-1)'
  8032. @end example
  8033. @item
  8034. Sharpen:
  8035. @example
  8036. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='1+squish(1-(Y+X)/100)'
  8037. @end example
  8038. @item
  8039. Blur:
  8040. @example
  8041. fftfilt=dc_Y=0:weight_Y='exp(-4 * ((Y+X)/(W+H)))'
  8042. @end example
  8043. @end itemize
  8044. @section field
  8045. Extract a single field from an interlaced image using stride
  8046. arithmetic to avoid wasting CPU time. The output frames are marked as
  8047. non-interlaced.
  8048. The filter accepts the following options:
  8049. @table @option
  8050. @item type
  8051. Specify whether to extract the top (if the value is @code{0} or
  8052. @code{top}) or the bottom field (if the value is @code{1} or
  8053. @code{bottom}).
  8054. @end table
  8055. @section fieldhint
  8056. Create new frames by copying the top and bottom fields from surrounding frames
  8057. supplied as numbers by the hint file.
  8058. @table @option
  8059. @item hint
  8060. Set file containing hints: absolute/relative frame numbers.
  8061. There must be one line for each frame in a clip. Each line must contain two
  8062. numbers separated by the comma, optionally followed by @code{-} or @code{+}.
  8063. Numbers supplied on each line of file can not be out of [N-1,N+1] where N
  8064. is current frame number for @code{absolute} mode or out of [-1, 1] range
  8065. for @code{relative} mode. First number tells from which frame to pick up top
  8066. field and second number tells from which frame to pick up bottom field.
  8067. If optionally followed by @code{+} output frame will be marked as interlaced,
  8068. else if followed by @code{-} output frame will be marked as progressive, else
  8069. it will be marked same as input frame.
  8070. If optionally followed by @code{t} output frame will use only top field, or in
  8071. case of @code{b} it will use only bottom field.
  8072. If line starts with @code{#} or @code{;} that line is skipped.
  8073. @item mode
  8074. Can be item @code{absolute} or @code{relative}. Default is @code{absolute}.
  8075. @end table
  8076. Example of first several lines of @code{hint} file for @code{relative} mode:
  8077. @example
  8078. 0,0 - # first frame
  8079. 1,0 - # second frame, use third's frame top field and second's frame bottom field
  8080. 1,0 - # third frame, use fourth's frame top field and third's frame bottom field
  8081. 1,0 -
  8082. 0,0 -
  8083. 0,0 -
  8084. 1,0 -
  8085. 1,0 -
  8086. 1,0 -
  8087. 0,0 -
  8088. 0,0 -
  8089. 1,0 -
  8090. 1,0 -
  8091. 1,0 -
  8092. 0,0 -
  8093. @end example
  8094. @section fieldmatch
  8095. Field matching filter for inverse telecine. It is meant to reconstruct the
  8096. progressive frames from a telecined stream. The filter does not drop duplicated
  8097. frames, so to achieve a complete inverse telecine @code{fieldmatch} needs to be
  8098. followed by a decimation filter such as @ref{decimate} in the filtergraph.
  8099. The separation of the field matching and the decimation is notably motivated by
  8100. the possibility of inserting a de-interlacing filter fallback between the two.
  8101. If the source has mixed telecined and real interlaced content,
  8102. @code{fieldmatch} will not be able to match fields for the interlaced parts.
  8103. But these remaining combed frames will be marked as interlaced, and thus can be
  8104. de-interlaced by a later filter such as @ref{yadif} before decimation.
  8105. In addition to the various configuration options, @code{fieldmatch} can take an
  8106. optional second stream, activated through the @option{ppsrc} option. If
  8107. enabled, the frames reconstruction will be based on the fields and frames from
  8108. this second stream. This allows the first input to be pre-processed in order to
  8109. help the various algorithms of the filter, while keeping the output lossless
  8110. (assuming the fields are matched properly). Typically, a field-aware denoiser,
  8111. or brightness/contrast adjustments can help.
  8112. Note that this filter uses the same algorithms as TIVTC/TFM (AviSynth project)
  8113. and VIVTC/VFM (VapourSynth project). The later is a light clone of TFM from
  8114. which @code{fieldmatch} is based on. While the semantic and usage are very
  8115. close, some behaviour and options names can differ.
  8116. The @ref{decimate} filter currently only works for constant frame rate input.
  8117. If your input has mixed telecined (30fps) and progressive content with a lower
  8118. framerate like 24fps use the following filterchain to produce the necessary cfr
  8119. stream: @code{dejudder,fps=30000/1001,fieldmatch,decimate}.
  8120. The filter accepts the following options:
  8121. @table @option
  8122. @item order
  8123. Specify the assumed field order of the input stream. Available values are:
  8124. @table @samp
  8125. @item auto
  8126. Auto detect parity (use FFmpeg's internal parity value).
  8127. @item bff
  8128. Assume bottom field first.
  8129. @item tff
  8130. Assume top field first.
  8131. @end table
  8132. Note that it is sometimes recommended not to trust the parity announced by the
  8133. stream.
  8134. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8135. @item mode
  8136. Set the matching mode or strategy to use. @option{pc} mode is the safest in the
  8137. sense that it won't risk creating jerkiness due to duplicate frames when
  8138. possible, but if there are bad edits or blended fields it will end up
  8139. outputting combed frames when a good match might actually exist. On the other
  8140. hand, @option{pcn_ub} mode is the most risky in terms of creating jerkiness,
  8141. but will almost always find a good frame if there is one. The other values are
  8142. all somewhere in between @option{pc} and @option{pcn_ub} in terms of risking
  8143. jerkiness and creating duplicate frames versus finding good matches in sections
  8144. with bad edits, orphaned fields, blended fields, etc.
  8145. More details about p/c/n/u/b are available in @ref{p/c/n/u/b meaning} section.
  8146. Available values are:
  8147. @table @samp
  8148. @item pc
  8149. 2-way matching (p/c)
  8150. @item pc_n
  8151. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match if still combed (p/c + n)
  8152. @item pc_u
  8153. 2-way matching, and trying 3rd match (same order) if still combed (p/c + u)
  8154. @item pc_n_ub
  8155. 2-way matching, trying 3rd match if still combed, and trying 4th/5th matches if
  8156. still combed (p/c + n + u/b)
  8157. @item pcn
  8158. 3-way matching (p/c/n)
  8159. @item pcn_ub
  8160. 3-way matching, and trying 4th/5th matches if all 3 of the original matches are
  8161. detected as combed (p/c/n + u/b)
  8162. @end table
  8163. The parenthesis at the end indicate the matches that would be used for that
  8164. mode assuming @option{order}=@var{tff} (and @option{field} on @var{auto} or
  8165. @var{top}).
  8166. In terms of speed @option{pc} mode is by far the fastest and @option{pcn_ub} is
  8167. the slowest.
  8168. Default value is @var{pc_n}.
  8169. @item ppsrc
  8170. Mark the main input stream as a pre-processed input, and enable the secondary
  8171. input stream as the clean source to pick the fields from. See the filter
  8172. introduction for more details. It is similar to the @option{clip2} feature from
  8173. VFM/TFM.
  8174. Default value is @code{0} (disabled).
  8175. @item field
  8176. Set the field to match from. It is recommended to set this to the same value as
  8177. @option{order} unless you experience matching failures with that setting. In
  8178. certain circumstances changing the field that is used to match from can have a
  8179. large impact on matching performance. Available values are:
  8180. @table @samp
  8181. @item auto
  8182. Automatic (same value as @option{order}).
  8183. @item bottom
  8184. Match from the bottom field.
  8185. @item top
  8186. Match from the top field.
  8187. @end table
  8188. Default value is @var{auto}.
  8189. @item mchroma
  8190. Set whether or not chroma is included during the match comparisons. In most
  8191. cases it is recommended to leave this enabled. You should set this to @code{0}
  8192. only if your clip has bad chroma problems such as heavy rainbowing or other
  8193. artifacts. Setting this to @code{0} could also be used to speed things up at
  8194. the cost of some accuracy.
  8195. Default value is @code{1}.
  8196. @item y0
  8197. @item y1
  8198. These define an exclusion band which excludes the lines between @option{y0} and
  8199. @option{y1} from being included in the field matching decision. An exclusion
  8200. band can be used to ignore subtitles, a logo, or other things that may
  8201. interfere with the matching. @option{y0} sets the starting scan line and
  8202. @option{y1} sets the ending line; all lines in between @option{y0} and
  8203. @option{y1} (including @option{y0} and @option{y1}) will be ignored. Setting
  8204. @option{y0} and @option{y1} to the same value will disable the feature.
  8205. @option{y0} and @option{y1} defaults to @code{0}.
  8206. @item scthresh
  8207. Set the scene change detection threshold as a percentage of maximum change on
  8208. the luma plane. Good values are in the @code{[8.0, 14.0]} range. Scene change
  8209. detection is only relevant in case @option{combmatch}=@var{sc}. The range for
  8210. @option{scthresh} is @code{[0.0, 100.0]}.
  8211. Default value is @code{12.0}.
  8212. @item combmatch
  8213. When @option{combatch} is not @var{none}, @code{fieldmatch} will take into
  8214. account the combed scores of matches when deciding what match to use as the
  8215. final match. Available values are:
  8216. @table @samp
  8217. @item none
  8218. No final matching based on combed scores.
  8219. @item sc
  8220. Combed scores are only used when a scene change is detected.
  8221. @item full
  8222. Use combed scores all the time.
  8223. @end table
  8224. Default is @var{sc}.
  8225. @item combdbg
  8226. Force @code{fieldmatch} to calculate the combed metrics for certain matches and
  8227. print them. This setting is known as @option{micout} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8228. Available values are:
  8229. @table @samp
  8230. @item none
  8231. No forced calculation.
  8232. @item pcn
  8233. Force p/c/n calculations.
  8234. @item pcnub
  8235. Force p/c/n/u/b calculations.
  8236. @end table
  8237. Default value is @var{none}.
  8238. @item cthresh
  8239. This is the area combing threshold used for combed frame detection. This
  8240. essentially controls how "strong" or "visible" combing must be to be detected.
  8241. Larger values mean combing must be more visible and smaller values mean combing
  8242. can be less visible or strong and still be detected. Valid settings are from
  8243. @code{-1} (every pixel will be detected as combed) to @code{255} (no pixel will
  8244. be detected as combed). This is basically a pixel difference value. A good
  8245. range is @code{[8, 12]}.
  8246. Default value is @code{9}.
  8247. @item chroma
  8248. Sets whether or not chroma is considered in the combed frame decision. Only
  8249. disable this if your source has chroma problems (rainbowing, etc.) that are
  8250. causing problems for the combed frame detection with chroma enabled. Actually,
  8251. using @option{chroma}=@var{0} is usually more reliable, except for the case
  8252. where there is chroma only combing in the source.
  8253. Default value is @code{0}.
  8254. @item blockx
  8255. @item blocky
  8256. Respectively set the x-axis and y-axis size of the window used during combed
  8257. frame detection. This has to do with the size of the area in which
  8258. @option{combpel} pixels are required to be detected as combed for a frame to be
  8259. declared combed. See the @option{combpel} parameter description for more info.
  8260. Possible values are any number that is a power of 2 starting at 4 and going up
  8261. to 512.
  8262. Default value is @code{16}.
  8263. @item combpel
  8264. The number of combed pixels inside any of the @option{blocky} by
  8265. @option{blockx} size blocks on the frame for the frame to be detected as
  8266. combed. While @option{cthresh} controls how "visible" the combing must be, this
  8267. setting controls "how much" combing there must be in any localized area (a
  8268. window defined by the @option{blockx} and @option{blocky} settings) on the
  8269. frame. Minimum value is @code{0} and maximum is @code{blocky x blockx} (at
  8270. which point no frames will ever be detected as combed). This setting is known
  8271. as @option{MI} in TFM/VFM vocabulary.
  8272. Default value is @code{80}.
  8273. @end table
  8274. @anchor{p/c/n/u/b meaning}
  8275. @subsection p/c/n/u/b meaning
  8276. @subsubsection p/c/n
  8277. We assume the following telecined stream:
  8278. @example
  8279. Top fields: 1 2 2 3 4
  8280. Bottom fields: 1 2 3 4 4
  8281. @end example
  8282. The numbers correspond to the progressive frame the fields relate to. Here, the
  8283. first two frames are progressive, the 3rd and 4th are combed, and so on.
  8284. When @code{fieldmatch} is configured to run a matching from bottom
  8285. (@option{field}=@var{bottom}) this is how this input stream get transformed:
  8286. @example
  8287. Input stream:
  8288. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8289. B 1 2 3 4 4 <-- matching reference
  8290. Matches: c c n n c
  8291. Output stream:
  8292. T 1 2 3 4 4
  8293. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8294. @end example
  8295. As a result of the field matching, we can see that some frames get duplicated.
  8296. To perform a complete inverse telecine, you need to rely on a decimation filter
  8297. after this operation. See for instance the @ref{decimate} filter.
  8298. The same operation now matching from top fields (@option{field}=@var{top})
  8299. looks like this:
  8300. @example
  8301. Input stream:
  8302. T 1 2 2 3 4 <-- matching reference
  8303. B 1 2 3 4 4
  8304. Matches: c c p p c
  8305. Output stream:
  8306. T 1 2 2 3 4
  8307. B 1 2 2 3 4
  8308. @end example
  8309. In these examples, we can see what @var{p}, @var{c} and @var{n} mean;
  8310. basically, they refer to the frame and field of the opposite parity:
  8311. @itemize
  8312. @item @var{p} matches the field of the opposite parity in the previous frame
  8313. @item @var{c} matches the field of the opposite parity in the current frame
  8314. @item @var{n} matches the field of the opposite parity in the next frame
  8315. @end itemize
  8316. @subsubsection u/b
  8317. The @var{u} and @var{b} matching are a bit special in the sense that they match
  8318. from the opposite parity flag. In the following examples, we assume that we are
  8319. currently matching the 2nd frame (Top:2, bottom:2). According to the match, a
  8320. 'x' is placed above and below each matched fields.
  8321. With bottom matching (@option{field}=@var{bottom}):
  8322. @example
  8323. Match: c p n b u
  8324. x x x x x
  8325. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8326. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8327. x x x x x
  8328. Output frames:
  8329. 2 1 2 2 2
  8330. 2 2 2 1 3
  8331. @end example
  8332. With top matching (@option{field}=@var{top}):
  8333. @example
  8334. Match: c p n b u
  8335. x x x x x
  8336. Top 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2 1 2 2
  8337. Bottom 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2 3
  8338. x x x x x
  8339. Output frames:
  8340. 2 2 2 1 2
  8341. 2 1 3 2 2
  8342. @end example
  8343. @subsection Examples
  8344. Simple IVTC of a top field first telecined stream:
  8345. @example
  8346. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=none, decimate
  8347. @end example
  8348. Advanced IVTC, with fallback on @ref{yadif} for still combed frames:
  8349. @example
  8350. fieldmatch=order=tff:combmatch=full, yadif=deint=interlaced, decimate
  8351. @end example
  8352. @section fieldorder
  8353. Transform the field order of the input video.
  8354. It accepts the following parameters:
  8355. @table @option
  8356. @item order
  8357. The output field order. Valid values are @var{tff} for top field first or @var{bff}
  8358. for bottom field first.
  8359. @end table
  8360. The default value is @samp{tff}.
  8361. The transformation is done by shifting the picture content up or down
  8362. by one line, and filling the remaining line with appropriate picture content.
  8363. This method is consistent with most broadcast field order converters.
  8364. If the input video is not flagged as being interlaced, or it is already
  8365. flagged as being of the required output field order, then this filter does
  8366. not alter the incoming video.
  8367. It is very useful when converting to or from PAL DV material,
  8368. which is bottom field first.
  8369. For example:
  8370. @example
  8371. ffmpeg -i in.vob -vf "fieldorder=bff" out.dv
  8372. @end example
  8373. @section fifo, afifo
  8374. Buffer input images and send them when they are requested.
  8375. It is mainly useful when auto-inserted by the libavfilter
  8376. framework.
  8377. It does not take parameters.
  8378. @section fillborders
  8379. Fill borders of the input video, without changing video stream dimensions.
  8380. Sometimes video can have garbage at the four edges and you may not want to
  8381. crop video input to keep size multiple of some number.
  8382. This filter accepts the following options:
  8383. @table @option
  8384. @item left
  8385. Number of pixels to fill from left border.
  8386. @item right
  8387. Number of pixels to fill from right border.
  8388. @item top
  8389. Number of pixels to fill from top border.
  8390. @item bottom
  8391. Number of pixels to fill from bottom border.
  8392. @item mode
  8393. Set fill mode.
  8394. It accepts the following values:
  8395. @table @samp
  8396. @item smear
  8397. fill pixels using outermost pixels
  8398. @item mirror
  8399. fill pixels using mirroring
  8400. @item fixed
  8401. fill pixels with constant value
  8402. @end table
  8403. Default is @var{smear}.
  8404. @item color
  8405. Set color for pixels in fixed mode. Default is @var{black}.
  8406. @end table
  8407. @subsection Commands
  8408. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  8409. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8410. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8411. value.
  8412. @section find_rect
  8413. Find a rectangular object
  8414. It accepts the following options:
  8415. @table @option
  8416. @item object
  8417. Filepath of the object image, needs to be in gray8.
  8418. @item threshold
  8419. Detection threshold, default is 0.5.
  8420. @item mipmaps
  8421. Number of mipmaps, default is 3.
  8422. @item xmin, ymin, xmax, ymax
  8423. Specifies the rectangle in which to search.
  8424. @end table
  8425. @subsection Examples
  8426. @itemize
  8427. @item
  8428. Cover a rectangular object by the supplied image of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  8429. @example
  8430. ffmpeg -i file.ts -vf find_rect=newref.pgm,cover_rect=cover.jpg:mode=cover new.mkv
  8431. @end example
  8432. @end itemize
  8433. @section floodfill
  8434. Flood area with values of same pixel components with another values.
  8435. It accepts the following options:
  8436. @table @option
  8437. @item x
  8438. Set pixel x coordinate.
  8439. @item y
  8440. Set pixel y coordinate.
  8441. @item s0
  8442. Set source #0 component value.
  8443. @item s1
  8444. Set source #1 component value.
  8445. @item s2
  8446. Set source #2 component value.
  8447. @item s3
  8448. Set source #3 component value.
  8449. @item d0
  8450. Set destination #0 component value.
  8451. @item d1
  8452. Set destination #1 component value.
  8453. @item d2
  8454. Set destination #2 component value.
  8455. @item d3
  8456. Set destination #3 component value.
  8457. @end table
  8458. @anchor{format}
  8459. @section format
  8460. Convert the input video to one of the specified pixel formats.
  8461. Libavfilter will try to pick one that is suitable as input to
  8462. the next filter.
  8463. It accepts the following parameters:
  8464. @table @option
  8465. @item pix_fmts
  8466. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  8467. "pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  8468. @end table
  8469. @subsection Examples
  8470. @itemize
  8471. @item
  8472. Convert the input video to the @var{yuv420p} format
  8473. @example
  8474. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p
  8475. @end example
  8476. Convert the input video to any of the formats in the list
  8477. @example
  8478. format=pix_fmts=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  8479. @end example
  8480. @end itemize
  8481. @anchor{fps}
  8482. @section fps
  8483. Convert the video to specified constant frame rate by duplicating or dropping
  8484. frames as necessary.
  8485. It accepts the following parameters:
  8486. @table @option
  8487. @item fps
  8488. The desired output frame rate. The default is @code{25}.
  8489. @item start_time
  8490. Assume the first PTS should be the given value, in seconds. This allows for
  8491. padding/trimming at the start of stream. By default, no assumption is made
  8492. about the first frame's expected PTS, so no padding or trimming is done.
  8493. For example, this could be set to 0 to pad the beginning with duplicates of
  8494. the first frame if a video stream starts after the audio stream or to trim any
  8495. frames with a negative PTS.
  8496. @item round
  8497. Timestamp (PTS) rounding method.
  8498. Possible values are:
  8499. @table @option
  8500. @item zero
  8501. round towards 0
  8502. @item inf
  8503. round away from 0
  8504. @item down
  8505. round towards -infinity
  8506. @item up
  8507. round towards +infinity
  8508. @item near
  8509. round to nearest
  8510. @end table
  8511. The default is @code{near}.
  8512. @item eof_action
  8513. Action performed when reading the last frame.
  8514. Possible values are:
  8515. @table @option
  8516. @item round
  8517. Use same timestamp rounding method as used for other frames.
  8518. @item pass
  8519. Pass through last frame if input duration has not been reached yet.
  8520. @end table
  8521. The default is @code{round}.
  8522. @end table
  8523. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8524. @var{fps}[:@var{start_time}[:@var{round}]].
  8525. See also the @ref{setpts} filter.
  8526. @subsection Examples
  8527. @itemize
  8528. @item
  8529. A typical usage in order to set the fps to 25:
  8530. @example
  8531. fps=fps=25
  8532. @end example
  8533. @item
  8534. Sets the fps to 24, using abbreviation and rounding method to round to nearest:
  8535. @example
  8536. fps=fps=film:round=near
  8537. @end example
  8538. @end itemize
  8539. @section framepack
  8540. Pack two different video streams into a stereoscopic video, setting proper
  8541. metadata on supported codecs. The two views should have the same size and
  8542. framerate and processing will stop when the shorter video ends. Please note
  8543. that you may conveniently adjust view properties with the @ref{scale} and
  8544. @ref{fps} filters.
  8545. It accepts the following parameters:
  8546. @table @option
  8547. @item format
  8548. The desired packing format. Supported values are:
  8549. @table @option
  8550. @item sbs
  8551. The views are next to each other (default).
  8552. @item tab
  8553. The views are on top of each other.
  8554. @item lines
  8555. The views are packed by line.
  8556. @item columns
  8557. The views are packed by column.
  8558. @item frameseq
  8559. The views are temporally interleaved.
  8560. @end table
  8561. @end table
  8562. Some examples:
  8563. @example
  8564. # Convert left and right views into a frame-sequential video
  8565. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex framepack=frameseq OUTPUT
  8566. # Convert views into a side-by-side video with the same output resolution as the input
  8567. ffmpeg -i LEFT -i RIGHT -filter_complex [0:v]scale=w=iw/2[left],[1:v]scale=w=iw/2[right],[left][right]framepack=sbs OUTPUT
  8568. @end example
  8569. @section framerate
  8570. Change the frame rate by interpolating new video output frames from the source
  8571. frames.
  8572. This filter is not designed to function correctly with interlaced media. If
  8573. you wish to change the frame rate of interlaced media then you are required
  8574. to deinterlace before this filter and re-interlace after this filter.
  8575. A description of the accepted options follows.
  8576. @table @option
  8577. @item fps
  8578. Specify the output frames per second. This option can also be specified
  8579. as a value alone. The default is @code{50}.
  8580. @item interp_start
  8581. Specify the start of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8582. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8583. the default is @code{15}.
  8584. @item interp_end
  8585. Specify the end of a range where the output frame will be created as a
  8586. linear interpolation of two frames. The range is [@code{0}-@code{255}],
  8587. the default is @code{240}.
  8588. @item scene
  8589. Specify the level at which a scene change is detected as a value between
  8590. 0 and 100 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  8591. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  8592. value means the current frame is more likely to be one.
  8593. The default is @code{8.2}.
  8594. @item flags
  8595. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  8596. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  8597. @table @option
  8598. @item scene_change_detect, scd
  8599. Enable scene change detection using the value of the option @var{scene}.
  8600. This flag is enabled by default.
  8601. @end table
  8602. @end table
  8603. @section framestep
  8604. Select one frame every N-th frame.
  8605. This filter accepts the following option:
  8606. @table @option
  8607. @item step
  8608. Select frame after every @code{step} frames.
  8609. Allowed values are positive integers higher than 0. Default value is @code{1}.
  8610. @end table
  8611. @section freezedetect
  8612. Detect frozen video.
  8613. This filter logs a message and sets frame metadata when it detects that the
  8614. input video has no significant change in content during a specified duration.
  8615. Video freeze detection calculates the mean average absolute difference of all
  8616. the components of video frames and compares it to a noise floor.
  8617. The printed times and duration are expressed in seconds. The
  8618. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_start} metadata key is set on the first frame
  8619. whose timestamp equals or exceeds the detection duration and it contains the
  8620. timestamp of the first frame of the freeze. The
  8621. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_duration} and
  8622. @code{lavfi.freezedetect.freeze_end} metadata keys are set on the first frame
  8623. after the freeze.
  8624. The filter accepts the following options:
  8625. @table @option
  8626. @item noise, n
  8627. Set noise tolerance. Can be specified in dB (in case "dB" is appended to the
  8628. specified value) or as a difference ratio between 0 and 1. Default is -60dB, or
  8629. 0.001.
  8630. @item duration, d
  8631. Set freeze duration until notification (default is 2 seconds).
  8632. @end table
  8633. @section freezeframes
  8634. Freeze video frames.
  8635. This filter freezes video frames using frame from 2nd input.
  8636. The filter accepts the following options:
  8637. @table @option
  8638. @item first
  8639. Set number of first frame from which to start freeze.
  8640. @item last
  8641. Set number of last frame from which to end freeze.
  8642. @item replace
  8643. Set number of frame from 2nd input which will be used instead of replaced frames.
  8644. @end table
  8645. @anchor{frei0r}
  8646. @section frei0r
  8647. Apply a frei0r effect to the input video.
  8648. To enable the compilation of this filter, you need to install the frei0r
  8649. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  8650. It accepts the following parameters:
  8651. @table @option
  8652. @item filter_name
  8653. The name of the frei0r effect to load. If the environment variable
  8654. @env{FREI0R_PATH} is defined, the frei0r effect is searched for in each of the
  8655. directories specified by the colon-separated list in @env{FREI0R_PATH}.
  8656. Otherwise, the standard frei0r paths are searched, in this order:
  8657. @file{HOME/.frei0r-1/lib/}, @file{/usr/local/lib/frei0r-1/},
  8658. @file{/usr/lib/frei0r-1/}.
  8659. @item filter_params
  8660. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r effect.
  8661. @end table
  8662. A frei0r effect parameter can be a boolean (its value is either
  8663. "y" or "n"), a double, a color (specified as
  8664. @var{R}/@var{G}/@var{B}, where @var{R}, @var{G}, and @var{B} are floating point
  8665. numbers between 0.0 and 1.0, inclusive) or a color description as specified in the
  8666. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils},
  8667. a position (specified as @var{X}/@var{Y}, where
  8668. @var{X} and @var{Y} are floating point numbers) and/or a string.
  8669. The number and types of parameters depend on the loaded effect. If an
  8670. effect parameter is not specified, the default value is set.
  8671. @subsection Examples
  8672. @itemize
  8673. @item
  8674. Apply the distort0r effect, setting the first two double parameters:
  8675. @example
  8676. frei0r=filter_name=distort0r:filter_params=0.5|0.01
  8677. @end example
  8678. @item
  8679. Apply the colordistance effect, taking a color as the first parameter:
  8680. @example
  8681. frei0r=colordistance:0.2/0.3/0.4
  8682. frei0r=colordistance:violet
  8683. frei0r=colordistance:0x112233
  8684. @end example
  8685. @item
  8686. Apply the perspective effect, specifying the top left and top right image
  8687. positions:
  8688. @example
  8689. frei0r=perspective:0.2/0.2|0.8/0.2
  8690. @end example
  8691. @end itemize
  8692. For more information, see
  8693. @url{http://frei0r.dyne.org}
  8694. @section fspp
  8695. Apply fast and simple postprocessing. It is a faster version of @ref{spp}.
  8696. It splits (I)DCT into horizontal/vertical passes. Unlike the simple post-
  8697. processing filter, one of them is performed once per block, not per pixel.
  8698. This allows for much higher speed.
  8699. The filter accepts the following options:
  8700. @table @option
  8701. @item quality
  8702. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  8703. an integer in the range 4-5. Default value is @code{4}.
  8704. @item qp
  8705. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range 0-63.
  8706. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream (if available).
  8707. @item strength
  8708. Set filter strength. It accepts an integer in range -15 to 32. Lower values mean
  8709. more details but also more artifacts, while higher values make the image smoother
  8710. but also blurrier. Default value is @code{0} − PSNR optimal.
  8711. @item use_bframe_qp
  8712. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  8713. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  8714. @code{0} (not enabled).
  8715. @end table
  8716. @section gblur
  8717. Apply Gaussian blur filter.
  8718. The filter accepts the following options:
  8719. @table @option
  8720. @item sigma
  8721. Set horizontal sigma, standard deviation of Gaussian blur. Default is @code{0.5}.
  8722. @item steps
  8723. Set number of steps for Gaussian approximation. Default is @code{1}.
  8724. @item planes
  8725. Set which planes to filter. By default all planes are filtered.
  8726. @item sigmaV
  8727. Set vertical sigma, if negative it will be same as @code{sigma}.
  8728. Default is @code{-1}.
  8729. @end table
  8730. @subsection Commands
  8731. This filter supports same commands as options.
  8732. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  8733. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  8734. value.
  8735. @section geq
  8736. Apply generic equation to each pixel.
  8737. The filter accepts the following options:
  8738. @table @option
  8739. @item lum_expr, lum
  8740. Set the luminance expression.
  8741. @item cb_expr, cb
  8742. Set the chrominance blue expression.
  8743. @item cr_expr, cr
  8744. Set the chrominance red expression.
  8745. @item alpha_expr, a
  8746. Set the alpha expression.
  8747. @item red_expr, r
  8748. Set the red expression.
  8749. @item green_expr, g
  8750. Set the green expression.
  8751. @item blue_expr, b
  8752. Set the blue expression.
  8753. @end table
  8754. The colorspace is selected according to the specified options. If one
  8755. of the @option{lum_expr}, @option{cb_expr}, or @option{cr_expr}
  8756. options is specified, the filter will automatically select a YCbCr
  8757. colorspace. If one of the @option{red_expr}, @option{green_expr}, or
  8758. @option{blue_expr} options is specified, it will select an RGB
  8759. colorspace.
  8760. If one of the chrominance expression is not defined, it falls back on the other
  8761. one. If no alpha expression is specified it will evaluate to opaque value.
  8762. If none of chrominance expressions are specified, they will evaluate
  8763. to the luminance expression.
  8764. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  8765. @table @option
  8766. @item N
  8767. The sequential number of the filtered frame, starting from @code{0}.
  8768. @item X
  8769. @item Y
  8770. The coordinates of the current sample.
  8771. @item W
  8772. @item H
  8773. The width and height of the image.
  8774. @item SW
  8775. @item SH
  8776. Width and height scale depending on the currently filtered plane. It is the
  8777. ratio between the corresponding luma plane number of pixels and the current
  8778. plane ones. E.g. for YUV4:2:0 the values are @code{1,1} for the luma plane, and
  8779. @code{0.5,0.5} for chroma planes.
  8780. @item T
  8781. Time of the current frame, expressed in seconds.
  8782. @item p(x, y)
  8783. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the current
  8784. plane.
  8785. @item lum(x, y)
  8786. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the luminance
  8787. plane.
  8788. @item cb(x, y)
  8789. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8790. blue-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8791. @item cr(x, y)
  8792. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8793. red-difference chroma plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8794. @item r(x, y)
  8795. @item g(x, y)
  8796. @item b(x, y)
  8797. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  8798. red/green/blue component. Return 0 if there is no such component.
  8799. @item alpha(x, y)
  8800. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the alpha
  8801. plane. Return 0 if there is no such plane.
  8802. @item psum(x,y), lumsum(x, y), cbsum(x,y), crsum(x,y), rsum(x,y), gsum(x,y), bsum(x,y), alphasum(x,y)
  8803. Sum of sample values in the rectangle from (0,0) to (x,y), this allows obtaining
  8804. sums of samples within a rectangle. See the functions without the sum postfix.
  8805. @item interpolation
  8806. Set one of interpolation methods:
  8807. @table @option
  8808. @item nearest, n
  8809. @item bilinear, b
  8810. @end table
  8811. Default is bilinear.
  8812. @end table
  8813. For functions, if @var{x} and @var{y} are outside the area, the value will be
  8814. automatically clipped to the closer edge.
  8815. Please note that this filter can use multiple threads in which case each slice
  8816. will have its own expression state. If you want to use only a single expression
  8817. state because your expressions depend on previous state then you should limit
  8818. the number of filter threads to 1.
  8819. @subsection Examples
  8820. @itemize
  8821. @item
  8822. Flip the image horizontally:
  8823. @example
  8824. geq=p(W-X\,Y)
  8825. @end example
  8826. @item
  8827. Generate a bidimensional sine wave, with angle @code{PI/3} and a
  8828. wavelength of 100 pixels:
  8829. @example
  8830. geq=128 + 100*sin(2*(PI/100)*(cos(PI/3)*(X-50*T) + sin(PI/3)*Y)):128:128
  8831. @end example
  8832. @item
  8833. Generate a fancy enigmatic moving light:
  8834. @example
  8835. nullsrc=s=256x256,geq=random(1)/hypot(X-cos(N*0.07)*W/2-W/2\,Y-sin(N*0.09)*H/2-H/2)^2*1000000*sin(N*0.02):128:128
  8836. @end example
  8837. @item
  8838. Generate a quick emboss effect:
  8839. @example
  8840. format=gray,geq=lum_expr='(p(X,Y)+(256-p(X-4,Y-4)))/2'
  8841. @end example
  8842. @item
  8843. Modify RGB components depending on pixel position:
  8844. @example
  8845. geq=r='X/W*r(X,Y)':g='(1-X/W)*g(X,Y)':b='(H-Y)/H*b(X,Y)'
  8846. @end example
  8847. @item
  8848. Create a radial gradient that is the same size as the input (also see
  8849. the @ref{vignette} filter):
  8850. @example
  8851. geq=lum=255*gauss((X/W-0.5)*3)*gauss((Y/H-0.5)*3)/gauss(0)/gauss(0),format=gray
  8852. @end example
  8853. @end itemize
  8854. @section gradfun
  8855. Fix the banding artifacts that are sometimes introduced into nearly flat
  8856. regions by truncation to 8-bit color depth.
  8857. Interpolate the gradients that should go where the bands are, and
  8858. dither them.
  8859. It is designed for playback only. Do not use it prior to
  8860. lossy compression, because compression tends to lose the dither and
  8861. bring back the bands.
  8862. It accepts the following parameters:
  8863. @table @option
  8864. @item strength
  8865. The maximum amount by which the filter will change any one pixel. This is also
  8866. the threshold for detecting nearly flat regions. Acceptable values range from
  8867. .51 to 64; the default value is 1.2. Out-of-range values will be clipped to the
  8868. valid range.
  8869. @item radius
  8870. The neighborhood to fit the gradient to. A larger radius makes for smoother
  8871. gradients, but also prevents the filter from modifying the pixels near detailed
  8872. regions. Acceptable values are 8-32; the default value is 16. Out-of-range
  8873. values will be clipped to the valid range.
  8874. @end table
  8875. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string:
  8876. @var{strength}[:@var{radius}]
  8877. @subsection Examples
  8878. @itemize
  8879. @item
  8880. Apply the filter with a @code{3.5} strength and radius of @code{8}:
  8881. @example
  8882. gradfun=3.5:8
  8883. @end example
  8884. @item
  8885. Specify radius, omitting the strength (which will fall-back to the default
  8886. value):
  8887. @example
  8888. gradfun=radius=8
  8889. @end example
  8890. @end itemize
  8891. @anchor{graphmonitor}
  8892. @section graphmonitor
  8893. Show various filtergraph stats.
  8894. With this filter one can debug complete filtergraph.
  8895. Especially issues with links filling with queued frames.
  8896. The filter accepts the following options:
  8897. @table @option
  8898. @item size, s
  8899. Set video output size. Default is @var{hd720}.
  8900. @item opacity, o
  8901. Set video opacity. Default is @var{0.9}. Allowed range is from @var{0} to @var{1}.
  8902. @item mode, m
  8903. Set output mode, can be @var{fulll} or @var{compact}.
  8904. In @var{compact} mode only filters with some queued frames have displayed stats.
  8905. @item flags, f
  8906. Set flags which enable which stats are shown in video.
  8907. Available values for flags are:
  8908. @table @samp
  8909. @item queue
  8910. Display number of queued frames in each link.
  8911. @item frame_count_in
  8912. Display number of frames taken from filter.
  8913. @item frame_count_out
  8914. Display number of frames given out from filter.
  8915. @item pts
  8916. Display current filtered frame pts.
  8917. @item time
  8918. Display current filtered frame time.
  8919. @item timebase
  8920. Display time base for filter link.
  8921. @item format
  8922. Display used format for filter link.
  8923. @item size
  8924. Display video size or number of audio channels in case of audio used by filter link.
  8925. @item rate
  8926. Display video frame rate or sample rate in case of audio used by filter link.
  8927. @end table
  8928. @item rate, r
  8929. Set upper limit for video rate of output stream, Default value is @var{25}.
  8930. This guarantee that output video frame rate will not be higher than this value.
  8931. @end table
  8932. @section greyedge
  8933. A color constancy variation filter which estimates scene illumination via grey edge algorithm
  8934. and corrects the scene colors accordingly.
  8935. See: @url{https://staff.science.uva.nl/th.gevers/pub/GeversTIP07.pdf}
  8936. The filter accepts the following options:
  8937. @table @option
  8938. @item difford
  8939. The order of differentiation to be applied on the scene. Must be chosen in the range
  8940. [0,2] and default value is 1.
  8941. @item minknorm
  8942. The Minkowski parameter to be used for calculating the Minkowski distance. Must
  8943. be chosen in the range [0,20] and default value is 1. Set to 0 for getting
  8944. max value instead of calculating Minkowski distance.
  8945. @item sigma
  8946. The standard deviation of Gaussian blur to be applied on the scene. Must be
  8947. chosen in the range [0,1024.0] and default value = 1. floor( @var{sigma} * break_off_sigma(3) )
  8948. can't be equal to 0 if @var{difford} is greater than 0.
  8949. @end table
  8950. @subsection Examples
  8951. @itemize
  8952. @item
  8953. Grey Edge:
  8954. @example
  8955. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=5:sigma=2
  8956. @end example
  8957. @item
  8958. Max Edge:
  8959. @example
  8960. greyedge=difford=1:minknorm=0:sigma=2
  8961. @end example
  8962. @end itemize
  8963. @anchor{haldclut}
  8964. @section haldclut
  8965. Apply a Hald CLUT to a video stream.
  8966. First input is the video stream to process, and second one is the Hald CLUT.
  8967. The Hald CLUT input can be a simple picture or a complete video stream.
  8968. The filter accepts the following options:
  8969. @table @option
  8970. @item shortest
  8971. Force termination when the shortest input terminates. Default is @code{0}.
  8972. @item repeatlast
  8973. Continue applying the last CLUT after the end of the stream. A value of
  8974. @code{0} disable the filter after the last frame of the CLUT is reached.
  8975. Default is @code{1}.
  8976. @end table
  8977. @code{haldclut} also has the same interpolation options as @ref{lut3d} (both
  8978. filters share the same internals).
  8979. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  8980. More information about the Hald CLUT can be found on Eskil Steenberg's website
  8981. (Hald CLUT author) at @url{http://www.quelsolaar.com/technology/clut.html}.
  8982. @subsection Workflow examples
  8983. @subsubsection Hald CLUT video stream
  8984. Generate an identity Hald CLUT stream altered with various effects:
  8985. @example
  8986. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "hue=H=2*PI*t:s=sin(2*PI*t)+1, curves=cross_process" -t 10 -c:v ffv1 clut.nut
  8987. @end example
  8988. Note: make sure you use a lossless codec.
  8989. Then use it with @code{haldclut} to apply it on some random stream:
  8990. @example
  8991. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i mandelbrot -i clut.nut -filter_complex '[0][1] haldclut' -t 20 mandelclut.mkv
  8992. @end example
  8993. The Hald CLUT will be applied to the 10 first seconds (duration of
  8994. @file{clut.nut}), then the latest picture of that CLUT stream will be applied
  8995. to the remaining frames of the @code{mandelbrot} stream.
  8996. @subsubsection Hald CLUT with preview
  8997. A Hald CLUT is supposed to be a squared image of @code{Level*Level*Level} by
  8998. @code{Level*Level*Level} pixels. For a given Hald CLUT, FFmpeg will select the
  8999. biggest possible square starting at the top left of the picture. The remaining
  9000. padding pixels (bottom or right) will be ignored. This area can be used to add
  9001. a preview of the Hald CLUT.
  9002. Typically, the following generated Hald CLUT will be supported by the
  9003. @code{haldclut} filter:
  9004. @example
  9005. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i @ref{haldclutsrc}=8 -vf "
  9006. pad=iw+320 [padded_clut];
  9007. smptebars=s=320x256, split [a][b];
  9008. [padded_clut][a] overlay=W-320:h, curves=color_negative [main];
  9009. [main][b] overlay=W-320" -frames:v 1 clut.png
  9010. @end example
  9011. It contains the original and a preview of the effect of the CLUT: SMPTE color
  9012. bars are displayed on the right-top, and below the same color bars processed by
  9013. the color changes.
  9014. Then, the effect of this Hald CLUT can be visualized with:
  9015. @example
  9016. ffplay input.mkv -vf "movie=clut.png, [in] haldclut"
  9017. @end example
  9018. @section hflip
  9019. Flip the input video horizontally.
  9020. For example, to horizontally flip the input video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  9021. @example
  9022. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "hflip" out.avi
  9023. @end example
  9024. @section histeq
  9025. This filter applies a global color histogram equalization on a
  9026. per-frame basis.
  9027. It can be used to correct video that has a compressed range of pixel
  9028. intensities. The filter redistributes the pixel intensities to
  9029. equalize their distribution across the intensity range. It may be
  9030. viewed as an "automatically adjusting contrast filter". This filter is
  9031. useful only for correcting degraded or poorly captured source
  9032. video.
  9033. The filter accepts the following options:
  9034. @table @option
  9035. @item strength
  9036. Determine the amount of equalization to be applied. As the strength
  9037. is reduced, the distribution of pixel intensities more-and-more
  9038. approaches that of the input frame. The value must be a float number
  9039. in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.200.
  9040. @item intensity
  9041. Set the maximum intensity that can generated and scale the output
  9042. values appropriately. The strength should be set as desired and then
  9043. the intensity can be limited if needed to avoid washing-out. The value
  9044. must be a float number in the range [0,1] and defaults to 0.210.
  9045. @item antibanding
  9046. Set the antibanding level. If enabled the filter will randomly vary
  9047. the luminance of output pixels by a small amount to avoid banding of
  9048. the histogram. Possible values are @code{none}, @code{weak} or
  9049. @code{strong}. It defaults to @code{none}.
  9050. @end table
  9051. @anchor{histogram}
  9052. @section histogram
  9053. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video.
  9054. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  9055. distribution in an image.
  9056. Standard histogram displays the color components distribution in an image.
  9057. Displays color graph for each color component. Shows distribution of
  9058. the Y, U, V, A or R, G, B components, depending on input format, in the
  9059. current frame. Below each graph a color component scale meter is shown.
  9060. The filter accepts the following options:
  9061. @table @option
  9062. @item level_height
  9063. Set height of level. Default value is @code{200}.
  9064. Allowed range is [50, 2048].
  9065. @item scale_height
  9066. Set height of color scale. Default value is @code{12}.
  9067. Allowed range is [0, 40].
  9068. @item display_mode
  9069. Set display mode.
  9070. It accepts the following values:
  9071. @table @samp
  9072. @item stack
  9073. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  9074. @item parade
  9075. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  9076. @item overlay
  9077. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  9078. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  9079. over one another.
  9080. @end table
  9081. Default is @code{stack}.
  9082. @item levels_mode
  9083. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  9084. Default is @code{linear}.
  9085. @item components
  9086. Set what color components to display.
  9087. Default is @code{7}.
  9088. @item fgopacity
  9089. Set foreground opacity. Default is @code{0.7}.
  9090. @item bgopacity
  9091. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.5}.
  9092. @end table
  9093. @subsection Examples
  9094. @itemize
  9095. @item
  9096. Calculate and draw histogram:
  9097. @example
  9098. ffplay -i input -vf histogram
  9099. @end example
  9100. @end itemize
  9101. @anchor{hqdn3d}
  9102. @section hqdn3d
  9103. This is a high precision/quality 3d denoise filter. It aims to reduce
  9104. image noise, producing smooth images and making still images really
  9105. still. It should enhance compressibility.
  9106. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9107. @table @option
  9108. @item luma_spatial
  9109. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial luma strength.
  9110. It defaults to 4.0.
  9111. @item chroma_spatial
  9112. A non-negative floating point number which specifies spatial chroma strength.
  9113. It defaults to 3.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9114. @item luma_tmp
  9115. A floating point number which specifies luma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9116. 6.0*@var{luma_spatial}/4.0.
  9117. @item chroma_tmp
  9118. A floating point number which specifies chroma temporal strength. It defaults to
  9119. @var{luma_tmp}*@var{chroma_spatial}/@var{luma_spatial}.
  9120. @end table
  9121. @subsection Commands
  9122. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9123. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9124. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9125. value.
  9126. @anchor{hwdownload}
  9127. @section hwdownload
  9128. Download hardware frames to system memory.
  9129. The input must be in hardware frames, and the output a non-hardware format.
  9130. Not all formats will be supported on the output - it may be necessary to insert
  9131. an additional @option{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get
  9132. the output in a supported format.
  9133. @section hwmap
  9134. Map hardware frames to system memory or to another device.
  9135. This filter has several different modes of operation; which one is used depends
  9136. on the input and output formats:
  9137. @itemize
  9138. @item
  9139. Hardware frame input, normal frame output
  9140. Map the input frames to system memory and pass them to the output. If the
  9141. original hardware frame is later required (for example, after overlaying
  9142. something else on part of it), the @option{hwmap} filter can be used again
  9143. in the next mode to retrieve it.
  9144. @item
  9145. Normal frame input, hardware frame output
  9146. If the input is actually a software-mapped hardware frame, then unmap it -
  9147. that is, return the original hardware frame.
  9148. Otherwise, a device must be provided. Create new hardware surfaces on that
  9149. device for the output, then map them back to the software format at the input
  9150. and give those frames to the preceding filter. This will then act like the
  9151. @option{hwupload} filter, but may be able to avoid an additional copy when
  9152. the input is already in a compatible format.
  9153. @item
  9154. Hardware frame input and output
  9155. A device must be supplied for the output, either directly or with the
  9156. @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices must be of
  9157. different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9158. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9159. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9160. If the input frames were originally created on the output device, then unmap
  9161. to retrieve the original frames.
  9162. Otherwise, map the frames to the output device - create new hardware frames
  9163. on the output corresponding to the frames on the input.
  9164. @end itemize
  9165. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9166. @table @option
  9167. @item mode
  9168. Set the frame mapping mode. Some combination of:
  9169. @table @var
  9170. @item read
  9171. The mapped frame should be readable.
  9172. @item write
  9173. The mapped frame should be writeable.
  9174. @item overwrite
  9175. The mapping will always overwrite the entire frame.
  9176. This may improve performance in some cases, as the original contents of the
  9177. frame need not be loaded.
  9178. @item direct
  9179. The mapping must not involve any copying.
  9180. Indirect mappings to copies of frames are created in some cases where either
  9181. direct mapping is not possible or it would have unexpected properties.
  9182. Setting this flag ensures that the mapping is direct and will fail if that is
  9183. not possible.
  9184. @end table
  9185. Defaults to @var{read+write} if not specified.
  9186. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9187. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9188. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9189. @item reverse
  9190. In a hardware to hardware mapping, map in reverse - create frames in the sink
  9191. and map them back to the source. This may be necessary in some cases where
  9192. a mapping in one direction is required but only the opposite direction is
  9193. supported by the devices being used.
  9194. This option is dangerous - it may break the preceding filter in undefined
  9195. ways if there are any additional constraints on that filter's output.
  9196. Do not use it without fully understanding the implications of its use.
  9197. @end table
  9198. @anchor{hwupload}
  9199. @section hwupload
  9200. Upload system memory frames to hardware surfaces.
  9201. The device to upload to must be supplied when the filter is initialised. If
  9202. using ffmpeg, select the appropriate device with the @option{-filter_hw_device}
  9203. option or with the @option{derive_device} option. The input and output devices
  9204. must be of different types and compatible - the exact meaning of this is
  9205. system-dependent, but typically it means that they must refer to the same
  9206. underlying hardware context (for example, refer to the same graphics card).
  9207. The following additional parameters are accepted:
  9208. @table @option
  9209. @item derive_device @var{type}
  9210. Rather than using the device supplied at initialisation, instead derive a new
  9211. device of type @var{type} from the device the input frames exist on.
  9212. @end table
  9213. @anchor{hwupload_cuda}
  9214. @section hwupload_cuda
  9215. Upload system memory frames to a CUDA device.
  9216. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9217. @table @option
  9218. @item device
  9219. The number of the CUDA device to use
  9220. @end table
  9221. @section hqx
  9222. Apply a high-quality magnification filter designed for pixel art. This filter
  9223. was originally created by Maxim Stepin.
  9224. It accepts the following option:
  9225. @table @option
  9226. @item n
  9227. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{hq2x}, @code{3} for
  9228. @code{hq3x} and @code{4} for @code{hq4x}.
  9229. Default is @code{3}.
  9230. @end table
  9231. @section hstack
  9232. Stack input videos horizontally.
  9233. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same height.
  9234. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  9235. to create same output.
  9236. The filter accepts the following option:
  9237. @table @option
  9238. @item inputs
  9239. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  9240. @item shortest
  9241. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  9242. terminates. Default value is 0.
  9243. @end table
  9244. @section hue
  9245. Modify the hue and/or the saturation of the input.
  9246. It accepts the following parameters:
  9247. @table @option
  9248. @item h
  9249. Specify the hue angle as a number of degrees. It accepts an expression,
  9250. and defaults to "0".
  9251. @item s
  9252. Specify the saturation in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9253. defaults to "1".
  9254. @item H
  9255. Specify the hue angle as a number of radians. It accepts an
  9256. expression, and defaults to "0".
  9257. @item b
  9258. Specify the brightness in the [-10,10] range. It accepts an expression and
  9259. defaults to "0".
  9260. @end table
  9261. @option{h} and @option{H} are mutually exclusive, and can't be
  9262. specified at the same time.
  9263. The @option{b}, @option{h}, @option{H} and @option{s} option values are
  9264. expressions containing the following constants:
  9265. @table @option
  9266. @item n
  9267. frame count of the input frame starting from 0
  9268. @item pts
  9269. presentation timestamp of the input frame expressed in time base units
  9270. @item r
  9271. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  9272. @item t
  9273. timestamp expressed in seconds, NAN if the input timestamp is unknown
  9274. @item tb
  9275. time base of the input video
  9276. @end table
  9277. @subsection Examples
  9278. @itemize
  9279. @item
  9280. Set the hue to 90 degrees and the saturation to 1.0:
  9281. @example
  9282. hue=h=90:s=1
  9283. @end example
  9284. @item
  9285. Same command but expressing the hue in radians:
  9286. @example
  9287. hue=H=PI/2:s=1
  9288. @end example
  9289. @item
  9290. Rotate hue and make the saturation swing between 0
  9291. and 2 over a period of 1 second:
  9292. @example
  9293. hue="H=2*PI*t: s=sin(2*PI*t)+1"
  9294. @end example
  9295. @item
  9296. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-in effect starting at 0:
  9297. @example
  9298. hue="s=min(t/3\,1)"
  9299. @end example
  9300. The general fade-in expression can be written as:
  9301. @example
  9302. hue="s=min(0\, max((t-START)/DURATION\, 1))"
  9303. @end example
  9304. @item
  9305. Apply a 3 seconds saturation fade-out effect starting at 5 seconds:
  9306. @example
  9307. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (8-t)/3))"
  9308. @end example
  9309. The general fade-out expression can be written as:
  9310. @example
  9311. hue="s=max(0\, min(1\, (START+DURATION-t)/DURATION))"
  9312. @end example
  9313. @end itemize
  9314. @subsection Commands
  9315. This filter supports the following commands:
  9316. @table @option
  9317. @item b
  9318. @item s
  9319. @item h
  9320. @item H
  9321. Modify the hue and/or the saturation and/or brightness of the input video.
  9322. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9323. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9324. value.
  9325. @end table
  9326. @section hysteresis
  9327. Grow first stream into second stream by connecting components.
  9328. This makes it possible to build more robust edge masks.
  9329. This filter accepts the following options:
  9330. @table @option
  9331. @item planes
  9332. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  9333. copied from first stream.
  9334. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  9335. @item threshold
  9336. Set threshold which is used in filtering. If pixel component value is higher than
  9337. this value filter algorithm for connecting components is activated.
  9338. By default value is 0.
  9339. @end table
  9340. @section idet
  9341. Detect video interlacing type.
  9342. This filter tries to detect if the input frames are interlaced, progressive,
  9343. top or bottom field first. It will also try to detect fields that are
  9344. repeated between adjacent frames (a sign of telecine).
  9345. Single frame detection considers only immediately adjacent frames when classifying each frame.
  9346. Multiple frame detection incorporates the classification history of previous frames.
  9347. The filter will log these metadata values:
  9348. @table @option
  9349. @item single.current_frame
  9350. Detected type of current frame using single-frame detection. One of:
  9351. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9352. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9353. @item single.tff
  9354. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using single-frame detection.
  9355. @item multiple.tff
  9356. Cumulative number of frames detected as top field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9357. @item single.bff
  9358. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using single-frame detection.
  9359. @item multiple.current_frame
  9360. Detected type of current frame using multiple-frame detection. One of:
  9361. ``tff'' (top field first), ``bff'' (bottom field first),
  9362. ``progressive'', or ``undetermined''
  9363. @item multiple.bff
  9364. Cumulative number of frames detected as bottom field first using multiple-frame detection.
  9365. @item single.progressive
  9366. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using single-frame detection.
  9367. @item multiple.progressive
  9368. Cumulative number of frames detected as progressive using multiple-frame detection.
  9369. @item single.undetermined
  9370. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using single-frame detection.
  9371. @item multiple.undetermined
  9372. Cumulative number of frames that could not be classified using multiple-frame detection.
  9373. @item repeated.current_frame
  9374. Which field in the current frame is repeated from the last. One of ``neither'', ``top'', or ``bottom''.
  9375. @item repeated.neither
  9376. Cumulative number of frames with no repeated field.
  9377. @item repeated.top
  9378. Cumulative number of frames with the top field repeated from the previous frame's top field.
  9379. @item repeated.bottom
  9380. Cumulative number of frames with the bottom field repeated from the previous frame's bottom field.
  9381. @end table
  9382. The filter accepts the following options:
  9383. @table @option
  9384. @item intl_thres
  9385. Set interlacing threshold.
  9386. @item prog_thres
  9387. Set progressive threshold.
  9388. @item rep_thres
  9389. Threshold for repeated field detection.
  9390. @item half_life
  9391. Number of frames after which a given frame's contribution to the
  9392. statistics is halved (i.e., it contributes only 0.5 to its
  9393. classification). The default of 0 means that all frames seen are given
  9394. full weight of 1.0 forever.
  9395. @item analyze_interlaced_flag
  9396. When this is not 0 then idet will use the specified number of frames to determine
  9397. if the interlaced flag is accurate, it will not count undetermined frames.
  9398. If the flag is found to be accurate it will be used without any further
  9399. computations, if it is found to be inaccurate it will be cleared without any
  9400. further computations. This allows inserting the idet filter as a low computational
  9401. method to clean up the interlaced flag
  9402. @end table
  9403. @section il
  9404. Deinterleave or interleave fields.
  9405. This filter allows one to process interlaced images fields without
  9406. deinterlacing them. Deinterleaving splits the input frame into 2
  9407. fields (so called half pictures). Odd lines are moved to the top
  9408. half of the output image, even lines to the bottom half.
  9409. You can process (filter) them independently and then re-interleave them.
  9410. The filter accepts the following options:
  9411. @table @option
  9412. @item luma_mode, l
  9413. @item chroma_mode, c
  9414. @item alpha_mode, a
  9415. Available values for @var{luma_mode}, @var{chroma_mode} and
  9416. @var{alpha_mode} are:
  9417. @table @samp
  9418. @item none
  9419. Do nothing.
  9420. @item deinterleave, d
  9421. Deinterleave fields, placing one above the other.
  9422. @item interleave, i
  9423. Interleave fields. Reverse the effect of deinterleaving.
  9424. @end table
  9425. Default value is @code{none}.
  9426. @item luma_swap, ls
  9427. @item chroma_swap, cs
  9428. @item alpha_swap, as
  9429. Swap luma/chroma/alpha fields. Exchange even & odd lines. Default value is @code{0}.
  9430. @end table
  9431. @subsection Commands
  9432. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9433. @section inflate
  9434. Apply inflate effect to the video.
  9435. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) average by taking into account
  9436. only values higher than the pixel.
  9437. It accepts the following options:
  9438. @table @option
  9439. @item threshold0
  9440. @item threshold1
  9441. @item threshold2
  9442. @item threshold3
  9443. Limit the maximum change for each plane, default is 65535.
  9444. If 0, plane will remain unchanged.
  9445. @end table
  9446. @subsection Commands
  9447. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  9448. @section interlace
  9449. Simple interlacing filter from progressive contents. This interleaves upper (or
  9450. lower) lines from odd frames with lower (or upper) lines from even frames,
  9451. halving the frame rate and preserving image height.
  9452. @example
  9453. Original Original New Frame
  9454. Frame 'j' Frame 'j+1' (tff)
  9455. ========== =========== ==================
  9456. Line 0 --------------------> Frame 'j' Line 0
  9457. Line 1 Line 1 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 1
  9458. Line 2 ---------------------> Frame 'j' Line 2
  9459. Line 3 Line 3 ----> Frame 'j+1' Line 3
  9460. ... ... ...
  9461. New Frame + 1 will be generated by Frame 'j+2' and Frame 'j+3' and so on
  9462. @end example
  9463. It accepts the following optional parameters:
  9464. @table @option
  9465. @item scan
  9466. This determines whether the interlaced frame is taken from the even
  9467. (tff - default) or odd (bff) lines of the progressive frame.
  9468. @item lowpass
  9469. Vertical lowpass filter to avoid twitter interlacing and
  9470. reduce moire patterns.
  9471. @table @samp
  9472. @item 0, off
  9473. Disable vertical lowpass filter
  9474. @item 1, linear
  9475. Enable linear filter (default)
  9476. @item 2, complex
  9477. Enable complex filter. This will slightly less reduce twitter and moire
  9478. but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  9479. @end table
  9480. @end table
  9481. @section kerndeint
  9482. Deinterlace input video by applying Donald Graft's adaptive kernel
  9483. deinterling. Work on interlaced parts of a video to produce
  9484. progressive frames.
  9485. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  9486. @table @option
  9487. @item thresh
  9488. Set the threshold which affects the filter's tolerance when
  9489. determining if a pixel line must be processed. It must be an integer
  9490. in the range [0,255] and defaults to 10. A value of 0 will result in
  9491. applying the process on every pixels.
  9492. @item map
  9493. Paint pixels exceeding the threshold value to white if set to 1.
  9494. Default is 0.
  9495. @item order
  9496. Set the fields order. Swap fields if set to 1, leave fields alone if
  9497. 0. Default is 0.
  9498. @item sharp
  9499. Enable additional sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9500. @item twoway
  9501. Enable twoway sharpening if set to 1. Default is 0.
  9502. @end table
  9503. @subsection Examples
  9504. @itemize
  9505. @item
  9506. Apply default values:
  9507. @example
  9508. kerndeint=thresh=10:map=0:order=0:sharp=0:twoway=0
  9509. @end example
  9510. @item
  9511. Enable additional sharpening:
  9512. @example
  9513. kerndeint=sharp=1
  9514. @end example
  9515. @item
  9516. Paint processed pixels in white:
  9517. @example
  9518. kerndeint=map=1
  9519. @end example
  9520. @end itemize
  9521. @section lagfun
  9522. Slowly update darker pixels.
  9523. This filter makes short flashes of light appear longer.
  9524. This filter accepts the following options:
  9525. @table @option
  9526. @item decay
  9527. Set factor for decaying. Default is .95. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  9528. @item planes
  9529. Set which planes to filter. Default is all. Allowed range is from 0 to 15.
  9530. @end table
  9531. @section lenscorrection
  9532. Correct radial lens distortion
  9533. This filter can be used to correct for radial distortion as can result from the use
  9534. of wide angle lenses, and thereby re-rectify the image. To find the right parameters
  9535. one can use tools available for example as part of opencv or simply trial-and-error.
  9536. To use opencv use the calibration sample (under samples/cpp) from the opencv sources
  9537. and extract the k1 and k2 coefficients from the resulting matrix.
  9538. Note that effectively the same filter is available in the open-source tools Krita and
  9539. Digikam from the KDE project.
  9540. In contrast to the @ref{vignette} filter, which can also be used to compensate lens errors,
  9541. this filter corrects the distortion of the image, whereas @ref{vignette} corrects the
  9542. brightness distribution, so you may want to use both filters together in certain
  9543. cases, though you will have to take care of ordering, i.e. whether vignetting should
  9544. be applied before or after lens correction.
  9545. @subsection Options
  9546. The filter accepts the following options:
  9547. @table @option
  9548. @item cx
  9549. Relative x-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9550. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9551. width. Default is 0.5.
  9552. @item cy
  9553. Relative y-coordinate of the focal point of the image, and thereby the center of the
  9554. distortion. This value has a range [0,1] and is expressed as fractions of the image
  9555. height. Default is 0.5.
  9556. @item k1
  9557. Coefficient of the quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1]. 0 means
  9558. no correction. Default is 0.
  9559. @item k2
  9560. Coefficient of the double quadratic correction term. This value has a range [-1,1].
  9561. 0 means no correction. Default is 0.
  9562. @end table
  9563. The formula that generates the correction is:
  9564. @var{r_src} = @var{r_tgt} * (1 + @var{k1} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^2 + @var{k2} * (@var{r_tgt} / @var{r_0})^4)
  9565. where @var{r_0} is halve of the image diagonal and @var{r_src} and @var{r_tgt} are the
  9566. distances from the focal point in the source and target images, respectively.
  9567. @section lensfun
  9568. Apply lens correction via the lensfun library (@url{http://lensfun.sourceforge.net/}).
  9569. The @code{lensfun} filter requires the camera make, camera model, and lens model
  9570. to apply the lens correction. The filter will load the lensfun database and
  9571. query it to find the corresponding camera and lens entries in the database. As
  9572. long as these entries can be found with the given options, the filter can
  9573. perform corrections on frames. Note that incomplete strings will result in the
  9574. filter choosing the best match with the given options, and the filter will
  9575. output the chosen camera and lens models (logged with level "info"). You must
  9576. provide the make, camera model, and lens model as they are required.
  9577. The filter accepts the following options:
  9578. @table @option
  9579. @item make
  9580. The make of the camera (for example, "Canon"). This option is required.
  9581. @item model
  9582. The model of the camera (for example, "Canon EOS 100D"). This option is
  9583. required.
  9584. @item lens_model
  9585. The model of the lens (for example, "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM"). This
  9586. option is required.
  9587. @item mode
  9588. The type of correction to apply. The following values are valid options:
  9589. @table @samp
  9590. @item vignetting
  9591. Enables fixing lens vignetting.
  9592. @item geometry
  9593. Enables fixing lens geometry. This is the default.
  9594. @item subpixel
  9595. Enables fixing chromatic aberrations.
  9596. @item vig_geo
  9597. Enables fixing lens vignetting and lens geometry.
  9598. @item vig_subpixel
  9599. Enables fixing lens vignetting and chromatic aberrations.
  9600. @item distortion
  9601. Enables fixing both lens geometry and chromatic aberrations.
  9602. @item all
  9603. Enables all possible corrections.
  9604. @end table
  9605. @item focal_length
  9606. The focal length of the image/video (zoom; expected constant for video). For
  9607. example, a 18--55mm lens has focal length range of [18--55], so a value in that
  9608. range should be chosen when using that lens. Default 18.
  9609. @item aperture
  9610. The aperture of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9611. aperture is only used for vignetting correction. Default 3.5.
  9612. @item focus_distance
  9613. The focus distance of the image/video (expected constant for video). Note that
  9614. focus distance is only used for vignetting and only slightly affects the
  9615. vignetting correction process. If unknown, leave it at the default value (which
  9616. is 1000).
  9617. @item scale
  9618. The scale factor which is applied after transformation. After correction the
  9619. video is no longer necessarily rectangular. This parameter controls how much of
  9620. the resulting image is visible. The value 0 means that a value will be chosen
  9621. automatically such that there is little or no unmapped area in the output
  9622. image. 1.0 means that no additional scaling is done. Lower values may result
  9623. in more of the corrected image being visible, while higher values may avoid
  9624. unmapped areas in the output.
  9625. @item target_geometry
  9626. The target geometry of the output image/video. The following values are valid
  9627. options:
  9628. @table @samp
  9629. @item rectilinear (default)
  9630. @item fisheye
  9631. @item panoramic
  9632. @item equirectangular
  9633. @item fisheye_orthographic
  9634. @item fisheye_stereographic
  9635. @item fisheye_equisolid
  9636. @item fisheye_thoby
  9637. @end table
  9638. @item reverse
  9639. Apply the reverse of image correction (instead of correcting distortion, apply
  9640. it).
  9641. @item interpolation
  9642. The type of interpolation used when correcting distortion. The following values
  9643. are valid options:
  9644. @table @samp
  9645. @item nearest
  9646. @item linear (default)
  9647. @item lanczos
  9648. @end table
  9649. @end table
  9650. @subsection Examples
  9651. @itemize
  9652. @item
  9653. Apply lens correction with make "Canon", camera model "Canon EOS 100D", and lens
  9654. model "Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM" with focal length of "18" and
  9655. aperture of "8.0".
  9656. @example
  9657. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8 -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9658. @end example
  9659. @item
  9660. Apply the same as before, but only for the first 5 seconds of video.
  9661. @example
  9662. ffmpeg -i input.mov -vf lensfun=make=Canon:model="Canon EOS 100D":lens_model="Canon EF-S 18-55mm f/3.5-5.6 IS STM":focal_length=18:aperture=8:enable='lte(t\,5)' -c:v h264 -b:v 8000k output.mov
  9663. @end example
  9664. @end itemize
  9665. @section libvmaf
  9666. Obtain the VMAF (Video Multi-Method Assessment Fusion)
  9667. score between two input videos.
  9668. The obtained VMAF score is printed through the logging system.
  9669. It requires Netflix's vmaf library (libvmaf) as a pre-requisite.
  9670. After installing the library it can be enabled using:
  9671. @code{./configure --enable-libvmaf --enable-version3}.
  9672. If no model path is specified it uses the default model: @code{vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl}.
  9673. The filter has following options:
  9674. @table @option
  9675. @item model_path
  9676. Set the model path which is to be used for SVM.
  9677. Default value: @code{"/usr/local/share/model/vmaf_v0.6.1.pkl"}
  9678. @item log_path
  9679. Set the file path to be used to store logs.
  9680. @item log_fmt
  9681. Set the format of the log file (xml or json).
  9682. @item enable_transform
  9683. This option can enable/disable the @code{score_transform} applied to the final predicted VMAF score,
  9684. if you have specified score_transform option in the input parameter file passed to @code{run_vmaf_training.py}
  9685. Default value: @code{false}
  9686. @item phone_model
  9687. Invokes the phone model which will generate VMAF scores higher than in the
  9688. regular model, which is more suitable for laptop, TV, etc. viewing conditions.
  9689. Default value: @code{false}
  9690. @item psnr
  9691. Enables computing psnr along with vmaf.
  9692. Default value: @code{false}
  9693. @item ssim
  9694. Enables computing ssim along with vmaf.
  9695. Default value: @code{false}
  9696. @item ms_ssim
  9697. Enables computing ms_ssim along with vmaf.
  9698. Default value: @code{false}
  9699. @item pool
  9700. Set the pool method to be used for computing vmaf.
  9701. Options are @code{min}, @code{harmonic_mean} or @code{mean} (default).
  9702. @item n_threads
  9703. Set number of threads to be used when computing vmaf.
  9704. Default value: @code{0}, which makes use of all available logical processors.
  9705. @item n_subsample
  9706. Set interval for frame subsampling used when computing vmaf.
  9707. Default value: @code{1}
  9708. @item enable_conf_interval
  9709. Enables confidence interval.
  9710. Default value: @code{false}
  9711. @end table
  9712. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  9713. @subsection Examples
  9714. @itemize
  9715. @item
  9716. On the below examples the input file @file{main.mpg} being processed is
  9717. compared with the reference file @file{ref.mpg}.
  9718. @example
  9719. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf -f null -
  9720. @end example
  9721. @item
  9722. Example with options:
  9723. @example
  9724. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi libvmaf="psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9725. @end example
  9726. @item
  9727. Example with options and different containers:
  9728. @example
  9729. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]libvmaf=psnr=1:log_fmt=json" -f null -
  9730. @end example
  9731. @end itemize
  9732. @section limiter
  9733. Limits the pixel components values to the specified range [min, max].
  9734. The filter accepts the following options:
  9735. @table @option
  9736. @item min
  9737. Lower bound. Defaults to the lowest allowed value for the input.
  9738. @item max
  9739. Upper bound. Defaults to the highest allowed value for the input.
  9740. @item planes
  9741. Specify which planes will be processed. Defaults to all available.
  9742. @end table
  9743. @section loop
  9744. Loop video frames.
  9745. The filter accepts the following options:
  9746. @table @option
  9747. @item loop
  9748. Set the number of loops. Setting this value to -1 will result in infinite loops.
  9749. Default is 0.
  9750. @item size
  9751. Set maximal size in number of frames. Default is 0.
  9752. @item start
  9753. Set first frame of loop. Default is 0.
  9754. @end table
  9755. @subsection Examples
  9756. @itemize
  9757. @item
  9758. Loop single first frame infinitely:
  9759. @example
  9760. loop=loop=-1:size=1:start=0
  9761. @end example
  9762. @item
  9763. Loop single first frame 10 times:
  9764. @example
  9765. loop=loop=10:size=1:start=0
  9766. @end example
  9767. @item
  9768. Loop 10 first frames 5 times:
  9769. @example
  9770. loop=loop=5:size=10:start=0
  9771. @end example
  9772. @end itemize
  9773. @section lut1d
  9774. Apply a 1D LUT to an input video.
  9775. The filter accepts the following options:
  9776. @table @option
  9777. @item file
  9778. Set the 1D LUT file name.
  9779. Currently supported formats:
  9780. @table @samp
  9781. @item cube
  9782. Iridas
  9783. @item csp
  9784. cineSpace
  9785. @end table
  9786. @item interp
  9787. Select interpolation mode.
  9788. Available values are:
  9789. @table @samp
  9790. @item nearest
  9791. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9792. @item linear
  9793. Interpolate values using the linear interpolation.
  9794. @item cosine
  9795. Interpolate values using the cosine interpolation.
  9796. @item cubic
  9797. Interpolate values using the cubic interpolation.
  9798. @item spline
  9799. Interpolate values using the spline interpolation.
  9800. @end table
  9801. @end table
  9802. @anchor{lut3d}
  9803. @section lut3d
  9804. Apply a 3D LUT to an input video.
  9805. The filter accepts the following options:
  9806. @table @option
  9807. @item file
  9808. Set the 3D LUT file name.
  9809. Currently supported formats:
  9810. @table @samp
  9811. @item 3dl
  9812. AfterEffects
  9813. @item cube
  9814. Iridas
  9815. @item dat
  9816. DaVinci
  9817. @item m3d
  9818. Pandora
  9819. @item csp
  9820. cineSpace
  9821. @end table
  9822. @item interp
  9823. Select interpolation mode.
  9824. Available values are:
  9825. @table @samp
  9826. @item nearest
  9827. Use values from the nearest defined point.
  9828. @item trilinear
  9829. Interpolate values using the 8 points defining a cube.
  9830. @item tetrahedral
  9831. Interpolate values using a tetrahedron.
  9832. @end table
  9833. @end table
  9834. @section lumakey
  9835. Turn certain luma values into transparency.
  9836. The filter accepts the following options:
  9837. @table @option
  9838. @item threshold
  9839. Set the luma which will be used as base for transparency.
  9840. Default value is @code{0}.
  9841. @item tolerance
  9842. Set the range of luma values to be keyed out.
  9843. Default value is @code{0.01}.
  9844. @item softness
  9845. Set the range of softness. Default value is @code{0}.
  9846. Use this to control gradual transition from zero to full transparency.
  9847. @end table
  9848. @subsection Commands
  9849. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  9850. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  9851. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  9852. value.
  9853. @section lut, lutrgb, lutyuv
  9854. Compute a look-up table for binding each pixel component input value
  9855. to an output value, and apply it to the input video.
  9856. @var{lutyuv} applies a lookup table to a YUV input video, @var{lutrgb}
  9857. to an RGB input video.
  9858. These filters accept the following parameters:
  9859. @table @option
  9860. @item c0
  9861. set first pixel component expression
  9862. @item c1
  9863. set second pixel component expression
  9864. @item c2
  9865. set third pixel component expression
  9866. @item c3
  9867. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9868. @item r
  9869. set red component expression
  9870. @item g
  9871. set green component expression
  9872. @item b
  9873. set blue component expression
  9874. @item a
  9875. alpha component expression
  9876. @item y
  9877. set Y/luminance component expression
  9878. @item u
  9879. set U/Cb component expression
  9880. @item v
  9881. set V/Cr component expression
  9882. @end table
  9883. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9884. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9885. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9886. format in input.
  9887. The @var{lut} filter requires either YUV or RGB pixel formats in input,
  9888. @var{lutrgb} requires RGB pixel formats in input, and @var{lutyuv} requires YUV.
  9889. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  9890. @table @option
  9891. @item w
  9892. @item h
  9893. The input width and height.
  9894. @item val
  9895. The input value for the pixel component.
  9896. @item clipval
  9897. The input value, clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9898. @item maxval
  9899. The maximum value for the pixel component.
  9900. @item minval
  9901. The minimum value for the pixel component.
  9902. @item negval
  9903. The negated value for the pixel component value, clipped to the
  9904. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range; it corresponds to the expression
  9905. "maxval-clipval+minval".
  9906. @item clip(val)
  9907. The computed value in @var{val}, clipped to the
  9908. @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range.
  9909. @item gammaval(gamma)
  9910. The computed gamma correction value of the pixel component value,
  9911. clipped to the @var{minval}-@var{maxval} range. It corresponds to the
  9912. expression
  9913. "pow((clipval-minval)/(maxval-minval)\,@var{gamma})*(maxval-minval)+minval"
  9914. @end table
  9915. All expressions default to "val".
  9916. @subsection Examples
  9917. @itemize
  9918. @item
  9919. Negate input video:
  9920. @example
  9921. lutrgb="r=maxval+minval-val:g=maxval+minval-val:b=maxval+minval-val"
  9922. lutyuv="y=maxval+minval-val:u=maxval+minval-val:v=maxval+minval-val"
  9923. @end example
  9924. The above is the same as:
  9925. @example
  9926. lutrgb="r=negval:g=negval:b=negval"
  9927. lutyuv="y=negval:u=negval:v=negval"
  9928. @end example
  9929. @item
  9930. Negate luminance:
  9931. @example
  9932. lutyuv=y=negval
  9933. @end example
  9934. @item
  9935. Remove chroma components, turning the video into a graytone image:
  9936. @example
  9937. lutyuv="u=128:v=128"
  9938. @end example
  9939. @item
  9940. Apply a luma burning effect:
  9941. @example
  9942. lutyuv="y=2*val"
  9943. @end example
  9944. @item
  9945. Remove green and blue components:
  9946. @example
  9947. lutrgb="g=0:b=0"
  9948. @end example
  9949. @item
  9950. Set a constant alpha channel value on input:
  9951. @example
  9952. format=rgba,lutrgb=a="maxval-minval/2"
  9953. @end example
  9954. @item
  9955. Correct luminance gamma by a factor of 0.5:
  9956. @example
  9957. lutyuv=y=gammaval(0.5)
  9958. @end example
  9959. @item
  9960. Discard least significant bits of luma:
  9961. @example
  9962. lutyuv=y='bitand(val, 128+64+32)'
  9963. @end example
  9964. @item
  9965. Technicolor like effect:
  9966. @example
  9967. lutyuv=u='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2':v='(val-maxval/2)*2+maxval/2'
  9968. @end example
  9969. @end itemize
  9970. @section lut2, tlut2
  9971. The @code{lut2} filter takes two input streams and outputs one
  9972. stream.
  9973. The @code{tlut2} (time lut2) filter takes two consecutive frames
  9974. from one single stream.
  9975. This filter accepts the following parameters:
  9976. @table @option
  9977. @item c0
  9978. set first pixel component expression
  9979. @item c1
  9980. set second pixel component expression
  9981. @item c2
  9982. set third pixel component expression
  9983. @item c3
  9984. set fourth pixel component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  9985. @item d
  9986. set output bit depth, only available for @code{lut2} filter. By default is 0,
  9987. which means bit depth is automatically picked from first input format.
  9988. @end table
  9989. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  9990. the corresponding pixel component values.
  9991. The exact component associated to each of the @var{c*} options depends on the
  9992. format in inputs.
  9993. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  9994. @table @option
  9995. @item w
  9996. @item h
  9997. The input width and height.
  9998. @item x
  9999. The first input value for the pixel component.
  10000. @item y
  10001. The second input value for the pixel component.
  10002. @item bdx
  10003. The first input video bit depth.
  10004. @item bdy
  10005. The second input video bit depth.
  10006. @end table
  10007. All expressions default to "x".
  10008. @subsection Examples
  10009. @itemize
  10010. @item
  10011. Highlight differences between two RGB video streams:
  10012. @example
  10013. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10014. @end example
  10015. @item
  10016. Highlight differences between two YUV video streams:
  10017. @example
  10018. lut2='ifnot(x-y,0,pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1):ifnot(x-y,pow(2,bdx-1),pow(2,bdx)-1)'
  10019. @end example
  10020. @item
  10021. Show max difference between two video streams:
  10022. @example
  10023. lut2='if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1))):if(lt(x,y),0,if(gt(x,y),pow(2,bdx)-1,pow(2,bdx-1)))'
  10024. @end example
  10025. @end itemize
  10026. @section maskedclamp
  10027. Clamp the first input stream with the second input and third input stream.
  10028. Returns the value of first stream to be between second input
  10029. stream - @code{undershoot} and third input stream + @code{overshoot}.
  10030. This filter accepts the following options:
  10031. @table @option
  10032. @item undershoot
  10033. Default value is @code{0}.
  10034. @item overshoot
  10035. Default value is @code{0}.
  10036. @item planes
  10037. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10038. copied from first stream.
  10039. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10040. @end table
  10041. @section maskedmax
  10042. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10043. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10044. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10045. stream if second absolute difference is greater than first one or from third input stream
  10046. otherwise.
  10047. This filter accepts the following options:
  10048. @table @option
  10049. @item planes
  10050. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10051. copied from first stream.
  10052. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10053. @end table
  10054. @section maskedmerge
  10055. Merge the first input stream with the second input stream using per pixel
  10056. weights in the third input stream.
  10057. A value of 0 in the third stream pixel component means that pixel component
  10058. from first stream is returned unchanged, while maximum value (eg. 255 for
  10059. 8-bit videos) means that pixel component from second stream is returned
  10060. unchanged. Intermediate values define the amount of merging between both
  10061. input stream's pixel components.
  10062. This filter accepts the following options:
  10063. @table @option
  10064. @item planes
  10065. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10066. copied from first stream.
  10067. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10068. @end table
  10069. @section maskedmin
  10070. Merge the second and third input stream into output stream using absolute differences
  10071. between second input stream and first input stream and absolute difference between
  10072. third input stream and first input stream. The picked value will be from second input
  10073. stream if second absolute difference is less than first one or from third input stream
  10074. otherwise.
  10075. This filter accepts the following options:
  10076. @table @option
  10077. @item planes
  10078. Set which planes will be processed as bitmap, unprocessed planes will be
  10079. copied from first stream.
  10080. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  10081. @end table
  10082. @section maskfun
  10083. Create mask from input video.
  10084. For example it is useful to create motion masks after @code{tblend} filter.
  10085. This filter accepts the following options:
  10086. @table @option
  10087. @item low
  10088. Set low threshold. Any pixel component lower or exact than this value will be set to 0.
  10089. @item high
  10090. Set high threshold. Any pixel component higher than this value will be set to max value
  10091. allowed for current pixel format.
  10092. @item planes
  10093. Set planes to filter, by default all available planes are filtered.
  10094. @item fill
  10095. Fill all frame pixels with this value.
  10096. @item sum
  10097. Set max average pixel value for frame. If sum of all pixel components is higher that this
  10098. average, output frame will be completely filled with value set by @var{fill} option.
  10099. Typically useful for scene changes when used in combination with @code{tblend} filter.
  10100. @end table
  10101. @section mcdeint
  10102. Apply motion-compensation deinterlacing.
  10103. It needs one field per frame as input and must thus be used together
  10104. with yadif=1/3 or equivalent.
  10105. This filter accepts the following options:
  10106. @table @option
  10107. @item mode
  10108. Set the deinterlacing mode.
  10109. It accepts one of the following values:
  10110. @table @samp
  10111. @item fast
  10112. @item medium
  10113. @item slow
  10114. use iterative motion estimation
  10115. @item extra_slow
  10116. like @samp{slow}, but use multiple reference frames.
  10117. @end table
  10118. Default value is @samp{fast}.
  10119. @item parity
  10120. Set the picture field parity assumed for the input video. It must be
  10121. one of the following values:
  10122. @table @samp
  10123. @item 0, tff
  10124. assume top field first
  10125. @item 1, bff
  10126. assume bottom field first
  10127. @end table
  10128. Default value is @samp{bff}.
  10129. @item qp
  10130. Set per-block quantization parameter (QP) used by the internal
  10131. encoder.
  10132. Higher values should result in a smoother motion vector field but less
  10133. optimal individual vectors. Default value is 1.
  10134. @end table
  10135. @section median
  10136. Pick median pixel from certain rectangle defined by radius.
  10137. This filter accepts the following options:
  10138. @table @option
  10139. @item radius
  10140. Set horizontal radius size. Default value is @code{1}.
  10141. Allowed range is integer from 1 to 127.
  10142. @item planes
  10143. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10144. @item radiusV
  10145. Set vertical radius size. Default value is @code{0}.
  10146. Allowed range is integer from 0 to 127.
  10147. If it is 0, value will be picked from horizontal @code{radius} option.
  10148. @item percentile
  10149. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  10150. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  10151. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  10152. @end table
  10153. @subsection Commands
  10154. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10155. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10156. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10157. value.
  10158. @section mergeplanes
  10159. Merge color channel components from several video streams.
  10160. The filter accepts up to 4 input streams, and merge selected input
  10161. planes to the output video.
  10162. This filter accepts the following options:
  10163. @table @option
  10164. @item mapping
  10165. Set input to output plane mapping. Default is @code{0}.
  10166. The mappings is specified as a bitmap. It should be specified as a
  10167. hexadecimal number in the form 0xAa[Bb[Cc[Dd]]]. 'Aa' describes the
  10168. mapping for the first plane of the output stream. 'A' sets the number of
  10169. the input stream to use (from 0 to 3), and 'a' the plane number of the
  10170. corresponding input to use (from 0 to 3). The rest of the mappings is
  10171. similar, 'Bb' describes the mapping for the output stream second
  10172. plane, 'Cc' describes the mapping for the output stream third plane and
  10173. 'Dd' describes the mapping for the output stream fourth plane.
  10174. @item format
  10175. Set output pixel format. Default is @code{yuva444p}.
  10176. @end table
  10177. @subsection Examples
  10178. @itemize
  10179. @item
  10180. Merge three gray video streams of same width and height into single video stream:
  10181. @example
  10182. [a0][a1][a2]mergeplanes=0x001020:yuv444p
  10183. @end example
  10184. @item
  10185. Merge 1st yuv444p stream and 2nd gray video stream into yuva444p video stream:
  10186. @example
  10187. [a0][a1]mergeplanes=0x00010210:yuva444p
  10188. @end example
  10189. @item
  10190. Swap Y and A plane in yuva444p stream:
  10191. @example
  10192. format=yuva444p,mergeplanes=0x03010200:yuva444p
  10193. @end example
  10194. @item
  10195. Swap U and V plane in yuv420p stream:
  10196. @example
  10197. format=yuv420p,mergeplanes=0x000201:yuv420p
  10198. @end example
  10199. @item
  10200. Cast a rgb24 clip to yuv444p:
  10201. @example
  10202. format=rgb24,mergeplanes=0x000102:yuv444p
  10203. @end example
  10204. @end itemize
  10205. @section mestimate
  10206. Estimate and export motion vectors using block matching algorithms.
  10207. Motion vectors are stored in frame side data to be used by other filters.
  10208. This filter accepts the following options:
  10209. @table @option
  10210. @item method
  10211. Specify the motion estimation method. Accepts one of the following values:
  10212. @table @samp
  10213. @item esa
  10214. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10215. @item tss
  10216. Three step search algorithm.
  10217. @item tdls
  10218. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10219. @item ntss
  10220. New three step search algorithm.
  10221. @item fss
  10222. Four step search algorithm.
  10223. @item ds
  10224. Diamond search algorithm.
  10225. @item hexbs
  10226. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10227. @item epzs
  10228. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10229. @item umh
  10230. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10231. @end table
  10232. Default value is @samp{esa}.
  10233. @item mb_size
  10234. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10235. @item search_param
  10236. Search parameter. Default @code{7}.
  10237. @end table
  10238. @section midequalizer
  10239. Apply Midway Image Equalization effect using two video streams.
  10240. Midway Image Equalization adjusts a pair of images to have the same
  10241. histogram, while maintaining their dynamics as much as possible. It's
  10242. useful for e.g. matching exposures from a pair of stereo cameras.
  10243. This filter has two inputs and one output, which must be of same pixel format, but
  10244. may be of different sizes. The output of filter is first input adjusted with
  10245. midway histogram of both inputs.
  10246. This filter accepts the following option:
  10247. @table @option
  10248. @item planes
  10249. Set which planes to process. Default is @code{15}, which is all available planes.
  10250. @end table
  10251. @section minterpolate
  10252. Convert the video to specified frame rate using motion interpolation.
  10253. This filter accepts the following options:
  10254. @table @option
  10255. @item fps
  10256. Specify the output frame rate. This can be rational e.g. @code{60000/1001}. Frames are dropped if @var{fps} is lower than source fps. Default @code{60}.
  10257. @item mi_mode
  10258. Motion interpolation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10259. @table @samp
  10260. @item dup
  10261. Duplicate previous or next frame for interpolating new ones.
  10262. @item blend
  10263. Blend source frames. Interpolated frame is mean of previous and next frames.
  10264. @item mci
  10265. Motion compensated interpolation. Following options are effective when this mode is selected:
  10266. @table @samp
  10267. @item mc_mode
  10268. Motion compensation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10269. @table @samp
  10270. @item obmc
  10271. Overlapped block motion compensation.
  10272. @item aobmc
  10273. Adaptive overlapped block motion compensation. Window weighting coefficients are controlled adaptively according to the reliabilities of the neighboring motion vectors to reduce oversmoothing.
  10274. @end table
  10275. Default mode is @samp{obmc}.
  10276. @item me_mode
  10277. Motion estimation mode. Following values are accepted:
  10278. @table @samp
  10279. @item bidir
  10280. Bidirectional motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated for each source frame in both forward and backward directions.
  10281. @item bilat
  10282. Bilateral motion estimation. Motion vectors are estimated directly for interpolated frame.
  10283. @end table
  10284. Default mode is @samp{bilat}.
  10285. @item me
  10286. The algorithm to be used for motion estimation. Following values are accepted:
  10287. @table @samp
  10288. @item esa
  10289. Exhaustive search algorithm.
  10290. @item tss
  10291. Three step search algorithm.
  10292. @item tdls
  10293. Two dimensional logarithmic search algorithm.
  10294. @item ntss
  10295. New three step search algorithm.
  10296. @item fss
  10297. Four step search algorithm.
  10298. @item ds
  10299. Diamond search algorithm.
  10300. @item hexbs
  10301. Hexagon-based search algorithm.
  10302. @item epzs
  10303. Enhanced predictive zonal search algorithm.
  10304. @item umh
  10305. Uneven multi-hexagon search algorithm.
  10306. @end table
  10307. Default algorithm is @samp{epzs}.
  10308. @item mb_size
  10309. Macroblock size. Default @code{16}.
  10310. @item search_param
  10311. Motion estimation search parameter. Default @code{32}.
  10312. @item vsbmc
  10313. Enable variable-size block motion compensation. Motion estimation is applied with smaller block sizes at object boundaries in order to make the them less blur. Default is @code{0} (disabled).
  10314. @end table
  10315. @end table
  10316. @item scd
  10317. Scene change detection method. Scene change leads motion vectors to be in random direction. Scene change detection replace interpolated frames by duplicate ones. May not be needed for other modes. Following values are accepted:
  10318. @table @samp
  10319. @item none
  10320. Disable scene change detection.
  10321. @item fdiff
  10322. Frame difference. Corresponding pixel values are compared and if it satisfies @var{scd_threshold} scene change is detected.
  10323. @end table
  10324. Default method is @samp{fdiff}.
  10325. @item scd_threshold
  10326. Scene change detection threshold. Default is @code{5.0}.
  10327. @end table
  10328. @section mix
  10329. Mix several video input streams into one video stream.
  10330. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10331. @table @option
  10332. @item nb_inputs
  10333. The number of inputs. If unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  10334. @item weights
  10335. Specify weight of each input video stream as sequence.
  10336. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights
  10337. is smaller than number of @var{frames} last specified
  10338. weight will be used for all remaining unset weights.
  10339. @item scale
  10340. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  10341. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  10342. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  10343. @item duration
  10344. Specify how end of stream is determined.
  10345. @table @samp
  10346. @item longest
  10347. The duration of the longest input. (default)
  10348. @item shortest
  10349. The duration of the shortest input.
  10350. @item first
  10351. The duration of the first input.
  10352. @end table
  10353. @end table
  10354. @section mpdecimate
  10355. Drop frames that do not differ greatly from the previous frame in
  10356. order to reduce frame rate.
  10357. The main use of this filter is for very-low-bitrate encoding
  10358. (e.g. streaming over dialup modem), but it could in theory be used for
  10359. fixing movies that were inverse-telecined incorrectly.
  10360. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10361. @table @option
  10362. @item max
  10363. Set the maximum number of consecutive frames which can be dropped (if
  10364. positive), or the minimum interval between dropped frames (if
  10365. negative). If the value is 0, the frame is dropped disregarding the
  10366. number of previous sequentially dropped frames.
  10367. Default value is 0.
  10368. @item hi
  10369. @item lo
  10370. @item frac
  10371. Set the dropping threshold values.
  10372. Values for @option{hi} and @option{lo} are for 8x8 pixel blocks and
  10373. represent actual pixel value differences, so a threshold of 64
  10374. corresponds to 1 unit of difference for each pixel, or the same spread
  10375. out differently over the block.
  10376. A frame is a candidate for dropping if no 8x8 blocks differ by more
  10377. than a threshold of @option{hi}, and if no more than @option{frac} blocks (1
  10378. meaning the whole image) differ by more than a threshold of @option{lo}.
  10379. Default value for @option{hi} is 64*12, default value for @option{lo} is
  10380. 64*5, and default value for @option{frac} is 0.33.
  10381. @end table
  10382. @section negate
  10383. Negate (invert) the input video.
  10384. It accepts the following option:
  10385. @table @option
  10386. @item negate_alpha
  10387. With value 1, it negates the alpha component, if present. Default value is 0.
  10388. @end table
  10389. @anchor{nlmeans}
  10390. @section nlmeans
  10391. Denoise frames using Non-Local Means algorithm.
  10392. Each pixel is adjusted by looking for other pixels with similar contexts. This
  10393. context similarity is defined by comparing their surrounding patches of size
  10394. @option{p}x@option{p}. Patches are searched in an area of @option{r}x@option{r}
  10395. around the pixel.
  10396. Note that the research area defines centers for patches, which means some
  10397. patches will be made of pixels outside that research area.
  10398. The filter accepts the following options.
  10399. @table @option
  10400. @item s
  10401. Set denoising strength. Default is 1.0. Must be in range [1.0, 30.0].
  10402. @item p
  10403. Set patch size. Default is 7. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10404. @item pc
  10405. Same as @option{p} but for chroma planes.
  10406. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10407. @item r
  10408. Set research size. Default is 15. Must be odd number in range [0, 99].
  10409. @item rc
  10410. Same as @option{r} but for chroma planes.
  10411. The default value is @var{0} and means automatic.
  10412. @end table
  10413. @section nnedi
  10414. Deinterlace video using neural network edge directed interpolation.
  10415. This filter accepts the following options:
  10416. @table @option
  10417. @item weights
  10418. Mandatory option, without binary file filter can not work.
  10419. Currently file can be found here:
  10420. https://github.com/dubhater/vapoursynth-nnedi3/blob/master/src/nnedi3_weights.bin
  10421. @item deint
  10422. Set which frames to deinterlace, by default it is @code{all}.
  10423. Can be @code{all} or @code{interlaced}.
  10424. @item field
  10425. Set mode of operation.
  10426. Can be one of the following:
  10427. @table @samp
  10428. @item af
  10429. Use frame flags, both fields.
  10430. @item a
  10431. Use frame flags, single field.
  10432. @item t
  10433. Use top field only.
  10434. @item b
  10435. Use bottom field only.
  10436. @item tf
  10437. Use both fields, top first.
  10438. @item bf
  10439. Use both fields, bottom first.
  10440. @end table
  10441. @item planes
  10442. Set which planes to process, by default filter process all frames.
  10443. @item nsize
  10444. Set size of local neighborhood around each pixel, used by the predictor neural
  10445. network.
  10446. Can be one of the following:
  10447. @table @samp
  10448. @item s8x6
  10449. @item s16x6
  10450. @item s32x6
  10451. @item s48x6
  10452. @item s8x4
  10453. @item s16x4
  10454. @item s32x4
  10455. @end table
  10456. @item nns
  10457. Set the number of neurons in predictor neural network.
  10458. Can be one of the following:
  10459. @table @samp
  10460. @item n16
  10461. @item n32
  10462. @item n64
  10463. @item n128
  10464. @item n256
  10465. @end table
  10466. @item qual
  10467. Controls the number of different neural network predictions that are blended
  10468. together to compute the final output value. Can be @code{fast}, default or
  10469. @code{slow}.
  10470. @item etype
  10471. Set which set of weights to use in the predictor.
  10472. Can be one of the following:
  10473. @table @samp
  10474. @item a
  10475. weights trained to minimize absolute error
  10476. @item s
  10477. weights trained to minimize squared error
  10478. @end table
  10479. @item pscrn
  10480. Controls whether or not the prescreener neural network is used to decide
  10481. which pixels should be processed by the predictor neural network and which
  10482. can be handled by simple cubic interpolation.
  10483. The prescreener is trained to know whether cubic interpolation will be
  10484. sufficient for a pixel or whether it should be predicted by the predictor nn.
  10485. The computational complexity of the prescreener nn is much less than that of
  10486. the predictor nn. Since most pixels can be handled by cubic interpolation,
  10487. using the prescreener generally results in much faster processing.
  10488. The prescreener is pretty accurate, so the difference between using it and not
  10489. using it is almost always unnoticeable.
  10490. Can be one of the following:
  10491. @table @samp
  10492. @item none
  10493. @item original
  10494. @item new
  10495. @end table
  10496. Default is @code{new}.
  10497. @item fapprox
  10498. Set various debugging flags.
  10499. @end table
  10500. @section noformat
  10501. Force libavfilter not to use any of the specified pixel formats for the
  10502. input to the next filter.
  10503. It accepts the following parameters:
  10504. @table @option
  10505. @item pix_fmts
  10506. A '|'-separated list of pixel format names, such as
  10507. pix_fmts=yuv420p|monow|rgb24".
  10508. @end table
  10509. @subsection Examples
  10510. @itemize
  10511. @item
  10512. Force libavfilter to use a format different from @var{yuv420p} for the
  10513. input to the vflip filter:
  10514. @example
  10515. noformat=pix_fmts=yuv420p,vflip
  10516. @end example
  10517. @item
  10518. Convert the input video to any of the formats not contained in the list:
  10519. @example
  10520. noformat=yuv420p|yuv444p|yuv410p
  10521. @end example
  10522. @end itemize
  10523. @section noise
  10524. Add noise on video input frame.
  10525. The filter accepts the following options:
  10526. @table @option
  10527. @item all_seed
  10528. @item c0_seed
  10529. @item c1_seed
  10530. @item c2_seed
  10531. @item c3_seed
  10532. Set noise seed for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10533. of @var{all_seed}. Default value is @code{123457}.
  10534. @item all_strength, alls
  10535. @item c0_strength, c0s
  10536. @item c1_strength, c1s
  10537. @item c2_strength, c2s
  10538. @item c3_strength, c3s
  10539. Set noise strength for specific pixel component or all pixel components in case
  10540. @var{all_strength}. Default value is @code{0}. Allowed range is [0, 100].
  10541. @item all_flags, allf
  10542. @item c0_flags, c0f
  10543. @item c1_flags, c1f
  10544. @item c2_flags, c2f
  10545. @item c3_flags, c3f
  10546. Set pixel component flags or set flags for all components if @var{all_flags}.
  10547. Available values for component flags are:
  10548. @table @samp
  10549. @item a
  10550. averaged temporal noise (smoother)
  10551. @item p
  10552. mix random noise with a (semi)regular pattern
  10553. @item t
  10554. temporal noise (noise pattern changes between frames)
  10555. @item u
  10556. uniform noise (gaussian otherwise)
  10557. @end table
  10558. @end table
  10559. @subsection Examples
  10560. Add temporal and uniform noise to input video:
  10561. @example
  10562. noise=alls=20:allf=t+u
  10563. @end example
  10564. @section normalize
  10565. Normalize RGB video (aka histogram stretching, contrast stretching).
  10566. See: https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normalization_(image_processing)
  10567. For each channel of each frame, the filter computes the input range and maps
  10568. it linearly to the user-specified output range. The output range defaults
  10569. to the full dynamic range from pure black to pure white.
  10570. Temporal smoothing can be used on the input range to reduce flickering (rapid
  10571. changes in brightness) caused when small dark or bright objects enter or leave
  10572. the scene. This is similar to the auto-exposure (automatic gain control) on a
  10573. video camera, and, like a video camera, it may cause a period of over- or
  10574. under-exposure of the video.
  10575. The R,G,B channels can be normalized independently, which may cause some
  10576. color shifting, or linked together as a single channel, which prevents
  10577. color shifting. Linked normalization preserves hue. Independent normalization
  10578. does not, so it can be used to remove some color casts. Independent and linked
  10579. normalization can be combined in any ratio.
  10580. The normalize filter accepts the following options:
  10581. @table @option
  10582. @item blackpt
  10583. @item whitept
  10584. Colors which define the output range. The minimum input value is mapped to
  10585. the @var{blackpt}. The maximum input value is mapped to the @var{whitept}.
  10586. The defaults are black and white respectively. Specifying white for
  10587. @var{blackpt} and black for @var{whitept} will give color-inverted,
  10588. normalized video. Shades of grey can be used to reduce the dynamic range
  10589. (contrast). Specifying saturated colors here can create some interesting
  10590. effects.
  10591. @item smoothing
  10592. The number of previous frames to use for temporal smoothing. The input range
  10593. of each channel is smoothed using a rolling average over the current frame
  10594. and the @var{smoothing} previous frames. The default is 0 (no temporal
  10595. smoothing).
  10596. @item independence
  10597. Controls the ratio of independent (color shifting) channel normalization to
  10598. linked (color preserving) normalization. 0.0 is fully linked, 1.0 is fully
  10599. independent. Defaults to 1.0 (fully independent).
  10600. @item strength
  10601. Overall strength of the filter. 1.0 is full strength. 0.0 is a rather
  10602. expensive no-op. Defaults to 1.0 (full strength).
  10603. @end table
  10604. @subsection Commands
  10605. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options, excluding @var{smoothing} option.
  10606. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10607. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10608. value.
  10609. @subsection Examples
  10610. Stretch video contrast to use the full dynamic range, with no temporal
  10611. smoothing; may flicker depending on the source content:
  10612. @example
  10613. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=0
  10614. @end example
  10615. As above, but with 50 frames of temporal smoothing; flicker should be
  10616. reduced, depending on the source content:
  10617. @example
  10618. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50
  10619. @end example
  10620. As above, but with hue-preserving linked channel normalization:
  10621. @example
  10622. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0
  10623. @end example
  10624. As above, but with half strength:
  10625. @example
  10626. normalize=blackpt=black:whitept=white:smoothing=50:independence=0:strength=0.5
  10627. @end example
  10628. Map the darkest input color to red, the brightest input color to cyan:
  10629. @example
  10630. normalize=blackpt=red:whitept=cyan
  10631. @end example
  10632. @section null
  10633. Pass the video source unchanged to the output.
  10634. @section ocr
  10635. Optical Character Recognition
  10636. This filter uses Tesseract for optical character recognition. To enable
  10637. compilation of this filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with
  10638. @code{--enable-libtesseract}.
  10639. It accepts the following options:
  10640. @table @option
  10641. @item datapath
  10642. Set datapath to tesseract data. Default is to use whatever was
  10643. set at installation.
  10644. @item language
  10645. Set language, default is "eng".
  10646. @item whitelist
  10647. Set character whitelist.
  10648. @item blacklist
  10649. Set character blacklist.
  10650. @end table
  10651. The filter exports recognized text as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.text}.
  10652. The filter exports confidence of recognized words as the frame metadata @code{lavfi.ocr.confidence}.
  10653. @section ocv
  10654. Apply a video transform using libopencv.
  10655. To enable this filter, install the libopencv library and headers and
  10656. configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libopencv}.
  10657. It accepts the following parameters:
  10658. @table @option
  10659. @item filter_name
  10660. The name of the libopencv filter to apply.
  10661. @item filter_params
  10662. The parameters to pass to the libopencv filter. If not specified, the default
  10663. values are assumed.
  10664. @end table
  10665. Refer to the official libopencv documentation for more precise
  10666. information:
  10667. @url{http://docs.opencv.org/master/modules/imgproc/doc/filtering.html}
  10668. Several libopencv filters are supported; see the following subsections.
  10669. @anchor{dilate}
  10670. @subsection dilate
  10671. Dilate an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10672. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvDilate}.
  10673. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}|@var{nb_iterations}.
  10674. @var{struct_el} represents a structuring element, and has the syntax:
  10675. @var{cols}x@var{rows}+@var{anchor_x}x@var{anchor_y}/@var{shape}
  10676. @var{cols} and @var{rows} represent the number of columns and rows of
  10677. the structuring element, @var{anchor_x} and @var{anchor_y} the anchor
  10678. point, and @var{shape} the shape for the structuring element. @var{shape}
  10679. must be "rect", "cross", "ellipse", or "custom".
  10680. If the value for @var{shape} is "custom", it must be followed by a
  10681. string of the form "=@var{filename}". The file with name
  10682. @var{filename} is assumed to represent a binary image, with each
  10683. printable character corresponding to a bright pixel. When a custom
  10684. @var{shape} is used, @var{cols} and @var{rows} are ignored, the number
  10685. or columns and rows of the read file are assumed instead.
  10686. The default value for @var{struct_el} is "3x3+0x0/rect".
  10687. @var{nb_iterations} specifies the number of times the transform is
  10688. applied to the image, and defaults to 1.
  10689. Some examples:
  10690. @example
  10691. # Use the default values
  10692. ocv=dilate
  10693. # Dilate using a structuring element with a 5x5 cross, iterating two times
  10694. ocv=filter_name=dilate:filter_params=5x5+2x2/cross|2
  10695. # Read the shape from the file diamond.shape, iterating two times.
  10696. # The file diamond.shape may contain a pattern of characters like this
  10697. # *
  10698. # ***
  10699. # *****
  10700. # ***
  10701. # *
  10702. # The specified columns and rows are ignored
  10703. # but the anchor point coordinates are not
  10704. ocv=dilate:0x0+2x2/custom=diamond.shape|2
  10705. @end example
  10706. @subsection erode
  10707. Erode an image by using a specific structuring element.
  10708. It corresponds to the libopencv function @code{cvErode}.
  10709. It accepts the parameters: @var{struct_el}:@var{nb_iterations},
  10710. with the same syntax and semantics as the @ref{dilate} filter.
  10711. @subsection smooth
  10712. Smooth the input video.
  10713. The filter takes the following parameters:
  10714. @var{type}|@var{param1}|@var{param2}|@var{param3}|@var{param4}.
  10715. @var{type} is the type of smooth filter to apply, and must be one of
  10716. the following values: "blur", "blur_no_scale", "median", "gaussian",
  10717. or "bilateral". The default value is "gaussian".
  10718. The meaning of @var{param1}, @var{param2}, @var{param3}, and @var{param4}
  10719. depends on the smooth type. @var{param1} and
  10720. @var{param2} accept integer positive values or 0. @var{param3} and
  10721. @var{param4} accept floating point values.
  10722. The default value for @var{param1} is 3. The default value for the
  10723. other parameters is 0.
  10724. These parameters correspond to the parameters assigned to the
  10725. libopencv function @code{cvSmooth}.
  10726. @section oscilloscope
  10727. 2D Video Oscilloscope.
  10728. Useful to measure spatial impulse, step responses, chroma delays, etc.
  10729. It accepts the following parameters:
  10730. @table @option
  10731. @item x
  10732. Set scope center x position.
  10733. @item y
  10734. Set scope center y position.
  10735. @item s
  10736. Set scope size, relative to frame diagonal.
  10737. @item t
  10738. Set scope tilt/rotation.
  10739. @item o
  10740. Set trace opacity.
  10741. @item tx
  10742. Set trace center x position.
  10743. @item ty
  10744. Set trace center y position.
  10745. @item tw
  10746. Set trace width, relative to width of frame.
  10747. @item th
  10748. Set trace height, relative to height of frame.
  10749. @item c
  10750. Set which components to trace. By default it traces first three components.
  10751. @item g
  10752. Draw trace grid. By default is enabled.
  10753. @item st
  10754. Draw some statistics. By default is enabled.
  10755. @item sc
  10756. Draw scope. By default is enabled.
  10757. @end table
  10758. @subsection Commands
  10759. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  10760. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10761. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10762. value.
  10763. @subsection Examples
  10764. @itemize
  10765. @item
  10766. Inspect full first row of video frame.
  10767. @example
  10768. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=0:s=1
  10769. @end example
  10770. @item
  10771. Inspect full last row of video frame.
  10772. @example
  10773. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=1:s=1
  10774. @end example
  10775. @item
  10776. Inspect full 5th line of video frame of height 1080.
  10777. @example
  10778. oscilloscope=x=0.5:y=5/1080:s=1
  10779. @end example
  10780. @item
  10781. Inspect full last column of video frame.
  10782. @example
  10783. oscilloscope=x=1:y=0.5:s=1:t=1
  10784. @end example
  10785. @end itemize
  10786. @anchor{overlay}
  10787. @section overlay
  10788. Overlay one video on top of another.
  10789. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main"
  10790. video on which the second input is overlaid.
  10791. It accepts the following parameters:
  10792. A description of the accepted options follows.
  10793. @table @option
  10794. @item x
  10795. @item y
  10796. Set the expression for the x and y coordinates of the overlaid video
  10797. on the main video. Default value is "0" for both expressions. In case
  10798. the expression is invalid, it is set to a huge value (meaning that the
  10799. overlay will not be displayed within the output visible area).
  10800. @item eof_action
  10801. See @ref{framesync}.
  10802. @item eval
  10803. Set when the expressions for @option{x}, and @option{y} are evaluated.
  10804. It accepts the following values:
  10805. @table @samp
  10806. @item init
  10807. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  10808. when a command is processed
  10809. @item frame
  10810. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  10811. @end table
  10812. Default value is @samp{frame}.
  10813. @item shortest
  10814. See @ref{framesync}.
  10815. @item format
  10816. Set the format for the output video.
  10817. It accepts the following values:
  10818. @table @samp
  10819. @item yuv420
  10820. force YUV420 output
  10821. @item yuv422
  10822. force YUV422 output
  10823. @item yuv444
  10824. force YUV444 output
  10825. @item rgb
  10826. force packed RGB output
  10827. @item gbrp
  10828. force planar RGB output
  10829. @item auto
  10830. automatically pick format
  10831. @end table
  10832. Default value is @samp{yuv420}.
  10833. @item repeatlast
  10834. See @ref{framesync}.
  10835. @item alpha
  10836. Set format of alpha of the overlaid video, it can be @var{straight} or
  10837. @var{premultiplied}. Default is @var{straight}.
  10838. @end table
  10839. The @option{x}, and @option{y} expressions can contain the following
  10840. parameters.
  10841. @table @option
  10842. @item main_w, W
  10843. @item main_h, H
  10844. The main input width and height.
  10845. @item overlay_w, w
  10846. @item overlay_h, h
  10847. The overlay input width and height.
  10848. @item x
  10849. @item y
  10850. The computed values for @var{x} and @var{y}. They are evaluated for
  10851. each new frame.
  10852. @item hsub
  10853. @item vsub
  10854. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values of the output
  10855. format. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and
  10856. @var{vsub} is 1.
  10857. @item n
  10858. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  10859. @item pos
  10860. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  10861. @item t
  10862. The timestamp, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  10863. @end table
  10864. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  10865. Note that the @var{n}, @var{pos}, @var{t} variables are available only
  10866. when evaluation is done @emph{per frame}, and will evaluate to NAN
  10867. when @option{eval} is set to @samp{init}.
  10868. Be aware that frames are taken from each input video in timestamp
  10869. order, hence, if their initial timestamps differ, it is a good idea
  10870. to pass the two inputs through a @var{setpts=PTS-STARTPTS} filter to
  10871. have them begin in the same zero timestamp, as the example for
  10872. the @var{movie} filter does.
  10873. You can chain together more overlays but you should test the
  10874. efficiency of such approach.
  10875. @subsection Commands
  10876. This filter supports the following commands:
  10877. @table @option
  10878. @item x
  10879. @item y
  10880. Modify the x and y of the overlay input.
  10881. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  10882. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  10883. value.
  10884. @end table
  10885. @subsection Examples
  10886. @itemize
  10887. @item
  10888. Draw the overlay at 10 pixels from the bottom right corner of the main
  10889. video:
  10890. @example
  10891. overlay=main_w-overlay_w-10:main_h-overlay_h-10
  10892. @end example
  10893. Using named options the example above becomes:
  10894. @example
  10895. overlay=x=main_w-overlay_w-10:y=main_h-overlay_h-10
  10896. @end example
  10897. @item
  10898. Insert a transparent PNG logo in the bottom left corner of the input,
  10899. using the @command{ffmpeg} tool with the @code{-filter_complex} option:
  10900. @example
  10901. ffmpeg -i input -i logo -filter_complex 'overlay=10:main_h-overlay_h-10' output
  10902. @end example
  10903. @item
  10904. Insert 2 different transparent PNG logos (second logo on bottom
  10905. right corner) using the @command{ffmpeg} tool:
  10906. @example
  10907. ffmpeg -i input -i logo1 -i logo2 -filter_complex 'overlay=x=10:y=H-h-10,overlay=x=W-w-10:y=H-h-10' output
  10908. @end example
  10909. @item
  10910. Add a transparent color layer on top of the main video; @code{WxH}
  10911. must specify the size of the main input to the overlay filter:
  10912. @example
  10913. color=color=red@@.3:size=WxH [over]; [in][over] overlay [out]
  10914. @end example
  10915. @item
  10916. Play an original video and a filtered version (here with the deshake
  10917. filter) side by side using the @command{ffplay} tool:
  10918. @example
  10919. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[a][b]; [a]pad=iw*2:ih[src]; [b]deshake[filt]; [src][filt]overlay=w'
  10920. @end example
  10921. The above command is the same as:
  10922. @example
  10923. ffplay input.avi -vf 'split[b], pad=iw*2[src], [b]deshake, [src]overlay=w'
  10924. @end example
  10925. @item
  10926. Make a sliding overlay appearing from the left to the right top part of the
  10927. screen starting since time 2:
  10928. @example
  10929. overlay=x='if(gte(t,2), -w+(t-2)*20, NAN)':y=0
  10930. @end example
  10931. @item
  10932. Compose output by putting two input videos side to side:
  10933. @example
  10934. ffmpeg -i left.avi -i right.avi -filter_complex "
  10935. nullsrc=size=200x100 [background];
  10936. [0:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [left];
  10937. [1:v] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS, scale=100x100 [right];
  10938. [background][left] overlay=shortest=1 [background+left];
  10939. [background+left][right] overlay=shortest=1:x=100 [left+right]
  10940. "
  10941. @end example
  10942. @item
  10943. Mask 10-20 seconds of a video by applying the delogo filter to a section
  10944. @example
  10945. ffmpeg -i test.avi -codec:v:0 wmv2 -ar 11025 -b:v 9000k
  10946. -vf '[in]split[split_main][split_delogo];[split_delogo]trim=start=360:end=371,delogo=0:0:640:480[delogoed];[split_main][delogoed]overlay=eof_action=pass[out]'
  10947. masked.avi
  10948. @end example
  10949. @item
  10950. Chain several overlays in cascade:
  10951. @example
  10952. nullsrc=s=200x200 [bg];
  10953. testsrc=s=100x100, split=4 [in0][in1][in2][in3];
  10954. [in0] lutrgb=r=0, [bg] overlay=0:0 [mid0];
  10955. [in1] lutrgb=g=0, [mid0] overlay=100:0 [mid1];
  10956. [in2] lutrgb=b=0, [mid1] overlay=0:100 [mid2];
  10957. [in3] null, [mid2] overlay=100:100 [out0]
  10958. @end example
  10959. @end itemize
  10960. @section owdenoise
  10961. Apply Overcomplete Wavelet denoiser.
  10962. The filter accepts the following options:
  10963. @table @option
  10964. @item depth
  10965. Set depth.
  10966. Larger depth values will denoise lower frequency components more, but
  10967. slow down filtering.
  10968. Must be an int in the range 8-16, default is @code{8}.
  10969. @item luma_strength, ls
  10970. Set luma strength.
  10971. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10972. @item chroma_strength, cs
  10973. Set chroma strength.
  10974. Must be a double value in the range 0-1000, default is @code{1.0}.
  10975. @end table
  10976. @anchor{pad}
  10977. @section pad
  10978. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  10979. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  10980. It accepts the following parameters:
  10981. @table @option
  10982. @item width, w
  10983. @item height, h
  10984. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  10985. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  10986. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  10987. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  10988. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  10989. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  10990. @item x
  10991. @item y
  10992. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  10993. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  10994. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  10995. expression, and vice versa.
  10996. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  10997. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  10998. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  10999. @item color
  11000. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  11001. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11002. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11003. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  11004. @item eval
  11005. Specify when to evaluate @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x} and @var{y} expression.
  11006. It accepts the following values:
  11007. @table @samp
  11008. @item init
  11009. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when
  11010. a command is processed.
  11011. @item frame
  11012. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  11013. @end table
  11014. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11015. @item aspect
  11016. Pad to aspect instead to a resolution.
  11017. @end table
  11018. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  11019. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  11020. @table @option
  11021. @item in_w
  11022. @item in_h
  11023. The input video width and height.
  11024. @item iw
  11025. @item ih
  11026. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  11027. @item out_w
  11028. @item out_h
  11029. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  11030. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  11031. @item ow
  11032. @item oh
  11033. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  11034. @item x
  11035. @item y
  11036. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  11037. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  11038. @item a
  11039. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  11040. @item sar
  11041. input sample aspect ratio
  11042. @item dar
  11043. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  11044. @item hsub
  11045. @item vsub
  11046. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  11047. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  11048. @end table
  11049. @subsection Examples
  11050. @itemize
  11051. @item
  11052. Add paddings with the color "violet" to the input video. The output video
  11053. size is 640x480, and the top-left corner of the input video is placed at
  11054. column 0, row 40
  11055. @example
  11056. pad=640:480:0:40:violet
  11057. @end example
  11058. The example above is equivalent to the following command:
  11059. @example
  11060. pad=width=640:height=480:x=0:y=40:color=violet
  11061. @end example
  11062. @item
  11063. Pad the input to get an output with dimensions increased by 3/2,
  11064. and put the input video at the center of the padded area:
  11065. @example
  11066. pad="3/2*iw:3/2*ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11067. @end example
  11068. @item
  11069. Pad the input to get a squared output with size equal to the maximum
  11070. value between the input width and height, and put the input video at
  11071. the center of the padded area:
  11072. @example
  11073. pad="max(iw\,ih):ow:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11074. @end example
  11075. @item
  11076. Pad the input to get a final w/h ratio of 16:9:
  11077. @example
  11078. pad="ih*16/9:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11079. @end example
  11080. @item
  11081. In case of anamorphic video, in order to set the output display aspect
  11082. correctly, it is necessary to use @var{sar} in the expression,
  11083. according to the relation:
  11084. @example
  11085. (ih * X / ih) * sar = output_dar
  11086. X = output_dar / sar
  11087. @end example
  11088. Thus the previous example needs to be modified to:
  11089. @example
  11090. pad="ih*16/9/sar:ih:(ow-iw)/2:(oh-ih)/2"
  11091. @end example
  11092. @item
  11093. Double the output size and put the input video in the bottom-right
  11094. corner of the output padded area:
  11095. @example
  11096. pad="2*iw:2*ih:ow-iw:oh-ih"
  11097. @end example
  11098. @end itemize
  11099. @anchor{palettegen}
  11100. @section palettegen
  11101. Generate one palette for a whole video stream.
  11102. It accepts the following options:
  11103. @table @option
  11104. @item max_colors
  11105. Set the maximum number of colors to quantize in the palette.
  11106. Note: the palette will still contain 256 colors; the unused palette entries
  11107. will be black.
  11108. @item reserve_transparent
  11109. Create a palette of 255 colors maximum and reserve the last one for
  11110. transparency. Reserving the transparency color is useful for GIF optimization.
  11111. If not set, the maximum of colors in the palette will be 256. You probably want
  11112. to disable this option for a standalone image.
  11113. Set by default.
  11114. @item transparency_color
  11115. Set the color that will be used as background for transparency.
  11116. @item stats_mode
  11117. Set statistics mode.
  11118. It accepts the following values:
  11119. @table @samp
  11120. @item full
  11121. Compute full frame histograms.
  11122. @item diff
  11123. Compute histograms only for the part that differs from previous frame. This
  11124. might be relevant to give more importance to the moving part of your input if
  11125. the background is static.
  11126. @item single
  11127. Compute new histogram for each frame.
  11128. @end table
  11129. Default value is @var{full}.
  11130. @end table
  11131. The filter also exports the frame metadata @code{lavfi.color_quant_ratio}
  11132. (@code{nb_color_in / nb_color_out}) which you can use to evaluate the degree of
  11133. color quantization of the palette. This information is also visible at
  11134. @var{info} logging level.
  11135. @subsection Examples
  11136. @itemize
  11137. @item
  11138. Generate a representative palette of a given video using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11139. @example
  11140. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf palettegen palette.png
  11141. @end example
  11142. @end itemize
  11143. @section paletteuse
  11144. Use a palette to downsample an input video stream.
  11145. The filter takes two inputs: one video stream and a palette. The palette must
  11146. be a 256 pixels image.
  11147. It accepts the following options:
  11148. @table @option
  11149. @item dither
  11150. Select dithering mode. Available algorithms are:
  11151. @table @samp
  11152. @item bayer
  11153. Ordered 8x8 bayer dithering (deterministic)
  11154. @item heckbert
  11155. Dithering as defined by Paul Heckbert in 1982 (simple error diffusion).
  11156. Note: this dithering is sometimes considered "wrong" and is included as a
  11157. reference.
  11158. @item floyd_steinberg
  11159. Floyd and Steingberg dithering (error diffusion)
  11160. @item sierra2
  11161. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 (error diffusion)
  11162. @item sierra2_4a
  11163. Frankie Sierra dithering v2 "Lite" (error diffusion)
  11164. @end table
  11165. Default is @var{sierra2_4a}.
  11166. @item bayer_scale
  11167. When @var{bayer} dithering is selected, this option defines the scale of the
  11168. pattern (how much the crosshatch pattern is visible). A low value means more
  11169. visible pattern for less banding, and higher value means less visible pattern
  11170. at the cost of more banding.
  11171. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,5]. Default is @var{2}.
  11172. @item diff_mode
  11173. If set, define the zone to process
  11174. @table @samp
  11175. @item rectangle
  11176. Only the changing rectangle will be reprocessed. This is similar to GIF
  11177. cropping/offsetting compression mechanism. This option can be useful for speed
  11178. if only a part of the image is changing, and has use cases such as limiting the
  11179. scope of the error diffusal @option{dither} to the rectangle that bounds the
  11180. moving scene (it leads to more deterministic output if the scene doesn't change
  11181. much, and as a result less moving noise and better GIF compression).
  11182. @end table
  11183. Default is @var{none}.
  11184. @item new
  11185. Take new palette for each output frame.
  11186. @item alpha_threshold
  11187. Sets the alpha threshold for transparency. Alpha values above this threshold
  11188. will be treated as completely opaque, and values below this threshold will be
  11189. treated as completely transparent.
  11190. The option must be an integer value in the range [0,255]. Default is @var{128}.
  11191. @end table
  11192. @subsection Examples
  11193. @itemize
  11194. @item
  11195. Use a palette (generated for example with @ref{palettegen}) to encode a GIF
  11196. using @command{ffmpeg}:
  11197. @example
  11198. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -i palette.png -lavfi paletteuse output.gif
  11199. @end example
  11200. @end itemize
  11201. @section perspective
  11202. Correct perspective of video not recorded perpendicular to the screen.
  11203. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11204. @table @option
  11205. @item x0
  11206. @item y0
  11207. @item x1
  11208. @item y1
  11209. @item x2
  11210. @item y2
  11211. @item x3
  11212. @item y3
  11213. Set coordinates expression for top left, top right, bottom left and bottom right corners.
  11214. Default values are @code{0:0:W:0:0:H:W:H} with which perspective will remain unchanged.
  11215. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{source}, then the specified points will be sent
  11216. to the corners of the destination. If the @code{sense} option is set to @code{destination},
  11217. then the corners of the source will be sent to the specified coordinates.
  11218. The expressions can use the following variables:
  11219. @table @option
  11220. @item W
  11221. @item H
  11222. the width and height of video frame.
  11223. @item in
  11224. Input frame count.
  11225. @item on
  11226. Output frame count.
  11227. @end table
  11228. @item interpolation
  11229. Set interpolation for perspective correction.
  11230. It accepts the following values:
  11231. @table @samp
  11232. @item linear
  11233. @item cubic
  11234. @end table
  11235. Default value is @samp{linear}.
  11236. @item sense
  11237. Set interpretation of coordinate options.
  11238. It accepts the following values:
  11239. @table @samp
  11240. @item 0, source
  11241. Send point in the source specified by the given coordinates to
  11242. the corners of the destination.
  11243. @item 1, destination
  11244. Send the corners of the source to the point in the destination specified
  11245. by the given coordinates.
  11246. Default value is @samp{source}.
  11247. @end table
  11248. @item eval
  11249. Set when the expressions for coordinates @option{x0,y0,...x3,y3} are evaluated.
  11250. It accepts the following values:
  11251. @table @samp
  11252. @item init
  11253. only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or
  11254. when a command is processed
  11255. @item frame
  11256. evaluate expressions for each incoming frame
  11257. @end table
  11258. Default value is @samp{init}.
  11259. @end table
  11260. @section phase
  11261. Delay interlaced video by one field time so that the field order changes.
  11262. The intended use is to fix PAL movies that have been captured with the
  11263. opposite field order to the film-to-video transfer.
  11264. A description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11265. @table @option
  11266. @item mode
  11267. Set phase mode.
  11268. It accepts the following values:
  11269. @table @samp
  11270. @item t
  11271. Capture field order top-first, transfer bottom-first.
  11272. Filter will delay the bottom field.
  11273. @item b
  11274. Capture field order bottom-first, transfer top-first.
  11275. Filter will delay the top field.
  11276. @item p
  11277. Capture and transfer with the same field order. This mode only exists
  11278. for the documentation of the other options to refer to, but if you
  11279. actually select it, the filter will faithfully do nothing.
  11280. @item a
  11281. Capture field order determined automatically by field flags, transfer
  11282. opposite.
  11283. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} modes on a frame by frame
  11284. basis using field flags. If no field information is available,
  11285. then this works just like @samp{u}.
  11286. @item u
  11287. Capture unknown or varying, transfer opposite.
  11288. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{b} on a frame by frame basis by
  11289. analyzing the images and selecting the alternative that produces best
  11290. match between the fields.
  11291. @item T
  11292. Capture top-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11293. Filter selects among @samp{t} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11294. @item B
  11295. Capture bottom-first, transfer unknown or varying.
  11296. Filter selects among @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis.
  11297. @item A
  11298. Capture determined by field flags, transfer unknown or varying.
  11299. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using field flags and
  11300. image analysis. If no field information is available, then this works just
  11301. like @samp{U}. This is the default mode.
  11302. @item U
  11303. Both capture and transfer unknown or varying.
  11304. Filter selects among @samp{t}, @samp{b} and @samp{p} using image analysis only.
  11305. @end table
  11306. @end table
  11307. @section photosensitivity
  11308. Reduce various flashes in video, so to help users with epilepsy.
  11309. It accepts the following options:
  11310. @table @option
  11311. @item frames, f
  11312. Set how many frames to use when filtering. Default is 30.
  11313. @item threshold, t
  11314. Set detection threshold factor. Default is 1.
  11315. Lower is stricter.
  11316. @item skip
  11317. Set how many pixels to skip when sampling frames. Default is 1.
  11318. Allowed range is from 1 to 1024.
  11319. @item bypass
  11320. Leave frames unchanged. Default is disabled.
  11321. @end table
  11322. @section pixdesctest
  11323. Pixel format descriptor test filter, mainly useful for internal
  11324. testing. The output video should be equal to the input video.
  11325. For example:
  11326. @example
  11327. format=monow, pixdesctest
  11328. @end example
  11329. can be used to test the monowhite pixel format descriptor definition.
  11330. @section pixscope
  11331. Display sample values of color channels. Mainly useful for checking color
  11332. and levels. Minimum supported resolution is 640x480.
  11333. The filters accept the following options:
  11334. @table @option
  11335. @item x
  11336. Set scope X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11337. @item y
  11338. Set scope Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11339. @item w
  11340. Set scope width.
  11341. @item h
  11342. Set scope height.
  11343. @item o
  11344. Set window opacity. This window also holds statistics about pixel area.
  11345. @item wx
  11346. Set window X position, relative offset on X axis.
  11347. @item wy
  11348. Set window Y position, relative offset on Y axis.
  11349. @end table
  11350. @section pp
  11351. Enable the specified chain of postprocessing subfilters using libpostproc. This
  11352. library should be automatically selected with a GPL build (@code{--enable-gpl}).
  11353. Subfilters must be separated by '/' and can be disabled by prepending a '-'.
  11354. Each subfilter and some options have a short and a long name that can be used
  11355. interchangeably, i.e. dr/dering are the same.
  11356. The filters accept the following options:
  11357. @table @option
  11358. @item subfilters
  11359. Set postprocessing subfilters string.
  11360. @end table
  11361. All subfilters share common options to determine their scope:
  11362. @table @option
  11363. @item a/autoq
  11364. Honor the quality commands for this subfilter.
  11365. @item c/chrom
  11366. Do chrominance filtering, too (default).
  11367. @item y/nochrom
  11368. Do luminance filtering only (no chrominance).
  11369. @item n/noluma
  11370. Do chrominance filtering only (no luminance).
  11371. @end table
  11372. These options can be appended after the subfilter name, separated by a '|'.
  11373. Available subfilters are:
  11374. @table @option
  11375. @item hb/hdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11376. Horizontal deblocking filter
  11377. @table @option
  11378. @item difference
  11379. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11380. @item flatness
  11381. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11382. @end table
  11383. @item vb/vdeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11384. Vertical deblocking filter
  11385. @table @option
  11386. @item difference
  11387. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11388. @item flatness
  11389. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11390. @end table
  11391. @item ha/hadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11392. Accurate horizontal deblocking filter
  11393. @table @option
  11394. @item difference
  11395. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11396. @item flatness
  11397. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11398. @end table
  11399. @item va/vadeblock[|difference[|flatness]]
  11400. Accurate vertical deblocking filter
  11401. @table @option
  11402. @item difference
  11403. Difference factor where higher values mean more deblocking (default: @code{32}).
  11404. @item flatness
  11405. Flatness threshold where lower values mean more deblocking (default: @code{39}).
  11406. @end table
  11407. @end table
  11408. The horizontal and vertical deblocking filters share the difference and
  11409. flatness values so you cannot set different horizontal and vertical
  11410. thresholds.
  11411. @table @option
  11412. @item h1/x1hdeblock
  11413. Experimental horizontal deblocking filter
  11414. @item v1/x1vdeblock
  11415. Experimental vertical deblocking filter
  11416. @item dr/dering
  11417. Deringing filter
  11418. @item tn/tmpnoise[|threshold1[|threshold2[|threshold3]]], temporal noise reducer
  11419. @table @option
  11420. @item threshold1
  11421. larger -> stronger filtering
  11422. @item threshold2
  11423. larger -> stronger filtering
  11424. @item threshold3
  11425. larger -> stronger filtering
  11426. @end table
  11427. @item al/autolevels[:f/fullyrange], automatic brightness / contrast correction
  11428. @table @option
  11429. @item f/fullyrange
  11430. Stretch luminance to @code{0-255}.
  11431. @end table
  11432. @item lb/linblenddeint
  11433. Linear blend deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11434. filtering all lines with a @code{(1 2 1)} filter.
  11435. @item li/linipoldeint
  11436. Linear interpolating deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by
  11437. linearly interpolating every second line.
  11438. @item ci/cubicipoldeint
  11439. Cubic interpolating deinterlacing filter deinterlaces the given block by
  11440. cubically interpolating every second line.
  11441. @item md/mediandeint
  11442. Median deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by applying a
  11443. median filter to every second line.
  11444. @item fd/ffmpegdeint
  11445. FFmpeg deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given block by filtering every
  11446. second line with a @code{(-1 4 2 4 -1)} filter.
  11447. @item l5/lowpass5
  11448. Vertically applied FIR lowpass deinterlacing filter that deinterlaces the given
  11449. block by filtering all lines with a @code{(-1 2 6 2 -1)} filter.
  11450. @item fq/forceQuant[|quantizer]
  11451. Overrides the quantizer table from the input with the constant quantizer you
  11452. specify.
  11453. @table @option
  11454. @item quantizer
  11455. Quantizer to use
  11456. @end table
  11457. @item de/default
  11458. Default pp filter combination (@code{hb|a,vb|a,dr|a})
  11459. @item fa/fast
  11460. Fast pp filter combination (@code{h1|a,v1|a,dr|a})
  11461. @item ac
  11462. High quality pp filter combination (@code{ha|a|128|7,va|a,dr|a})
  11463. @end table
  11464. @subsection Examples
  11465. @itemize
  11466. @item
  11467. Apply horizontal and vertical deblocking, deringing and automatic
  11468. brightness/contrast:
  11469. @example
  11470. pp=hb/vb/dr/al
  11471. @end example
  11472. @item
  11473. Apply default filters without brightness/contrast correction:
  11474. @example
  11475. pp=de/-al
  11476. @end example
  11477. @item
  11478. Apply default filters and temporal denoiser:
  11479. @example
  11480. pp=default/tmpnoise|1|2|3
  11481. @end example
  11482. @item
  11483. Apply deblocking on luminance only, and switch vertical deblocking on or off
  11484. automatically depending on available CPU time:
  11485. @example
  11486. pp=hb|y/vb|a
  11487. @end example
  11488. @end itemize
  11489. @section pp7
  11490. Apply Postprocessing filter 7. It is variant of the @ref{spp} filter,
  11491. similar to spp = 6 with 7 point DCT, where only the center sample is
  11492. used after IDCT.
  11493. The filter accepts the following options:
  11494. @table @option
  11495. @item qp
  11496. Force a constant quantization parameter. It accepts an integer in range
  11497. 0 to 63. If not set, the filter will use the QP from the video stream
  11498. (if available).
  11499. @item mode
  11500. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  11501. @table @samp
  11502. @item hard
  11503. Set hard thresholding.
  11504. @item soft
  11505. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  11506. @item medium
  11507. Set medium thresholding (good results, default).
  11508. @end table
  11509. @end table
  11510. @section premultiply
  11511. Apply alpha premultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  11512. of second stream as alpha.
  11513. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  11514. The filter accepts the following option:
  11515. @table @option
  11516. @item planes
  11517. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11518. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11519. @item inplace
  11520. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  11521. @end table
  11522. @section prewitt
  11523. Apply prewitt operator to input video stream.
  11524. The filter accepts the following option:
  11525. @table @option
  11526. @item planes
  11527. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11528. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11529. @item scale
  11530. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11531. @item delta
  11532. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11533. @end table
  11534. @section pseudocolor
  11535. Alter frame colors in video with pseudocolors.
  11536. This filter accepts the following options:
  11537. @table @option
  11538. @item c0
  11539. set pixel first component expression
  11540. @item c1
  11541. set pixel second component expression
  11542. @item c2
  11543. set pixel third component expression
  11544. @item c3
  11545. set pixel fourth component expression, corresponds to the alpha component
  11546. @item i
  11547. set component to use as base for altering colors
  11548. @end table
  11549. Each of them specifies the expression to use for computing the lookup table for
  11550. the corresponding pixel component values.
  11551. The expressions can contain the following constants and functions:
  11552. @table @option
  11553. @item w
  11554. @item h
  11555. The input width and height.
  11556. @item val
  11557. The input value for the pixel component.
  11558. @item ymin, umin, vmin, amin
  11559. The minimum allowed component value.
  11560. @item ymax, umax, vmax, amax
  11561. The maximum allowed component value.
  11562. @end table
  11563. All expressions default to "val".
  11564. @subsection Examples
  11565. @itemize
  11566. @item
  11567. Change too high luma values to gradient:
  11568. @example
  11569. pseudocolor="'if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(ymin,ymax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(umax,umin,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):if(between(val,ymax,amax),lerp(vmin,vmax,(val-ymax)/(amax-ymax)),-1):-1'"
  11570. @end example
  11571. @end itemize
  11572. @section psnr
  11573. Obtain the average, maximum and minimum PSNR (Peak Signal to Noise
  11574. Ratio) between two input videos.
  11575. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  11576. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  11577. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  11578. the PSNR.
  11579. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  11580. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  11581. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  11582. The obtained average PSNR is printed through the logging system.
  11583. The filter stores the accumulated MSE (mean squared error) of each
  11584. frame, and at the end of the processing it is averaged across all frames
  11585. equally, and the following formula is applied to obtain the PSNR:
  11586. @example
  11587. PSNR = 10*log10(MAX^2/MSE)
  11588. @end example
  11589. Where MAX is the average of the maximum values of each component of the
  11590. image.
  11591. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  11592. @table @option
  11593. @item stats_file, f
  11594. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the PSNR of
  11595. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  11596. standard output.
  11597. @item stats_version
  11598. Specifies which version of the stats file format to use. Details of
  11599. each format are written below.
  11600. Default value is 1.
  11601. @item stats_add_max
  11602. Determines whether the max value is output to the stats log.
  11603. Default value is 0.
  11604. Requires stats_version >= 2. If this is set and stats_version < 2,
  11605. the filter will return an error.
  11606. @end table
  11607. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  11608. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  11609. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  11610. couple of frames.
  11611. If a @var{stats_version} greater than 1 is specified, a header line precedes
  11612. the list of per-frame-pair stats, with key value pairs following the frame
  11613. format with the following parameters:
  11614. @table @option
  11615. @item psnr_log_version
  11616. The version of the log file format. Will match @var{stats_version}.
  11617. @item fields
  11618. A comma separated list of the per-frame-pair parameters included in
  11619. the log.
  11620. @end table
  11621. A description of each shown per-frame-pair parameter follows:
  11622. @table @option
  11623. @item n
  11624. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  11625. @item mse_avg
  11626. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11627. frames, averaged over all the image components.
  11628. @item mse_y, mse_u, mse_v, mse_r, mse_g, mse_b, mse_a
  11629. Mean Square Error pixel-by-pixel average difference of the compared
  11630. frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  11631. @item psnr_y, psnr_u, psnr_v, psnr_r, psnr_g, psnr_b, psnr_a
  11632. Peak Signal to Noise ratio of the compared frames for the component
  11633. specified by the suffix.
  11634. @item max_avg, max_y, max_u, max_v
  11635. Maximum allowed value for each channel, and average over all
  11636. channels.
  11637. @end table
  11638. @subsection Examples
  11639. @itemize
  11640. @item
  11641. For example:
  11642. @example
  11643. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  11644. [main][ref] psnr="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  11645. @end example
  11646. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  11647. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The PSNR of each individual frame
  11648. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  11649. @item
  11650. Another example with different containers:
  11651. @example
  11652. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]psnr" -f null -
  11653. @end example
  11654. @end itemize
  11655. @anchor{pullup}
  11656. @section pullup
  11657. Pulldown reversal (inverse telecine) filter, capable of handling mixed
  11658. hard-telecine, 24000/1001 fps progressive, and 30000/1001 fps progressive
  11659. content.
  11660. The pullup filter is designed to take advantage of future context in making
  11661. its decisions. This filter is stateless in the sense that it does not lock
  11662. onto a pattern to follow, but it instead looks forward to the following
  11663. fields in order to identify matches and rebuild progressive frames.
  11664. To produce content with an even framerate, insert the fps filter after
  11665. pullup, use @code{fps=24000/1001} if the input frame rate is 29.97fps,
  11666. @code{fps=24} for 30fps and the (rare) telecined 25fps input.
  11667. The filter accepts the following options:
  11668. @table @option
  11669. @item jl
  11670. @item jr
  11671. @item jt
  11672. @item jb
  11673. These options set the amount of "junk" to ignore at the left, right, top, and
  11674. bottom of the image, respectively. Left and right are in units of 8 pixels,
  11675. while top and bottom are in units of 2 lines.
  11676. The default is 8 pixels on each side.
  11677. @item sb
  11678. Set the strict breaks. Setting this option to 1 will reduce the chances of
  11679. filter generating an occasional mismatched frame, but it may also cause an
  11680. excessive number of frames to be dropped during high motion sequences.
  11681. Conversely, setting it to -1 will make filter match fields more easily.
  11682. This may help processing of video where there is slight blurring between
  11683. the fields, but may also cause there to be interlaced frames in the output.
  11684. Default value is @code{0}.
  11685. @item mp
  11686. Set the metric plane to use. It accepts the following values:
  11687. @table @samp
  11688. @item l
  11689. Use luma plane.
  11690. @item u
  11691. Use chroma blue plane.
  11692. @item v
  11693. Use chroma red plane.
  11694. @end table
  11695. This option may be set to use chroma plane instead of the default luma plane
  11696. for doing filter's computations. This may improve accuracy on very clean
  11697. source material, but more likely will decrease accuracy, especially if there
  11698. is chroma noise (rainbow effect) or any grayscale video.
  11699. The main purpose of setting @option{mp} to a chroma plane is to reduce CPU
  11700. load and make pullup usable in realtime on slow machines.
  11701. @end table
  11702. For best results (without duplicated frames in the output file) it is
  11703. necessary to change the output frame rate. For example, to inverse
  11704. telecine NTSC input:
  11705. @example
  11706. ffmpeg -i input -vf pullup -r 24000/1001 ...
  11707. @end example
  11708. @section qp
  11709. Change video quantization parameters (QP).
  11710. The filter accepts the following option:
  11711. @table @option
  11712. @item qp
  11713. Set expression for quantization parameter.
  11714. @end table
  11715. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain, among others,
  11716. the following constants:
  11717. @table @var
  11718. @item known
  11719. 1 if index is not 129, 0 otherwise.
  11720. @item qp
  11721. Sequential index starting from -129 to 128.
  11722. @end table
  11723. @subsection Examples
  11724. @itemize
  11725. @item
  11726. Some equation like:
  11727. @example
  11728. qp=2+2*sin(PI*qp)
  11729. @end example
  11730. @end itemize
  11731. @section random
  11732. Flush video frames from internal cache of frames into a random order.
  11733. No frame is discarded.
  11734. Inspired by @ref{frei0r} nervous filter.
  11735. @table @option
  11736. @item frames
  11737. Set size in number of frames of internal cache, in range from @code{2} to
  11738. @code{512}. Default is @code{30}.
  11739. @item seed
  11740. Set seed for random number generator, must be an integer included between
  11741. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  11742. less than @code{0}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a
  11743. best effort basis.
  11744. @end table
  11745. @section readeia608
  11746. Read closed captioning (EIA-608) information from the top lines of a video frame.
  11747. This filter adds frame metadata for @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.cc} and
  11748. @code{lavfi.readeia608.X.line}, where @code{X} is the number of the identified line
  11749. with EIA-608 data (starting from 0). A description of each metadata value follows:
  11750. @table @option
  11751. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.cc
  11752. The two bytes stored as EIA-608 data (printed in hexadecimal).
  11753. @item lavfi.readeia608.X.line
  11754. The number of the line on which the EIA-608 data was identified and read.
  11755. @end table
  11756. This filter accepts the following options:
  11757. @table @option
  11758. @item scan_min
  11759. Set the line to start scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{0}.
  11760. @item scan_max
  11761. Set the line to end scanning for EIA-608 data. Default is @code{29}.
  11762. @item spw
  11763. Set the ratio of width reserved for sync code detection.
  11764. Default is @code{0.27}. Allowed range is @code{[0.1 - 0.7]}.
  11765. @item chp
  11766. Enable checking the parity bit. In the event of a parity error, the filter will output
  11767. @code{0x00} for that character. Default is false.
  11768. @item lp
  11769. Lowpass lines prior to further processing. Default is enabled.
  11770. @end table
  11771. @subsection Examples
  11772. @itemize
  11773. @item
  11774. Output a csv with presentation time and the first two lines of identified EIA-608 captioning data.
  11775. @example
  11776. ffprobe -f lavfi -i movie=captioned_video.mov,readeia608 -show_entries frame=pkt_pts_time:frame_tags=lavfi.readeia608.0.cc,lavfi.readeia608.1.cc -of csv
  11777. @end example
  11778. @end itemize
  11779. @section readvitc
  11780. Read vertical interval timecode (VITC) information from the top lines of a
  11781. video frame.
  11782. The filter adds frame metadata key @code{lavfi.readvitc.tc_str} with the
  11783. timecode value, if a valid timecode has been detected. Further metadata key
  11784. @code{lavfi.readvitc.found} is set to 0/1 depending on whether
  11785. timecode data has been found or not.
  11786. This filter accepts the following options:
  11787. @table @option
  11788. @item scan_max
  11789. Set the maximum number of lines to scan for VITC data. If the value is set to
  11790. @code{-1} the full video frame is scanned. Default is @code{45}.
  11791. @item thr_b
  11792. Set the luma threshold for black. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11793. default value is @code{0.2}. The value must be equal or less than @code{thr_w}.
  11794. @item thr_w
  11795. Set the luma threshold for white. Accepts float numbers in the range [0.0,1.0],
  11796. default value is @code{0.6}. The value must be equal or greater than @code{thr_b}.
  11797. @end table
  11798. @subsection Examples
  11799. @itemize
  11800. @item
  11801. Detect and draw VITC data onto the video frame; if no valid VITC is detected,
  11802. draw @code{--:--:--:--} as a placeholder:
  11803. @example
  11804. ffmpeg -i input.avi -filter:v 'readvitc,drawtext=fontfile=FreeMono.ttf:text=%@{metadata\\:lavfi.readvitc.tc_str\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--\\\\\\:--@}:x=(w-tw)/2:y=400-ascent'
  11805. @end example
  11806. @end itemize
  11807. @section remap
  11808. Remap pixels using 2nd: Xmap and 3rd: Ymap input video stream.
  11809. Destination pixel at position (X, Y) will be picked from source (x, y) position
  11810. where x = Xmap(X, Y) and y = Ymap(X, Y). If mapping values are out of range, zero
  11811. value for pixel will be used for destination pixel.
  11812. Xmap and Ymap input video streams must be of same dimensions. Output video stream
  11813. will have Xmap/Ymap video stream dimensions.
  11814. Xmap and Ymap input video streams are 16bit depth, single channel.
  11815. @table @option
  11816. @item format
  11817. Specify pixel format of output from this filter. Can be @code{color} or @code{gray}.
  11818. Default is @code{color}.
  11819. @item fill
  11820. Specify the color of the unmapped pixels. For the syntax of this option,
  11821. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  11822. manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default color is @code{black}.
  11823. @end table
  11824. @section removegrain
  11825. The removegrain filter is a spatial denoiser for progressive video.
  11826. @table @option
  11827. @item m0
  11828. Set mode for the first plane.
  11829. @item m1
  11830. Set mode for the second plane.
  11831. @item m2
  11832. Set mode for the third plane.
  11833. @item m3
  11834. Set mode for the fourth plane.
  11835. @end table
  11836. Range of mode is from 0 to 24. Description of each mode follows:
  11837. @table @var
  11838. @item 0
  11839. Leave input plane unchanged. Default.
  11840. @item 1
  11841. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11842. @item 2
  11843. Clips the pixel with the second minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11844. @item 3
  11845. Clips the pixel with the third minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11846. @item 4
  11847. Clips the pixel with the fourth minimum and maximum of the 8 neighbour pixels.
  11848. This is equivalent to a median filter.
  11849. @item 5
  11850. Line-sensitive clipping giving the minimal change.
  11851. @item 6
  11852. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11853. @item 7
  11854. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11855. @item 8
  11856. Line-sensitive clipping, intermediate.
  11857. @item 9
  11858. Line-sensitive clipping on a line where the neighbours pixels are the closest.
  11859. @item 10
  11860. Replaces the target pixel with the closest neighbour.
  11861. @item 11
  11862. [1 2 1] horizontal and vertical kernel blur.
  11863. @item 12
  11864. Same as mode 11.
  11865. @item 13
  11866. Bob mode, interpolates top field from the line where the neighbours
  11867. pixels are the closest.
  11868. @item 14
  11869. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field from the line where the neighbours
  11870. pixels are the closest.
  11871. @item 15
  11872. Bob mode, interpolates top field. Same as 13 but with a more complicated
  11873. interpolation formula.
  11874. @item 16
  11875. Bob mode, interpolates bottom field. Same as 14 but with a more complicated
  11876. interpolation formula.
  11877. @item 17
  11878. Clips the pixel with the minimum and maximum of respectively the maximum and
  11879. minimum of each pair of opposite neighbour pixels.
  11880. @item 18
  11881. Line-sensitive clipping using opposite neighbours whose greatest distance from
  11882. the current pixel is minimal.
  11883. @item 19
  11884. Replaces the pixel with the average of its 8 neighbours.
  11885. @item 20
  11886. Averages the 9 pixels ([1 1 1] horizontal and vertical blur).
  11887. @item 21
  11888. Clips pixels using the averages of opposite neighbour.
  11889. @item 22
  11890. Same as mode 21 but simpler and faster.
  11891. @item 23
  11892. Small edge and halo removal, but reputed useless.
  11893. @item 24
  11894. Similar as 23.
  11895. @end table
  11896. @section removelogo
  11897. Suppress a TV station logo, using an image file to determine which
  11898. pixels comprise the logo. It works by filling in the pixels that
  11899. comprise the logo with neighboring pixels.
  11900. The filter accepts the following options:
  11901. @table @option
  11902. @item filename, f
  11903. Set the filter bitmap file, which can be any image format supported by
  11904. libavformat. The width and height of the image file must match those of the
  11905. video stream being processed.
  11906. @end table
  11907. Pixels in the provided bitmap image with a value of zero are not
  11908. considered part of the logo, non-zero pixels are considered part of
  11909. the logo. If you use white (255) for the logo and black (0) for the
  11910. rest, you will be safe. For making the filter bitmap, it is
  11911. recommended to take a screen capture of a black frame with the logo
  11912. visible, and then using a threshold filter followed by the erode
  11913. filter once or twice.
  11914. If needed, little splotches can be fixed manually. Remember that if
  11915. logo pixels are not covered, the filter quality will be much
  11916. reduced. Marking too many pixels as part of the logo does not hurt as
  11917. much, but it will increase the amount of blurring needed to cover over
  11918. the image and will destroy more information than necessary, and extra
  11919. pixels will slow things down on a large logo.
  11920. @section repeatfields
  11921. This filter uses the repeat_field flag from the Video ES headers and hard repeats
  11922. fields based on its value.
  11923. @section reverse
  11924. Reverse a video clip.
  11925. Warning: This filter requires memory to buffer the entire clip, so trimming
  11926. is suggested.
  11927. @subsection Examples
  11928. @itemize
  11929. @item
  11930. Take the first 5 seconds of a clip, and reverse it.
  11931. @example
  11932. trim=end=5,reverse
  11933. @end example
  11934. @end itemize
  11935. @section rgbashift
  11936. Shift R/G/B/A pixels horizontally and/or vertically.
  11937. The filter accepts the following options:
  11938. @table @option
  11939. @item rh
  11940. Set amount to shift red horizontally.
  11941. @item rv
  11942. Set amount to shift red vertically.
  11943. @item gh
  11944. Set amount to shift green horizontally.
  11945. @item gv
  11946. Set amount to shift green vertically.
  11947. @item bh
  11948. Set amount to shift blue horizontally.
  11949. @item bv
  11950. Set amount to shift blue vertically.
  11951. @item ah
  11952. Set amount to shift alpha horizontally.
  11953. @item av
  11954. Set amount to shift alpha vertically.
  11955. @item edge
  11956. Set edge mode, can be @var{smear}, default, or @var{warp}.
  11957. @end table
  11958. @subsection Commands
  11959. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  11960. @section roberts
  11961. Apply roberts cross operator to input video stream.
  11962. The filter accepts the following option:
  11963. @table @option
  11964. @item planes
  11965. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  11966. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  11967. @item scale
  11968. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  11969. @item delta
  11970. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  11971. @end table
  11972. @section rotate
  11973. Rotate video by an arbitrary angle expressed in radians.
  11974. The filter accepts the following options:
  11975. A description of the optional parameters follows.
  11976. @table @option
  11977. @item angle, a
  11978. Set an expression for the angle by which to rotate the input video
  11979. clockwise, expressed as a number of radians. A negative value will
  11980. result in a counter-clockwise rotation. By default it is set to "0".
  11981. This expression is evaluated for each frame.
  11982. @item out_w, ow
  11983. Set the output width expression, default value is "iw".
  11984. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11985. @item out_h, oh
  11986. Set the output height expression, default value is "ih".
  11987. This expression is evaluated just once during configuration.
  11988. @item bilinear
  11989. Enable bilinear interpolation if set to 1, a value of 0 disables
  11990. it. Default value is 1.
  11991. @item fillcolor, c
  11992. Set the color used to fill the output area not covered by the rotated
  11993. image. For the general syntax of this option, check the
  11994. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  11995. If the special value "none" is selected then no
  11996. background is printed (useful for example if the background is never shown).
  11997. Default value is "black".
  11998. @end table
  11999. The expressions for the angle and the output size can contain the
  12000. following constants and functions:
  12001. @table @option
  12002. @item n
  12003. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 0. It is always NAN
  12004. before the first frame is filtered.
  12005. @item t
  12006. time in seconds of the input frame, it is set to 0 when the filter is
  12007. configured. It is always NAN before the first frame is filtered.
  12008. @item hsub
  12009. @item vsub
  12010. horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12011. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12012. @item in_w, iw
  12013. @item in_h, ih
  12014. the input video width and height
  12015. @item out_w, ow
  12016. @item out_h, oh
  12017. the output width and height, that is the size of the padded area as
  12018. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions
  12019. @item rotw(a)
  12020. @item roth(a)
  12021. the minimal width/height required for completely containing the input
  12022. video rotated by @var{a} radians.
  12023. These are only available when computing the @option{out_w} and
  12024. @option{out_h} expressions.
  12025. @end table
  12026. @subsection Examples
  12027. @itemize
  12028. @item
  12029. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians clockwise:
  12030. @example
  12031. rotate=PI/6
  12032. @end example
  12033. @item
  12034. Rotate the input by PI/6 radians counter-clockwise:
  12035. @example
  12036. rotate=-PI/6
  12037. @end example
  12038. @item
  12039. Rotate the input by 45 degrees clockwise:
  12040. @example
  12041. rotate=45*PI/180
  12042. @end example
  12043. @item
  12044. Apply a constant rotation with period T, starting from an angle of PI/3:
  12045. @example
  12046. rotate=PI/3+2*PI*t/T
  12047. @end example
  12048. @item
  12049. Make the input video rotation oscillating with a period of T
  12050. seconds and an amplitude of A radians:
  12051. @example
  12052. rotate=A*sin(2*PI/T*t)
  12053. @end example
  12054. @item
  12055. Rotate the video, output size is chosen so that the whole rotating
  12056. input video is always completely contained in the output:
  12057. @example
  12058. rotate='2*PI*t:ow=hypot(iw,ih):oh=ow'
  12059. @end example
  12060. @item
  12061. Rotate the video, reduce the output size so that no background is ever
  12062. shown:
  12063. @example
  12064. rotate=2*PI*t:ow='min(iw,ih)/sqrt(2)':oh=ow:c=none
  12065. @end example
  12066. @end itemize
  12067. @subsection Commands
  12068. The filter supports the following commands:
  12069. @table @option
  12070. @item a, angle
  12071. Set the angle expression.
  12072. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12073. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12074. value.
  12075. @end table
  12076. @section sab
  12077. Apply Shape Adaptive Blur.
  12078. The filter accepts the following options:
  12079. @table @option
  12080. @item luma_radius, lr
  12081. Set luma blur filter strength, must be a value in range 0.1-4.0, default
  12082. value is 1.0. A greater value will result in a more blurred image, and
  12083. in slower processing.
  12084. @item luma_pre_filter_radius, lpfr
  12085. Set luma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the 0.1-2.0 range, default
  12086. value is 1.0.
  12087. @item luma_strength, ls
  12088. Set luma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered, must
  12089. be a value in the 0.1-100.0 range, default value is 1.0.
  12090. @item chroma_radius, cr
  12091. Set chroma blur filter strength, must be a value in range -0.9-4.0. A
  12092. greater value will result in a more blurred image, and in slower
  12093. processing.
  12094. @item chroma_pre_filter_radius, cpfr
  12095. Set chroma pre-filter radius, must be a value in the -0.9-2.0 range.
  12096. @item chroma_strength, cs
  12097. Set chroma maximum difference between pixels to still be considered,
  12098. must be a value in the -0.9-100.0 range.
  12099. @end table
  12100. Each chroma option value, if not explicitly specified, is set to the
  12101. corresponding luma option value.
  12102. @anchor{scale}
  12103. @section scale
  12104. Scale (resize) the input video, using the libswscale library.
  12105. The scale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  12106. of the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  12107. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  12108. the next filter, the scale filter will convert the input to the
  12109. requested format.
  12110. @subsection Options
  12111. The filter accepts the following options, or any of the options
  12112. supported by the libswscale scaler.
  12113. See @ref{scaler_options,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for
  12114. the complete list of scaler options.
  12115. @table @option
  12116. @item width, w
  12117. @item height, h
  12118. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  12119. dimension.
  12120. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  12121. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  12122. is used for the output.
  12123. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the scale filter
  12124. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  12125. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  12126. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  12127. adjust the value if necessary.
  12128. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  12129. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  12130. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  12131. expression.
  12132. @item eval
  12133. Specify when to evaluate @var{width} and @var{height} expression. It accepts the following values:
  12134. @table @samp
  12135. @item init
  12136. Only evaluate expressions once during the filter initialization or when a command is processed.
  12137. @item frame
  12138. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame.
  12139. @end table
  12140. Default value is @samp{init}.
  12141. @item interl
  12142. Set the interlacing mode. It accepts the following values:
  12143. @table @samp
  12144. @item 1
  12145. Force interlaced aware scaling.
  12146. @item 0
  12147. Do not apply interlaced scaling.
  12148. @item -1
  12149. Select interlaced aware scaling depending on whether the source frames
  12150. are flagged as interlaced or not.
  12151. @end table
  12152. Default value is @samp{0}.
  12153. @item flags
  12154. Set libswscale scaling flags. See
  12155. @ref{sws_flags,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12156. complete list of values. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12157. the default flags.
  12158. @item param0, param1
  12159. Set libswscale input parameters for scaling algorithms that need them. See
  12160. @ref{sws_params,,the ffmpeg-scaler manual,ffmpeg-scaler} for the
  12161. complete documentation. If not explicitly specified the filter applies
  12162. empty parameters.
  12163. @item size, s
  12164. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12165. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12166. @item in_color_matrix
  12167. @item out_color_matrix
  12168. Set in/output YCbCr color space type.
  12169. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12170. a specific value used for the output and encoder.
  12171. If not specified, the color space type depends on the pixel format.
  12172. Possible values:
  12173. @table @samp
  12174. @item auto
  12175. Choose automatically.
  12176. @item bt709
  12177. Format conforming to International Telecommunication Union (ITU)
  12178. Recommendation BT.709.
  12179. @item fcc
  12180. Set color space conforming to the United States Federal Communications
  12181. Commission (FCC) Code of Federal Regulations (CFR) Title 47 (2003) 73.682 (a).
  12182. @item bt601
  12183. @item bt470
  12184. @item smpte170m
  12185. Set color space conforming to:
  12186. @itemize
  12187. @item
  12188. ITU Radiocommunication Sector (ITU-R) Recommendation BT.601
  12189. @item
  12190. ITU-R Rec. BT.470-6 (1998) Systems B, B1, and G
  12191. @item
  12192. Society of Motion Picture and Television Engineers (SMPTE) ST 170:2004
  12193. @end itemize
  12194. @item smpte240m
  12195. Set color space conforming to SMPTE ST 240:1999.
  12196. @item bt2020
  12197. Set color space conforming to ITU-R BT.2020 non-constant luminance system.
  12198. @end table
  12199. @item in_range
  12200. @item out_range
  12201. Set in/output YCbCr sample range.
  12202. This allows the autodetected value to be overridden as well as allows forcing
  12203. a specific value used for the output and encoder. If not specified, the
  12204. range depends on the pixel format. Possible values:
  12205. @table @samp
  12206. @item auto/unknown
  12207. Choose automatically.
  12208. @item jpeg/full/pc
  12209. Set full range (0-255 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12210. @item mpeg/limited/tv
  12211. Set "MPEG" range (16-235 in case of 8-bit luma).
  12212. @end table
  12213. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12214. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12215. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12216. @table @samp
  12217. @item disable
  12218. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12219. @item decrease
  12220. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12221. @item increase
  12222. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12223. @end table
  12224. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12225. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12226. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12227. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12228. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12229. 1280x533.
  12230. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12231. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12232. to work.
  12233. @item force_divisible_by
  12234. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12235. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12236. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12237. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12238. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12239. may be slightly modified.
  12240. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12241. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12242. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12243. @end table
  12244. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  12245. containing the following constants:
  12246. @table @var
  12247. @item in_w
  12248. @item in_h
  12249. The input width and height
  12250. @item iw
  12251. @item ih
  12252. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  12253. @item out_w
  12254. @item out_h
  12255. The output (scaled) width and height
  12256. @item ow
  12257. @item oh
  12258. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  12259. @item a
  12260. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  12261. @item sar
  12262. input sample aspect ratio
  12263. @item dar
  12264. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  12265. @item hsub
  12266. @item vsub
  12267. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12268. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12269. @item ohsub
  12270. @item ovsub
  12271. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  12272. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12273. @item n
  12274. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12275. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12276. @item t
  12277. The presentation timestamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12278. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12279. @item pos
  12280. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the input stream, or NaN if
  12281. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12282. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12283. @end table
  12284. @subsection Examples
  12285. @itemize
  12286. @item
  12287. Scale the input video to a size of 200x100
  12288. @example
  12289. scale=w=200:h=100
  12290. @end example
  12291. This is equivalent to:
  12292. @example
  12293. scale=200:100
  12294. @end example
  12295. or:
  12296. @example
  12297. scale=200x100
  12298. @end example
  12299. @item
  12300. Specify a size abbreviation for the output size:
  12301. @example
  12302. scale=qcif
  12303. @end example
  12304. which can also be written as:
  12305. @example
  12306. scale=size=qcif
  12307. @end example
  12308. @item
  12309. Scale the input to 2x:
  12310. @example
  12311. scale=w=2*iw:h=2*ih
  12312. @end example
  12313. @item
  12314. The above is the same as:
  12315. @example
  12316. scale=2*in_w:2*in_h
  12317. @end example
  12318. @item
  12319. Scale the input to 2x with forced interlaced scaling:
  12320. @example
  12321. scale=2*iw:2*ih:interl=1
  12322. @end example
  12323. @item
  12324. Scale the input to half size:
  12325. @example
  12326. scale=w=iw/2:h=ih/2
  12327. @end example
  12328. @item
  12329. Increase the width, and set the height to the same size:
  12330. @example
  12331. scale=3/2*iw:ow
  12332. @end example
  12333. @item
  12334. Seek Greek harmony:
  12335. @example
  12336. scale=iw:1/PHI*iw
  12337. scale=ih*PHI:ih
  12338. @end example
  12339. @item
  12340. Increase the height, and set the width to 3/2 of the height:
  12341. @example
  12342. scale=w=3/2*oh:h=3/5*ih
  12343. @end example
  12344. @item
  12345. Increase the size, making the size a multiple of the chroma
  12346. subsample values:
  12347. @example
  12348. scale="trunc(3/2*iw/hsub)*hsub:trunc(3/2*ih/vsub)*vsub"
  12349. @end example
  12350. @item
  12351. Increase the width to a maximum of 500 pixels,
  12352. keeping the same aspect ratio as the input:
  12353. @example
  12354. scale=w='min(500\, iw*3/2):h=-1'
  12355. @end example
  12356. @item
  12357. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar:
  12358. @example
  12359. scale='trunc(ih*dar):ih',setsar=1/1
  12360. @end example
  12361. @item
  12362. Make pixels square by combining scale and setsar,
  12363. making sure the resulting resolution is even (required by some codecs):
  12364. @example
  12365. scale='trunc(ih*dar/2)*2:trunc(ih/2)*2',setsar=1/1
  12366. @end example
  12367. @end itemize
  12368. @subsection Commands
  12369. This filter supports the following commands:
  12370. @table @option
  12371. @item width, w
  12372. @item height, h
  12373. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12374. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12375. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12376. value.
  12377. @end table
  12378. @section scale_npp
  12379. Use the NVIDIA Performance Primitives (libnpp) to perform scaling and/or pixel
  12380. format conversion on CUDA video frames. Setting the output width and height
  12381. works in the same way as for the @var{scale} filter.
  12382. The following additional options are accepted:
  12383. @table @option
  12384. @item format
  12385. The pixel format of the output CUDA frames. If set to the string "same" (the
  12386. default), the input format will be kept. Note that automatic format negotiation
  12387. and conversion is not yet supported for hardware frames
  12388. @item interp_algo
  12389. The interpolation algorithm used for resizing. One of the following:
  12390. @table @option
  12391. @item nn
  12392. Nearest neighbour.
  12393. @item linear
  12394. @item cubic
  12395. @item cubic2p_bspline
  12396. 2-parameter cubic (B=1, C=0)
  12397. @item cubic2p_catmullrom
  12398. 2-parameter cubic (B=0, C=1/2)
  12399. @item cubic2p_b05c03
  12400. 2-parameter cubic (B=1/2, C=3/10)
  12401. @item super
  12402. Supersampling
  12403. @item lanczos
  12404. @end table
  12405. @item force_original_aspect_ratio
  12406. Enable decreasing or increasing output video width or height if necessary to
  12407. keep the original aspect ratio. Possible values:
  12408. @table @samp
  12409. @item disable
  12410. Scale the video as specified and disable this feature.
  12411. @item decrease
  12412. The output video dimensions will automatically be decreased if needed.
  12413. @item increase
  12414. The output video dimensions will automatically be increased if needed.
  12415. @end table
  12416. One useful instance of this option is that when you know a specific device's
  12417. maximum allowed resolution, you can use this to limit the output video to
  12418. that, while retaining the aspect ratio. For example, device A allows
  12419. 1280x720 playback, and your video is 1920x800. Using this option (set it to
  12420. decrease) and specifying 1280x720 to the command line makes the output
  12421. 1280x533.
  12422. Please note that this is a different thing than specifying -1 for @option{w}
  12423. or @option{h}, you still need to specify the output resolution for this option
  12424. to work.
  12425. @item force_divisible_by
  12426. Ensures that both the output dimensions, width and height, are divisible by the
  12427. given integer when used together with @option{force_original_aspect_ratio}. This
  12428. works similar to using @code{-n} in the @option{w} and @option{h} options.
  12429. This option respects the value set for @option{force_original_aspect_ratio},
  12430. increasing or decreasing the resolution accordingly. The video's aspect ratio
  12431. may be slightly modified.
  12432. This option can be handy if you need to have a video fit within or exceed
  12433. a defined resolution using @option{force_original_aspect_ratio} but also have
  12434. encoder restrictions on width or height divisibility.
  12435. @end table
  12436. @section scale2ref
  12437. Scale (resize) the input video, based on a reference video.
  12438. See the scale filter for available options, scale2ref supports the same but
  12439. uses the reference video instead of the main input as basis. scale2ref also
  12440. supports the following additional constants for the @option{w} and
  12441. @option{h} options:
  12442. @table @var
  12443. @item main_w
  12444. @item main_h
  12445. The main input video's width and height
  12446. @item main_a
  12447. The same as @var{main_w} / @var{main_h}
  12448. @item main_sar
  12449. The main input video's sample aspect ratio
  12450. @item main_dar, mdar
  12451. The main input video's display aspect ratio. Calculated from
  12452. @code{(main_w / main_h) * main_sar}.
  12453. @item main_hsub
  12454. @item main_vsub
  12455. The main input video's horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values.
  12456. For example for the pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub}
  12457. is 1.
  12458. @item main_n
  12459. The (sequential) number of the main input frame, starting from 0.
  12460. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12461. @item main_t
  12462. The presentation timestamp of the main input frame, expressed as a number of
  12463. seconds. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12464. @item main_pos
  12465. The position (byte offset) of the frame in the main input stream, or NaN if
  12466. this information is unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12467. Only available with @code{eval=frame}.
  12468. @end table
  12469. @subsection Examples
  12470. @itemize
  12471. @item
  12472. Scale a subtitle stream (b) to match the main video (a) in size before overlaying
  12473. @example
  12474. 'scale2ref[b][a];[a][b]overlay'
  12475. @end example
  12476. @item
  12477. Scale a logo to 1/10th the height of a video, while preserving its display aspect ratio.
  12478. @example
  12479. [logo-in][video-in]scale2ref=w=oh*mdar:h=ih/10[logo-out][video-out]
  12480. @end example
  12481. @end itemize
  12482. @subsection Commands
  12483. This filter supports the following commands:
  12484. @table @option
  12485. @item width, w
  12486. @item height, h
  12487. Set the output video dimension expression.
  12488. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  12489. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  12490. value.
  12491. @end table
  12492. @section scroll
  12493. Scroll input video horizontally and/or vertically by constant speed.
  12494. The filter accepts the following options:
  12495. @table @option
  12496. @item horizontal, h
  12497. Set the horizontal scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12498. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12499. @item vertical, v
  12500. Set the vertical scrolling speed. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -1 to 1.
  12501. Negative values changes scrolling direction.
  12502. @item hpos
  12503. Set the initial horizontal scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12504. @item vpos
  12505. Set the initial vertical scrolling position. Default is 0. Allowed range is from 0 to 1.
  12506. @end table
  12507. @subsection Commands
  12508. This filter supports the following @ref{commands}:
  12509. @table @option
  12510. @item horizontal, h
  12511. Set the horizontal scrolling speed.
  12512. @item vertical, v
  12513. Set the vertical scrolling speed.
  12514. @end table
  12515. @anchor{selectivecolor}
  12516. @section selectivecolor
  12517. Adjust cyan, magenta, yellow and black (CMYK) to certain ranges of colors (such
  12518. as "reds", "yellows", "greens", "cyans", ...). The adjustment range is defined
  12519. by the "purity" of the color (that is, how saturated it already is).
  12520. This filter is similar to the Adobe Photoshop Selective Color tool.
  12521. The filter accepts the following options:
  12522. @table @option
  12523. @item correction_method
  12524. Select color correction method.
  12525. Available values are:
  12526. @table @samp
  12527. @item absolute
  12528. Specified adjustments are applied "as-is" (added/subtracted to original pixel
  12529. component value).
  12530. @item relative
  12531. Specified adjustments are relative to the original component value.
  12532. @end table
  12533. Default is @code{absolute}.
  12534. @item reds
  12535. Adjustments for red pixels (pixels where the red component is the maximum)
  12536. @item yellows
  12537. Adjustments for yellow pixels (pixels where the blue component is the minimum)
  12538. @item greens
  12539. Adjustments for green pixels (pixels where the green component is the maximum)
  12540. @item cyans
  12541. Adjustments for cyan pixels (pixels where the red component is the minimum)
  12542. @item blues
  12543. Adjustments for blue pixels (pixels where the blue component is the maximum)
  12544. @item magentas
  12545. Adjustments for magenta pixels (pixels where the green component is the minimum)
  12546. @item whites
  12547. Adjustments for white pixels (pixels where all components are greater than 128)
  12548. @item neutrals
  12549. Adjustments for all pixels except pure black and pure white
  12550. @item blacks
  12551. Adjustments for black pixels (pixels where all components are lesser than 128)
  12552. @item psfile
  12553. Specify a Photoshop selective color file (@code{.asv}) to import the settings from.
  12554. @end table
  12555. All the adjustment settings (@option{reds}, @option{yellows}, ...) accept up to
  12556. 4 space separated floating point adjustment values in the [-1,1] range,
  12557. respectively to adjust the amount of cyan, magenta, yellow and black for the
  12558. pixels of its range.
  12559. @subsection Examples
  12560. @itemize
  12561. @item
  12562. Increase cyan by 50% and reduce yellow by 33% in every green areas, and
  12563. increase magenta by 27% in blue areas:
  12564. @example
  12565. selectivecolor=greens=.5 0 -.33 0:blues=0 .27
  12566. @end example
  12567. @item
  12568. Use a Photoshop selective color preset:
  12569. @example
  12570. selectivecolor=psfile=MySelectiveColorPresets/Misty.asv
  12571. @end example
  12572. @end itemize
  12573. @anchor{separatefields}
  12574. @section separatefields
  12575. The @code{separatefields} takes a frame-based video input and splits
  12576. each frame into its components fields, producing a new half height clip
  12577. with twice the frame rate and twice the frame count.
  12578. This filter use field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  12579. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  12580. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{separatefields} filter.
  12581. @section setdar, setsar
  12582. The @code{setdar} filter sets the Display Aspect Ratio for the filter
  12583. output video.
  12584. This is done by changing the specified Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect
  12585. Ratio, according to the following equation:
  12586. @example
  12587. @var{DAR} = @var{HORIZONTAL_RESOLUTION} / @var{VERTICAL_RESOLUTION} * @var{SAR}
  12588. @end example
  12589. Keep in mind that the @code{setdar} filter does not modify the pixel
  12590. dimensions of the video frame. Also, the display aspect ratio set by
  12591. this filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain,
  12592. e.g. in case of scaling or if another "setdar" or a "setsar" filter is
  12593. applied.
  12594. The @code{setsar} filter sets the Sample (aka Pixel) Aspect Ratio for
  12595. the filter output video.
  12596. Note that as a consequence of the application of this filter, the
  12597. output display aspect ratio will change according to the equation
  12598. above.
  12599. Keep in mind that the sample aspect ratio set by the @code{setsar}
  12600. filter may be changed by later filters in the filterchain, e.g. if
  12601. another "setsar" or a "setdar" filter is applied.
  12602. It accepts the following parameters:
  12603. @table @option
  12604. @item r, ratio, dar (@code{setdar} only), sar (@code{setsar} only)
  12605. Set the aspect ratio used by the filter.
  12606. The parameter can be a floating point number string, an expression, or
  12607. a string of the form @var{num}:@var{den}, where @var{num} and
  12608. @var{den} are the numerator and denominator of the aspect ratio. If
  12609. the parameter is not specified, it is assumed the value "0".
  12610. In case the form "@var{num}:@var{den}" is used, the @code{:} character
  12611. should be escaped.
  12612. @item max
  12613. Set the maximum integer value to use for expressing numerator and
  12614. denominator when reducing the expressed aspect ratio to a rational.
  12615. Default value is @code{100}.
  12616. @end table
  12617. The parameter @var{sar} is an expression containing
  12618. the following constants:
  12619. @table @option
  12620. @item E, PI, PHI
  12621. These are approximated values for the mathematical constants e
  12622. (Euler's number), pi (Greek pi), and phi (the golden ratio).
  12623. @item w, h
  12624. The input width and height.
  12625. @item a
  12626. These are the same as @var{w} / @var{h}.
  12627. @item sar
  12628. The input sample aspect ratio.
  12629. @item dar
  12630. The input display aspect ratio. It is the same as
  12631. (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}.
  12632. @item hsub, vsub
  12633. Horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  12634. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  12635. @end table
  12636. @subsection Examples
  12637. @itemize
  12638. @item
  12639. To change the display aspect ratio to 16:9, specify one of the following:
  12640. @example
  12641. setdar=dar=1.77777
  12642. setdar=dar=16/9
  12643. @end example
  12644. @item
  12645. To change the sample aspect ratio to 10:11, specify:
  12646. @example
  12647. setsar=sar=10/11
  12648. @end example
  12649. @item
  12650. To set a display aspect ratio of 16:9, and specify a maximum integer value of
  12651. 1000 in the aspect ratio reduction, use the command:
  12652. @example
  12653. setdar=ratio=16/9:max=1000
  12654. @end example
  12655. @end itemize
  12656. @anchor{setfield}
  12657. @section setfield
  12658. Force field for the output video frame.
  12659. The @code{setfield} filter marks the interlace type field for the
  12660. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12661. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12662. following filters (e.g. @code{fieldorder} or @code{yadif}).
  12663. The filter accepts the following options:
  12664. @table @option
  12665. @item mode
  12666. Available values are:
  12667. @table @samp
  12668. @item auto
  12669. Keep the same field property.
  12670. @item bff
  12671. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12672. @item tff
  12673. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12674. @item prog
  12675. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12676. @end table
  12677. @end table
  12678. @anchor{setparams}
  12679. @section setparams
  12680. Force frame parameter for the output video frame.
  12681. The @code{setparams} filter marks interlace and color range for the
  12682. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  12683. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  12684. filters/encoders.
  12685. @table @option
  12686. @item field_mode
  12687. Available values are:
  12688. @table @samp
  12689. @item auto
  12690. Keep the same field property (default).
  12691. @item bff
  12692. Mark the frame as bottom-field-first.
  12693. @item tff
  12694. Mark the frame as top-field-first.
  12695. @item prog
  12696. Mark the frame as progressive.
  12697. @end table
  12698. @item range
  12699. Available values are:
  12700. @table @samp
  12701. @item auto
  12702. Keep the same color range property (default).
  12703. @item unspecified, unknown
  12704. Mark the frame as unspecified color range.
  12705. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  12706. Mark the frame as limited range.
  12707. @item full, pc, jpeg
  12708. Mark the frame as full range.
  12709. @end table
  12710. @item color_primaries
  12711. Set the color primaries.
  12712. Available values are:
  12713. @table @samp
  12714. @item auto
  12715. Keep the same color primaries property (default).
  12716. @item bt709
  12717. @item unknown
  12718. @item bt470m
  12719. @item bt470bg
  12720. @item smpte170m
  12721. @item smpte240m
  12722. @item film
  12723. @item bt2020
  12724. @item smpte428
  12725. @item smpte431
  12726. @item smpte432
  12727. @item jedec-p22
  12728. @end table
  12729. @item color_trc
  12730. Set the color transfer.
  12731. Available values are:
  12732. @table @samp
  12733. @item auto
  12734. Keep the same color trc property (default).
  12735. @item bt709
  12736. @item unknown
  12737. @item bt470m
  12738. @item bt470bg
  12739. @item smpte170m
  12740. @item smpte240m
  12741. @item linear
  12742. @item log100
  12743. @item log316
  12744. @item iec61966-2-4
  12745. @item bt1361e
  12746. @item iec61966-2-1
  12747. @item bt2020-10
  12748. @item bt2020-12
  12749. @item smpte2084
  12750. @item smpte428
  12751. @item arib-std-b67
  12752. @end table
  12753. @item colorspace
  12754. Set the colorspace.
  12755. Available values are:
  12756. @table @samp
  12757. @item auto
  12758. Keep the same colorspace property (default).
  12759. @item gbr
  12760. @item bt709
  12761. @item unknown
  12762. @item fcc
  12763. @item bt470bg
  12764. @item smpte170m
  12765. @item smpte240m
  12766. @item ycgco
  12767. @item bt2020nc
  12768. @item bt2020c
  12769. @item smpte2085
  12770. @item chroma-derived-nc
  12771. @item chroma-derived-c
  12772. @item ictcp
  12773. @end table
  12774. @end table
  12775. @section showinfo
  12776. Show a line containing various information for each input video frame.
  12777. The input video is not modified.
  12778. This filter supports the following options:
  12779. @table @option
  12780. @item checksum
  12781. Calculate checksums of each plane. By default enabled.
  12782. @end table
  12783. The shown line contains a sequence of key/value pairs of the form
  12784. @var{key}:@var{value}.
  12785. The following values are shown in the output:
  12786. @table @option
  12787. @item n
  12788. The (sequential) number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  12789. @item pts
  12790. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12791. time base units. The time base unit depends on the filter input pad.
  12792. @item pts_time
  12793. The Presentation TimeStamp of the input frame, expressed as a number of
  12794. seconds.
  12795. @item pos
  12796. The position of the frame in the input stream, or -1 if this information is
  12797. unavailable and/or meaningless (for example in case of synthetic video).
  12798. @item fmt
  12799. The pixel format name.
  12800. @item sar
  12801. The sample aspect ratio of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12802. @var{num}/@var{den}.
  12803. @item s
  12804. The size of the input frame. For the syntax of this option, check the
  12805. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  12806. @item i
  12807. The type of interlaced mode ("P" for "progressive", "T" for top field first, "B"
  12808. for bottom field first).
  12809. @item iskey
  12810. This is 1 if the frame is a key frame, 0 otherwise.
  12811. @item type
  12812. The picture type of the input frame ("I" for an I-frame, "P" for a
  12813. P-frame, "B" for a B-frame, or "?" for an unknown type).
  12814. Also refer to the documentation of the @code{AVPictureType} enum and of
  12815. the @code{av_get_picture_type_char} function defined in
  12816. @file{libavutil/avutil.h}.
  12817. @item checksum
  12818. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of all the planes of the input frame.
  12819. @item plane_checksum
  12820. The Adler-32 checksum (printed in hexadecimal) of each plane of the input frame,
  12821. expressed in the form "[@var{c0} @var{c1} @var{c2} @var{c3}]".
  12822. @item mean
  12823. The mean value of pixels in each plane of the input frame, expressed in the form
  12824. "[@var{mean0} @var{mean1} @var{mean2} @var{mean3}]".
  12825. @item stdev
  12826. The standard deviation of pixel values in each plane of the input frame, expressed
  12827. in the form "[@var{stdev0} @var{stdev1} @var{stdev2} @var{stdev3}]".
  12828. @end table
  12829. @section showpalette
  12830. Displays the 256 colors palette of each frame. This filter is only relevant for
  12831. @var{pal8} pixel format frames.
  12832. It accepts the following option:
  12833. @table @option
  12834. @item s
  12835. Set the size of the box used to represent one palette color entry. Default is
  12836. @code{30} (for a @code{30x30} pixel box).
  12837. @end table
  12838. @section shuffleframes
  12839. Reorder and/or duplicate and/or drop video frames.
  12840. It accepts the following parameters:
  12841. @table @option
  12842. @item mapping
  12843. Set the destination indexes of input frames.
  12844. This is space or '|' separated list of indexes that maps input frames to output
  12845. frames. Number of indexes also sets maximal value that each index may have.
  12846. '-1' index have special meaning and that is to drop frame.
  12847. @end table
  12848. The first frame has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12849. @subsection Examples
  12850. @itemize
  12851. @item
  12852. Swap second and third frame of every three frames of the input:
  12853. @example
  12854. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=0 2 1" OUTPUT
  12855. @end example
  12856. @item
  12857. Swap 10th and 1st frame of every ten frames of the input:
  12858. @example
  12859. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf "shuffleframes=9 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0" OUTPUT
  12860. @end example
  12861. @end itemize
  12862. @section shuffleplanes
  12863. Reorder and/or duplicate video planes.
  12864. It accepts the following parameters:
  12865. @table @option
  12866. @item map0
  12867. The index of the input plane to be used as the first output plane.
  12868. @item map1
  12869. The index of the input plane to be used as the second output plane.
  12870. @item map2
  12871. The index of the input plane to be used as the third output plane.
  12872. @item map3
  12873. The index of the input plane to be used as the fourth output plane.
  12874. @end table
  12875. The first plane has the index 0. The default is to keep the input unchanged.
  12876. @subsection Examples
  12877. @itemize
  12878. @item
  12879. Swap the second and third planes of the input:
  12880. @example
  12881. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf shuffleplanes=0:2:1:3 OUTPUT
  12882. @end example
  12883. @end itemize
  12884. @anchor{signalstats}
  12885. @section signalstats
  12886. Evaluate various visual metrics that assist in determining issues associated
  12887. with the digitization of analog video media.
  12888. By default the filter will log these metadata values:
  12889. @table @option
  12890. @item YMIN
  12891. Display the minimal Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12892. range of [0-255].
  12893. @item YLOW
  12894. Display the Y value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12895. range of [0-255].
  12896. @item YAVG
  12897. Display the average Y value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12898. [0-255].
  12899. @item YHIGH
  12900. Display the Y value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12901. range of [0-255].
  12902. @item YMAX
  12903. Display the maximum Y value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12904. range of [0-255].
  12905. @item UMIN
  12906. Display the minimal U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12907. range of [0-255].
  12908. @item ULOW
  12909. Display the U value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12910. range of [0-255].
  12911. @item UAVG
  12912. Display the average U value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12913. [0-255].
  12914. @item UHIGH
  12915. Display the U value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12916. range of [0-255].
  12917. @item UMAX
  12918. Display the maximum U value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12919. range of [0-255].
  12920. @item VMIN
  12921. Display the minimal V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12922. range of [0-255].
  12923. @item VLOW
  12924. Display the V value at the 10% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12925. range of [0-255].
  12926. @item VAVG
  12927. Display the average V value within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12928. [0-255].
  12929. @item VHIGH
  12930. Display the V value at the 90% percentile within the input frame. Expressed in
  12931. range of [0-255].
  12932. @item VMAX
  12933. Display the maximum V value contained within the input frame. Expressed in
  12934. range of [0-255].
  12935. @item SATMIN
  12936. Display the minimal saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12937. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12938. @item SATLOW
  12939. Display the saturation value at the 10% percentile within the input frame.
  12940. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12941. @item SATAVG
  12942. Display the average saturation value within the input frame. Expressed in range
  12943. of [0-~181.02].
  12944. @item SATHIGH
  12945. Display the saturation value at the 90% percentile within the input frame.
  12946. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12947. @item SATMAX
  12948. Display the maximum saturation value contained within the input frame.
  12949. Expressed in range of [0-~181.02].
  12950. @item HUEMED
  12951. Display the median value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12952. [0-360].
  12953. @item HUEAVG
  12954. Display the average value for hue within the input frame. Expressed in range of
  12955. [0-360].
  12956. @item YDIF
  12957. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the Y
  12958. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12959. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12960. @item UDIF
  12961. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the U
  12962. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12963. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12964. @item VDIF
  12965. Display the average of sample value difference between all values of the V
  12966. plane in the current frame and corresponding values of the previous input frame.
  12967. Expressed in range of [0-255].
  12968. @item YBITDEPTH
  12969. Display bit depth of Y plane in current frame.
  12970. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12971. @item UBITDEPTH
  12972. Display bit depth of U plane in current frame.
  12973. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12974. @item VBITDEPTH
  12975. Display bit depth of V plane in current frame.
  12976. Expressed in range of [0-16].
  12977. @end table
  12978. The filter accepts the following options:
  12979. @table @option
  12980. @item stat
  12981. @item out
  12982. @option{stat} specify an additional form of image analysis.
  12983. @option{out} output video with the specified type of pixel highlighted.
  12984. Both options accept the following values:
  12985. @table @samp
  12986. @item tout
  12987. Identify @var{temporal outliers} pixels. A @var{temporal outlier} is a pixel
  12988. unlike the neighboring pixels of the same field. Examples of temporal outliers
  12989. include the results of video dropouts, head clogs, or tape tracking issues.
  12990. @item vrep
  12991. Identify @var{vertical line repetition}. Vertical line repetition includes
  12992. similar rows of pixels within a frame. In born-digital video vertical line
  12993. repetition is common, but this pattern is uncommon in video digitized from an
  12994. analog source. When it occurs in video that results from the digitization of an
  12995. analog source it can indicate concealment from a dropout compensator.
  12996. @item brng
  12997. Identify pixels that fall outside of legal broadcast range.
  12998. @end table
  12999. @item color, c
  13000. Set the highlight color for the @option{out} option. The default color is
  13001. yellow.
  13002. @end table
  13003. @subsection Examples
  13004. @itemize
  13005. @item
  13006. Output data of various video metrics:
  13007. @example
  13008. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats="stat=tout+vrep+brng" -show_frames
  13009. @end example
  13010. @item
  13011. Output specific data about the minimum and maximum values of the Y plane per frame:
  13012. @example
  13013. ffprobe -f lavfi movie=example.mov,signalstats -show_entries frame_tags=lavfi.signalstats.YMAX,lavfi.signalstats.YMIN
  13014. @end example
  13015. @item
  13016. Playback video while highlighting pixels that are outside of broadcast range in red.
  13017. @example
  13018. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats="out=brng:color=red"
  13019. @end example
  13020. @item
  13021. Playback video with signalstats metadata drawn over the frame.
  13022. @example
  13023. ffplay example.mov -vf signalstats=stat=brng+vrep+tout,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:textfile=signalstat_drawtext.txt
  13024. @end example
  13025. The contents of signalstat_drawtext.txt used in the command are:
  13026. @example
  13027. time %@{pts:hms@}
  13028. Y (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.YMAX@})
  13029. U (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.UMAX@})
  13030. V (%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMIN@}-%@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.VMAX@})
  13031. saturation maximum: %@{metadata:lavfi.signalstats.SATMAX@}
  13032. @end example
  13033. @end itemize
  13034. @anchor{signature}
  13035. @section signature
  13036. Calculates the MPEG-7 Video Signature. The filter can handle more than one
  13037. input. In this case the matching between the inputs can be calculated additionally.
  13038. The filter always passes through the first input. The signature of each stream can
  13039. be written into a file.
  13040. It accepts the following options:
  13041. @table @option
  13042. @item detectmode
  13043. Enable or disable the matching process.
  13044. Available values are:
  13045. @table @samp
  13046. @item off
  13047. Disable the calculation of a matching (default).
  13048. @item full
  13049. Calculate the matching for the whole video and output whether the whole video
  13050. matches or only parts.
  13051. @item fast
  13052. Calculate only until a matching is found or the video ends. Should be faster in
  13053. some cases.
  13054. @end table
  13055. @item nb_inputs
  13056. Set the number of inputs. The option value must be a non negative integer.
  13057. Default value is 1.
  13058. @item filename
  13059. Set the path to which the output is written. If there is more than one input,
  13060. the path must be a prototype, i.e. must contain %d or %0nd (where n is a positive
  13061. integer), that will be replaced with the input number. If no filename is
  13062. specified, no output will be written. This is the default.
  13063. @item format
  13064. Choose the output format.
  13065. Available values are:
  13066. @table @samp
  13067. @item binary
  13068. Use the specified binary representation (default).
  13069. @item xml
  13070. Use the specified xml representation.
  13071. @end table
  13072. @item th_d
  13073. Set threshold to detect one word as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13074. greater than zero. The default value is 9000.
  13075. @item th_dc
  13076. Set threshold to detect all words as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13077. greater than zero. The default value is 60000.
  13078. @item th_xh
  13079. Set threshold to detect frames as similar. The option value must be an integer
  13080. greater than zero. The default value is 116.
  13081. @item th_di
  13082. Set the minimum length of a sequence in frames to recognize it as matching
  13083. sequence. The option value must be a non negative integer value.
  13084. The default value is 0.
  13085. @item th_it
  13086. Set the minimum relation, that matching frames to all frames must have.
  13087. The option value must be a double value between 0 and 1. The default value is 0.5.
  13088. @end table
  13089. @subsection Examples
  13090. @itemize
  13091. @item
  13092. To calculate the signature of an input video and store it in signature.bin:
  13093. @example
  13094. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf signature=filename=signature.bin -map 0:v -f null -
  13095. @end example
  13096. @item
  13097. To detect whether two videos match and store the signatures in XML format in
  13098. signature0.xml and signature1.xml:
  13099. @example
  13100. ffmpeg -i input1.mkv -i input2.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] signature=nb_inputs=2:detectmode=full:format=xml:filename=signature%d.xml" -map :v -f null -
  13101. @end example
  13102. @end itemize
  13103. @anchor{smartblur}
  13104. @section smartblur
  13105. Blur the input video without impacting the outlines.
  13106. It accepts the following options:
  13107. @table @option
  13108. @item luma_radius, lr
  13109. Set the luma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13110. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13111. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is 1.0.
  13112. @item luma_strength, ls
  13113. Set the luma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13114. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13115. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13116. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is 1.0.
  13117. @item luma_threshold, lt
  13118. Set the luma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13119. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13120. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13121. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13122. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is 0.
  13123. @item chroma_radius, cr
  13124. Set the chroma radius. The option value must be a float number in
  13125. the range [0.1,5.0] that specifies the variance of the gaussian filter
  13126. used to blur the image (slower if larger). Default value is @option{luma_radius}.
  13127. @item chroma_strength, cs
  13128. Set the chroma strength. The option value must be a float number
  13129. in the range [-1.0,1.0] that configures the blurring. A value included
  13130. in [0.0,1.0] will blur the image whereas a value included in
  13131. [-1.0,0.0] will sharpen the image. Default value is @option{luma_strength}.
  13132. @item chroma_threshold, ct
  13133. Set the chroma threshold used as a coefficient to determine
  13134. whether a pixel should be blurred or not. The option value must be an
  13135. integer in the range [-30,30]. A value of 0 will filter all the image,
  13136. a value included in [0,30] will filter flat areas and a value included
  13137. in [-30,0] will filter edges. Default value is @option{luma_threshold}.
  13138. @end table
  13139. If a chroma option is not explicitly set, the corresponding luma value
  13140. is set.
  13141. @section sobel
  13142. Apply sobel operator to input video stream.
  13143. The filter accepts the following option:
  13144. @table @option
  13145. @item planes
  13146. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13147. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13148. @item scale
  13149. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  13150. @item delta
  13151. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  13152. @end table
  13153. @anchor{spp}
  13154. @section spp
  13155. Apply a simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses the image
  13156. at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{6} - all) shifts
  13157. and average the results.
  13158. The filter accepts the following options:
  13159. @table @option
  13160. @item quality
  13161. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  13162. an integer in the range 0-6. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  13163. effect. A value of @code{6} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  13164. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  13165. @code{3}.
  13166. @item qp
  13167. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  13168. from the video stream (if available).
  13169. @item mode
  13170. Set thresholding mode. Available modes are:
  13171. @table @samp
  13172. @item hard
  13173. Set hard thresholding (default).
  13174. @item soft
  13175. Set soft thresholding (better de-ringing effect, but likely blurrier).
  13176. @end table
  13177. @item use_bframe_qp
  13178. Enable the use of the QP from the B-Frames if set to @code{1}. Using this
  13179. option may cause flicker since the B-Frames have often larger QP. Default is
  13180. @code{0} (not enabled).
  13181. @end table
  13182. @subsection Commands
  13183. This filter supports the following commands:
  13184. @table @option
  13185. @item quality, level
  13186. Set quality level. The value @code{max} can be used to set the maximum level,
  13187. currently @code{6}.
  13188. @end table
  13189. @section sr
  13190. Scale the input by applying one of the super-resolution methods based on
  13191. convolutional neural networks. Supported models:
  13192. @itemize
  13193. @item
  13194. Super-Resolution Convolutional Neural Network model (SRCNN).
  13195. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1501.00092}.
  13196. @item
  13197. Efficient Sub-Pixel Convolutional Neural Network model (ESPCN).
  13198. See @url{https://arxiv.org/abs/1609.05158}.
  13199. @end itemize
  13200. Training scripts as well as scripts for model file (.pb) saving can be found at
  13201. @url{https://github.com/XueweiMeng/sr/tree/sr_dnn_native}. Original repository
  13202. is at @url{https://github.com/HighVoltageRocknRoll/sr.git}.
  13203. Native model files (.model) can be generated from TensorFlow model
  13204. files (.pb) by using tools/python/convert.py
  13205. The filter accepts the following options:
  13206. @table @option
  13207. @item dnn_backend
  13208. Specify which DNN backend to use for model loading and execution. This option accepts
  13209. the following values:
  13210. @table @samp
  13211. @item native
  13212. Native implementation of DNN loading and execution.
  13213. @item tensorflow
  13214. TensorFlow backend. To enable this backend you
  13215. need to install the TensorFlow for C library (see
  13216. @url{https://www.tensorflow.org/install/install_c}) and configure FFmpeg with
  13217. @code{--enable-libtensorflow}
  13218. @end table
  13219. Default value is @samp{native}.
  13220. @item model
  13221. Set path to model file specifying network architecture and its parameters.
  13222. Note that different backends use different file formats. TensorFlow backend
  13223. can load files for both formats, while native backend can load files for only
  13224. its format.
  13225. @item scale_factor
  13226. Set scale factor for SRCNN model. Allowed values are @code{2}, @code{3} and @code{4}.
  13227. Default value is @code{2}. Scale factor is necessary for SRCNN model, because it accepts
  13228. input upscaled using bicubic upscaling with proper scale factor.
  13229. @end table
  13230. @section ssim
  13231. Obtain the SSIM (Structural SImilarity Metric) between two input videos.
  13232. This filter takes in input two input videos, the first input is
  13233. considered the "main" source and is passed unchanged to the
  13234. output. The second input is used as a "reference" video for computing
  13235. the SSIM.
  13236. Both video inputs must have the same resolution and pixel format for
  13237. this filter to work correctly. Also it assumes that both inputs
  13238. have the same number of frames, which are compared one by one.
  13239. The filter stores the calculated SSIM of each frame.
  13240. The description of the accepted parameters follows.
  13241. @table @option
  13242. @item stats_file, f
  13243. If specified the filter will use the named file to save the SSIM of
  13244. each individual frame. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to
  13245. standard output.
  13246. @end table
  13247. The file printed if @var{stats_file} is selected, contains a sequence of
  13248. key/value pairs of the form @var{key}:@var{value} for each compared
  13249. couple of frames.
  13250. A description of each shown parameter follows:
  13251. @table @option
  13252. @item n
  13253. sequential number of the input frame, starting from 1
  13254. @item Y, U, V, R, G, B
  13255. SSIM of the compared frames for the component specified by the suffix.
  13256. @item All
  13257. SSIM of the compared frames for the whole frame.
  13258. @item dB
  13259. Same as above but in dB representation.
  13260. @end table
  13261. This filter also supports the @ref{framesync} options.
  13262. @subsection Examples
  13263. @itemize
  13264. @item
  13265. For example:
  13266. @example
  13267. movie=ref_movie.mpg, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  13268. [main][ref] ssim="stats_file=stats.log" [out]
  13269. @end example
  13270. On this example the input file being processed is compared with the
  13271. reference file @file{ref_movie.mpg}. The SSIM of each individual frame
  13272. is stored in @file{stats.log}.
  13273. @item
  13274. Another example with both psnr and ssim at same time:
  13275. @example
  13276. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mpg -lavfi "ssim;[0:v][1:v]psnr" -f null -
  13277. @end example
  13278. @item
  13279. Another example with different containers:
  13280. @example
  13281. ffmpeg -i main.mpg -i ref.mkv -lavfi "[0:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[main];[1:v]settb=AVTB,setpts=PTS-STARTPTS[ref];[main][ref]ssim" -f null -
  13282. @end example
  13283. @end itemize
  13284. @section stereo3d
  13285. Convert between different stereoscopic image formats.
  13286. The filters accept the following options:
  13287. @table @option
  13288. @item in
  13289. Set stereoscopic image format of input.
  13290. Available values for input image formats are:
  13291. @table @samp
  13292. @item sbsl
  13293. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13294. @item sbsr
  13295. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13296. @item sbs2l
  13297. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13298. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13299. @item sbs2r
  13300. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13301. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13302. @item abl
  13303. @item tbl
  13304. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13305. @item abr
  13306. @item tbr
  13307. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13308. @item ab2l
  13309. @item tb2l
  13310. above-below with half height resolution
  13311. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13312. @item ab2r
  13313. @item tb2r
  13314. above-below with half height resolution
  13315. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13316. @item al
  13317. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13318. @item ar
  13319. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13320. @item irl
  13321. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13322. @item irr
  13323. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13324. @item icl
  13325. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13326. @item icr
  13327. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13328. Default value is @samp{sbsl}.
  13329. @end table
  13330. @item out
  13331. Set stereoscopic image format of output.
  13332. @table @samp
  13333. @item sbsl
  13334. side by side parallel (left eye left, right eye right)
  13335. @item sbsr
  13336. side by side crosseye (right eye left, left eye right)
  13337. @item sbs2l
  13338. side by side parallel with half width resolution
  13339. (left eye left, right eye right)
  13340. @item sbs2r
  13341. side by side crosseye with half width resolution
  13342. (right eye left, left eye right)
  13343. @item abl
  13344. @item tbl
  13345. above-below (left eye above, right eye below)
  13346. @item abr
  13347. @item tbr
  13348. above-below (right eye above, left eye below)
  13349. @item ab2l
  13350. @item tb2l
  13351. above-below with half height resolution
  13352. (left eye above, right eye below)
  13353. @item ab2r
  13354. @item tb2r
  13355. above-below with half height resolution
  13356. (right eye above, left eye below)
  13357. @item al
  13358. alternating frames (left eye first, right eye second)
  13359. @item ar
  13360. alternating frames (right eye first, left eye second)
  13361. @item irl
  13362. interleaved rows (left eye has top row, right eye starts on next row)
  13363. @item irr
  13364. interleaved rows (right eye has top row, left eye starts on next row)
  13365. @item arbg
  13366. anaglyph red/blue gray
  13367. (red filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13368. @item argg
  13369. anaglyph red/green gray
  13370. (red filter on left eye, green filter on right eye)
  13371. @item arcg
  13372. anaglyph red/cyan gray
  13373. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13374. @item arch
  13375. anaglyph red/cyan half colored
  13376. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13377. @item arcc
  13378. anaglyph red/cyan color
  13379. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13380. @item arcd
  13381. anaglyph red/cyan color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13382. (red filter on left eye, cyan filter on right eye)
  13383. @item agmg
  13384. anaglyph green/magenta gray
  13385. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13386. @item agmh
  13387. anaglyph green/magenta half colored
  13388. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13389. @item agmc
  13390. anaglyph green/magenta colored
  13391. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13392. @item agmd
  13393. anaglyph green/magenta color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13394. (green filter on left eye, magenta filter on right eye)
  13395. @item aybg
  13396. anaglyph yellow/blue gray
  13397. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13398. @item aybh
  13399. anaglyph yellow/blue half colored
  13400. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13401. @item aybc
  13402. anaglyph yellow/blue colored
  13403. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13404. @item aybd
  13405. anaglyph yellow/blue color optimized with the least squares projection of dubois
  13406. (yellow filter on left eye, blue filter on right eye)
  13407. @item ml
  13408. mono output (left eye only)
  13409. @item mr
  13410. mono output (right eye only)
  13411. @item chl
  13412. checkerboard, left eye first
  13413. @item chr
  13414. checkerboard, right eye first
  13415. @item icl
  13416. interleaved columns, left eye first
  13417. @item icr
  13418. interleaved columns, right eye first
  13419. @item hdmi
  13420. HDMI frame pack
  13421. @end table
  13422. Default value is @samp{arcd}.
  13423. @end table
  13424. @subsection Examples
  13425. @itemize
  13426. @item
  13427. Convert input video from side by side parallel to anaglyph yellow/blue dubois:
  13428. @example
  13429. stereo3d=sbsl:aybd
  13430. @end example
  13431. @item
  13432. Convert input video from above below (left eye above, right eye below) to side by side crosseye.
  13433. @example
  13434. stereo3d=abl:sbsr
  13435. @end example
  13436. @end itemize
  13437. @section streamselect, astreamselect
  13438. Select video or audio streams.
  13439. The filter accepts the following options:
  13440. @table @option
  13441. @item inputs
  13442. Set number of inputs. Default is 2.
  13443. @item map
  13444. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13445. @end table
  13446. @subsection Commands
  13447. The @code{streamselect} and @code{astreamselect} filter supports the following
  13448. commands:
  13449. @table @option
  13450. @item map
  13451. Set input indexes to remap to outputs.
  13452. @end table
  13453. @subsection Examples
  13454. @itemize
  13455. @item
  13456. Select first 5 seconds 1st stream and rest of time 2nd stream:
  13457. @example
  13458. sendcmd='5.0 streamselect map 1',streamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13459. @end example
  13460. @item
  13461. Same as above, but for audio:
  13462. @example
  13463. asendcmd='5.0 astreamselect map 1',astreamselect=inputs=2:map=0
  13464. @end example
  13465. @end itemize
  13466. @anchor{subtitles}
  13467. @section subtitles
  13468. Draw subtitles on top of input video using the libass library.
  13469. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  13470. @code{--enable-libass}. This filter also requires a build with libavcodec and
  13471. libavformat to convert the passed subtitles file to ASS (Advanced Substation
  13472. Alpha) subtitles format.
  13473. The filter accepts the following options:
  13474. @table @option
  13475. @item filename, f
  13476. Set the filename of the subtitle file to read. It must be specified.
  13477. @item original_size
  13478. Specify the size of the original video, the video for which the ASS file
  13479. was composed. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13480. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13481. Due to a misdesign in ASS aspect ratio arithmetic, this is necessary to
  13482. correctly scale the fonts if the aspect ratio has been changed.
  13483. @item fontsdir
  13484. Set a directory path containing fonts that can be used by the filter.
  13485. These fonts will be used in addition to whatever the font provider uses.
  13486. @item alpha
  13487. Process alpha channel, by default alpha channel is untouched.
  13488. @item charenc
  13489. Set subtitles input character encoding. @code{subtitles} filter only. Only
  13490. useful if not UTF-8.
  13491. @item stream_index, si
  13492. Set subtitles stream index. @code{subtitles} filter only.
  13493. @item force_style
  13494. Override default style or script info parameters of the subtitles. It accepts a
  13495. string containing ASS style format @code{KEY=VALUE} couples separated by ",".
  13496. @end table
  13497. If the first key is not specified, it is assumed that the first value
  13498. specifies the @option{filename}.
  13499. For example, to render the file @file{sub.srt} on top of the input
  13500. video, use the command:
  13501. @example
  13502. subtitles=sub.srt
  13503. @end example
  13504. which is equivalent to:
  13505. @example
  13506. subtitles=filename=sub.srt
  13507. @end example
  13508. To render the default subtitles stream from file @file{video.mkv}, use:
  13509. @example
  13510. subtitles=video.mkv
  13511. @end example
  13512. To render the second subtitles stream from that file, use:
  13513. @example
  13514. subtitles=video.mkv:si=1
  13515. @end example
  13516. To make the subtitles stream from @file{sub.srt} appear in 80% transparent blue
  13517. @code{DejaVu Serif}, use:
  13518. @example
  13519. subtitles=sub.srt:force_style='FontName=DejaVu Serif,PrimaryColour=&HCCFF0000'
  13520. @end example
  13521. @section super2xsai
  13522. Scale the input by 2x and smooth using the Super2xSaI (Scale and
  13523. Interpolate) pixel art scaling algorithm.
  13524. Useful for enlarging pixel art images without reducing sharpness.
  13525. @section swaprect
  13526. Swap two rectangular objects in video.
  13527. This filter accepts the following options:
  13528. @table @option
  13529. @item w
  13530. Set object width.
  13531. @item h
  13532. Set object height.
  13533. @item x1
  13534. Set 1st rect x coordinate.
  13535. @item y1
  13536. Set 1st rect y coordinate.
  13537. @item x2
  13538. Set 2nd rect x coordinate.
  13539. @item y2
  13540. Set 2nd rect y coordinate.
  13541. All expressions are evaluated once for each frame.
  13542. @end table
  13543. The all options are expressions containing the following constants:
  13544. @table @option
  13545. @item w
  13546. @item h
  13547. The input width and height.
  13548. @item a
  13549. same as @var{w} / @var{h}
  13550. @item sar
  13551. input sample aspect ratio
  13552. @item dar
  13553. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{w} / @var{h}) * @var{sar}
  13554. @item n
  13555. The number of the input frame, starting from 0.
  13556. @item t
  13557. The timestamp expressed in seconds. It's NAN if the input timestamp is unknown.
  13558. @item pos
  13559. the position in the file of the input frame, NAN if unknown
  13560. @end table
  13561. @section swapuv
  13562. Swap U & V plane.
  13563. @section telecine
  13564. Apply telecine process to the video.
  13565. This filter accepts the following options:
  13566. @table @option
  13567. @item first_field
  13568. @table @samp
  13569. @item top, t
  13570. top field first
  13571. @item bottom, b
  13572. bottom field first
  13573. The default value is @code{top}.
  13574. @end table
  13575. @item pattern
  13576. A string of numbers representing the pulldown pattern you wish to apply.
  13577. The default value is @code{23}.
  13578. @end table
  13579. @example
  13580. Some typical patterns:
  13581. NTSC output (30i):
  13582. 27.5p: 32222
  13583. 24p: 23 (classic)
  13584. 24p: 2332 (preferred)
  13585. 20p: 33
  13586. 18p: 334
  13587. 16p: 3444
  13588. PAL output (25i):
  13589. 27.5p: 12222
  13590. 24p: 222222222223 ("Euro pulldown")
  13591. 16.67p: 33
  13592. 16p: 33333334
  13593. @end example
  13594. @section thistogram
  13595. Compute and draw a color distribution histogram for the input video across time.
  13596. Unlike @ref{histogram} video filter which only shows histogram of single input frame
  13597. at certain time, this filter shows also past histograms of number of frames defined
  13598. by @code{width} option.
  13599. The computed histogram is a representation of the color component
  13600. distribution in an image.
  13601. The filter accepts the following options:
  13602. @table @option
  13603. @item width, w
  13604. Set width of single color component output. Default value is @code{0}.
  13605. Value of @code{0} means width will be picked from input video.
  13606. This also set number of passed histograms to keep.
  13607. Allowed range is [0, 8192].
  13608. @item display_mode, d
  13609. Set display mode.
  13610. It accepts the following values:
  13611. @table @samp
  13612. @item stack
  13613. Per color component graphs are placed below each other.
  13614. @item parade
  13615. Per color component graphs are placed side by side.
  13616. @item overlay
  13617. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  13618. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  13619. over one another.
  13620. @end table
  13621. Default is @code{stack}.
  13622. @item levels_mode, m
  13623. Set mode. Can be either @code{linear}, or @code{logarithmic}.
  13624. Default is @code{linear}.
  13625. @item components, c
  13626. Set what color components to display.
  13627. Default is @code{7}.
  13628. @item bgopacity, b
  13629. Set background opacity. Default is @code{0.9}.
  13630. @item envelope, e
  13631. Show envelope. Default is disabled.
  13632. @item ecolor, ec
  13633. Set envelope color. Default is @code{gold}.
  13634. @end table
  13635. @section threshold
  13636. Apply threshold effect to video stream.
  13637. This filter needs four video streams to perform thresholding.
  13638. First stream is stream we are filtering.
  13639. Second stream is holding threshold values, third stream is holding min values,
  13640. and last, fourth stream is holding max values.
  13641. The filter accepts the following option:
  13642. @table @option
  13643. @item planes
  13644. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  13645. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  13646. @end table
  13647. For example if first stream pixel's component value is less then threshold value
  13648. of pixel component from 2nd threshold stream, third stream value will picked,
  13649. otherwise fourth stream pixel component value will be picked.
  13650. Using color source filter one can perform various types of thresholding:
  13651. @subsection Examples
  13652. @itemize
  13653. @item
  13654. Binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13655. @example
  13656. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=black -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13657. @end example
  13658. @item
  13659. Inverted binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13660. @example
  13661. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -f lavfi -i color=black -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13662. @end example
  13663. @item
  13664. Truncate binary threshold, using gray color as threshold:
  13665. @example
  13666. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13667. @end example
  13668. @item
  13669. Threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13670. @example
  13671. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -f lavfi -i color=white -i 320x240.avi -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13672. @end example
  13673. @item
  13674. Inverted threshold to zero, using gray color as threshold:
  13675. @example
  13676. ffmpeg -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=gray -i 320x240.avi -f lavfi -i color=white -lavfi threshold output.avi
  13677. @end example
  13678. @end itemize
  13679. @section thumbnail
  13680. Select the most representative frame in a given sequence of consecutive frames.
  13681. The filter accepts the following options:
  13682. @table @option
  13683. @item n
  13684. Set the frames batch size to analyze; in a set of @var{n} frames, the filter
  13685. will pick one of them, and then handle the next batch of @var{n} frames until
  13686. the end. Default is @code{100}.
  13687. @end table
  13688. Since the filter keeps track of the whole frames sequence, a bigger @var{n}
  13689. value will result in a higher memory usage, so a high value is not recommended.
  13690. @subsection Examples
  13691. @itemize
  13692. @item
  13693. Extract one picture each 50 frames:
  13694. @example
  13695. thumbnail=50
  13696. @end example
  13697. @item
  13698. Complete example of a thumbnail creation with @command{ffmpeg}:
  13699. @example
  13700. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf thumbnail,scale=300:200 -frames:v 1 out.png
  13701. @end example
  13702. @end itemize
  13703. @section tile
  13704. Tile several successive frames together.
  13705. The filter accepts the following options:
  13706. @table @option
  13707. @item layout
  13708. Set the grid size (i.e. the number of lines and columns). For the syntax of
  13709. this option, check the
  13710. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13711. @item nb_frames
  13712. Set the maximum number of frames to render in the given area. It must be less
  13713. than or equal to @var{w}x@var{h}. The default value is @code{0}, meaning all
  13714. the area will be used.
  13715. @item margin
  13716. Set the outer border margin in pixels.
  13717. @item padding
  13718. Set the inner border thickness (i.e. the number of pixels between frames). For
  13719. more advanced padding options (such as having different values for the edges),
  13720. refer to the pad video filter.
  13721. @item color
  13722. Specify the color of the unused area. For the syntax of this option, check the
  13723. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  13724. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  13725. @item overlap
  13726. Set the number of frames to overlap when tiling several successive frames together.
  13727. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13728. @item init_padding
  13729. Set the number of frames to initially be empty before displaying first output frame.
  13730. This controls how soon will one get first output frame.
  13731. The value must be between @code{0} and @var{nb_frames - 1}.
  13732. @end table
  13733. @subsection Examples
  13734. @itemize
  13735. @item
  13736. Produce 8x8 PNG tiles of all keyframes (@option{-skip_frame nokey}) in a movie:
  13737. @example
  13738. ffmpeg -skip_frame nokey -i file.avi -vf 'scale=128:72,tile=8x8' -an -vsync 0 keyframes%03d.png
  13739. @end example
  13740. The @option{-vsync 0} is necessary to prevent @command{ffmpeg} from
  13741. duplicating each output frame to accommodate the originally detected frame
  13742. rate.
  13743. @item
  13744. Display @code{5} pictures in an area of @code{3x2} frames,
  13745. with @code{7} pixels between them, and @code{2} pixels of initial margin, using
  13746. mixed flat and named options:
  13747. @example
  13748. tile=3x2:nb_frames=5:padding=7:margin=2
  13749. @end example
  13750. @end itemize
  13751. @section tinterlace
  13752. Perform various types of temporal field interlacing.
  13753. Frames are counted starting from 1, so the first input frame is
  13754. considered odd.
  13755. The filter accepts the following options:
  13756. @table @option
  13757. @item mode
  13758. Specify the mode of the interlacing. This option can also be specified
  13759. as a value alone. See below for a list of values for this option.
  13760. Available values are:
  13761. @table @samp
  13762. @item merge, 0
  13763. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13764. generating a double height frame at half frame rate.
  13765. @example
  13766. ------> time
  13767. Input:
  13768. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13769. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13770. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13771. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13772. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13773. Output:
  13774. 11111 33333
  13775. 22222 44444
  13776. 11111 33333
  13777. 22222 44444
  13778. 11111 33333
  13779. 22222 44444
  13780. 11111 33333
  13781. 22222 44444
  13782. @end example
  13783. @item drop_even, 1
  13784. Only output odd frames, even frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13785. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13786. @example
  13787. ------> time
  13788. Input:
  13789. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13790. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13791. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13792. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13793. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13794. Output:
  13795. 11111 33333
  13796. 11111 33333
  13797. 11111 33333
  13798. 11111 33333
  13799. @end example
  13800. @item drop_odd, 2
  13801. Only output even frames, odd frames are dropped, generating a frame with
  13802. unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13803. @example
  13804. ------> time
  13805. Input:
  13806. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13807. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13808. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13809. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13810. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13811. Output:
  13812. 22222 44444
  13813. 22222 44444
  13814. 22222 44444
  13815. 22222 44444
  13816. @end example
  13817. @item pad, 3
  13818. Expand each frame to full height, but pad alternate lines with black,
  13819. generating a frame with double height at the same input frame rate.
  13820. @example
  13821. ------> time
  13822. Input:
  13823. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13824. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13825. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13826. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13827. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13828. Output:
  13829. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13830. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13831. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13832. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13833. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13834. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13835. 11111 ..... 33333 .....
  13836. ..... 22222 ..... 44444
  13837. @end example
  13838. @item interleave_top, 4
  13839. Interleave the upper field from odd frames with the lower field from
  13840. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13841. @example
  13842. ------> time
  13843. Input:
  13844. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13845. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13846. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13847. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13848. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13849. Output:
  13850. 11111 33333
  13851. 22222 44444
  13852. 11111 33333
  13853. 22222 44444
  13854. @end example
  13855. @item interleave_bottom, 5
  13856. Interleave the lower field from odd frames with the upper field from
  13857. even frames, generating a frame with unchanged height at half frame rate.
  13858. @example
  13859. ------> time
  13860. Input:
  13861. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13862. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13863. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13864. 11111 22222<- 33333 44444<-
  13865. 11111<- 22222 33333<- 44444
  13866. Output:
  13867. 22222 44444
  13868. 11111 33333
  13869. 22222 44444
  13870. 11111 33333
  13871. @end example
  13872. @item interlacex2, 6
  13873. Double frame rate with unchanged height. Frames are inserted each
  13874. containing the second temporal field from the previous input frame and
  13875. the first temporal field from the next input frame. This mode relies on
  13876. the top_field_first flag. Useful for interlaced video displays with no
  13877. field synchronisation.
  13878. @example
  13879. ------> time
  13880. Input:
  13881. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13882. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13883. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13884. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13885. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13886. Output:
  13887. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13888. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13889. 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444 44444
  13890. 11111 11111 22222 22222 33333 33333 44444
  13891. @end example
  13892. @item mergex2, 7
  13893. Move odd frames into the upper field, even into the lower field,
  13894. generating a double height frame at same frame rate.
  13895. @example
  13896. ------> time
  13897. Input:
  13898. Frame 1 Frame 2 Frame 3 Frame 4
  13899. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13900. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13901. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13902. 11111 22222 33333 44444
  13903. Output:
  13904. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13905. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13906. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13907. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13908. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13909. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13910. 11111 33333 33333 55555
  13911. 22222 22222 44444 44444
  13912. @end example
  13913. @end table
  13914. Numeric values are deprecated but are accepted for backward
  13915. compatibility reasons.
  13916. Default mode is @code{merge}.
  13917. @item flags
  13918. Specify flags influencing the filter process.
  13919. Available value for @var{flags} is:
  13920. @table @option
  13921. @item low_pass_filter, vlpf
  13922. Enable linear vertical low-pass filtering in the filter.
  13923. Vertical low-pass filtering is required when creating an interlaced
  13924. destination from a progressive source which contains high-frequency
  13925. vertical detail. Filtering will reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13926. patterning.
  13927. @item complex_filter, cvlpf
  13928. Enable complex vertical low-pass filtering.
  13929. This will slightly less reduce interlace 'twitter' and Moire
  13930. patterning but better retain detail and subjective sharpness impression.
  13931. @item bypass_il
  13932. Bypass already interlaced frames, only adjust the frame rate.
  13933. @end table
  13934. Vertical low-pass filtering and bypassing already interlaced frames can only be
  13935. enabled for @option{mode} @var{interleave_top} and @var{interleave_bottom}.
  13936. @end table
  13937. @section tmix
  13938. Mix successive video frames.
  13939. A description of the accepted options follows.
  13940. @table @option
  13941. @item frames
  13942. The number of successive frames to mix. If unspecified, it defaults to 3.
  13943. @item weights
  13944. Specify weight of each input video frame.
  13945. Each weight is separated by space. If number of weights is smaller than
  13946. number of @var{frames} last specified weight will be used for all remaining
  13947. unset weights.
  13948. @item scale
  13949. Specify scale, if it is set it will be multiplied with sum
  13950. of each weight multiplied with pixel values to give final destination
  13951. pixel value. By default @var{scale} is auto scaled to sum of weights.
  13952. @end table
  13953. @subsection Examples
  13954. @itemize
  13955. @item
  13956. Average 7 successive frames:
  13957. @example
  13958. tmix=frames=7:weights="1 1 1 1 1 1 1"
  13959. @end example
  13960. @item
  13961. Apply simple temporal convolution:
  13962. @example
  13963. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 3 -1"
  13964. @end example
  13965. @item
  13966. Similar as above but only showing temporal differences:
  13967. @example
  13968. tmix=frames=3:weights="-1 2 -1":scale=1
  13969. @end example
  13970. @end itemize
  13971. @anchor{tonemap}
  13972. @section tonemap
  13973. Tone map colors from different dynamic ranges.
  13974. This filter expects data in single precision floating point, as it needs to
  13975. operate on (and can output) out-of-range values. Another filter, such as
  13976. @ref{zscale}, is needed to convert the resulting frame to a usable format.
  13977. The tonemapping algorithms implemented only work on linear light, so input
  13978. data should be linearized beforehand (and possibly correctly tagged).
  13979. @example
  13980. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf zscale=transfer=linear,tonemap=clip,zscale=transfer=bt709,format=yuv420p OUTPUT
  13981. @end example
  13982. @subsection Options
  13983. The filter accepts the following options.
  13984. @table @option
  13985. @item tonemap
  13986. Set the tone map algorithm to use.
  13987. Possible values are:
  13988. @table @var
  13989. @item none
  13990. Do not apply any tone map, only desaturate overbright pixels.
  13991. @item clip
  13992. Hard-clip any out-of-range values. Use it for perfect color accuracy for
  13993. in-range values, while distorting out-of-range values.
  13994. @item linear
  13995. Stretch the entire reference gamut to a linear multiple of the display.
  13996. @item gamma
  13997. Fit a logarithmic transfer between the tone curves.
  13998. @item reinhard
  13999. Preserve overall image brightness with a simple curve, using nonlinear
  14000. contrast, which results in flattening details and degrading color accuracy.
  14001. @item hable
  14002. Preserve both dark and bright details better than @var{reinhard}, at the cost
  14003. of slightly darkening everything. Use it when detail preservation is more
  14004. important than color and brightness accuracy.
  14005. @item mobius
  14006. Smoothly map out-of-range values, while retaining contrast and colors for
  14007. in-range material as much as possible. Use it when color accuracy is more
  14008. important than detail preservation.
  14009. @end table
  14010. Default is none.
  14011. @item param
  14012. Tune the tone mapping algorithm.
  14013. This affects the following algorithms:
  14014. @table @var
  14015. @item none
  14016. Ignored.
  14017. @item linear
  14018. Specifies the scale factor to use while stretching.
  14019. Default to 1.0.
  14020. @item gamma
  14021. Specifies the exponent of the function.
  14022. Default to 1.8.
  14023. @item clip
  14024. Specify an extra linear coefficient to multiply into the signal before clipping.
  14025. Default to 1.0.
  14026. @item reinhard
  14027. Specify the local contrast coefficient at the display peak.
  14028. Default to 0.5, which means that in-gamut values will be about half as bright
  14029. as when clipping.
  14030. @item hable
  14031. Ignored.
  14032. @item mobius
  14033. Specify the transition point from linear to mobius transform. Every value
  14034. below this point is guaranteed to be mapped 1:1. The higher the value, the
  14035. more accurate the result will be, at the cost of losing bright details.
  14036. Default to 0.3, which due to the steep initial slope still preserves in-range
  14037. colors fairly accurately.
  14038. @end table
  14039. @item desat
  14040. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  14041. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  14042. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  14043. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  14044. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  14045. The default of 2.0 is somewhat conservative and will mostly just apply to
  14046. skies or directly sunlit surfaces. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  14047. This option works only if the input frame has a supported color tag.
  14048. @item peak
  14049. Override signal/nominal/reference peak with this value. Useful when the
  14050. embedded peak information in display metadata is not reliable or when tone
  14051. mapping from a lower range to a higher range.
  14052. @end table
  14053. @section tpad
  14054. Temporarily pad video frames.
  14055. The filter accepts the following options:
  14056. @table @option
  14057. @item start
  14058. Specify number of delay frames before input video stream.
  14059. @item stop
  14060. Specify number of padding frames after input video stream.
  14061. Set to -1 to pad indefinitely.
  14062. @item start_mode
  14063. Set kind of frames added to beginning of stream.
  14064. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14065. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14066. With @var{clone} frames are clones of first frame.
  14067. @item stop_mode
  14068. Set kind of frames added to end of stream.
  14069. Can be either @var{add} or @var{clone}.
  14070. With @var{add} frames of solid-color are added.
  14071. With @var{clone} frames are clones of last frame.
  14072. @item start_duration, stop_duration
  14073. Specify the duration of the start/stop delay. See
  14074. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14075. for the accepted syntax.
  14076. These options override @var{start} and @var{stop}.
  14077. @item color
  14078. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  14079. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  14080. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  14081. The default value of @var{color} is "black".
  14082. @end table
  14083. @anchor{transpose}
  14084. @section transpose
  14085. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14086. It accepts the following parameters:
  14087. @table @option
  14088. @item dir
  14089. Specify the transposition direction.
  14090. Can assume the following values:
  14091. @table @samp
  14092. @item 0, 4, cclock_flip
  14093. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip (default), that is:
  14094. @example
  14095. L.R L.l
  14096. . . -> . .
  14097. l.r R.r
  14098. @end example
  14099. @item 1, 5, clock
  14100. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise, that is:
  14101. @example
  14102. L.R l.L
  14103. . . -> . .
  14104. l.r r.R
  14105. @end example
  14106. @item 2, 6, cclock
  14107. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise, that is:
  14108. @example
  14109. L.R R.r
  14110. . . -> . .
  14111. l.r L.l
  14112. @end example
  14113. @item 3, 7, clock_flip
  14114. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip, that is:
  14115. @example
  14116. L.R r.R
  14117. . . -> . .
  14118. l.r l.L
  14119. @end example
  14120. @end table
  14121. For values between 4-7, the transposition is only done if the input
  14122. video geometry is portrait and not landscape. These values are
  14123. deprecated, the @code{passthrough} option should be used instead.
  14124. Numerical values are deprecated, and should be dropped in favor of
  14125. symbolic constants.
  14126. @item passthrough
  14127. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14128. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14129. @table @samp
  14130. @item none
  14131. Always apply transposition.
  14132. @item portrait
  14133. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14134. @item landscape
  14135. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14136. @end table
  14137. Default value is @code{none}.
  14138. @end table
  14139. For example to rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and preserve portrait
  14140. layout:
  14141. @example
  14142. transpose=dir=1:passthrough=portrait
  14143. @end example
  14144. The command above can also be specified as:
  14145. @example
  14146. transpose=1:portrait
  14147. @end example
  14148. @section transpose_npp
  14149. Transpose rows with columns in the input video and optionally flip it.
  14150. For more in depth examples see the @ref{transpose} video filter, which shares mostly the same options.
  14151. It accepts the following parameters:
  14152. @table @option
  14153. @item dir
  14154. Specify the transposition direction.
  14155. Can assume the following values:
  14156. @table @samp
  14157. @item cclock_flip
  14158. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise and vertically flip. (default)
  14159. @item clock
  14160. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise.
  14161. @item cclock
  14162. Rotate by 90 degrees counterclockwise.
  14163. @item clock_flip
  14164. Rotate by 90 degrees clockwise and vertically flip.
  14165. @end table
  14166. @item passthrough
  14167. Do not apply the transposition if the input geometry matches the one
  14168. specified by the specified value. It accepts the following values:
  14169. @table @samp
  14170. @item none
  14171. Always apply transposition. (default)
  14172. @item portrait
  14173. Preserve portrait geometry (when @var{height} >= @var{width}).
  14174. @item landscape
  14175. Preserve landscape geometry (when @var{width} >= @var{height}).
  14176. @end table
  14177. @end table
  14178. @section trim
  14179. Trim the input so that the output contains one continuous subpart of the input.
  14180. It accepts the following parameters:
  14181. @table @option
  14182. @item start
  14183. Specify the time of the start of the kept section, i.e. the frame with the
  14184. timestamp @var{start} will be the first frame in the output.
  14185. @item end
  14186. Specify the time of the first frame that will be dropped, i.e. the frame
  14187. immediately preceding the one with the timestamp @var{end} will be the last
  14188. frame in the output.
  14189. @item start_pts
  14190. This is the same as @var{start}, except this option sets the start timestamp
  14191. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14192. @item end_pts
  14193. This is the same as @var{end}, except this option sets the end timestamp
  14194. in timebase units instead of seconds.
  14195. @item duration
  14196. The maximum duration of the output in seconds.
  14197. @item start_frame
  14198. The number of the first frame that should be passed to the output.
  14199. @item end_frame
  14200. The number of the first frame that should be dropped.
  14201. @end table
  14202. @option{start}, @option{end}, and @option{duration} are expressed as time
  14203. duration specifications; see
  14204. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  14205. for the accepted syntax.
  14206. Note that the first two sets of the start/end options and the @option{duration}
  14207. option look at the frame timestamp, while the _frame variants simply count the
  14208. frames that pass through the filter. Also note that this filter does not modify
  14209. the timestamps. If you wish for the output timestamps to start at zero, insert a
  14210. setpts filter after the trim filter.
  14211. If multiple start or end options are set, this filter tries to be greedy and
  14212. keep all the frames that match at least one of the specified constraints. To keep
  14213. only the part that matches all the constraints at once, chain multiple trim
  14214. filters.
  14215. The defaults are such that all the input is kept. So it is possible to set e.g.
  14216. just the end values to keep everything before the specified time.
  14217. Examples:
  14218. @itemize
  14219. @item
  14220. Drop everything except the second minute of input:
  14221. @example
  14222. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=60:120
  14223. @end example
  14224. @item
  14225. Keep only the first second:
  14226. @example
  14227. ffmpeg -i INPUT -vf trim=duration=1
  14228. @end example
  14229. @end itemize
  14230. @section unpremultiply
  14231. Apply alpha unpremultiply effect to input video stream using first plane
  14232. of second stream as alpha.
  14233. Both streams must have same dimensions and same pixel format.
  14234. The filter accepts the following option:
  14235. @table @option
  14236. @item planes
  14237. Set which planes will be processed, unprocessed planes will be copied.
  14238. By default value 0xf, all planes will be processed.
  14239. If the format has 1 or 2 components, then luma is bit 0.
  14240. If the format has 3 or 4 components:
  14241. for RGB formats bit 0 is green, bit 1 is blue and bit 2 is red;
  14242. for YUV formats bit 0 is luma, bit 1 is chroma-U and bit 2 is chroma-V.
  14243. If present, the alpha channel is always the last bit.
  14244. @item inplace
  14245. Do not require 2nd input for processing, instead use alpha plane from input stream.
  14246. @end table
  14247. @anchor{unsharp}
  14248. @section unsharp
  14249. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  14250. It accepts the following parameters:
  14251. @table @option
  14252. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  14253. Set the luma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer between
  14254. 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14255. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  14256. Set the luma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer between 3
  14257. and 23. The default value is 5.
  14258. @item luma_amount, la
  14259. Set the luma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14260. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14261. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14262. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14263. Default value is 1.0.
  14264. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  14265. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size. It must be an odd integer
  14266. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14267. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  14268. Set the chroma matrix vertical size. It must be an odd integer
  14269. between 3 and 23. The default value is 5.
  14270. @item chroma_amount, ca
  14271. Set the chroma effect strength. It must be a floating point number, reasonable
  14272. values lay between -1.5 and 1.5.
  14273. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  14274. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  14275. Default value is 0.0.
  14276. @end table
  14277. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  14278. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  14279. @subsection Examples
  14280. @itemize
  14281. @item
  14282. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  14283. @example
  14284. unsharp=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5
  14285. @end example
  14286. @item
  14287. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  14288. @example
  14289. unsharp=7:7:-2:7:7:-2
  14290. @end example
  14291. @end itemize
  14292. @section uspp
  14293. Apply ultra slow/simple postprocessing filter that compresses and decompresses
  14294. the image at several (or - in the case of @option{quality} level @code{8} - all)
  14295. shifts and average the results.
  14296. The way this differs from the behavior of spp is that uspp actually encodes &
  14297. decodes each case with libavcodec Snow, whereas spp uses a simplified intra only 8x8
  14298. DCT similar to MJPEG.
  14299. The filter accepts the following options:
  14300. @table @option
  14301. @item quality
  14302. Set quality. This option defines the number of levels for averaging. It accepts
  14303. an integer in the range 0-8. If set to @code{0}, the filter will have no
  14304. effect. A value of @code{8} means the higher quality. For each increment of
  14305. that value the speed drops by a factor of approximately 2. Default value is
  14306. @code{3}.
  14307. @item qp
  14308. Force a constant quantization parameter. If not set, the filter will use the QP
  14309. from the video stream (if available).
  14310. @end table
  14311. @section v360
  14312. Convert 360 videos between various formats.
  14313. The filter accepts the following options:
  14314. @table @option
  14315. @item input
  14316. @item output
  14317. Set format of the input/output video.
  14318. Available formats:
  14319. @table @samp
  14320. @item e
  14321. @item equirect
  14322. Equirectangular projection.
  14323. @item c3x2
  14324. @item c6x1
  14325. @item c1x6
  14326. Cubemap with 3x2/6x1/1x6 layout.
  14327. Format specific options:
  14328. @table @option
  14329. @item in_pad
  14330. @item out_pad
  14331. Set padding proportion for the input/output cubemap. Values in decimals.
  14332. Example values:
  14333. @table @samp
  14334. @item 0
  14335. No padding.
  14336. @item 0.01
  14337. 1% of face is padding. For example, with 1920x1280 resolution face size would be 640x640 and padding would be 3 pixels from each side. (640 * 0.01 = 6 pixels)
  14338. @end table
  14339. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14340. @item fin_pad
  14341. @item fout_pad
  14342. Set fixed padding for the input/output cubemap. Values in pixels.
  14343. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}. If greater than zero it overrides other padding options.
  14344. @item in_forder
  14345. @item out_forder
  14346. Set order of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one direction for each position.
  14347. Designation of directions:
  14348. @table @samp
  14349. @item r
  14350. right
  14351. @item l
  14352. left
  14353. @item u
  14354. up
  14355. @item d
  14356. down
  14357. @item f
  14358. forward
  14359. @item b
  14360. back
  14361. @end table
  14362. Default value is @b{@samp{rludfb}}.
  14363. @item in_frot
  14364. @item out_frot
  14365. Set rotation of faces for the input/output cubemap. Choose one angle for each position.
  14366. Designation of angles:
  14367. @table @samp
  14368. @item 0
  14369. 0 degrees clockwise
  14370. @item 1
  14371. 90 degrees clockwise
  14372. @item 2
  14373. 180 degrees clockwise
  14374. @item 3
  14375. 270 degrees clockwise
  14376. @end table
  14377. Default value is @b{@samp{000000}}.
  14378. @end table
  14379. @item eac
  14380. Equi-Angular Cubemap.
  14381. @item flat
  14382. @item gnomonic
  14383. @item rectilinear
  14384. Regular video.
  14385. Format specific options:
  14386. @table @option
  14387. @item h_fov
  14388. @item v_fov
  14389. @item d_fov
  14390. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14391. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14392. @item ih_fov
  14393. @item iv_fov
  14394. @item id_fov
  14395. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14396. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14397. @end table
  14398. @item dfisheye
  14399. Dual fisheye.
  14400. Format specific options:
  14401. @table @option
  14402. @item in_pad
  14403. @item out_pad
  14404. Set padding proportion. Values in decimals.
  14405. Example values:
  14406. @table @samp
  14407. @item 0
  14408. No padding.
  14409. @item 0.01
  14410. 1% padding.
  14411. @end table
  14412. Default value is @b{@samp{0}}.
  14413. @end table
  14414. @item barrel
  14415. @item fb
  14416. Facebook's 360 format.
  14417. @item sg
  14418. Stereographic format.
  14419. Format specific options:
  14420. @table @option
  14421. @item h_fov
  14422. @item v_fov
  14423. @item d_fov
  14424. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14425. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14426. @item ih_fov
  14427. @item iv_fov
  14428. @item id_fov
  14429. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14430. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14431. @end table
  14432. @item mercator
  14433. Mercator format.
  14434. @item ball
  14435. Ball format, gives significant distortion toward the back.
  14436. @item hammer
  14437. Hammer-Aitoff map projection format.
  14438. @item sinusoidal
  14439. Sinusoidal map projection format.
  14440. @item fisheye
  14441. Fisheye projection.
  14442. Format specific options:
  14443. @table @option
  14444. @item h_fov
  14445. @item v_fov
  14446. @item d_fov
  14447. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14448. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14449. @item ih_fov
  14450. @item iv_fov
  14451. @item id_fov
  14452. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14453. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14454. @end table
  14455. @item pannini
  14456. Pannini projection. @i{(output only)}
  14457. Format specific options:
  14458. @table @option
  14459. @item h_fov
  14460. Set pannini parameter.
  14461. @end table
  14462. @item cylindrical
  14463. Cylindrical projection.
  14464. Format specific options:
  14465. @table @option
  14466. @item h_fov
  14467. @item v_fov
  14468. @item d_fov
  14469. Set output horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14470. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14471. @item ih_fov
  14472. @item iv_fov
  14473. @item id_fov
  14474. Set input horizontal/vertical/diagonal field of view. Values in degrees.
  14475. If diagonal field of view is set it overrides horizontal and vertical field of view.
  14476. @end table
  14477. @item perspective
  14478. Perspective projection. @i{(output only)}
  14479. Format specific options:
  14480. @table @option
  14481. @item v_fov
  14482. Set perspective parameter.
  14483. @end table
  14484. @item tetrahedron
  14485. Tetrahedron projection.
  14486. @end table
  14487. @item interp
  14488. Set interpolation method.@*
  14489. @i{Note: more complex interpolation methods require much more memory to run.}
  14490. Available methods:
  14491. @table @samp
  14492. @item near
  14493. @item nearest
  14494. Nearest neighbour.
  14495. @item line
  14496. @item linear
  14497. Bilinear interpolation.
  14498. @item cube
  14499. @item cubic
  14500. Bicubic interpolation.
  14501. @item lanc
  14502. @item lanczos
  14503. Lanczos interpolation.
  14504. @item sp16
  14505. @item spline16
  14506. Spline16 interpolation.
  14507. @item gauss
  14508. @item gaussian
  14509. Gaussian interpolation.
  14510. @end table
  14511. Default value is @b{@samp{line}}.
  14512. @item w
  14513. @item h
  14514. Set the output video resolution.
  14515. Default resolution depends on formats.
  14516. @item in_stereo
  14517. @item out_stereo
  14518. Set the input/output stereo format.
  14519. @table @samp
  14520. @item 2d
  14521. 2D mono
  14522. @item sbs
  14523. Side by side
  14524. @item tb
  14525. Top bottom
  14526. @end table
  14527. Default value is @b{@samp{2d}} for input and output format.
  14528. @item yaw
  14529. @item pitch
  14530. @item roll
  14531. Set rotation for the output video. Values in degrees.
  14532. @item rorder
  14533. Set rotation order for the output video. Choose one item for each position.
  14534. @table @samp
  14535. @item y, Y
  14536. yaw
  14537. @item p, P
  14538. pitch
  14539. @item r, R
  14540. roll
  14541. @end table
  14542. Default value is @b{@samp{ypr}}.
  14543. @item h_flip
  14544. @item v_flip
  14545. @item d_flip
  14546. Flip the output video horizontally(swaps left-right)/vertically(swaps up-down)/in-depth(swaps back-forward). Boolean values.
  14547. @item ih_flip
  14548. @item iv_flip
  14549. Set if input video is flipped horizontally/vertically. Boolean values.
  14550. @item in_trans
  14551. Set if input video is transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14552. @item out_trans
  14553. Set if output video needs to be transposed. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14554. @item alpha_mask
  14555. Build mask in alpha plane for all unmapped pixels by marking them fully transparent. Boolean value, by default disabled.
  14556. @end table
  14557. @subsection Examples
  14558. @itemize
  14559. @item
  14560. Convert equirectangular video to cubemap with 3x2 layout and 1% padding using bicubic interpolation:
  14561. @example
  14562. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=e:c3x2:cubic:out_pad=0.01 output.mkv
  14563. @end example
  14564. @item
  14565. Extract back view of Equi-Angular Cubemap:
  14566. @example
  14567. ffmpeg -i input.mkv -vf v360=eac:flat:yaw=180 output.mkv
  14568. @end example
  14569. @item
  14570. Convert transposed and horizontally flipped Equi-Angular Cubemap in side-by-side stereo format to equirectangular top-bottom stereo format:
  14571. @example
  14572. v360=eac:equirect:in_stereo=sbs:in_trans=1:ih_flip=1:out_stereo=tb
  14573. @end example
  14574. @end itemize
  14575. @section vaguedenoiser
  14576. Apply a wavelet based denoiser.
  14577. It transforms each frame from the video input into the wavelet domain,
  14578. using Cohen-Daubechies-Feauveau 9/7. Then it applies some filtering to
  14579. the obtained coefficients. It does an inverse wavelet transform after.
  14580. Due to wavelet properties, it should give a nice smoothed result, and
  14581. reduced noise, without blurring picture features.
  14582. This filter accepts the following options:
  14583. @table @option
  14584. @item threshold
  14585. The filtering strength. The higher, the more filtered the video will be.
  14586. Hard thresholding can use a higher threshold than soft thresholding
  14587. before the video looks overfiltered. Default value is 2.
  14588. @item method
  14589. The filtering method the filter will use.
  14590. It accepts the following values:
  14591. @table @samp
  14592. @item hard
  14593. All values under the threshold will be zeroed.
  14594. @item soft
  14595. All values under the threshold will be zeroed. All values above will be
  14596. reduced by the threshold.
  14597. @item garrote
  14598. Scales or nullifies coefficients - intermediary between (more) soft and
  14599. (less) hard thresholding.
  14600. @end table
  14601. Default is garrote.
  14602. @item nsteps
  14603. Number of times, the wavelet will decompose the picture. Picture can't
  14604. be decomposed beyond a particular point (typically, 8 for a 640x480
  14605. frame - as 2^9 = 512 > 480). Valid values are integers between 1 and 32. Default value is 6.
  14606. @item percent
  14607. Partial of full denoising (limited coefficients shrinking), from 0 to 100. Default value is 85.
  14608. @item planes
  14609. A list of the planes to process. By default all planes are processed.
  14610. @end table
  14611. @section vectorscope
  14612. Display 2 color component values in the two dimensional graph (which is called
  14613. a vectorscope).
  14614. This filter accepts the following options:
  14615. @table @option
  14616. @item mode, m
  14617. Set vectorscope mode.
  14618. It accepts the following values:
  14619. @table @samp
  14620. @item gray
  14621. @item tint
  14622. Gray values are displayed on graph, higher brightness means more pixels have
  14623. same component color value on location in graph. This is the default mode.
  14624. @item color
  14625. Gray values are displayed on graph. Surrounding pixels values which are not
  14626. present in video frame are drawn in gradient of 2 color components which are
  14627. set by option @code{x} and @code{y}. The 3rd color component is static.
  14628. @item color2
  14629. Actual color components values present in video frame are displayed on graph.
  14630. @item color3
  14631. Similar as color2 but higher frequency of same values @code{x} and @code{y}
  14632. on graph increases value of another color component, which is luminance by
  14633. default values of @code{x} and @code{y}.
  14634. @item color4
  14635. Actual colors present in video frame are displayed on graph. If two different
  14636. colors map to same position on graph then color with higher value of component
  14637. not present in graph is picked.
  14638. @item color5
  14639. Gray values are displayed on graph. Similar to @code{color} but with 3rd color
  14640. component picked from radial gradient.
  14641. @end table
  14642. @item x
  14643. Set which color component will be represented on X-axis. Default is @code{1}.
  14644. @item y
  14645. Set which color component will be represented on Y-axis. Default is @code{2}.
  14646. @item intensity, i
  14647. Set intensity, used by modes: gray, color, color3 and color5 for increasing brightness
  14648. of color component which represents frequency of (X, Y) location in graph.
  14649. @item envelope, e
  14650. @table @samp
  14651. @item none
  14652. No envelope, this is default.
  14653. @item instant
  14654. Instant envelope, even darkest single pixel will be clearly highlighted.
  14655. @item peak
  14656. Hold maximum and minimum values presented in graph over time. This way you
  14657. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at vectorscope.
  14658. @item peak+instant
  14659. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  14660. @end table
  14661. @item graticule, g
  14662. Set what kind of graticule to draw.
  14663. @table @samp
  14664. @item none
  14665. @item green
  14666. @item color
  14667. @item invert
  14668. @end table
  14669. @item opacity, o
  14670. Set graticule opacity.
  14671. @item flags, f
  14672. Set graticule flags.
  14673. @table @samp
  14674. @item white
  14675. Draw graticule for white point.
  14676. @item black
  14677. Draw graticule for black point.
  14678. @item name
  14679. Draw color points short names.
  14680. @end table
  14681. @item bgopacity, b
  14682. Set background opacity.
  14683. @item lthreshold, l
  14684. Set low threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14685. Values lower than this value will be ignored. Default is 0.
  14686. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14687. can have. So for 8-bit input and low threshold value of 0.1 actual threshold
  14688. is 0.1 * 255 = 25.
  14689. @item hthreshold, h
  14690. Set high threshold for color component not represented on X or Y axis.
  14691. Values higher than this value will be ignored. Default is 1.
  14692. Note this value is multiplied with actual max possible value one pixel component
  14693. can have. So for 8-bit input and high threshold value of 0.9 actual threshold
  14694. is 0.9 * 255 = 230.
  14695. @item colorspace, c
  14696. Set what kind of colorspace to use when drawing graticule.
  14697. @table @samp
  14698. @item auto
  14699. @item 601
  14700. @item 709
  14701. @end table
  14702. Default is auto.
  14703. @item tint0, t0
  14704. @item tint1, t1
  14705. Set color tint for gray/tint vectorscope mode. By default both options are zero.
  14706. This means no tint, and output will remain gray.
  14707. @end table
  14708. @anchor{vidstabdetect}
  14709. @section vidstabdetect
  14710. Analyze video stabilization/deshaking. Perform pass 1 of 2, see
  14711. @ref{vidstabtransform} for pass 2.
  14712. This filter generates a file with relative translation and rotation
  14713. transform information about subsequent frames, which is then used by
  14714. the @ref{vidstabtransform} filter.
  14715. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14716. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14717. This filter accepts the following options:
  14718. @table @option
  14719. @item result
  14720. Set the path to the file used to write the transforms information.
  14721. Default value is @file{transforms.trf}.
  14722. @item shakiness
  14723. Set how shaky the video is and how quick the camera is. It accepts an
  14724. integer in the range 1-10, a value of 1 means little shakiness, a
  14725. value of 10 means strong shakiness. Default value is 5.
  14726. @item accuracy
  14727. Set the accuracy of the detection process. It must be a value in the
  14728. range 1-15. A value of 1 means low accuracy, a value of 15 means high
  14729. accuracy. Default value is 15.
  14730. @item stepsize
  14731. Set stepsize of the search process. The region around minimum is
  14732. scanned with 1 pixel resolution. Default value is 6.
  14733. @item mincontrast
  14734. Set minimum contrast. Below this value a local measurement field is
  14735. discarded. Must be a floating point value in the range 0-1. Default
  14736. value is 0.3.
  14737. @item tripod
  14738. Set reference frame number for tripod mode.
  14739. If enabled, the motion of the frames is compared to a reference frame
  14740. in the filtered stream, identified by the specified number. The idea
  14741. is to compensate all movements in a more-or-less static scene and keep
  14742. the camera view absolutely still.
  14743. If set to 0, it is disabled. The frames are counted starting from 1.
  14744. @item show
  14745. Show fields and transforms in the resulting frames. It accepts an
  14746. integer in the range 0-2. Default value is 0, which disables any
  14747. visualization.
  14748. @end table
  14749. @subsection Examples
  14750. @itemize
  14751. @item
  14752. Use default values:
  14753. @example
  14754. vidstabdetect
  14755. @end example
  14756. @item
  14757. Analyze strongly shaky movie and put the results in file
  14758. @file{mytransforms.trf}:
  14759. @example
  14760. vidstabdetect=shakiness=10:accuracy=15:result="mytransforms.trf"
  14761. @end example
  14762. @item
  14763. Visualize the result of internal transformations in the resulting
  14764. video:
  14765. @example
  14766. vidstabdetect=show=1
  14767. @end example
  14768. @item
  14769. Analyze a video with medium shakiness using @command{ffmpeg}:
  14770. @example
  14771. ffmpeg -i input -vf vidstabdetect=shakiness=5:show=1 dummy.avi
  14772. @end example
  14773. @end itemize
  14774. @anchor{vidstabtransform}
  14775. @section vidstabtransform
  14776. Video stabilization/deshaking: pass 2 of 2,
  14777. see @ref{vidstabdetect} for pass 1.
  14778. Read a file with transform information for each frame and
  14779. apply/compensate them. Together with the @ref{vidstabdetect}
  14780. filter this can be used to deshake videos. See also
  14781. @url{http://public.hronopik.de/vid.stab}. It is important to also use
  14782. the @ref{unsharp} filter, see below.
  14783. To enable compilation of this filter you need to configure FFmpeg with
  14784. @code{--enable-libvidstab}.
  14785. @subsection Options
  14786. @table @option
  14787. @item input
  14788. Set path to the file used to read the transforms. Default value is
  14789. @file{transforms.trf}.
  14790. @item smoothing
  14791. Set the number of frames (value*2 + 1) used for lowpass filtering the
  14792. camera movements. Default value is 10.
  14793. For example a number of 10 means that 21 frames are used (10 in the
  14794. past and 10 in the future) to smoothen the motion in the video. A
  14795. larger value leads to a smoother video, but limits the acceleration of
  14796. the camera (pan/tilt movements). 0 is a special case where a static
  14797. camera is simulated.
  14798. @item optalgo
  14799. Set the camera path optimization algorithm.
  14800. Accepted values are:
  14801. @table @samp
  14802. @item gauss
  14803. gaussian kernel low-pass filter on camera motion (default)
  14804. @item avg
  14805. averaging on transformations
  14806. @end table
  14807. @item maxshift
  14808. Set maximal number of pixels to translate frames. Default value is -1,
  14809. meaning no limit.
  14810. @item maxangle
  14811. Set maximal angle in radians (degree*PI/180) to rotate frames. Default
  14812. value is -1, meaning no limit.
  14813. @item crop
  14814. Specify how to deal with borders that may be visible due to movement
  14815. compensation.
  14816. Available values are:
  14817. @table @samp
  14818. @item keep
  14819. keep image information from previous frame (default)
  14820. @item black
  14821. fill the border black
  14822. @end table
  14823. @item invert
  14824. Invert transforms if set to 1. Default value is 0.
  14825. @item relative
  14826. Consider transforms as relative to previous frame if set to 1,
  14827. absolute if set to 0. Default value is 0.
  14828. @item zoom
  14829. Set percentage to zoom. A positive value will result in a zoom-in
  14830. effect, a negative value in a zoom-out effect. Default value is 0 (no
  14831. zoom).
  14832. @item optzoom
  14833. Set optimal zooming to avoid borders.
  14834. Accepted values are:
  14835. @table @samp
  14836. @item 0
  14837. disabled
  14838. @item 1
  14839. optimal static zoom value is determined (only very strong movements
  14840. will lead to visible borders) (default)
  14841. @item 2
  14842. optimal adaptive zoom value is determined (no borders will be
  14843. visible), see @option{zoomspeed}
  14844. @end table
  14845. Note that the value given at zoom is added to the one calculated here.
  14846. @item zoomspeed
  14847. Set percent to zoom maximally each frame (enabled when
  14848. @option{optzoom} is set to 2). Range is from 0 to 5, default value is
  14849. 0.25.
  14850. @item interpol
  14851. Specify type of interpolation.
  14852. Available values are:
  14853. @table @samp
  14854. @item no
  14855. no interpolation
  14856. @item linear
  14857. linear only horizontal
  14858. @item bilinear
  14859. linear in both directions (default)
  14860. @item bicubic
  14861. cubic in both directions (slow)
  14862. @end table
  14863. @item tripod
  14864. Enable virtual tripod mode if set to 1, which is equivalent to
  14865. @code{relative=0:smoothing=0}. Default value is 0.
  14866. Use also @code{tripod} option of @ref{vidstabdetect}.
  14867. @item debug
  14868. Increase log verbosity if set to 1. Also the detected global motions
  14869. are written to the temporary file @file{global_motions.trf}. Default
  14870. value is 0.
  14871. @end table
  14872. @subsection Examples
  14873. @itemize
  14874. @item
  14875. Use @command{ffmpeg} for a typical stabilization with default values:
  14876. @example
  14877. ffmpeg -i inp.mpeg -vf vidstabtransform,unsharp=5:5:0.8:3:3:0.4 inp_stabilized.mpeg
  14878. @end example
  14879. Note the use of the @ref{unsharp} filter which is always recommended.
  14880. @item
  14881. Zoom in a bit more and load transform data from a given file:
  14882. @example
  14883. vidstabtransform=zoom=5:input="mytransforms.trf"
  14884. @end example
  14885. @item
  14886. Smoothen the video even more:
  14887. @example
  14888. vidstabtransform=smoothing=30
  14889. @end example
  14890. @end itemize
  14891. @section vflip
  14892. Flip the input video vertically.
  14893. For example, to vertically flip a video with @command{ffmpeg}:
  14894. @example
  14895. ffmpeg -i in.avi -vf "vflip" out.avi
  14896. @end example
  14897. @section vfrdet
  14898. Detect variable frame rate video.
  14899. This filter tries to detect if the input is variable or constant frame rate.
  14900. At end it will output number of frames detected as having variable delta pts,
  14901. and ones with constant delta pts.
  14902. If there was frames with variable delta, than it will also show min, max and
  14903. average delta encountered.
  14904. @section vibrance
  14905. Boost or alter saturation.
  14906. The filter accepts the following options:
  14907. @table @option
  14908. @item intensity
  14909. Set strength of boost if positive value or strength of alter if negative value.
  14910. Default is 0. Allowed range is from -2 to 2.
  14911. @item rbal
  14912. Set the red balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14913. @item gbal
  14914. Set the green balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14915. @item bbal
  14916. Set the blue balance. Default is 1. Allowed range is from -10 to 10.
  14917. @item rlum
  14918. Set the red luma coefficient.
  14919. @item glum
  14920. Set the green luma coefficient.
  14921. @item blum
  14922. Set the blue luma coefficient.
  14923. @item alternate
  14924. If @code{intensity} is negative and this is set to 1, colors will change,
  14925. otherwise colors will be less saturated, more towards gray.
  14926. @end table
  14927. @subsection Commands
  14928. This filter supports the all above options as @ref{commands}.
  14929. @anchor{vignette}
  14930. @section vignette
  14931. Make or reverse a natural vignetting effect.
  14932. The filter accepts the following options:
  14933. @table @option
  14934. @item angle, a
  14935. Set lens angle expression as a number of radians.
  14936. The value is clipped in the @code{[0,PI/2]} range.
  14937. Default value: @code{"PI/5"}
  14938. @item x0
  14939. @item y0
  14940. Set center coordinates expressions. Respectively @code{"w/2"} and @code{"h/2"}
  14941. by default.
  14942. @item mode
  14943. Set forward/backward mode.
  14944. Available modes are:
  14945. @table @samp
  14946. @item forward
  14947. The larger the distance from the central point, the darker the image becomes.
  14948. @item backward
  14949. The larger the distance from the central point, the brighter the image becomes.
  14950. This can be used to reverse a vignette effect, though there is no automatic
  14951. detection to extract the lens @option{angle} and other settings (yet). It can
  14952. also be used to create a burning effect.
  14953. @end table
  14954. Default value is @samp{forward}.
  14955. @item eval
  14956. Set evaluation mode for the expressions (@option{angle}, @option{x0}, @option{y0}).
  14957. It accepts the following values:
  14958. @table @samp
  14959. @item init
  14960. Evaluate expressions only once during the filter initialization.
  14961. @item frame
  14962. Evaluate expressions for each incoming frame. This is way slower than the
  14963. @samp{init} mode since it requires all the scalers to be re-computed, but it
  14964. allows advanced dynamic expressions.
  14965. @end table
  14966. Default value is @samp{init}.
  14967. @item dither
  14968. Set dithering to reduce the circular banding effects. Default is @code{1}
  14969. (enabled).
  14970. @item aspect
  14971. Set vignette aspect. This setting allows one to adjust the shape of the vignette.
  14972. Setting this value to the SAR of the input will make a rectangular vignetting
  14973. following the dimensions of the video.
  14974. Default is @code{1/1}.
  14975. @end table
  14976. @subsection Expressions
  14977. The @option{alpha}, @option{x0} and @option{y0} expressions can contain the
  14978. following parameters.
  14979. @table @option
  14980. @item w
  14981. @item h
  14982. input width and height
  14983. @item n
  14984. the number of input frame, starting from 0
  14985. @item pts
  14986. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) time of the filtered video frame, expressed in
  14987. @var{TB} units, NAN if undefined
  14988. @item r
  14989. frame rate of the input video, NAN if the input frame rate is unknown
  14990. @item t
  14991. the PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  14992. expressed in seconds, NAN if undefined
  14993. @item tb
  14994. time base of the input video
  14995. @end table
  14996. @subsection Examples
  14997. @itemize
  14998. @item
  14999. Apply simple strong vignetting effect:
  15000. @example
  15001. vignette=PI/4
  15002. @end example
  15003. @item
  15004. Make a flickering vignetting:
  15005. @example
  15006. vignette='PI/4+random(1)*PI/50':eval=frame
  15007. @end example
  15008. @end itemize
  15009. @section vmafmotion
  15010. Obtain the average VMAF motion score of a video.
  15011. It is one of the component metrics of VMAF.
  15012. The obtained average motion score is printed through the logging system.
  15013. The filter accepts the following options:
  15014. @table @option
  15015. @item stats_file
  15016. If specified, the filter will use the named file to save the motion score of
  15017. each frame with respect to the previous frame.
  15018. When filename equals "-" the data is sent to standard output.
  15019. @end table
  15020. Example:
  15021. @example
  15022. ffmpeg -i ref.mpg -vf vmafmotion -f null -
  15023. @end example
  15024. @section vstack
  15025. Stack input videos vertically.
  15026. All streams must be of same pixel format and of same width.
  15027. Note that this filter is faster than using @ref{overlay} and @ref{pad} filter
  15028. to create same output.
  15029. The filter accepts the following options:
  15030. @table @option
  15031. @item inputs
  15032. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15033. @item shortest
  15034. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15035. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15036. @end table
  15037. @section w3fdif
  15038. Deinterlace the input video ("w3fdif" stands for "Weston 3 Field
  15039. Deinterlacing Filter").
  15040. Based on the process described by Martin Weston for BBC R&D, and
  15041. implemented based on the de-interlace algorithm written by Jim
  15042. Easterbrook for BBC R&D, the Weston 3 field deinterlacing filter
  15043. uses filter coefficients calculated by BBC R&D.
  15044. This filter uses field-dominance information in frame to decide which
  15045. of each pair of fields to place first in the output.
  15046. If it gets it wrong use @ref{setfield} filter before @code{w3fdif} filter.
  15047. There are two sets of filter coefficients, so called "simple"
  15048. and "complex". Which set of filter coefficients is used can
  15049. be set by passing an optional parameter:
  15050. @table @option
  15051. @item filter
  15052. Set the interlacing filter coefficients. Accepts one of the following values:
  15053. @table @samp
  15054. @item simple
  15055. Simple filter coefficient set.
  15056. @item complex
  15057. More-complex filter coefficient set.
  15058. @end table
  15059. Default value is @samp{complex}.
  15060. @item deint
  15061. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following values:
  15062. @table @samp
  15063. @item all
  15064. Deinterlace all frames,
  15065. @item interlaced
  15066. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15067. @end table
  15068. Default value is @samp{all}.
  15069. @end table
  15070. @section waveform
  15071. Video waveform monitor.
  15072. The waveform monitor plots color component intensity. By default luminance
  15073. only. Each column of the waveform corresponds to a column of pixels in the
  15074. source video.
  15075. It accepts the following options:
  15076. @table @option
  15077. @item mode, m
  15078. Can be either @code{row}, or @code{column}. Default is @code{column}.
  15079. In row mode, the graph on the left side represents color component value 0 and
  15080. the right side represents value = 255. In column mode, the top side represents
  15081. color component value = 0 and bottom side represents value = 255.
  15082. @item intensity, i
  15083. Set intensity. Smaller values are useful to find out how many values of the same
  15084. luminance are distributed across input rows/columns.
  15085. Default value is @code{0.04}. Allowed range is [0, 1].
  15086. @item mirror, r
  15087. Set mirroring mode. @code{0} means unmirrored, @code{1} means mirrored.
  15088. In mirrored mode, higher values will be represented on the left
  15089. side for @code{row} mode and at the top for @code{column} mode. Default is
  15090. @code{1} (mirrored).
  15091. @item display, d
  15092. Set display mode.
  15093. It accepts the following values:
  15094. @table @samp
  15095. @item overlay
  15096. Presents information identical to that in the @code{parade}, except
  15097. that the graphs representing color components are superimposed directly
  15098. over one another.
  15099. This display mode makes it easier to spot relative differences or similarities
  15100. in overlapping areas of the color components that are supposed to be identical,
  15101. such as neutral whites, grays, or blacks.
  15102. @item stack
  15103. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15104. @code{row} mode or one below the other in @code{column} mode.
  15105. @item parade
  15106. Display separate graph for the color components side by side in
  15107. @code{column} mode or one below the other in @code{row} mode.
  15108. Using this display mode makes it easy to spot color casts in the highlights
  15109. and shadows of an image, by comparing the contours of the top and the bottom
  15110. graphs of each waveform. Since whites, grays, and blacks are characterized
  15111. by exactly equal amounts of red, green, and blue, neutral areas of the picture
  15112. should display three waveforms of roughly equal width/height. If not, the
  15113. correction is easy to perform by making level adjustments the three waveforms.
  15114. @end table
  15115. Default is @code{stack}.
  15116. @item components, c
  15117. Set which color components to display. Default is 1, which means only luminance
  15118. or red color component if input is in RGB colorspace. If is set for example to
  15119. 7 it will display all 3 (if) available color components.
  15120. @item envelope, e
  15121. @table @samp
  15122. @item none
  15123. No envelope, this is default.
  15124. @item instant
  15125. Instant envelope, minimum and maximum values presented in graph will be easily
  15126. visible even with small @code{step} value.
  15127. @item peak
  15128. Hold minimum and maximum values presented in graph across time. This way you
  15129. can still spot out of range values without constantly looking at waveforms.
  15130. @item peak+instant
  15131. Peak and instant envelope combined together.
  15132. @end table
  15133. @item filter, f
  15134. @table @samp
  15135. @item lowpass
  15136. No filtering, this is default.
  15137. @item flat
  15138. Luma and chroma combined together.
  15139. @item aflat
  15140. Similar as above, but shows difference between blue and red chroma.
  15141. @item xflat
  15142. Similar as above, but use different colors.
  15143. @item yflat
  15144. Similar as above, but again with different colors.
  15145. @item chroma
  15146. Displays only chroma.
  15147. @item color
  15148. Displays actual color value on waveform.
  15149. @item acolor
  15150. Similar as above, but with luma showing frequency of chroma values.
  15151. @end table
  15152. @item graticule, g
  15153. Set which graticule to display.
  15154. @table @samp
  15155. @item none
  15156. Do not display graticule.
  15157. @item green
  15158. Display green graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15159. @item orange
  15160. Display orange graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15161. @item invert
  15162. Display invert graticule showing legal broadcast ranges.
  15163. @end table
  15164. @item opacity, o
  15165. Set graticule opacity.
  15166. @item flags, fl
  15167. Set graticule flags.
  15168. @table @samp
  15169. @item numbers
  15170. Draw numbers above lines. By default enabled.
  15171. @item dots
  15172. Draw dots instead of lines.
  15173. @end table
  15174. @item scale, s
  15175. Set scale used for displaying graticule.
  15176. @table @samp
  15177. @item digital
  15178. @item millivolts
  15179. @item ire
  15180. @end table
  15181. Default is digital.
  15182. @item bgopacity, b
  15183. Set background opacity.
  15184. @item tint0, t0
  15185. @item tint1, t1
  15186. Set tint for output.
  15187. Only used with lowpass filter and when display is not overlay and input
  15188. pixel formats are not RGB.
  15189. @end table
  15190. @section weave, doubleweave
  15191. The @code{weave} takes a field-based video input and join
  15192. each two sequential fields into single frame, producing a new double
  15193. height clip with half the frame rate and half the frame count.
  15194. The @code{doubleweave} works same as @code{weave} but without
  15195. halving frame rate and frame count.
  15196. It accepts the following option:
  15197. @table @option
  15198. @item first_field
  15199. Set first field. Available values are:
  15200. @table @samp
  15201. @item top, t
  15202. Set the frame as top-field-first.
  15203. @item bottom, b
  15204. Set the frame as bottom-field-first.
  15205. @end table
  15206. @end table
  15207. @subsection Examples
  15208. @itemize
  15209. @item
  15210. Interlace video using @ref{select} and @ref{separatefields} filter:
  15211. @example
  15212. separatefields,select=eq(mod(n,4),0)+eq(mod(n,4),3),weave
  15213. @end example
  15214. @end itemize
  15215. @section xbr
  15216. Apply the xBR high-quality magnification filter which is designed for pixel
  15217. art. It follows a set of edge-detection rules, see
  15218. @url{https://forums.libretro.com/t/xbr-algorithm-tutorial/123}.
  15219. It accepts the following option:
  15220. @table @option
  15221. @item n
  15222. Set the scaling dimension: @code{2} for @code{2xBR}, @code{3} for
  15223. @code{3xBR} and @code{4} for @code{4xBR}.
  15224. Default is @code{3}.
  15225. @end table
  15226. @section xfade
  15227. Apply cross fade from one input video stream to another input video stream.
  15228. The cross fade is applied for specified duration.
  15229. The filter accepts the following options:
  15230. @table @option
  15231. @item transition
  15232. Set one of available transition effects:
  15233. @table @samp
  15234. @item custom
  15235. @item fade
  15236. @item wipeleft
  15237. @item wiperight
  15238. @item wipeup
  15239. @item wipedown
  15240. @item slideleft
  15241. @item slideright
  15242. @item slideup
  15243. @item slidedown
  15244. @item circlecrop
  15245. @item rectcrop
  15246. @item distance
  15247. @item fadeblack
  15248. @item fadewhite
  15249. @item radial
  15250. @item smoothleft
  15251. @item smoothright
  15252. @item smoothup
  15253. @item smoothdown
  15254. @item circleopen
  15255. @item circleclose
  15256. @item vertopen
  15257. @item vertclose
  15258. @item horzopen
  15259. @item horzclose
  15260. @item dissolve
  15261. @item pixelize
  15262. @item diagtl
  15263. @item diagtr
  15264. @item diagbl
  15265. @item diagbr
  15266. @end table
  15267. Default transition effect is fade.
  15268. @item duration
  15269. Set cross fade duration in seconds.
  15270. Default duration is 1 second.
  15271. @item offset
  15272. Set cross fade start relative to first input stream in seconds.
  15273. Default offset is 0.
  15274. @item expr
  15275. Set expression for custom transition effect.
  15276. The expressions can use the following variables and functions:
  15277. @table @option
  15278. @item X
  15279. @item Y
  15280. The coordinates of the current sample.
  15281. @item W
  15282. @item H
  15283. The width and height of the image.
  15284. @item P
  15285. Progress of transition effect.
  15286. @item PLANE
  15287. Currently processed plane.
  15288. @item A
  15289. Return value of first input at current location and plane.
  15290. @item B
  15291. Return value of second input at current location and plane.
  15292. @item a0(x, y)
  15293. @item a1(x, y)
  15294. @item a2(x, y)
  15295. @item a3(x, y)
  15296. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15297. first/second/third/fourth component of first input.
  15298. @item b0(x, y)
  15299. @item b1(x, y)
  15300. @item b2(x, y)
  15301. @item b3(x, y)
  15302. Return the value of the pixel at location (@var{x},@var{y}) of the
  15303. first/second/third/fourth component of second input.
  15304. @end table
  15305. @end table
  15306. @subsection Examples
  15307. @itemize
  15308. @item
  15309. Cross fade from one input video to another input video, with fade transition and duration of transition
  15310. of 2 seconds starting at offset of 5 seconds:
  15311. @example
  15312. ffmpeg -i first.mp4 -i second.mp4 -filter_complex xfade=transition=fade:duration=2:offset=5 output.mp4
  15313. @end example
  15314. @end itemize
  15315. @section xmedian
  15316. Pick median pixels from several input videos.
  15317. The filter accepts the following options:
  15318. @table @option
  15319. @item inputs
  15320. Set number of inputs.
  15321. Default is 3. Allowed range is from 3 to 255.
  15322. If number of inputs is even number, than result will be mean value between two median values.
  15323. @item planes
  15324. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{15}, by which all planes are processed.
  15325. @item percentile
  15326. Set median percentile. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  15327. Default value of @code{0.5} will pick always median values, while @code{0} will pick
  15328. minimum values, and @code{1} maximum values.
  15329. @end table
  15330. @section xstack
  15331. Stack video inputs into custom layout.
  15332. All streams must be of same pixel format.
  15333. The filter accepts the following options:
  15334. @table @option
  15335. @item inputs
  15336. Set number of input streams. Default is 2.
  15337. @item layout
  15338. Specify layout of inputs.
  15339. This option requires the desired layout configuration to be explicitly set by the user.
  15340. This sets position of each video input in output. Each input
  15341. is separated by '|'.
  15342. The first number represents the column, and the second number represents the row.
  15343. Numbers start at 0 and are separated by '_'. Optionally one can use wX and hX,
  15344. where X is video input from which to take width or height.
  15345. Multiple values can be used when separated by '+'. In such
  15346. case values are summed together.
  15347. Note that if inputs are of different sizes gaps may appear, as not all of
  15348. the output video frame will be filled. Similarly, videos can overlap each
  15349. other if their position doesn't leave enough space for the full frame of
  15350. adjoining videos.
  15351. For 2 inputs, a default layout of @code{0_0|w0_0} is set. In all other cases,
  15352. a layout must be set by the user.
  15353. @item shortest
  15354. If set to 1, force the output to terminate when the shortest input
  15355. terminates. Default value is 0.
  15356. @item fill
  15357. If set to valid color, all unused pixels will be filled with that color.
  15358. By default fill is set to none, so it is disabled.
  15359. @end table
  15360. @subsection Examples
  15361. @itemize
  15362. @item
  15363. Display 4 inputs into 2x2 grid.
  15364. Layout:
  15365. @example
  15366. input1(0, 0) | input3(w0, 0)
  15367. input2(0, h0) | input4(w0, h0)
  15368. @end example
  15369. @example
  15370. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|w0_0|w0_h0
  15371. @end example
  15372. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15373. @item
  15374. Display 4 inputs into 1x4 grid.
  15375. Layout:
  15376. @example
  15377. input1(0, 0)
  15378. input2(0, h0)
  15379. input3(0, h0+h1)
  15380. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)
  15381. @end example
  15382. @example
  15383. xstack=inputs=4:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2
  15384. @end example
  15385. Note that if inputs are of different widths, unused space will appear.
  15386. @item
  15387. Display 9 inputs into 3x3 grid.
  15388. Layout:
  15389. @example
  15390. input1(0, 0) | input4(w0, 0) | input7(w0+w3, 0)
  15391. input2(0, h0) | input5(w0, h0) | input8(w0+w3, h0)
  15392. input3(0, h0+h1) | input6(w0, h0+h1) | input9(w0+w3, h0+h1)
  15393. @end example
  15394. @example
  15395. xstack=inputs=9:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0+w3_0|w0+w3_h0|w0+w3_h0+h1
  15396. @end example
  15397. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15398. @item
  15399. Display 16 inputs into 4x4 grid.
  15400. Layout:
  15401. @example
  15402. input1(0, 0) | input5(w0, 0) | input9 (w0+w4, 0) | input13(w0+w4+w8, 0)
  15403. input2(0, h0) | input6(w0, h0) | input10(w0+w4, h0) | input14(w0+w4+w8, h0)
  15404. input3(0, h0+h1) | input7(w0, h0+h1) | input11(w0+w4, h0+h1) | input15(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1)
  15405. input4(0, h0+h1+h2)| input8(w0, h0+h1+h2)| input12(w0+w4, h0+h1+h2)| input16(w0+w4+w8, h0+h1+h2)
  15406. @end example
  15407. @example
  15408. xstack=inputs=16:layout=0_0|0_h0|0_h0+h1|0_h0+h1+h2|w0_0|w0_h0|w0_h0+h1|w0_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4_0|
  15409. w0+w4_h0|w0+w4_h0+h1|w0+w4_h0+h1+h2|w0+w4+w8_0|w0+w4+w8_h0|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1|w0+w4+w8_h0+h1+h2
  15410. @end example
  15411. Note that if inputs are of different sizes, gaps or overlaps may occur.
  15412. @end itemize
  15413. @anchor{yadif}
  15414. @section yadif
  15415. Deinterlace the input video ("yadif" means "yet another deinterlacing
  15416. filter").
  15417. It accepts the following parameters:
  15418. @table @option
  15419. @item mode
  15420. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15421. @table @option
  15422. @item 0, send_frame
  15423. Output one frame for each frame.
  15424. @item 1, send_field
  15425. Output one frame for each field.
  15426. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15427. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15428. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15429. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15430. @end table
  15431. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15432. @item parity
  15433. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15434. of the following values:
  15435. @table @option
  15436. @item 0, tff
  15437. Assume the top field is first.
  15438. @item 1, bff
  15439. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15440. @item -1, auto
  15441. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15442. @end table
  15443. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15444. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15445. top field first will be assumed.
  15446. @item deint
  15447. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15448. values:
  15449. @table @option
  15450. @item 0, all
  15451. Deinterlace all frames.
  15452. @item 1, interlaced
  15453. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15454. @end table
  15455. The default value is @code{all}.
  15456. @end table
  15457. @section yadif_cuda
  15458. Deinterlace the input video using the @ref{yadif} algorithm, but implemented
  15459. in CUDA so that it can work as part of a GPU accelerated pipeline with nvdec
  15460. and/or nvenc.
  15461. It accepts the following parameters:
  15462. @table @option
  15463. @item mode
  15464. The interlacing mode to adopt. It accepts one of the following values:
  15465. @table @option
  15466. @item 0, send_frame
  15467. Output one frame for each frame.
  15468. @item 1, send_field
  15469. Output one frame for each field.
  15470. @item 2, send_frame_nospatial
  15471. Like @code{send_frame}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15472. @item 3, send_field_nospatial
  15473. Like @code{send_field}, but it skips the spatial interlacing check.
  15474. @end table
  15475. The default value is @code{send_frame}.
  15476. @item parity
  15477. The picture field parity assumed for the input interlaced video. It accepts one
  15478. of the following values:
  15479. @table @option
  15480. @item 0, tff
  15481. Assume the top field is first.
  15482. @item 1, bff
  15483. Assume the bottom field is first.
  15484. @item -1, auto
  15485. Enable automatic detection of field parity.
  15486. @end table
  15487. The default value is @code{auto}.
  15488. If the interlacing is unknown or the decoder does not export this information,
  15489. top field first will be assumed.
  15490. @item deint
  15491. Specify which frames to deinterlace. Accepts one of the following
  15492. values:
  15493. @table @option
  15494. @item 0, all
  15495. Deinterlace all frames.
  15496. @item 1, interlaced
  15497. Only deinterlace frames marked as interlaced.
  15498. @end table
  15499. The default value is @code{all}.
  15500. @end table
  15501. @section yaepblur
  15502. Apply blur filter while preserving edges ("yaepblur" means "yet another edge preserving blur filter").
  15503. The algorithm is described in
  15504. "J. S. Lee, Digital image enhancement and noise filtering by use of local statistics, IEEE Trans. Pattern Anal. Mach. Intell. PAMI-2, 1980."
  15505. It accepts the following parameters:
  15506. @table @option
  15507. @item radius, r
  15508. Set the window radius. Default value is 3.
  15509. @item planes, p
  15510. Set which planes to filter. Default is only the first plane.
  15511. @item sigma, s
  15512. Set blur strength. Default value is 128.
  15513. @end table
  15514. @subsection Commands
  15515. This filter supports same @ref{commands} as options.
  15516. @section zoompan
  15517. Apply Zoom & Pan effect.
  15518. This filter accepts the following options:
  15519. @table @option
  15520. @item zoom, z
  15521. Set the zoom expression. Range is 1-10. Default is 1.
  15522. @item x
  15523. @item y
  15524. Set the x and y expression. Default is 0.
  15525. @item d
  15526. Set the duration expression in number of frames.
  15527. This sets for how many number of frames effect will last for
  15528. single input image.
  15529. @item s
  15530. Set the output image size, default is 'hd720'.
  15531. @item fps
  15532. Set the output frame rate, default is '25'.
  15533. @end table
  15534. Each expression can contain the following constants:
  15535. @table @option
  15536. @item in_w, iw
  15537. Input width.
  15538. @item in_h, ih
  15539. Input height.
  15540. @item out_w, ow
  15541. Output width.
  15542. @item out_h, oh
  15543. Output height.
  15544. @item in
  15545. Input frame count.
  15546. @item on
  15547. Output frame count.
  15548. @item x
  15549. @item y
  15550. Last calculated 'x' and 'y' position from 'x' and 'y' expression
  15551. for current input frame.
  15552. @item px
  15553. @item py
  15554. 'x' and 'y' of last output frame of previous input frame or 0 when there was
  15555. not yet such frame (first input frame).
  15556. @item zoom
  15557. Last calculated zoom from 'z' expression for current input frame.
  15558. @item pzoom
  15559. Last calculated zoom of last output frame of previous input frame.
  15560. @item duration
  15561. Number of output frames for current input frame. Calculated from 'd' expression
  15562. for each input frame.
  15563. @item pduration
  15564. number of output frames created for previous input frame
  15565. @item a
  15566. Rational number: input width / input height
  15567. @item sar
  15568. sample aspect ratio
  15569. @item dar
  15570. display aspect ratio
  15571. @end table
  15572. @subsection Examples
  15573. @itemize
  15574. @item
  15575. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan at same time to some spot near center of picture:
  15576. @example
  15577. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='if(gte(zoom,1.5),x,x+1/a)':y='if(gte(zoom,1.5),y,y+1)':s=640x360
  15578. @end example
  15579. @item
  15580. Zoom-in up to 1.5 and pan always at center of picture:
  15581. @example
  15582. zoompan=z='min(zoom+0.0015,1.5)':d=700:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15583. @end example
  15584. @item
  15585. Same as above but without pausing:
  15586. @example
  15587. zoompan=z='min(max(zoom,pzoom)+0.0015,1.5)':d=1:x='iw/2-(iw/zoom/2)':y='ih/2-(ih/zoom/2)'
  15588. @end example
  15589. @end itemize
  15590. @anchor{zscale}
  15591. @section zscale
  15592. Scale (resize) the input video, using the z.lib library:
  15593. @url{https://github.com/sekrit-twc/zimg}. To enable compilation of this
  15594. filter, you need to configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzimg}.
  15595. The zscale filter forces the output display aspect ratio to be the same
  15596. as the input, by changing the output sample aspect ratio.
  15597. If the input image format is different from the format requested by
  15598. the next filter, the zscale filter will convert the input to the
  15599. requested format.
  15600. @subsection Options
  15601. The filter accepts the following options.
  15602. @table @option
  15603. @item width, w
  15604. @item height, h
  15605. Set the output video dimension expression. Default value is the input
  15606. dimension.
  15607. If the @var{width} or @var{w} value is 0, the input width is used for
  15608. the output. If the @var{height} or @var{h} value is 0, the input height
  15609. is used for the output.
  15610. If one and only one of the values is -n with n >= 1, the zscale filter
  15611. will use a value that maintains the aspect ratio of the input image,
  15612. calculated from the other specified dimension. After that it will,
  15613. however, make sure that the calculated dimension is divisible by n and
  15614. adjust the value if necessary.
  15615. If both values are -n with n >= 1, the behavior will be identical to
  15616. both values being set to 0 as previously detailed.
  15617. See below for the list of accepted constants for use in the dimension
  15618. expression.
  15619. @item size, s
  15620. Set the video size. For the syntax of this option, check the
  15621. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  15622. @item dither, d
  15623. Set the dither type.
  15624. Possible values are:
  15625. @table @var
  15626. @item none
  15627. @item ordered
  15628. @item random
  15629. @item error_diffusion
  15630. @end table
  15631. Default is none.
  15632. @item filter, f
  15633. Set the resize filter type.
  15634. Possible values are:
  15635. @table @var
  15636. @item point
  15637. @item bilinear
  15638. @item bicubic
  15639. @item spline16
  15640. @item spline36
  15641. @item lanczos
  15642. @end table
  15643. Default is bilinear.
  15644. @item range, r
  15645. Set the color range.
  15646. Possible values are:
  15647. @table @var
  15648. @item input
  15649. @item limited
  15650. @item full
  15651. @end table
  15652. Default is same as input.
  15653. @item primaries, p
  15654. Set the color primaries.
  15655. Possible values are:
  15656. @table @var
  15657. @item input
  15658. @item 709
  15659. @item unspecified
  15660. @item 170m
  15661. @item 240m
  15662. @item 2020
  15663. @end table
  15664. Default is same as input.
  15665. @item transfer, t
  15666. Set the transfer characteristics.
  15667. Possible values are:
  15668. @table @var
  15669. @item input
  15670. @item 709
  15671. @item unspecified
  15672. @item 601
  15673. @item linear
  15674. @item 2020_10
  15675. @item 2020_12
  15676. @item smpte2084
  15677. @item iec61966-2-1
  15678. @item arib-std-b67
  15679. @end table
  15680. Default is same as input.
  15681. @item matrix, m
  15682. Set the colorspace matrix.
  15683. Possible value are:
  15684. @table @var
  15685. @item input
  15686. @item 709
  15687. @item unspecified
  15688. @item 470bg
  15689. @item 170m
  15690. @item 2020_ncl
  15691. @item 2020_cl
  15692. @end table
  15693. Default is same as input.
  15694. @item rangein, rin
  15695. Set the input color range.
  15696. Possible values are:
  15697. @table @var
  15698. @item input
  15699. @item limited
  15700. @item full
  15701. @end table
  15702. Default is same as input.
  15703. @item primariesin, pin
  15704. Set the input color primaries.
  15705. Possible values are:
  15706. @table @var
  15707. @item input
  15708. @item 709
  15709. @item unspecified
  15710. @item 170m
  15711. @item 240m
  15712. @item 2020
  15713. @end table
  15714. Default is same as input.
  15715. @item transferin, tin
  15716. Set the input transfer characteristics.
  15717. Possible values are:
  15718. @table @var
  15719. @item input
  15720. @item 709
  15721. @item unspecified
  15722. @item 601
  15723. @item linear
  15724. @item 2020_10
  15725. @item 2020_12
  15726. @end table
  15727. Default is same as input.
  15728. @item matrixin, min
  15729. Set the input colorspace matrix.
  15730. Possible value are:
  15731. @table @var
  15732. @item input
  15733. @item 709
  15734. @item unspecified
  15735. @item 470bg
  15736. @item 170m
  15737. @item 2020_ncl
  15738. @item 2020_cl
  15739. @end table
  15740. @item chromal, c
  15741. Set the output chroma location.
  15742. Possible values are:
  15743. @table @var
  15744. @item input
  15745. @item left
  15746. @item center
  15747. @item topleft
  15748. @item top
  15749. @item bottomleft
  15750. @item bottom
  15751. @end table
  15752. @item chromalin, cin
  15753. Set the input chroma location.
  15754. Possible values are:
  15755. @table @var
  15756. @item input
  15757. @item left
  15758. @item center
  15759. @item topleft
  15760. @item top
  15761. @item bottomleft
  15762. @item bottom
  15763. @end table
  15764. @item npl
  15765. Set the nominal peak luminance.
  15766. @end table
  15767. The values of the @option{w} and @option{h} options are expressions
  15768. containing the following constants:
  15769. @table @var
  15770. @item in_w
  15771. @item in_h
  15772. The input width and height
  15773. @item iw
  15774. @item ih
  15775. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  15776. @item out_w
  15777. @item out_h
  15778. The output (scaled) width and height
  15779. @item ow
  15780. @item oh
  15781. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}
  15782. @item a
  15783. The same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  15784. @item sar
  15785. input sample aspect ratio
  15786. @item dar
  15787. The input display aspect ratio. Calculated from @code{(iw / ih) * sar}.
  15788. @item hsub
  15789. @item vsub
  15790. horizontal and vertical input chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15791. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15792. @item ohsub
  15793. @item ovsub
  15794. horizontal and vertical output chroma subsample values. For example for the
  15795. pixel format "yuv422p" @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15796. @end table
  15797. @subsection Commands
  15798. This filter supports the following commands:
  15799. @table @option
  15800. @item width, w
  15801. @item height, h
  15802. Set the output video dimension expression.
  15803. The command accepts the same syntax of the corresponding option.
  15804. If the specified expression is not valid, it is kept at its current
  15805. value.
  15806. @end table
  15807. @c man end VIDEO FILTERS
  15808. @chapter OpenCL Video Filters
  15809. @c man begin OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  15810. Below is a description of the currently available OpenCL video filters.
  15811. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  15812. @code{--enable-opencl}.
  15813. Running OpenCL filters requires you to initialize a hardware device and to pass that device to all filters in any filter graph.
  15814. @table @option
  15815. @item -init_hw_device opencl[=@var{name}][:@var{device}[,@var{key=value}...]]
  15816. Initialise a new hardware device of type @var{opencl} called @var{name}, using the
  15817. given device parameters.
  15818. @item -filter_hw_device @var{name}
  15819. Pass the hardware device called @var{name} to all filters in any filter graph.
  15820. @end table
  15821. For more detailed information see @url{https://www.ffmpeg.org/ffmpeg.html#Advanced-Video-options}
  15822. @itemize
  15823. @item
  15824. Example of choosing the first device on the second platform and running avgblur_opencl filter with default parameters on it.
  15825. @example
  15826. -init_hw_device opencl=gpu:1.0 -filter_hw_device gpu -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15827. @end example
  15828. @end itemize
  15829. Since OpenCL filters are not able to access frame data in normal memory, all frame data needs to be uploaded(@ref{hwupload}) to hardware surfaces connected to the appropriate device before being used and then downloaded(@ref{hwdownload}) back to normal memory. Note that @ref{hwupload} will upload to a surface with the same layout as the software frame, so it may be necessary to add a @ref{format} filter immediately before to get the input into the right format and @ref{hwdownload} does not support all formats on the output - it may be necessary to insert an additional @ref{format} filter immediately following in the graph to get the output in a supported format.
  15830. @section avgblur_opencl
  15831. Apply average blur filter.
  15832. The filter accepts the following options:
  15833. @table @option
  15834. @item sizeX
  15835. Set horizontal radius size.
  15836. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{1}.
  15837. @item planes
  15838. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  15839. @item sizeY
  15840. Set vertical radius size. Range is @code{[1, 1024]} and default value is @code{0}. If zero, @code{sizeX} value will be used.
  15841. @end table
  15842. @subsection Example
  15843. @itemize
  15844. @item
  15845. Apply average blur filter with horizontal and vertical size of 3, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of the 7x7 region centered on it in the input. For pixels on the edges of the image, the region does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15846. @example
  15847. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, avgblur_opencl=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15848. @end example
  15849. @end itemize
  15850. @section boxblur_opencl
  15851. Apply a boxblur algorithm to the input video.
  15852. It accepts the following parameters:
  15853. @table @option
  15854. @item luma_radius, lr
  15855. @item luma_power, lp
  15856. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15857. @item chroma_power, cp
  15858. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15859. @item alpha_power, ap
  15860. @end table
  15861. A description of the accepted options follows.
  15862. @table @option
  15863. @item luma_radius, lr
  15864. @item chroma_radius, cr
  15865. @item alpha_radius, ar
  15866. Set an expression for the box radius in pixels used for blurring the
  15867. corresponding input plane.
  15868. The radius value must be a non-negative number, and must not be
  15869. greater than the value of the expression @code{min(w,h)/2} for the
  15870. luma and alpha planes, and of @code{min(cw,ch)/2} for the chroma
  15871. planes.
  15872. Default value for @option{luma_radius} is "2". If not specified,
  15873. @option{chroma_radius} and @option{alpha_radius} default to the
  15874. corresponding value set for @option{luma_radius}.
  15875. The expressions can contain the following constants:
  15876. @table @option
  15877. @item w
  15878. @item h
  15879. The input width and height in pixels.
  15880. @item cw
  15881. @item ch
  15882. The input chroma image width and height in pixels.
  15883. @item hsub
  15884. @item vsub
  15885. The horizontal and vertical chroma subsample values. For example, for the
  15886. pixel format "yuv422p", @var{hsub} is 2 and @var{vsub} is 1.
  15887. @end table
  15888. @item luma_power, lp
  15889. @item chroma_power, cp
  15890. @item alpha_power, ap
  15891. Specify how many times the boxblur filter is applied to the
  15892. corresponding plane.
  15893. Default value for @option{luma_power} is 2. If not specified,
  15894. @option{chroma_power} and @option{alpha_power} default to the
  15895. corresponding value set for @option{luma_power}.
  15896. A value of 0 will disable the effect.
  15897. @end table
  15898. @subsection Examples
  15899. Apply boxblur filter, setting each pixel of the output to the average value of box-radiuses @var{luma_radius}, @var{chroma_radius}, @var{alpha_radius} for each plane respectively. The filter will apply @var{luma_power}, @var{chroma_power}, @var{alpha_power} times onto the corresponding plane. For pixels on the edges of the image, the radius does not extend beyond the image boundaries, and so out-of-range coordinates are not used in the calculations.
  15900. @itemize
  15901. @item
  15902. Apply a boxblur filter with the luma, chroma, and alpha radius
  15903. set to 2 and luma, chroma, and alpha power set to 3. The filter will run 3 times with box-radius set to 2 for every plane of the image.
  15904. @example
  15905. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=luma_radius=2:luma_power=3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15906. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:3, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15907. @end example
  15908. @item
  15909. Apply a boxblur filter with luma radius set to 2, luma_power to 1, chroma_radius to 4, chroma_power to 5, alpha_radius to 3 and alpha_power to 7.
  15910. For the luma plane, a 2x2 box radius will be run once.
  15911. For the chroma plane, a 4x4 box radius will be run 5 times.
  15912. For the alpha plane, a 3x3 box radius will be run 7 times.
  15913. @example
  15914. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, boxblur_opencl=2:1:4:5:3:7, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15915. @end example
  15916. @end itemize
  15917. @section colorkey_opencl
  15918. RGB colorspace color keying.
  15919. The filter accepts the following options:
  15920. @table @option
  15921. @item color
  15922. The color which will be replaced with transparency.
  15923. @item similarity
  15924. Similarity percentage with the key color.
  15925. 0.01 matches only the exact key color, while 1.0 matches everything.
  15926. @item blend
  15927. Blend percentage.
  15928. 0.0 makes pixels either fully transparent, or not transparent at all.
  15929. Higher values result in semi-transparent pixels, with a higher transparency
  15930. the more similar the pixels color is to the key color.
  15931. @end table
  15932. @subsection Examples
  15933. @itemize
  15934. @item
  15935. Make every semi-green pixel in the input transparent with some slight blending:
  15936. @example
  15937. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, colorkey_opencl=green:0.3:0.1, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15938. @end example
  15939. @end itemize
  15940. @section convolution_opencl
  15941. Apply convolution of 3x3, 5x5, 7x7 matrix.
  15942. The filter accepts the following options:
  15943. @table @option
  15944. @item 0m
  15945. @item 1m
  15946. @item 2m
  15947. @item 3m
  15948. Set matrix for each plane.
  15949. Matrix is sequence of 9, 25 or 49 signed numbers.
  15950. Default value for each plane is @code{0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0}.
  15951. @item 0rdiv
  15952. @item 1rdiv
  15953. @item 2rdiv
  15954. @item 3rdiv
  15955. Set multiplier for calculated value for each plane.
  15956. If unset or 0, it will be sum of all matrix elements.
  15957. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{1.0}.
  15958. @item 0bias
  15959. @item 1bias
  15960. @item 2bias
  15961. @item 3bias
  15962. Set bias for each plane. This value is added to the result of the multiplication.
  15963. Useful for making the overall image brighter or darker.
  15964. The option value must be a float number greater or equal to @code{0.0}. Default value is @code{0.0}.
  15965. @end table
  15966. @subsection Examples
  15967. @itemize
  15968. @item
  15969. Apply sharpen:
  15970. @example
  15971. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0:0 -1 0 -1 5 -1 0 -1 0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15972. @end example
  15973. @item
  15974. Apply blur:
  15975. @example
  15976. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1:1/9:1/9:1/9:1/9, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15977. @end example
  15978. @item
  15979. Apply edge enhance:
  15980. @example
  15981. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:0 0 0 -1 1 0 0 0 0:5:1:1:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15982. @end example
  15983. @item
  15984. Apply edge detect:
  15985. @example
  15986. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:0 1 0 1 -4 1 0 1 0:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:128, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15987. @end example
  15988. @item
  15989. Apply laplacian edge detector which includes diagonals:
  15990. @example
  15991. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:1 1 1 1 -8 1 1 1 1:5:5:5:1:0:128:128:0, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15992. @end example
  15993. @item
  15994. Apply emboss:
  15995. @example
  15996. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, convolution_opencl=-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2:-2 -1 0 -1 1 1 0 1 2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  15997. @end example
  15998. @end itemize
  15999. @section erosion_opencl
  16000. Apply erosion effect to the video.
  16001. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) minimum.
  16002. It accepts the following options:
  16003. @table @option
  16004. @item threshold0
  16005. @item threshold1
  16006. @item threshold2
  16007. @item threshold3
  16008. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16009. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16010. @item coordinates
  16011. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16012. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16013. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16014. 1 2 3
  16015. 4 x 5
  16016. 6 7 8
  16017. @end table
  16018. @subsection Example
  16019. @itemize
  16020. @item
  16021. Apply erosion filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local minimum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local minimum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel - threshold of corresponding plane.
  16022. @example
  16023. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, erosion_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16024. @end example
  16025. @end itemize
  16026. @section deshake_opencl
  16027. Feature-point based video stabilization filter.
  16028. The filter accepts the following options:
  16029. @table @option
  16030. @item tripod
  16031. Simulates a tripod by preventing any camera movement whatsoever from the original frame. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16032. @item debug
  16033. Whether or not additional debug info should be displayed, both in the processed output and in the console.
  16034. Note that in order to see console debug output you will also need to pass @code{-v verbose} to ffmpeg.
  16035. Viewing point matches in the output video is only supported for RGB input.
  16036. Defaults to @code{0}.
  16037. @item adaptive_crop
  16038. Whether or not to do a tiny bit of cropping at the borders to cut down on the amount of mirrored pixels.
  16039. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16040. @item refine_features
  16041. Whether or not feature points should be refined at a sub-pixel level.
  16042. This can be turned off for a slight performance gain at the cost of precision.
  16043. Defaults to @code{1}.
  16044. @item smooth_strength
  16045. The strength of the smoothing applied to the camera path from @code{0.0} to @code{1.0}.
  16046. @code{1.0} is the maximum smoothing strength while values less than that result in less smoothing.
  16047. @code{0.0} causes the filter to adaptively choose a smoothing strength on a per-frame basis.
  16048. Defaults to @code{0.0}.
  16049. @item smooth_window_multiplier
  16050. Controls the size of the smoothing window (the number of frames buffered to determine motion information from).
  16051. The size of the smoothing window is determined by multiplying the framerate of the video by this number.
  16052. Acceptable values range from @code{0.1} to @code{10.0}.
  16053. Larger values increase the amount of motion data available for determining how to smooth the camera path,
  16054. potentially improving smoothness, but also increase latency and memory usage.
  16055. Defaults to @code{2.0}.
  16056. @end table
  16057. @subsection Examples
  16058. @itemize
  16059. @item
  16060. Stabilize a video with a fixed, medium smoothing strength:
  16061. @example
  16062. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, deshake_opencl=smooth_strength=0.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16063. @end example
  16064. @item
  16065. Stabilize a video with debugging (both in console and in rendered video):
  16066. @example
  16067. -i INPUT -filter_complex "[0:v]format=rgba, hwupload, deshake_opencl=debug=1, hwdownload, format=rgba, format=yuv420p" -v verbose OUTPUT
  16068. @end example
  16069. @end itemize
  16070. @section dilation_opencl
  16071. Apply dilation effect to the video.
  16072. This filter replaces the pixel by the local(3x3) maximum.
  16073. It accepts the following options:
  16074. @table @option
  16075. @item threshold0
  16076. @item threshold1
  16077. @item threshold2
  16078. @item threshold3
  16079. Limit the maximum change for each plane. Range is @code{[0, 65535]} and default value is @code{65535}.
  16080. If @code{0}, plane will remain unchanged.
  16081. @item coordinates
  16082. Flag which specifies the pixel to refer to.
  16083. Range is @code{[0, 255]} and default value is @code{255}, i.e. all eight pixels are used.
  16084. Flags to local 3x3 coordinates region centered on @code{x}:
  16085. 1 2 3
  16086. 4 x 5
  16087. 6 7 8
  16088. @end table
  16089. @subsection Example
  16090. @itemize
  16091. @item
  16092. Apply dilation filter with threshold0 set to 30, threshold1 set 40, threshold2 set to 50 and coordinates set to 231, setting each pixel of the output to the local maximum between pixels: 1, 2, 3, 6, 7, 8 of the 3x3 region centered on it in the input. If the difference between input pixel and local maximum is more then threshold of the corresponding plane, output pixel will be set to input pixel + threshold of corresponding plane.
  16093. @example
  16094. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, dilation_opencl=30:40:50:coordinates=231, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16095. @end example
  16096. @end itemize
  16097. @section nlmeans_opencl
  16098. Non-local Means denoise filter through OpenCL, this filter accepts same options as @ref{nlmeans}.
  16099. @section overlay_opencl
  16100. Overlay one video on top of another.
  16101. It takes two inputs and has one output. The first input is the "main" video on which the second input is overlaid.
  16102. This filter requires same memory layout for all the inputs. So, format conversion may be needed.
  16103. The filter accepts the following options:
  16104. @table @option
  16105. @item x
  16106. Set the x coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16107. Default value is @code{0}.
  16108. @item y
  16109. Set the y coordinate of the overlaid video on the main video.
  16110. Default value is @code{0}.
  16111. @end table
  16112. @subsection Examples
  16113. @itemize
  16114. @item
  16115. Overlay an image LOGO at the top-left corner of the INPUT video. Both inputs are yuv420p format.
  16116. @example
  16117. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuv420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16118. @end example
  16119. @item
  16120. The inputs have same memory layout for color channels , the overlay has additional alpha plane, like INPUT is yuv420p, and the LOGO is yuva420p.
  16121. @example
  16122. -i INPUT -i LOGO -filter_complex "[0:v]hwupload[a], [1:v]format=yuva420p, hwupload[b], [a][b]overlay_opencl, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16123. @end example
  16124. @end itemize
  16125. @section pad_opencl
  16126. Add paddings to the input image, and place the original input at the
  16127. provided @var{x}, @var{y} coordinates.
  16128. It accepts the following options:
  16129. @table @option
  16130. @item width, w
  16131. @item height, h
  16132. Specify an expression for the size of the output image with the
  16133. paddings added. If the value for @var{width} or @var{height} is 0, the
  16134. corresponding input size is used for the output.
  16135. The @var{width} expression can reference the value set by the
  16136. @var{height} expression, and vice versa.
  16137. The default value of @var{width} and @var{height} is 0.
  16138. @item x
  16139. @item y
  16140. Specify the offsets to place the input image at within the padded area,
  16141. with respect to the top/left border of the output image.
  16142. The @var{x} expression can reference the value set by the @var{y}
  16143. expression, and vice versa.
  16144. The default value of @var{x} and @var{y} is 0.
  16145. If @var{x} or @var{y} evaluate to a negative number, they'll be changed
  16146. so the input image is centered on the padded area.
  16147. @item color
  16148. Specify the color of the padded area. For the syntax of this option,
  16149. check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils
  16150. manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16151. @item aspect
  16152. Pad to an aspect instead to a resolution.
  16153. @end table
  16154. The value for the @var{width}, @var{height}, @var{x}, and @var{y}
  16155. options are expressions containing the following constants:
  16156. @table @option
  16157. @item in_w
  16158. @item in_h
  16159. The input video width and height.
  16160. @item iw
  16161. @item ih
  16162. These are the same as @var{in_w} and @var{in_h}.
  16163. @item out_w
  16164. @item out_h
  16165. The output width and height (the size of the padded area), as
  16166. specified by the @var{width} and @var{height} expressions.
  16167. @item ow
  16168. @item oh
  16169. These are the same as @var{out_w} and @var{out_h}.
  16170. @item x
  16171. @item y
  16172. The x and y offsets as specified by the @var{x} and @var{y}
  16173. expressions, or NAN if not yet specified.
  16174. @item a
  16175. same as @var{iw} / @var{ih}
  16176. @item sar
  16177. input sample aspect ratio
  16178. @item dar
  16179. input display aspect ratio, it is the same as (@var{iw} / @var{ih}) * @var{sar}
  16180. @end table
  16181. @section prewitt_opencl
  16182. Apply the Prewitt operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Prewitt_operator}) to input video stream.
  16183. The filter accepts the following option:
  16184. @table @option
  16185. @item planes
  16186. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16187. @item scale
  16188. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16189. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16190. @item delta
  16191. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16192. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16193. @end table
  16194. @subsection Example
  16195. @itemize
  16196. @item
  16197. Apply the Prewitt operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10.
  16198. @example
  16199. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, prewitt_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16200. @end example
  16201. @end itemize
  16202. @anchor{program_opencl}
  16203. @section program_opencl
  16204. Filter video using an OpenCL program.
  16205. @table @option
  16206. @item source
  16207. OpenCL program source file.
  16208. @item kernel
  16209. Kernel name in program.
  16210. @item inputs
  16211. Number of inputs to the filter. Defaults to 1.
  16212. @item size, s
  16213. Size of output frames. Defaults to the same as the first input.
  16214. @end table
  16215. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16216. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16217. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16218. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16219. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16220. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16221. @itemize
  16222. @item
  16223. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16224. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16225. @item
  16226. Frame index, @var{unsigned int}.
  16227. This is a counter starting from zero and increasing by one for each frame.
  16228. @item
  16229. Source images, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16230. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16231. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16232. @end itemize
  16233. Example programs:
  16234. @itemize
  16235. @item
  16236. Copy the input to the output (output must be the same size as the input).
  16237. @verbatim
  16238. __kernel void copy(__write_only image2d_t destination,
  16239. unsigned int index,
  16240. __read_only image2d_t source)
  16241. {
  16242. const sampler_t sampler = CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE;
  16243. int2 location = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16244. float4 value = read_imagef(source, sampler, location);
  16245. write_imagef(destination, location, value);
  16246. }
  16247. @end verbatim
  16248. @item
  16249. Apply a simple transformation, rotating the input by an amount increasing
  16250. with the index counter. Pixel values are linearly interpolated by the
  16251. sampler, and the output need not have the same dimensions as the input.
  16252. @verbatim
  16253. __kernel void rotate_image(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16254. unsigned int index,
  16255. __read_only image2d_t src)
  16256. {
  16257. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16258. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16259. float angle = (float)index / 100.0f;
  16260. float2 dst_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  16261. float2 src_dim = convert_float2(get_image_dim(src));
  16262. float2 dst_cen = dst_dim / 2.0f;
  16263. float2 src_cen = src_dim / 2.0f;
  16264. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16265. float2 dst_pos = convert_float2(dst_loc) - dst_cen;
  16266. float2 src_pos = {
  16267. cos(angle) * dst_pos.x - sin(angle) * dst_pos.y,
  16268. sin(angle) * dst_pos.x + cos(angle) * dst_pos.y
  16269. };
  16270. src_pos = src_pos * src_dim / dst_dim;
  16271. float2 src_loc = src_pos + src_cen;
  16272. if (src_loc.x < 0.0f || src_loc.y < 0.0f ||
  16273. src_loc.x > src_dim.x || src_loc.y > src_dim.y)
  16274. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, 0.5f);
  16275. else
  16276. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, read_imagef(src, sampler, src_loc));
  16277. }
  16278. @end verbatim
  16279. @item
  16280. Blend two inputs together, with the amount of each input used varying
  16281. with the index counter.
  16282. @verbatim
  16283. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16284. unsigned int index,
  16285. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16286. __read_only image2d_t src2)
  16287. {
  16288. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16289. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16290. float blend = (cos((float)index / 50.0f) + 1.0f) / 2.0f;
  16291. int2 dst_loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16292. int2 src1_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src1) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16293. int2 src2_loc = dst_loc * get_image_dim(src2) / get_image_dim(dst);
  16294. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, src1_loc);
  16295. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, src2_loc);
  16296. write_imagef(dst, dst_loc, val1 * blend + val2 * (1.0f - blend));
  16297. }
  16298. @end verbatim
  16299. @end itemize
  16300. @section roberts_opencl
  16301. Apply the Roberts cross operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Roberts_cross}) to input video stream.
  16302. The filter accepts the following option:
  16303. @table @option
  16304. @item planes
  16305. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16306. @item scale
  16307. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16308. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16309. @item delta
  16310. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16311. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16312. @end table
  16313. @subsection Example
  16314. @itemize
  16315. @item
  16316. Apply the Roberts cross operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16317. @example
  16318. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, roberts_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16319. @end example
  16320. @end itemize
  16321. @section sobel_opencl
  16322. Apply the Sobel operator (@url{https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Sobel_operator}) to input video stream.
  16323. The filter accepts the following option:
  16324. @table @option
  16325. @item planes
  16326. Set which planes to filter. Default value is @code{0xf}, by which all planes are processed.
  16327. @item scale
  16328. Set value which will be multiplied with filtered result.
  16329. Range is @code{[0.0, 65535]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16330. @item delta
  16331. Set value which will be added to filtered result.
  16332. Range is @code{[-65535, 65535]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16333. @end table
  16334. @subsection Example
  16335. @itemize
  16336. @item
  16337. Apply sobel operator with scale set to 2 and delta set to 10
  16338. @example
  16339. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, sobel_opencl=scale=2:delta=10, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16340. @end example
  16341. @end itemize
  16342. @section tonemap_opencl
  16343. Perform HDR(PQ/HLG) to SDR conversion with tone-mapping.
  16344. It accepts the following parameters:
  16345. @table @option
  16346. @item tonemap
  16347. Specify the tone-mapping operator to be used. Same as tonemap option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16348. @item param
  16349. Tune the tone mapping algorithm. same as param option in @ref{tonemap}.
  16350. @item desat
  16351. Apply desaturation for highlights that exceed this level of brightness. The
  16352. higher the parameter, the more color information will be preserved. This
  16353. setting helps prevent unnaturally blown-out colors for super-highlights, by
  16354. (smoothly) turning into white instead. This makes images feel more natural,
  16355. at the cost of reducing information about out-of-range colors.
  16356. The default value is 0.5, and the algorithm here is a little different from
  16357. the cpu version tonemap currently. A setting of 0.0 disables this option.
  16358. @item threshold
  16359. The tonemapping algorithm parameters is fine-tuned per each scene. And a threshold
  16360. is used to detect whether the scene has changed or not. If the distance between
  16361. the current frame average brightness and the current running average exceeds
  16362. a threshold value, we would re-calculate scene average and peak brightness.
  16363. The default value is 0.2.
  16364. @item format
  16365. Specify the output pixel format.
  16366. Currently supported formats are:
  16367. @table @var
  16368. @item p010
  16369. @item nv12
  16370. @end table
  16371. @item range, r
  16372. Set the output color range.
  16373. Possible values are:
  16374. @table @var
  16375. @item tv/mpeg
  16376. @item pc/jpeg
  16377. @end table
  16378. Default is same as input.
  16379. @item primaries, p
  16380. Set the output color primaries.
  16381. Possible values are:
  16382. @table @var
  16383. @item bt709
  16384. @item bt2020
  16385. @end table
  16386. Default is same as input.
  16387. @item transfer, t
  16388. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16389. Possible values are:
  16390. @table @var
  16391. @item bt709
  16392. @item bt2020
  16393. @end table
  16394. Default is bt709.
  16395. @item matrix, m
  16396. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16397. Possible value are:
  16398. @table @var
  16399. @item bt709
  16400. @item bt2020
  16401. @end table
  16402. Default is same as input.
  16403. @end table
  16404. @subsection Example
  16405. @itemize
  16406. @item
  16407. Convert HDR(PQ/HLG) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format using linear operator.
  16408. @example
  16409. -i INPUT -vf "format=p010,hwupload,tonemap_opencl=t=bt2020:tonemap=linear:format=p010,hwdownload,format=p010" OUTPUT
  16410. @end example
  16411. @end itemize
  16412. @section unsharp_opencl
  16413. Sharpen or blur the input video.
  16414. It accepts the following parameters:
  16415. @table @option
  16416. @item luma_msize_x, lx
  16417. Set the luma matrix horizontal size.
  16418. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16419. @item luma_msize_y, ly
  16420. Set the luma matrix vertical size.
  16421. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16422. @item luma_amount, la
  16423. Set the luma effect strength.
  16424. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{1.0}.
  16425. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16426. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16427. @item chroma_msize_x, cx
  16428. Set the chroma matrix horizontal size.
  16429. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16430. @item chroma_msize_y, cy
  16431. Set the chroma matrix vertical size.
  16432. Range is @code{[1, 23]} and default value is @code{5}.
  16433. @item chroma_amount, ca
  16434. Set the chroma effect strength.
  16435. Range is @code{[-10, 10]} and default value is @code{0.0}.
  16436. Negative values will blur the input video, while positive values will
  16437. sharpen it, a value of zero will disable the effect.
  16438. @end table
  16439. All parameters are optional and default to the equivalent of the
  16440. string '5:5:1.0:5:5:0.0'.
  16441. @subsection Examples
  16442. @itemize
  16443. @item
  16444. Apply strong luma sharpen effect:
  16445. @example
  16446. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=luma_msize_x=7:luma_msize_y=7:luma_amount=2.5, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16447. @end example
  16448. @item
  16449. Apply a strong blur of both luma and chroma parameters:
  16450. @example
  16451. -i INPUT -vf "hwupload, unsharp_opencl=7:7:-2:7:7:-2, hwdownload" OUTPUT
  16452. @end example
  16453. @end itemize
  16454. @section xfade_opencl
  16455. Cross fade two videos with custom transition effect by using OpenCL.
  16456. It accepts the following options:
  16457. @table @option
  16458. @item transition
  16459. Set one of possible transition effects.
  16460. @table @option
  16461. @item custom
  16462. Select custom transition effect, the actual transition description
  16463. will be picked from source and kernel options.
  16464. @item fade
  16465. @item wipeleft
  16466. @item wiperight
  16467. @item wipeup
  16468. @item wipedown
  16469. @item slideleft
  16470. @item slideright
  16471. @item slideup
  16472. @item slidedown
  16473. Default transition is fade.
  16474. @end table
  16475. @item source
  16476. OpenCL program source file for custom transition.
  16477. @item kernel
  16478. Set name of kernel to use for custom transition from program source file.
  16479. @item duration
  16480. Set duration of video transition.
  16481. @item offset
  16482. Set time of start of transition relative to first video.
  16483. @end table
  16484. The program source file must contain a kernel function with the given name,
  16485. which will be run once for each plane of the output. Each run on a plane
  16486. gets enqueued as a separate 2D global NDRange with one work-item for each
  16487. pixel to be generated. The global ID offset for each work-item is therefore
  16488. the coordinates of a pixel in the destination image.
  16489. The kernel function needs to take the following arguments:
  16490. @itemize
  16491. @item
  16492. Destination image, @var{__write_only image2d_t}.
  16493. This image will become the output; the kernel should write all of it.
  16494. @item
  16495. First Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16496. Second Source image, @var{__read_only image2d_t}.
  16497. These are the most recent images on each input. The kernel may read from
  16498. them to generate the output, but they can't be written to.
  16499. @item
  16500. Transition progress, @var{float}. This value is always between 0 and 1 inclusive.
  16501. @end itemize
  16502. Example programs:
  16503. @itemize
  16504. @item
  16505. Apply dots curtain transition effect:
  16506. @verbatim
  16507. __kernel void blend_images(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  16508. __read_only image2d_t src1,
  16509. __read_only image2d_t src2,
  16510. float progress)
  16511. {
  16512. const sampler_t sampler = (CLK_NORMALIZED_COORDS_FALSE |
  16513. CLK_FILTER_LINEAR);
  16514. int2 p = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16515. float2 rp = (float2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  16516. float2 dim = (float2)(get_image_dim(src1).x, get_image_dim(src1).y);
  16517. rp = rp / dim;
  16518. float2 dots = (float2)(20.0, 20.0);
  16519. float2 center = (float2)(0,0);
  16520. float2 unused;
  16521. float4 val1 = read_imagef(src1, sampler, p);
  16522. float4 val2 = read_imagef(src2, sampler, p);
  16523. bool next = distance(fract(rp * dots, &unused), (float2)(0.5, 0.5)) < (progress / distance(rp, center));
  16524. write_imagef(dst, p, next ? val1 : val2);
  16525. }
  16526. @end verbatim
  16527. @end itemize
  16528. @c man end OPENCL VIDEO FILTERS
  16529. @chapter VAAPI Video Filters
  16530. @c man begin VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16531. VAAPI Video filters are usually used with VAAPI decoder and VAAPI encoder. Below is a description of VAAPI video filters.
  16532. To enable compilation of these filters you need to configure FFmpeg with
  16533. @code{--enable-vaapi}.
  16534. To use vaapi filters, you need to setup the vaapi device correctly. For more information, please read @url{https://trac.ffmpeg.org/wiki/Hardware/VAAPI}
  16535. @section tonemap_vaapi
  16536. Perform HDR(High Dynamic Range) to SDR(Standard Dynamic Range) conversion with tone-mapping.
  16537. It maps the dynamic range of HDR10 content to the SDR content.
  16538. It currently only accepts HDR10 as input.
  16539. It accepts the following parameters:
  16540. @table @option
  16541. @item format
  16542. Specify the output pixel format.
  16543. Currently supported formats are:
  16544. @table @var
  16545. @item p010
  16546. @item nv12
  16547. @end table
  16548. Default is nv12.
  16549. @item primaries, p
  16550. Set the output color primaries.
  16551. Default is same as input.
  16552. @item transfer, t
  16553. Set the output transfer characteristics.
  16554. Default is bt709.
  16555. @item matrix, m
  16556. Set the output colorspace matrix.
  16557. Default is same as input.
  16558. @end table
  16559. @subsection Example
  16560. @itemize
  16561. @item
  16562. Convert HDR(HDR10) video to bt2020-transfer-characteristic p010 format
  16563. @example
  16564. tonemap_vaapi=format=p010:t=bt2020-10
  16565. @end example
  16566. @end itemize
  16567. @c man end VAAPI VIDEO FILTERS
  16568. @chapter Video Sources
  16569. @c man begin VIDEO SOURCES
  16570. Below is a description of the currently available video sources.
  16571. @section buffer
  16572. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the filter chain.
  16573. This source is mainly intended for a programmatic use, in particular
  16574. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/vsrc_buffer.h}.
  16575. It accepts the following parameters:
  16576. @table @option
  16577. @item video_size
  16578. Specify the size (width and height) of the buffered video frames. For the
  16579. syntax of this option, check the
  16580. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16581. @item width
  16582. The input video width.
  16583. @item height
  16584. The input video height.
  16585. @item pix_fmt
  16586. A string representing the pixel format of the buffered video frames.
  16587. It may be a number corresponding to a pixel format, or a pixel format
  16588. name.
  16589. @item time_base
  16590. Specify the timebase assumed by the timestamps of the buffered frames.
  16591. @item frame_rate
  16592. Specify the frame rate expected for the video stream.
  16593. @item pixel_aspect, sar
  16594. The sample (pixel) aspect ratio of the input video.
  16595. @item sws_param
  16596. This option is deprecated and ignored. Prepend @code{sws_flags=@var{flags};}
  16597. to the filtergraph description to specify swscale flags for automatically
  16598. inserted scalers. See @ref{Filtergraph syntax}.
  16599. @item hw_frames_ctx
  16600. When using a hardware pixel format, this should be a reference to an
  16601. AVHWFramesContext describing input frames.
  16602. @end table
  16603. For example:
  16604. @example
  16605. buffer=width=320:height=240:pix_fmt=yuv410p:time_base=1/24:sar=1
  16606. @end example
  16607. will instruct the source to accept video frames with size 320x240 and
  16608. with format "yuv410p", assuming 1/24 as the timestamps timebase and
  16609. square pixels (1:1 sample aspect ratio).
  16610. Since the pixel format with name "yuv410p" corresponds to the number 6
  16611. (check the enum AVPixelFormat definition in @file{libavutil/pixfmt.h}),
  16612. this example corresponds to:
  16613. @example
  16614. buffer=size=320x240:pixfmt=6:time_base=1/24:pixel_aspect=1/1
  16615. @end example
  16616. Alternatively, the options can be specified as a flat string, but this
  16617. syntax is deprecated:
  16618. @var{width}:@var{height}:@var{pix_fmt}:@var{time_base.num}:@var{time_base.den}:@var{pixel_aspect.num}:@var{pixel_aspect.den}
  16619. @section cellauto
  16620. Create a pattern generated by an elementary cellular automaton.
  16621. The initial state of the cellular automaton can be defined through the
  16622. @option{filename} and @option{pattern} options. If such options are
  16623. not specified an initial state is created randomly.
  16624. At each new frame a new row in the video is filled with the result of
  16625. the cellular automaton next generation. The behavior when the whole
  16626. frame is filled is defined by the @option{scroll} option.
  16627. This source accepts the following options:
  16628. @table @option
  16629. @item filename, f
  16630. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16631. the specified file.
  16632. In the file, each non-whitespace character is considered an alive
  16633. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16634. file will be ignored.
  16635. @item pattern, p
  16636. Read the initial cellular automaton state, i.e. the starting row, from
  16637. the specified string.
  16638. Each non-whitespace character in the string is considered an alive
  16639. cell, a newline will terminate the row, and further characters in the
  16640. string will be ignored.
  16641. @item rate, r
  16642. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16643. Default is 25.
  16644. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16645. Set the random fill ratio for the initial cellular automaton row. It
  16646. is a floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to
  16647. 1/PHI.
  16648. This option is ignored when a file or a pattern is specified.
  16649. @item random_seed, seed
  16650. Set the seed for filling randomly the initial row, must be an integer
  16651. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16652. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16653. effort basis.
  16654. @item rule
  16655. Set the cellular automaton rule, it is a number ranging from 0 to 255.
  16656. Default value is 110.
  16657. @item size, s
  16658. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16659. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16660. If @option{filename} or @option{pattern} is specified, the size is set
  16661. by default to the width of the specified initial state row, and the
  16662. height is set to @var{width} * PHI.
  16663. If @option{size} is set, it must contain the width of the specified
  16664. pattern string, and the specified pattern will be centered in the
  16665. larger row.
  16666. If a filename or a pattern string is not specified, the size value
  16667. defaults to "320x518" (used for a randomly generated initial state).
  16668. @item scroll
  16669. If set to 1, scroll the output upward when all the rows in the output
  16670. have been already filled. If set to 0, the new generated row will be
  16671. written over the top row just after the bottom row is filled.
  16672. Defaults to 1.
  16673. @item start_full, full
  16674. If set to 1, completely fill the output with generated rows before
  16675. outputting the first frame.
  16676. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16677. @item stitch
  16678. If set to 1, stitch the left and right row edges together.
  16679. This is the default behavior, for disabling set the value to 0.
  16680. @end table
  16681. @subsection Examples
  16682. @itemize
  16683. @item
  16684. Read the initial state from @file{pattern}, and specify an output of
  16685. size 200x400.
  16686. @example
  16687. cellauto=f=pattern:s=200x400
  16688. @end example
  16689. @item
  16690. Generate a random initial row with a width of 200 cells, with a fill
  16691. ratio of 2/3:
  16692. @example
  16693. cellauto=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16694. @end example
  16695. @item
  16696. Create a pattern generated by rule 18 starting by a single alive cell
  16697. centered on an initial row with width 100:
  16698. @example
  16699. cellauto=p=@@:s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16700. @end example
  16701. @item
  16702. Specify a more elaborated initial pattern:
  16703. @example
  16704. cellauto=p='@@@@ @@ @@@@':s=100x400:full=0:rule=18
  16705. @end example
  16706. @end itemize
  16707. @anchor{coreimagesrc}
  16708. @section coreimagesrc
  16709. Video source generated on GPU using Apple's CoreImage API on OSX.
  16710. This video source is a specialized version of the @ref{coreimage} video filter.
  16711. Use a core image generator at the beginning of the applied filterchain to
  16712. generate the content.
  16713. The coreimagesrc video source accepts the following options:
  16714. @table @option
  16715. @item list_generators
  16716. List all available generators along with all their respective options as well as
  16717. possible minimum and maximum values along with the default values.
  16718. @example
  16719. list_generators=true
  16720. @end example
  16721. @item size, s
  16722. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16723. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16724. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  16725. @item rate, r
  16726. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16727. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16728. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16729. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16730. "25".
  16731. @item sar
  16732. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  16733. @item duration, d
  16734. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16735. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16736. for the accepted syntax.
  16737. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16738. supposed to be generated forever.
  16739. @end table
  16740. Additionally, all options of the @ref{coreimage} video filter are accepted.
  16741. A complete filterchain can be used for further processing of the
  16742. generated input without CPU-HOST transfer. See @ref{coreimage} documentation
  16743. and examples for details.
  16744. @subsection Examples
  16745. @itemize
  16746. @item
  16747. Use CIQRCodeGenerator to create a QR code for the FFmpeg homepage,
  16748. given as complete and escaped command-line for Apple's standard bash shell:
  16749. @example
  16750. ffmpeg -f lavfi -i coreimagesrc=s=100x100:filter=CIQRCodeGenerator@@inputMessage=https\\\\\://FFmpeg.org/@@inputCorrectionLevel=H -frames:v 1 QRCode.png
  16751. @end example
  16752. This example is equivalent to the QRCode example of @ref{coreimage} without the
  16753. need for a nullsrc video source.
  16754. @end itemize
  16755. @section mandelbrot
  16756. Generate a Mandelbrot set fractal, and progressively zoom towards the
  16757. point specified with @var{start_x} and @var{start_y}.
  16758. This source accepts the following options:
  16759. @table @option
  16760. @item end_pts
  16761. Set the terminal pts value. Default value is 400.
  16762. @item end_scale
  16763. Set the terminal scale value.
  16764. Must be a floating point value. Default value is 0.3.
  16765. @item inner
  16766. Set the inner coloring mode, that is the algorithm used to draw the
  16767. Mandelbrot fractal internal region.
  16768. It shall assume one of the following values:
  16769. @table @option
  16770. @item black
  16771. Set black mode.
  16772. @item convergence
  16773. Show time until convergence.
  16774. @item mincol
  16775. Set color based on point closest to the origin of the iterations.
  16776. @item period
  16777. Set period mode.
  16778. @end table
  16779. Default value is @var{mincol}.
  16780. @item bailout
  16781. Set the bailout value. Default value is 10.0.
  16782. @item maxiter
  16783. Set the maximum of iterations performed by the rendering
  16784. algorithm. Default value is 7189.
  16785. @item outer
  16786. Set outer coloring mode.
  16787. It shall assume one of following values:
  16788. @table @option
  16789. @item iteration_count
  16790. Set iteration count mode.
  16791. @item normalized_iteration_count
  16792. set normalized iteration count mode.
  16793. @end table
  16794. Default value is @var{normalized_iteration_count}.
  16795. @item rate, r
  16796. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  16797. value is "25".
  16798. @item size, s
  16799. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  16800. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  16801. @item start_scale
  16802. Set the initial scale value. Default value is 3.0.
  16803. @item start_x
  16804. Set the initial x position. Must be a floating point value between
  16805. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.743643887037158704752191506114774.
  16806. @item start_y
  16807. Set the initial y position. Must be a floating point value between
  16808. -100 and 100. Default value is -0.131825904205311970493132056385139.
  16809. @end table
  16810. @section mptestsrc
  16811. Generate various test patterns, as generated by the MPlayer test filter.
  16812. The size of the generated video is fixed, and is 256x256.
  16813. This source is useful in particular for testing encoding features.
  16814. This source accepts the following options:
  16815. @table @option
  16816. @item rate, r
  16817. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  16818. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  16819. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  16820. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  16821. "25".
  16822. @item duration, d
  16823. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  16824. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  16825. for the accepted syntax.
  16826. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  16827. supposed to be generated forever.
  16828. @item test, t
  16829. Set the number or the name of the test to perform. Supported tests are:
  16830. @table @option
  16831. @item dc_luma
  16832. @item dc_chroma
  16833. @item freq_luma
  16834. @item freq_chroma
  16835. @item amp_luma
  16836. @item amp_chroma
  16837. @item cbp
  16838. @item mv
  16839. @item ring1
  16840. @item ring2
  16841. @item all
  16842. @item max_frames, m
  16843. Set the maximum number of frames generated for each test, default value is 30.
  16844. @end table
  16845. Default value is "all", which will cycle through the list of all tests.
  16846. @end table
  16847. Some examples:
  16848. @example
  16849. mptestsrc=t=dc_luma
  16850. @end example
  16851. will generate a "dc_luma" test pattern.
  16852. @section frei0r_src
  16853. Provide a frei0r source.
  16854. To enable compilation of this filter you need to install the frei0r
  16855. header and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-frei0r}.
  16856. This source accepts the following parameters:
  16857. @table @option
  16858. @item size
  16859. The size of the video to generate. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16860. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16861. @item framerate
  16862. The framerate of the generated video. It may be a string of the form
  16863. @var{num}/@var{den} or a frame rate abbreviation.
  16864. @item filter_name
  16865. The name to the frei0r source to load. For more information regarding frei0r and
  16866. how to set the parameters, read the @ref{frei0r} section in the video filters
  16867. documentation.
  16868. @item filter_params
  16869. A '|'-separated list of parameters to pass to the frei0r source.
  16870. @end table
  16871. For example, to generate a frei0r partik0l source with size 200x200
  16872. and frame rate 10 which is overlaid on the overlay filter main input:
  16873. @example
  16874. frei0r_src=size=200x200:framerate=10:filter_name=partik0l:filter_params=1234 [overlay]; [in][overlay] overlay
  16875. @end example
  16876. @section life
  16877. Generate a life pattern.
  16878. This source is based on a generalization of John Conway's life game.
  16879. The sourced input represents a life grid, each pixel represents a cell
  16880. which can be in one of two possible states, alive or dead. Every cell
  16881. interacts with its eight neighbours, which are the cells that are
  16882. horizontally, vertically, or diagonally adjacent.
  16883. At each interaction the grid evolves according to the adopted rule,
  16884. which specifies the number of neighbor alive cells which will make a
  16885. cell stay alive or born. The @option{rule} option allows one to specify
  16886. the rule to adopt.
  16887. This source accepts the following options:
  16888. @table @option
  16889. @item filename, f
  16890. Set the file from which to read the initial grid state. In the file,
  16891. each non-whitespace character is considered an alive cell, and newline
  16892. is used to delimit the end of each row.
  16893. If this option is not specified, the initial grid is generated
  16894. randomly.
  16895. @item rate, r
  16896. Set the video rate, that is the number of frames generated per second.
  16897. Default is 25.
  16898. @item random_fill_ratio, ratio
  16899. Set the random fill ratio for the initial random grid. It is a
  16900. floating point number value ranging from 0 to 1, defaults to 1/PHI.
  16901. It is ignored when a file is specified.
  16902. @item random_seed, seed
  16903. Set the seed for filling the initial random grid, must be an integer
  16904. included between 0 and UINT32_MAX. If not specified, or if explicitly
  16905. set to -1, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best
  16906. effort basis.
  16907. @item rule
  16908. Set the life rule.
  16909. A rule can be specified with a code of the kind "S@var{NS}/B@var{NB}",
  16910. where @var{NS} and @var{NB} are sequences of numbers in the range 0-8,
  16911. @var{NS} specifies the number of alive neighbor cells which make a
  16912. live cell stay alive, and @var{NB} the number of alive neighbor cells
  16913. which make a dead cell to become alive (i.e. to "born").
  16914. "s" and "b" can be used in place of "S" and "B", respectively.
  16915. Alternatively a rule can be specified by an 18-bits integer. The 9
  16916. high order bits are used to encode the next cell state if it is alive
  16917. for each number of neighbor alive cells, the low order bits specify
  16918. the rule for "borning" new cells. Higher order bits encode for an
  16919. higher number of neighbor cells.
  16920. For example the number 6153 = @code{(12<<9)+9} specifies a stay alive
  16921. rule of 12 and a born rule of 9, which corresponds to "S23/B03".
  16922. Default value is "S23/B3", which is the original Conway's game of life
  16923. rule, and will keep a cell alive if it has 2 or 3 neighbor alive
  16924. cells, and will born a new cell if there are three alive cells around
  16925. a dead cell.
  16926. @item size, s
  16927. Set the size of the output video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  16928. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16929. If @option{filename} is specified, the size is set by default to the
  16930. same size of the input file. If @option{size} is set, it must contain
  16931. the size specified in the input file, and the initial grid defined in
  16932. that file is centered in the larger resulting area.
  16933. If a filename is not specified, the size value defaults to "320x240"
  16934. (used for a randomly generated initial grid).
  16935. @item stitch
  16936. If set to 1, stitch the left and right grid edges together, and the
  16937. top and bottom edges also. Defaults to 1.
  16938. @item mold
  16939. Set cell mold speed. If set, a dead cell will go from @option{death_color} to
  16940. @option{mold_color} with a step of @option{mold}. @option{mold} can have a
  16941. value from 0 to 255.
  16942. @item life_color
  16943. Set the color of living (or new born) cells.
  16944. @item death_color
  16945. Set the color of dead cells. If @option{mold} is set, this is the first color
  16946. used to represent a dead cell.
  16947. @item mold_color
  16948. Set mold color, for definitely dead and moldy cells.
  16949. For the syntax of these 3 color options, check the @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the
  16950. ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  16951. @end table
  16952. @subsection Examples
  16953. @itemize
  16954. @item
  16955. Read a grid from @file{pattern}, and center it on a grid of size
  16956. 300x300 pixels:
  16957. @example
  16958. life=f=pattern:s=300x300
  16959. @end example
  16960. @item
  16961. Generate a random grid of size 200x200, with a fill ratio of 2/3:
  16962. @example
  16963. life=ratio=2/3:s=200x200
  16964. @end example
  16965. @item
  16966. Specify a custom rule for evolving a randomly generated grid:
  16967. @example
  16968. life=rule=S14/B34
  16969. @end example
  16970. @item
  16971. Full example with slow death effect (mold) using @command{ffplay}:
  16972. @example
  16973. ffplay -f lavfi life=s=300x200:mold=10:r=60:ratio=0.1:death_color=#C83232:life_color=#00ff00,scale=1200:800:flags=16
  16974. @end example
  16975. @end itemize
  16976. @anchor{allrgb}
  16977. @anchor{allyuv}
  16978. @anchor{color}
  16979. @anchor{haldclutsrc}
  16980. @anchor{nullsrc}
  16981. @anchor{pal75bars}
  16982. @anchor{pal100bars}
  16983. @anchor{rgbtestsrc}
  16984. @anchor{smptebars}
  16985. @anchor{smptehdbars}
  16986. @anchor{testsrc}
  16987. @anchor{testsrc2}
  16988. @anchor{yuvtestsrc}
  16989. @section allrgb, allyuv, color, haldclutsrc, nullsrc, pal75bars, pal100bars, rgbtestsrc, smptebars, smptehdbars, testsrc, testsrc2, yuvtestsrc
  16990. The @code{allrgb} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all rgb colors.
  16991. The @code{allyuv} source returns frames of size 4096x4096 of all yuv colors.
  16992. The @code{color} source provides an uniformly colored input.
  16993. The @code{haldclutsrc} source provides an identity Hald CLUT. See also
  16994. @ref{haldclut} filter.
  16995. The @code{nullsrc} source returns unprocessed video frames. It is
  16996. mainly useful to be employed in analysis / debugging tools, or as the
  16997. source for filters which ignore the input data.
  16998. The @code{pal75bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  16999. EBU PAL recommendations with 75% color levels.
  17000. The @code{pal100bars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17001. EBU PAL recommendations with 100% color levels.
  17002. The @code{rgbtestsrc} source generates an RGB test pattern useful for
  17003. detecting RGB vs BGR issues. You should see a red, green and blue
  17004. stripe from top to bottom.
  17005. The @code{smptebars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17006. the SMPTE Engineering Guideline EG 1-1990.
  17007. The @code{smptehdbars} source generates a color bars pattern, based on
  17008. the SMPTE RP 219-2002.
  17009. The @code{testsrc} source generates a test video pattern, showing a
  17010. color pattern, a scrolling gradient and a timestamp. This is mainly
  17011. intended for testing purposes.
  17012. The @code{testsrc2} source is similar to testsrc, but supports more
  17013. pixel formats instead of just @code{rgb24}. This allows using it as an
  17014. input for other tests without requiring a format conversion.
  17015. The @code{yuvtestsrc} source generates an YUV test pattern. You should
  17016. see a y, cb and cr stripe from top to bottom.
  17017. The sources accept the following parameters:
  17018. @table @option
  17019. @item level
  17020. Specify the level of the Hald CLUT, only available in the @code{haldclutsrc}
  17021. source. A level of @code{N} generates a picture of @code{N*N*N} by @code{N*N*N}
  17022. pixels to be used as identity matrix for 3D lookup tables. Each component is
  17023. coded on a @code{1/(N*N)} scale.
  17024. @item color, c
  17025. Specify the color of the source, only available in the @code{color}
  17026. source. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17027. @ref{color syntax,,"Color" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17028. @item size, s
  17029. Specify the size of the sourced video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17030. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17031. The default value is @code{320x240}.
  17032. This option is not available with the @code{allrgb}, @code{allyuv}, and
  17033. @code{haldclutsrc} filters.
  17034. @item rate, r
  17035. Specify the frame rate of the sourced video, as the number of frames
  17036. generated per second. It has to be a string in the format
  17037. @var{frame_rate_num}/@var{frame_rate_den}, an integer number, a floating point
  17038. number or a valid video frame rate abbreviation. The default value is
  17039. "25".
  17040. @item duration, d
  17041. Set the duration of the sourced video. See
  17042. @ref{time duration syntax,,the Time duration section in the ffmpeg-utils(1) manual,ffmpeg-utils}
  17043. for the accepted syntax.
  17044. If not specified, or the expressed duration is negative, the video is
  17045. supposed to be generated forever.
  17046. @item sar
  17047. Set the sample aspect ratio of the sourced video.
  17048. @item alpha
  17049. Specify the alpha (opacity) of the background, only available in the
  17050. @code{testsrc2} source. The value must be between 0 (fully transparent) and
  17051. 255 (fully opaque, the default).
  17052. @item decimals, n
  17053. Set the number of decimals to show in the timestamp, only available in the
  17054. @code{testsrc} source.
  17055. The displayed timestamp value will correspond to the original
  17056. timestamp value multiplied by the power of 10 of the specified
  17057. value. Default value is 0.
  17058. @end table
  17059. @subsection Examples
  17060. @itemize
  17061. @item
  17062. Generate a video with a duration of 5.3 seconds, with size
  17063. 176x144 and a frame rate of 10 frames per second:
  17064. @example
  17065. testsrc=duration=5.3:size=qcif:rate=10
  17066. @end example
  17067. @item
  17068. The following graph description will generate a red source
  17069. with an opacity of 0.2, with size "qcif" and a frame rate of 10
  17070. frames per second:
  17071. @example
  17072. color=c=red@@0.2:s=qcif:r=10
  17073. @end example
  17074. @item
  17075. If the input content is to be ignored, @code{nullsrc} can be used. The
  17076. following command generates noise in the luminance plane by employing
  17077. the @code{geq} filter:
  17078. @example
  17079. nullsrc=s=256x256, geq=random(1)*255:128:128
  17080. @end example
  17081. @end itemize
  17082. @subsection Commands
  17083. The @code{color} source supports the following commands:
  17084. @table @option
  17085. @item c, color
  17086. Set the color of the created image. Accepts the same syntax of the
  17087. corresponding @option{color} option.
  17088. @end table
  17089. @section openclsrc
  17090. Generate video using an OpenCL program.
  17091. @table @option
  17092. @item source
  17093. OpenCL program source file.
  17094. @item kernel
  17095. Kernel name in program.
  17096. @item size, s
  17097. Size of frames to generate. This must be set.
  17098. @item format
  17099. Pixel format to use for the generated frames. This must be set.
  17100. @item rate, r
  17101. Number of frames generated every second. Default value is '25'.
  17102. @end table
  17103. For details of how the program loading works, see the @ref{program_opencl}
  17104. filter.
  17105. Example programs:
  17106. @itemize
  17107. @item
  17108. Generate a colour ramp by setting pixel values from the position of the pixel
  17109. in the output image. (Note that this will work with all pixel formats, but
  17110. the generated output will not be the same.)
  17111. @verbatim
  17112. __kernel void ramp(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17113. unsigned int index)
  17114. {
  17115. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17116. float4 val;
  17117. val.xy = val.zw = convert_float2(loc) / convert_float2(get_image_dim(dst));
  17118. write_imagef(dst, loc, val);
  17119. }
  17120. @end verbatim
  17121. @item
  17122. Generate a Sierpinski carpet pattern, panning by a single pixel each frame.
  17123. @verbatim
  17124. __kernel void sierpinski_carpet(__write_only image2d_t dst,
  17125. unsigned int index)
  17126. {
  17127. int2 loc = (int2)(get_global_id(0), get_global_id(1));
  17128. float4 value = 0.0f;
  17129. int x = loc.x + index;
  17130. int y = loc.y + index;
  17131. while (x > 0 || y > 0) {
  17132. if (x % 3 == 1 && y % 3 == 1) {
  17133. value = 1.0f;
  17134. break;
  17135. }
  17136. x /= 3;
  17137. y /= 3;
  17138. }
  17139. write_imagef(dst, loc, value);
  17140. }
  17141. @end verbatim
  17142. @end itemize
  17143. @section sierpinski
  17144. Generate a Sierpinski carpet/triangle fractal, and randomly pan around.
  17145. This source accepts the following options:
  17146. @table @option
  17147. @item size, s
  17148. Set frame size. For the syntax of this option, check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video
  17149. size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}. Default value is "640x480".
  17150. @item rate, r
  17151. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17152. value is "25".
  17153. @item seed
  17154. Set seed which is used for random panning.
  17155. @item jump
  17156. Set max jump for single pan destination. Allowed range is from 1 to 10000.
  17157. @item type
  17158. Set fractal type, can be default @code{carpet} or @code{triangle}.
  17159. @end table
  17160. @c man end VIDEO SOURCES
  17161. @chapter Video Sinks
  17162. @c man begin VIDEO SINKS
  17163. Below is a description of the currently available video sinks.
  17164. @section buffersink
  17165. Buffer video frames, and make them available to the end of the filter
  17166. graph.
  17167. This sink is mainly intended for programmatic use, in particular
  17168. through the interface defined in @file{libavfilter/buffersink.h}
  17169. or the options system.
  17170. It accepts a pointer to an AVBufferSinkContext structure, which
  17171. defines the incoming buffers' formats, to be passed as the opaque
  17172. parameter to @code{avfilter_init_filter} for initialization.
  17173. @section nullsink
  17174. Null video sink: do absolutely nothing with the input video. It is
  17175. mainly useful as a template and for use in analysis / debugging
  17176. tools.
  17177. @c man end VIDEO SINKS
  17178. @chapter Multimedia Filters
  17179. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  17180. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia filters.
  17181. @section abitscope
  17182. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the audio bit scope.
  17183. The filter accepts the following options:
  17184. @table @option
  17185. @item rate, r
  17186. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17187. value is "25".
  17188. @item size, s
  17189. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17190. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17191. Default value is @code{1024x256}.
  17192. @item colors
  17193. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  17194. draw channels. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  17195. by white color.
  17196. @end table
  17197. @section adrawgraph
  17198. Draw a graph using input audio metadata.
  17199. See @ref{drawgraph}
  17200. @section agraphmonitor
  17201. See @ref{graphmonitor}.
  17202. @section ahistogram
  17203. Convert input audio to a video output, displaying the volume histogram.
  17204. The filter accepts the following options:
  17205. @table @option
  17206. @item dmode
  17207. Specify how histogram is calculated.
  17208. It accepts the following values:
  17209. @table @samp
  17210. @item single
  17211. Use single histogram for all channels.
  17212. @item separate
  17213. Use separate histogram for each channel.
  17214. @end table
  17215. Default is @code{single}.
  17216. @item rate, r
  17217. Set frame rate, expressed as number of frames per second. Default
  17218. value is "25".
  17219. @item size, s
  17220. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17221. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17222. Default value is @code{hd720}.
  17223. @item scale
  17224. Set display scale.
  17225. It accepts the following values:
  17226. @table @samp
  17227. @item log
  17228. logarithmic
  17229. @item sqrt
  17230. square root
  17231. @item cbrt
  17232. cubic root
  17233. @item lin
  17234. linear
  17235. @item rlog
  17236. reverse logarithmic
  17237. @end table
  17238. Default is @code{log}.
  17239. @item ascale
  17240. Set amplitude scale.
  17241. It accepts the following values:
  17242. @table @samp
  17243. @item log
  17244. logarithmic
  17245. @item lin
  17246. linear
  17247. @end table
  17248. Default is @code{log}.
  17249. @item acount
  17250. Set how much frames to accumulate in histogram.
  17251. Default is 1. Setting this to -1 accumulates all frames.
  17252. @item rheight
  17253. Set histogram ratio of window height.
  17254. @item slide
  17255. Set sonogram sliding.
  17256. It accepts the following values:
  17257. @table @samp
  17258. @item replace
  17259. replace old rows with new ones.
  17260. @item scroll
  17261. scroll from top to bottom.
  17262. @end table
  17263. Default is @code{replace}.
  17264. @end table
  17265. @section aphasemeter
  17266. Measures phase of input audio, which is exported as metadata @code{lavfi.aphasemeter.phase},
  17267. representing mean phase of current audio frame. A video output can also be produced and is
  17268. enabled by default. The audio is passed through as first output.
  17269. Audio will be rematrixed to stereo if it has a different channel layout. Phase value is in
  17270. range @code{[-1, 1]} where @code{-1} means left and right channels are completely out of phase
  17271. and @code{1} means channels are in phase.
  17272. The filter accepts the following options, all related to its video output:
  17273. @table @option
  17274. @item rate, r
  17275. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17276. @item size, s
  17277. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17278. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17279. Default value is @code{800x400}.
  17280. @item rc
  17281. @item gc
  17282. @item bc
  17283. Specify the red, green, blue contrast. Default values are @code{2},
  17284. @code{7} and @code{1}.
  17285. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17286. @item mpc
  17287. Set color which will be used for drawing median phase. If color is
  17288. @code{none} which is default, no median phase value will be drawn.
  17289. @item video
  17290. Enable video output. Default is enabled.
  17291. @end table
  17292. @section avectorscope
  17293. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio vector
  17294. scope.
  17295. The filter is used to measure the difference between channels of stereo
  17296. audio stream. A monaural signal, consisting of identical left and right
  17297. signal, results in straight vertical line. Any stereo separation is visible
  17298. as a deviation from this line, creating a Lissajous figure.
  17299. If the straight (or deviation from it) but horizontal line appears this
  17300. indicates that the left and right channels are out of phase.
  17301. The filter accepts the following options:
  17302. @table @option
  17303. @item mode, m
  17304. Set the vectorscope mode.
  17305. Available values are:
  17306. @table @samp
  17307. @item lissajous
  17308. Lissajous rotated by 45 degrees.
  17309. @item lissajous_xy
  17310. Same as above but not rotated.
  17311. @item polar
  17312. Shape resembling half of circle.
  17313. @end table
  17314. Default value is @samp{lissajous}.
  17315. @item size, s
  17316. Set the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  17317. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17318. Default value is @code{400x400}.
  17319. @item rate, r
  17320. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  17321. @item rc
  17322. @item gc
  17323. @item bc
  17324. @item ac
  17325. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha contrast. Default values are @code{40},
  17326. @code{160}, @code{80} and @code{255}.
  17327. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17328. @item rf
  17329. @item gf
  17330. @item bf
  17331. @item af
  17332. Specify the red, green, blue and alpha fade. Default values are @code{15},
  17333. @code{10}, @code{5} and @code{5}.
  17334. Allowed range is @code{[0, 255]}.
  17335. @item zoom
  17336. Set the zoom factor. Default value is @code{1}. Allowed range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  17337. Values lower than @var{1} will auto adjust zoom factor to maximal possible value.
  17338. @item draw
  17339. Set the vectorscope drawing mode.
  17340. Available values are:
  17341. @table @samp
  17342. @item dot
  17343. Draw dot for each sample.
  17344. @item line
  17345. Draw line between previous and current sample.
  17346. @end table
  17347. Default value is @samp{dot}.
  17348. @item scale
  17349. Specify amplitude scale of audio samples.
  17350. Available values are:
  17351. @table @samp
  17352. @item lin
  17353. Linear.
  17354. @item sqrt
  17355. Square root.
  17356. @item cbrt
  17357. Cubic root.
  17358. @item log
  17359. Logarithmic.
  17360. @end table
  17361. @item swap
  17362. Swap left channel axis with right channel axis.
  17363. @item mirror
  17364. Mirror axis.
  17365. @table @samp
  17366. @item none
  17367. No mirror.
  17368. @item x
  17369. Mirror only x axis.
  17370. @item y
  17371. Mirror only y axis.
  17372. @item xy
  17373. Mirror both axis.
  17374. @end table
  17375. @end table
  17376. @subsection Examples
  17377. @itemize
  17378. @item
  17379. Complete example using @command{ffplay}:
  17380. @example
  17381. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  17382. [a] avectorscope=zoom=1.3:rc=2:gc=200:bc=10:rf=1:gf=8:bf=7 [out0]'
  17383. @end example
  17384. @end itemize
  17385. @section bench, abench
  17386. Benchmark part of a filtergraph.
  17387. The filter accepts the following options:
  17388. @table @option
  17389. @item action
  17390. Start or stop a timer.
  17391. Available values are:
  17392. @table @samp
  17393. @item start
  17394. Get the current time, set it as frame metadata (using the key
  17395. @code{lavfi.bench.start_time}), and forward the frame to the next filter.
  17396. @item stop
  17397. Get the current time and fetch the @code{lavfi.bench.start_time} metadata from
  17398. the input frame metadata to get the time difference. Time difference, average,
  17399. maximum and minimum time (respectively @code{t}, @code{avg}, @code{max} and
  17400. @code{min}) are then printed. The timestamps are expressed in seconds.
  17401. @end table
  17402. @end table
  17403. @subsection Examples
  17404. @itemize
  17405. @item
  17406. Benchmark @ref{selectivecolor} filter:
  17407. @example
  17408. bench=start,selectivecolor=reds=-.2 .12 -.49,bench=stop
  17409. @end example
  17410. @end itemize
  17411. @section concat
  17412. Concatenate audio and video streams, joining them together one after the
  17413. other.
  17414. The filter works on segments of synchronized video and audio streams. All
  17415. segments must have the same number of streams of each type, and that will
  17416. also be the number of streams at output.
  17417. The filter accepts the following options:
  17418. @table @option
  17419. @item n
  17420. Set the number of segments. Default is 2.
  17421. @item v
  17422. Set the number of output video streams, that is also the number of video
  17423. streams in each segment. Default is 1.
  17424. @item a
  17425. Set the number of output audio streams, that is also the number of audio
  17426. streams in each segment. Default is 0.
  17427. @item unsafe
  17428. Activate unsafe mode: do not fail if segments have a different format.
  17429. @end table
  17430. The filter has @var{v}+@var{a} outputs: first @var{v} video outputs, then
  17431. @var{a} audio outputs.
  17432. There are @var{n}x(@var{v}+@var{a}) inputs: first the inputs for the first
  17433. segment, in the same order as the outputs, then the inputs for the second
  17434. segment, etc.
  17435. Related streams do not always have exactly the same duration, for various
  17436. reasons including codec frame size or sloppy authoring. For that reason,
  17437. related synchronized streams (e.g. a video and its audio track) should be
  17438. concatenated at once. The concat filter will use the duration of the longest
  17439. stream in each segment (except the last one), and if necessary pad shorter
  17440. audio streams with silence.
  17441. For this filter to work correctly, all segments must start at timestamp 0.
  17442. All corresponding streams must have the same parameters in all segments; the
  17443. filtering system will automatically select a common pixel format for video
  17444. streams, and a common sample format, sample rate and channel layout for
  17445. audio streams, but other settings, such as resolution, must be converted
  17446. explicitly by the user.
  17447. Different frame rates are acceptable but will result in variable frame rate
  17448. at output; be sure to configure the output file to handle it.
  17449. @subsection Examples
  17450. @itemize
  17451. @item
  17452. Concatenate an opening, an episode and an ending, all in bilingual version
  17453. (video in stream 0, audio in streams 1 and 2):
  17454. @example
  17455. ffmpeg -i opening.mkv -i episode.mkv -i ending.mkv -filter_complex \
  17456. '[0:0] [0:1] [0:2] [1:0] [1:1] [1:2] [2:0] [2:1] [2:2]
  17457. concat=n=3:v=1:a=2 [v] [a1] [a2]' \
  17458. -map '[v]' -map '[a1]' -map '[a2]' output.mkv
  17459. @end example
  17460. @item
  17461. Concatenate two parts, handling audio and video separately, using the
  17462. (a)movie sources, and adjusting the resolution:
  17463. @example
  17464. movie=part1.mp4, scale=512:288 [v1] ; amovie=part1.mp4 [a1] ;
  17465. movie=part2.mp4, scale=512:288 [v2] ; amovie=part2.mp4 [a2] ;
  17466. [v1] [v2] concat [outv] ; [a1] [a2] concat=v=0:a=1 [outa]
  17467. @end example
  17468. Note that a desync will happen at the stitch if the audio and video streams
  17469. do not have exactly the same duration in the first file.
  17470. @end itemize
  17471. @subsection Commands
  17472. This filter supports the following commands:
  17473. @table @option
  17474. @item next
  17475. Close the current segment and step to the next one
  17476. @end table
  17477. @anchor{ebur128}
  17478. @section ebur128
  17479. EBU R128 scanner filter. This filter takes an audio stream and analyzes its loudness
  17480. level. By default, it logs a message at a frequency of 10Hz with the
  17481. Momentary loudness (identified by @code{M}), Short-term loudness (@code{S}),
  17482. Integrated loudness (@code{I}) and Loudness Range (@code{LRA}).
  17483. The filter can only analyze streams which have a sampling rate of 48000 Hz and whose
  17484. sample format is double-precision floating point. The input stream will be converted to
  17485. this specification, if needed. Users may need to insert aformat and/or aresample filters
  17486. after this filter to obtain the original parameters.
  17487. The filter also has a video output (see the @var{video} option) with a real
  17488. time graph to observe the loudness evolution. The graphic contains the logged
  17489. message mentioned above, so it is not printed anymore when this option is set,
  17490. unless the verbose logging is set. The main graphing area contains the
  17491. short-term loudness (3 seconds of analysis), and the gauge on the right is for
  17492. the momentary loudness (400 milliseconds), but can optionally be configured
  17493. to instead display short-term loudness (see @var{gauge}).
  17494. The green area marks a +/- 1LU target range around the target loudness
  17495. (-23LUFS by default, unless modified through @var{target}).
  17496. More information about the Loudness Recommendation EBU R128 on
  17497. @url{http://tech.ebu.ch/loudness}.
  17498. The filter accepts the following options:
  17499. @table @option
  17500. @item video
  17501. Activate the video output. The audio stream is passed unchanged whether this
  17502. option is set or no. The video stream will be the first output stream if
  17503. activated. Default is @code{0}.
  17504. @item size
  17505. Set the video size. This option is for video only. For the syntax of this
  17506. option, check the
  17507. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  17508. Default and minimum resolution is @code{640x480}.
  17509. @item meter
  17510. Set the EBU scale meter. Default is @code{9}. Common values are @code{9} and
  17511. @code{18}, respectively for EBU scale meter +9 and EBU scale meter +18. Any
  17512. other integer value between this range is allowed.
  17513. @item metadata
  17514. Set metadata injection. If set to @code{1}, the audio input will be segmented
  17515. into 100ms output frames, each of them containing various loudness information
  17516. in metadata. All the metadata keys are prefixed with @code{lavfi.r128.}.
  17517. Default is @code{0}.
  17518. @item framelog
  17519. Force the frame logging level.
  17520. Available values are:
  17521. @table @samp
  17522. @item info
  17523. information logging level
  17524. @item verbose
  17525. verbose logging level
  17526. @end table
  17527. By default, the logging level is set to @var{info}. If the @option{video} or
  17528. the @option{metadata} options are set, it switches to @var{verbose}.
  17529. @item peak
  17530. Set peak mode(s).
  17531. Available modes can be cumulated (the option is a @code{flag} type). Possible
  17532. values are:
  17533. @table @samp
  17534. @item none
  17535. Disable any peak mode (default).
  17536. @item sample
  17537. Enable sample-peak mode.
  17538. Simple peak mode looking for the higher sample value. It logs a message
  17539. for sample-peak (identified by @code{SPK}).
  17540. @item true
  17541. Enable true-peak mode.
  17542. If enabled, the peak lookup is done on an over-sampled version of the input
  17543. stream for better peak accuracy. It logs a message for true-peak.
  17544. (identified by @code{TPK}) and true-peak per frame (identified by @code{FTPK}).
  17545. This mode requires a build with @code{libswresample}.
  17546. @end table
  17547. @item dualmono
  17548. Treat mono input files as "dual mono". If a mono file is intended for playback
  17549. on a stereo system, its EBU R128 measurement will be perceptually incorrect.
  17550. If set to @code{true}, this option will compensate for this effect.
  17551. Multi-channel input files are not affected by this option.
  17552. @item panlaw
  17553. Set a specific pan law to be used for the measurement of dual mono files.
  17554. This parameter is optional, and has a default value of -3.01dB.
  17555. @item target
  17556. Set a specific target level (in LUFS) used as relative zero in the visualization.
  17557. This parameter is optional and has a default value of -23LUFS as specified
  17558. by EBU R128. However, material published online may prefer a level of -16LUFS
  17559. (e.g. for use with podcasts or video platforms).
  17560. @item gauge
  17561. Set the value displayed by the gauge. Valid values are @code{momentary} and s
  17562. @code{shortterm}. By default the momentary value will be used, but in certain
  17563. scenarios it may be more useful to observe the short term value instead (e.g.
  17564. live mixing).
  17565. @item scale
  17566. Sets the display scale for the loudness. Valid parameters are @code{absolute}
  17567. (in LUFS) or @code{relative} (LU) relative to the target. This only affects the
  17568. video output, not the summary or continuous log output.
  17569. @end table
  17570. @subsection Examples
  17571. @itemize
  17572. @item
  17573. Real-time graph using @command{ffplay}, with a EBU scale meter +18:
  17574. @example
  17575. ffplay -f lavfi -i "amovie=input.mp3,ebur128=video=1:meter=18 [out0][out1]"
  17576. @end example
  17577. @item
  17578. Run an analysis with @command{ffmpeg}:
  17579. @example
  17580. ffmpeg -nostats -i input.mp3 -filter_complex ebur128 -f null -
  17581. @end example
  17582. @end itemize
  17583. @section interleave, ainterleave
  17584. Temporally interleave frames from several inputs.
  17585. @code{interleave} works with video inputs, @code{ainterleave} with audio.
  17586. These filters read frames from several inputs and send the oldest
  17587. queued frame to the output.
  17588. Input streams must have well defined, monotonically increasing frame
  17589. timestamp values.
  17590. In order to submit one frame to output, these filters need to enqueue
  17591. at least one frame for each input, so they cannot work in case one
  17592. input is not yet terminated and will not receive incoming frames.
  17593. For example consider the case when one input is a @code{select} filter
  17594. which always drops input frames. The @code{interleave} filter will keep
  17595. reading from that input, but it will never be able to send new frames
  17596. to output until the input sends an end-of-stream signal.
  17597. Also, depending on inputs synchronization, the filters will drop
  17598. frames in case one input receives more frames than the other ones, and
  17599. the queue is already filled.
  17600. These filters accept the following options:
  17601. @table @option
  17602. @item nb_inputs, n
  17603. Set the number of different inputs, it is 2 by default.
  17604. @end table
  17605. @subsection Examples
  17606. @itemize
  17607. @item
  17608. Interleave frames belonging to different streams using @command{ffmpeg}:
  17609. @example
  17610. ffmpeg -i bambi.avi -i pr0n.mkv -filter_complex "[0:v][1:v] interleave" out.avi
  17611. @end example
  17612. @item
  17613. Add flickering blur effect:
  17614. @example
  17615. select='if(gt(random(0), 0.2), 1, 2)':n=2 [tmp], boxblur=2:2, [tmp] interleave
  17616. @end example
  17617. @end itemize
  17618. @section metadata, ametadata
  17619. Manipulate frame metadata.
  17620. This filter accepts the following options:
  17621. @table @option
  17622. @item mode
  17623. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  17624. Can be one of the following:
  17625. @table @samp
  17626. @item select
  17627. If both @code{value} and @code{key} is set, select frames
  17628. which have such metadata. If only @code{key} is set, select
  17629. every frame that has such key in metadata.
  17630. @item add
  17631. Add new metadata @code{key} and @code{value}. If key is already available
  17632. do nothing.
  17633. @item modify
  17634. Modify value of already present key.
  17635. @item delete
  17636. If @code{value} is set, delete only keys that have such value.
  17637. Otherwise, delete key. If @code{key} is not set, delete all metadata values in
  17638. the frame.
  17639. @item print
  17640. Print key and its value if metadata was found. If @code{key} is not set print all
  17641. metadata values available in frame.
  17642. @end table
  17643. @item key
  17644. Set key used with all modes. Must be set for all modes except @code{print} and @code{delete}.
  17645. @item value
  17646. Set metadata value which will be used. This option is mandatory for
  17647. @code{modify} and @code{add} mode.
  17648. @item function
  17649. Which function to use when comparing metadata value and @code{value}.
  17650. Can be one of following:
  17651. @table @samp
  17652. @item same_str
  17653. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value is same as @code{value}.
  17654. @item starts_with
  17655. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value starts with
  17656. the @code{value} option string.
  17657. @item less
  17658. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is less than @code{value}.
  17659. @item equal
  17660. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if @code{value} is equal with metadata value.
  17661. @item greater
  17662. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if metadata value is greater than @code{value}.
  17663. @item expr
  17664. Values are interpreted as floats, returns true if expression from option @code{expr}
  17665. evaluates to true.
  17666. @item ends_with
  17667. Values are interpreted as strings, returns true if metadata value ends with
  17668. the @code{value} option string.
  17669. @end table
  17670. @item expr
  17671. Set expression which is used when @code{function} is set to @code{expr}.
  17672. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  17673. constants:
  17674. @table @option
  17675. @item VALUE1
  17676. Float representation of @code{value} from metadata key.
  17677. @item VALUE2
  17678. Float representation of @code{value} as supplied by user in @code{value} option.
  17679. @end table
  17680. @item file
  17681. If specified in @code{print} mode, output is written to the named file. Instead of
  17682. plain filename any writable url can be specified. Filename ``-'' is a shorthand
  17683. for standard output. If @code{file} option is not set, output is written to the log
  17684. with AV_LOG_INFO loglevel.
  17685. @item direct
  17686. Reduces buffering in print mode when output is written to a URL set using @var{file}.
  17687. @end table
  17688. @subsection Examples
  17689. @itemize
  17690. @item
  17691. Print all metadata values for frames with key @code{lavfi.signalstats.YDIF} with values
  17692. between 0 and 1.
  17693. @example
  17694. signalstats,metadata=print:key=lavfi.signalstats.YDIF:value=0:function=expr:expr='between(VALUE1,0,1)'
  17695. @end example
  17696. @item
  17697. Print silencedetect output to file @file{metadata.txt}.
  17698. @example
  17699. silencedetect,ametadata=mode=print:file=metadata.txt
  17700. @end example
  17701. @item
  17702. Direct all metadata to a pipe with file descriptor 4.
  17703. @example
  17704. metadata=mode=print:file='pipe\:4'
  17705. @end example
  17706. @end itemize
  17707. @section perms, aperms
  17708. Set read/write permissions for the output frames.
  17709. These filters are mainly aimed at developers to test direct path in the
  17710. following filter in the filtergraph.
  17711. The filters accept the following options:
  17712. @table @option
  17713. @item mode
  17714. Select the permissions mode.
  17715. It accepts the following values:
  17716. @table @samp
  17717. @item none
  17718. Do nothing. This is the default.
  17719. @item ro
  17720. Set all the output frames read-only.
  17721. @item rw
  17722. Set all the output frames directly writable.
  17723. @item toggle
  17724. Make the frame read-only if writable, and writable if read-only.
  17725. @item random
  17726. Set each output frame read-only or writable randomly.
  17727. @end table
  17728. @item seed
  17729. Set the seed for the @var{random} mode, must be an integer included between
  17730. @code{0} and @code{UINT32_MAX}. If not specified, or if explicitly set to
  17731. @code{-1}, the filter will try to use a good random seed on a best effort
  17732. basis.
  17733. @end table
  17734. Note: in case of auto-inserted filter between the permission filter and the
  17735. following one, the permission might not be received as expected in that
  17736. following filter. Inserting a @ref{format} or @ref{aformat} filter before the
  17737. perms/aperms filter can avoid this problem.
  17738. @section realtime, arealtime
  17739. Slow down filtering to match real time approximately.
  17740. These filters will pause the filtering for a variable amount of time to
  17741. match the output rate with the input timestamps.
  17742. They are similar to the @option{re} option to @code{ffmpeg}.
  17743. They accept the following options:
  17744. @table @option
  17745. @item limit
  17746. Time limit for the pauses. Any pause longer than that will be considered
  17747. a timestamp discontinuity and reset the timer. Default is 2 seconds.
  17748. @item speed
  17749. Speed factor for processing. The value must be a float larger than zero.
  17750. Values larger than 1.0 will result in faster than realtime processing,
  17751. smaller will slow processing down. The @var{limit} is automatically adapted
  17752. accordingly. Default is 1.0.
  17753. A processing speed faster than what is possible without these filters cannot
  17754. be achieved.
  17755. @end table
  17756. @anchor{select}
  17757. @section select, aselect
  17758. Select frames to pass in output.
  17759. This filter accepts the following options:
  17760. @table @option
  17761. @item expr, e
  17762. Set expression, which is evaluated for each input frame.
  17763. If the expression is evaluated to zero, the frame is discarded.
  17764. If the evaluation result is negative or NaN, the frame is sent to the
  17765. first output; otherwise it is sent to the output with index
  17766. @code{ceil(val)-1}, assuming that the input index starts from 0.
  17767. For example a value of @code{1.2} corresponds to the output with index
  17768. @code{ceil(1.2)-1 = 2-1 = 1}, that is the second output.
  17769. @item outputs, n
  17770. Set the number of outputs. The output to which to send the selected
  17771. frame is based on the result of the evaluation. Default value is 1.
  17772. @end table
  17773. The expression can contain the following constants:
  17774. @table @option
  17775. @item n
  17776. The (sequential) number of the filtered frame, starting from 0.
  17777. @item selected_n
  17778. The (sequential) number of the selected frame, starting from 0.
  17779. @item prev_selected_n
  17780. The sequential number of the last selected frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17781. @item TB
  17782. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  17783. @item pts
  17784. The PTS (Presentation TimeStamp) of the filtered video frame,
  17785. expressed in @var{TB} units. It's NAN if undefined.
  17786. @item t
  17787. The PTS of the filtered video frame,
  17788. expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17789. @item prev_pts
  17790. The PTS of the previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17791. @item prev_selected_pts
  17792. The PTS of the last previously filtered video frame. It's NAN if undefined.
  17793. @item prev_selected_t
  17794. The PTS of the last previously selected video frame, expressed in seconds. It's NAN if undefined.
  17795. @item start_pts
  17796. The PTS of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17797. @item start_t
  17798. The time of the first video frame in the video. It's NAN if undefined.
  17799. @item pict_type @emph{(video only)}
  17800. The type of the filtered frame. It can assume one of the following
  17801. values:
  17802. @table @option
  17803. @item I
  17804. @item P
  17805. @item B
  17806. @item S
  17807. @item SI
  17808. @item SP
  17809. @item BI
  17810. @end table
  17811. @item interlace_type @emph{(video only)}
  17812. The frame interlace type. It can assume one of the following values:
  17813. @table @option
  17814. @item PROGRESSIVE
  17815. The frame is progressive (not interlaced).
  17816. @item TOPFIRST
  17817. The frame is top-field-first.
  17818. @item BOTTOMFIRST
  17819. The frame is bottom-field-first.
  17820. @end table
  17821. @item consumed_sample_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17822. the number of selected samples before the current frame
  17823. @item samples_n @emph{(audio only)}
  17824. the number of samples in the current frame
  17825. @item sample_rate @emph{(audio only)}
  17826. the input sample rate
  17827. @item key
  17828. This is 1 if the filtered frame is a key-frame, 0 otherwise.
  17829. @item pos
  17830. the position in the file of the filtered frame, -1 if the information
  17831. is not available (e.g. for synthetic video)
  17832. @item scene @emph{(video only)}
  17833. value between 0 and 1 to indicate a new scene; a low value reflects a low
  17834. probability for the current frame to introduce a new scene, while a higher
  17835. value means the current frame is more likely to be one (see the example below)
  17836. @item concatdec_select
  17837. The concat demuxer can select only part of a concat input file by setting an
  17838. inpoint and an outpoint, but the output packets may not be entirely contained
  17839. in the selected interval. By using this variable, it is possible to skip frames
  17840. generated by the concat demuxer which are not exactly contained in the selected
  17841. interval.
  17842. This works by comparing the frame pts against the @var{lavf.concat.start_time}
  17843. and the @var{lavf.concat.duration} packet metadata values which are also
  17844. present in the decoded frames.
  17845. The @var{concatdec_select} variable is -1 if the frame pts is at least
  17846. start_time and either the duration metadata is missing or the frame pts is less
  17847. than start_time + duration, 0 otherwise, and NaN if the start_time metadata is
  17848. missing.
  17849. That basically means that an input frame is selected if its pts is within the
  17850. interval set by the concat demuxer.
  17851. @end table
  17852. The default value of the select expression is "1".
  17853. @subsection Examples
  17854. @itemize
  17855. @item
  17856. Select all frames in input:
  17857. @example
  17858. select
  17859. @end example
  17860. The example above is the same as:
  17861. @example
  17862. select=1
  17863. @end example
  17864. @item
  17865. Skip all frames:
  17866. @example
  17867. select=0
  17868. @end example
  17869. @item
  17870. Select only I-frames:
  17871. @example
  17872. select='eq(pict_type\,I)'
  17873. @end example
  17874. @item
  17875. Select one frame every 100:
  17876. @example
  17877. select='not(mod(n\,100))'
  17878. @end example
  17879. @item
  17880. Select only frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17881. @example
  17882. select=between(t\,10\,20)
  17883. @end example
  17884. @item
  17885. Select only I-frames contained in the 10-20 time interval:
  17886. @example
  17887. select=between(t\,10\,20)*eq(pict_type\,I)
  17888. @end example
  17889. @item
  17890. Select frames with a minimum distance of 10 seconds:
  17891. @example
  17892. select='isnan(prev_selected_t)+gte(t-prev_selected_t\,10)'
  17893. @end example
  17894. @item
  17895. Use aselect to select only audio frames with samples number > 100:
  17896. @example
  17897. aselect='gt(samples_n\,100)'
  17898. @end example
  17899. @item
  17900. Create a mosaic of the first scenes:
  17901. @example
  17902. ffmpeg -i video.avi -vf select='gt(scene\,0.4)',scale=160:120,tile -frames:v 1 preview.png
  17903. @end example
  17904. Comparing @var{scene} against a value between 0.3 and 0.5 is generally a sane
  17905. choice.
  17906. @item
  17907. Send even and odd frames to separate outputs, and compose them:
  17908. @example
  17909. select=n=2:e='mod(n, 2)+1' [odd][even]; [odd] pad=h=2*ih [tmp]; [tmp][even] overlay=y=h
  17910. @end example
  17911. @item
  17912. Select useful frames from an ffconcat file which is using inpoints and
  17913. outpoints but where the source files are not intra frame only.
  17914. @example
  17915. ffmpeg -copyts -vsync 0 -segment_time_metadata 1 -i input.ffconcat -vf select=concatdec_select -af aselect=concatdec_select output.avi
  17916. @end example
  17917. @end itemize
  17918. @section sendcmd, asendcmd
  17919. Send commands to filters in the filtergraph.
  17920. These filters read commands to be sent to other filters in the
  17921. filtergraph.
  17922. @code{sendcmd} must be inserted between two video filters,
  17923. @code{asendcmd} must be inserted between two audio filters, but apart
  17924. from that they act the same way.
  17925. The specification of commands can be provided in the filter arguments
  17926. with the @var{commands} option, or in a file specified by the
  17927. @var{filename} option.
  17928. These filters accept the following options:
  17929. @table @option
  17930. @item commands, c
  17931. Set the commands to be read and sent to the other filters.
  17932. @item filename, f
  17933. Set the filename of the commands to be read and sent to the other
  17934. filters.
  17935. @end table
  17936. @subsection Commands syntax
  17937. A commands description consists of a sequence of interval
  17938. specifications, comprising a list of commands to be executed when a
  17939. particular event related to that interval occurs. The occurring event
  17940. is typically the current frame time entering or leaving a given time
  17941. interval.
  17942. An interval is specified by the following syntax:
  17943. @example
  17944. @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS};
  17945. @end example
  17946. The time interval is specified by the @var{START} and @var{END} times.
  17947. @var{END} is optional and defaults to the maximum time.
  17948. The current frame time is considered within the specified interval if
  17949. it is included in the interval [@var{START}, @var{END}), that is when
  17950. the time is greater or equal to @var{START} and is lesser than
  17951. @var{END}.
  17952. @var{COMMANDS} consists of a sequence of one or more command
  17953. specifications, separated by ",", relating to that interval. The
  17954. syntax of a command specification is given by:
  17955. @example
  17956. [@var{FLAGS}] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} @var{ARG}
  17957. @end example
  17958. @var{FLAGS} is optional and specifies the type of events relating to
  17959. the time interval which enable sending the specified command, and must
  17960. be a non-null sequence of identifier flags separated by "+" or "|" and
  17961. enclosed between "[" and "]".
  17962. The following flags are recognized:
  17963. @table @option
  17964. @item enter
  17965. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp enters the
  17966. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17967. previous frame timestamp was not in the given interval, and the
  17968. current is.
  17969. @item leave
  17970. The command is sent when the current frame timestamp leaves the
  17971. specified interval. In other words, the command is sent when the
  17972. previous frame timestamp was in the given interval, and the
  17973. current is not.
  17974. @end table
  17975. If @var{FLAGS} is not specified, a default value of @code{[enter]} is
  17976. assumed.
  17977. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  17978. the filter class or a specific filter instance name.
  17979. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  17980. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional list of argument for
  17981. the given @var{COMMAND}.
  17982. Between one interval specification and another, whitespaces, or
  17983. sequences of characters starting with @code{#} until the end of line,
  17984. are ignored and can be used to annotate comments.
  17985. A simplified BNF description of the commands specification syntax
  17986. follows:
  17987. @example
  17988. @var{COMMAND_FLAG} ::= "enter" | "leave"
  17989. @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} ::= @var{COMMAND_FLAG} [(+|"|")@var{COMMAND_FLAG}]
  17990. @var{COMMAND} ::= ["[" @var{COMMAND_FLAGS} "]"] @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  17991. @var{COMMANDS} ::= @var{COMMAND} [,@var{COMMANDS}]
  17992. @var{INTERVAL} ::= @var{START}[-@var{END}] @var{COMMANDS}
  17993. @var{INTERVALS} ::= @var{INTERVAL}[;@var{INTERVALS}]
  17994. @end example
  17995. @subsection Examples
  17996. @itemize
  17997. @item
  17998. Specify audio tempo change at second 4:
  17999. @example
  18000. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo tempo 1.5',atempo
  18001. @end example
  18002. @item
  18003. Target a specific filter instance:
  18004. @example
  18005. asendcmd=c='4.0 atempo@@my tempo 1.5',atempo@@my
  18006. @end example
  18007. @item
  18008. Specify a list of drawtext and hue commands in a file.
  18009. @example
  18010. # show text in the interval 5-10
  18011. 5.0-10.0 [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=hello world',
  18012. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=';
  18013. # desaturate the image in the interval 15-20
  18014. 15.0-20.0 [enter] hue s 0,
  18015. [enter] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=nocolor',
  18016. [leave] hue s 1,
  18017. [leave] drawtext reinit 'fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text=color';
  18018. # apply an exponential saturation fade-out effect, starting from time 25
  18019. 25 [enter] hue s exp(25-t)
  18020. @end example
  18021. A filtergraph allowing to read and process the above command list
  18022. stored in a file @file{test.cmd}, can be specified with:
  18023. @example
  18024. sendcmd=f=test.cmd,drawtext=fontfile=FreeSerif.ttf:text='',hue
  18025. @end example
  18026. @end itemize
  18027. @anchor{setpts}
  18028. @section setpts, asetpts
  18029. Change the PTS (presentation timestamp) of the input frames.
  18030. @code{setpts} works on video frames, @code{asetpts} on audio frames.
  18031. This filter accepts the following options:
  18032. @table @option
  18033. @item expr
  18034. The expression which is evaluated for each frame to construct its timestamp.
  18035. @end table
  18036. The expression is evaluated through the eval API and can contain the following
  18037. constants:
  18038. @table @option
  18039. @item FRAME_RATE, FR
  18040. frame rate, only defined for constant frame-rate video
  18041. @item PTS
  18042. The presentation timestamp in input
  18043. @item N
  18044. The count of the input frame for video or the number of consumed samples,
  18045. not including the current frame for audio, starting from 0.
  18046. @item NB_CONSUMED_SAMPLES
  18047. The number of consumed samples, not including the current frame (only
  18048. audio)
  18049. @item NB_SAMPLES, S
  18050. The number of samples in the current frame (only audio)
  18051. @item SAMPLE_RATE, SR
  18052. The audio sample rate.
  18053. @item STARTPTS
  18054. The PTS of the first frame.
  18055. @item STARTT
  18056. the time in seconds of the first frame
  18057. @item INTERLACED
  18058. State whether the current frame is interlaced.
  18059. @item T
  18060. the time in seconds of the current frame
  18061. @item POS
  18062. original position in the file of the frame, or undefined if undefined
  18063. for the current frame
  18064. @item PREV_INPTS
  18065. The previous input PTS.
  18066. @item PREV_INT
  18067. previous input time in seconds
  18068. @item PREV_OUTPTS
  18069. The previous output PTS.
  18070. @item PREV_OUTT
  18071. previous output time in seconds
  18072. @item RTCTIME
  18073. The wallclock (RTC) time in microseconds. This is deprecated, use time(0)
  18074. instead.
  18075. @item RTCSTART
  18076. The wallclock (RTC) time at the start of the movie in microseconds.
  18077. @item TB
  18078. The timebase of the input timestamps.
  18079. @end table
  18080. @subsection Examples
  18081. @itemize
  18082. @item
  18083. Start counting PTS from zero
  18084. @example
  18085. setpts=PTS-STARTPTS
  18086. @end example
  18087. @item
  18088. Apply fast motion effect:
  18089. @example
  18090. setpts=0.5*PTS
  18091. @end example
  18092. @item
  18093. Apply slow motion effect:
  18094. @example
  18095. setpts=2.0*PTS
  18096. @end example
  18097. @item
  18098. Set fixed rate of 25 frames per second:
  18099. @example
  18100. setpts=N/(25*TB)
  18101. @end example
  18102. @item
  18103. Set fixed rate 25 fps with some jitter:
  18104. @example
  18105. setpts='1/(25*TB) * (N + 0.05 * sin(N*2*PI/25))'
  18106. @end example
  18107. @item
  18108. Apply an offset of 10 seconds to the input PTS:
  18109. @example
  18110. setpts=PTS+10/TB
  18111. @end example
  18112. @item
  18113. Generate timestamps from a "live source" and rebase onto the current timebase:
  18114. @example
  18115. setpts='(RTCTIME - RTCSTART) / (TB * 1000000)'
  18116. @end example
  18117. @item
  18118. Generate timestamps by counting samples:
  18119. @example
  18120. asetpts=N/SR/TB
  18121. @end example
  18122. @end itemize
  18123. @section setrange
  18124. Force color range for the output video frame.
  18125. The @code{setrange} filter marks the color range property for the
  18126. output frames. It does not change the input frame, but only sets the
  18127. corresponding property, which affects how the frame is treated by
  18128. following filters.
  18129. The filter accepts the following options:
  18130. @table @option
  18131. @item range
  18132. Available values are:
  18133. @table @samp
  18134. @item auto
  18135. Keep the same color range property.
  18136. @item unspecified, unknown
  18137. Set the color range as unspecified.
  18138. @item limited, tv, mpeg
  18139. Set the color range as limited.
  18140. @item full, pc, jpeg
  18141. Set the color range as full.
  18142. @end table
  18143. @end table
  18144. @section settb, asettb
  18145. Set the timebase to use for the output frames timestamps.
  18146. It is mainly useful for testing timebase configuration.
  18147. It accepts the following parameters:
  18148. @table @option
  18149. @item expr, tb
  18150. The expression which is evaluated into the output timebase.
  18151. @end table
  18152. The value for @option{tb} is an arithmetic expression representing a
  18153. rational. The expression can contain the constants "AVTB" (the default
  18154. timebase), "intb" (the input timebase) and "sr" (the sample rate,
  18155. audio only). Default value is "intb".
  18156. @subsection Examples
  18157. @itemize
  18158. @item
  18159. Set the timebase to 1/25:
  18160. @example
  18161. settb=expr=1/25
  18162. @end example
  18163. @item
  18164. Set the timebase to 1/10:
  18165. @example
  18166. settb=expr=0.1
  18167. @end example
  18168. @item
  18169. Set the timebase to 1001/1000:
  18170. @example
  18171. settb=1+0.001
  18172. @end example
  18173. @item
  18174. Set the timebase to 2*intb:
  18175. @example
  18176. settb=2*intb
  18177. @end example
  18178. @item
  18179. Set the default timebase value:
  18180. @example
  18181. settb=AVTB
  18182. @end example
  18183. @end itemize
  18184. @section showcqt
  18185. Convert input audio to a video output representing frequency spectrum
  18186. logarithmically using Brown-Puckette constant Q transform algorithm with
  18187. direct frequency domain coefficient calculation (but the transform itself
  18188. is not really constant Q, instead the Q factor is actually variable/clamped),
  18189. with musical tone scale, from E0 to D#10.
  18190. The filter accepts the following options:
  18191. @table @option
  18192. @item size, s
  18193. Specify the video size for the output. It must be even. For the syntax of this option,
  18194. check the @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18195. Default value is @code{1920x1080}.
  18196. @item fps, rate, r
  18197. Set the output frame rate. Default value is @code{25}.
  18198. @item bar_h
  18199. Set the bargraph height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18200. computes the bargraph height automatically.
  18201. @item axis_h
  18202. Set the axis height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which computes
  18203. the axis height automatically.
  18204. @item sono_h
  18205. Set the sonogram height. It must be even. Default value is @code{-1} which
  18206. computes the sonogram height automatically.
  18207. @item fullhd
  18208. Set the fullhd resolution. This option is deprecated, use @var{size}, @var{s}
  18209. instead. Default value is @code{1}.
  18210. @item sono_v, volume
  18211. Specify the sonogram volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18212. @table @option
  18213. @item bar_v
  18214. the @var{bar_v} evaluated expression
  18215. @item frequency, freq, f
  18216. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18217. @item timeclamp, tc
  18218. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18219. @end table
  18220. and functions:
  18221. @table @option
  18222. @item a_weighting(f)
  18223. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18224. @item b_weighting(f)
  18225. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18226. @item c_weighting(f)
  18227. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18228. @end table
  18229. Default value is @code{16}.
  18230. @item bar_v, volume2
  18231. Specify the bargraph volume expression. It can contain variables:
  18232. @table @option
  18233. @item sono_v
  18234. the @var{sono_v} evaluated expression
  18235. @item frequency, freq, f
  18236. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18237. @item timeclamp, tc
  18238. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18239. @end table
  18240. and functions:
  18241. @table @option
  18242. @item a_weighting(f)
  18243. A-weighting of equal loudness
  18244. @item b_weighting(f)
  18245. B-weighting of equal loudness
  18246. @item c_weighting(f)
  18247. C-weighting of equal loudness.
  18248. @end table
  18249. Default value is @code{sono_v}.
  18250. @item sono_g, gamma
  18251. Specify the sonogram gamma. Lower gamma makes the spectrum more contrast,
  18252. higher gamma makes the spectrum having more range. Default value is @code{3}.
  18253. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 7]}.
  18254. @item bar_g, gamma2
  18255. Specify the bargraph gamma. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is
  18256. @code{[1, 7]}.
  18257. @item bar_t
  18258. Specify the bargraph transparency level. Lower value makes the bargraph sharper.
  18259. Default value is @code{1}. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18260. @item timeclamp, tc
  18261. Specify the transform timeclamp. At low frequency, there is trade-off between
  18262. accuracy in time domain and frequency domain. If timeclamp is lower,
  18263. event in time domain is represented more accurately (such as fast bass drum),
  18264. otherwise event in frequency domain is represented more accurately
  18265. (such as bass guitar). Acceptable range is @code{[0.002, 1]}. Default value is @code{0.17}.
  18266. @item attack
  18267. Set attack time in seconds. The default is @code{0} (disabled). Otherwise, it
  18268. limits future samples by applying asymmetric windowing in time domain, useful
  18269. when low latency is required. Accepted range is @code{[0, 1]}.
  18270. @item basefreq
  18271. Specify the transform base frequency. Default value is @code{20.01523126408007475},
  18272. which is frequency 50 cents below E0. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18273. @item endfreq
  18274. Specify the transform end frequency. Default value is @code{20495.59681441799654},
  18275. which is frequency 50 cents above D#10. Acceptable range is @code{[10, 100000]}.
  18276. @item coeffclamp
  18277. This option is deprecated and ignored.
  18278. @item tlength
  18279. Specify the transform length in time domain. Use this option to control accuracy
  18280. trade-off between time domain and frequency domain at every frequency sample.
  18281. It can contain variables:
  18282. @table @option
  18283. @item frequency, freq, f
  18284. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18285. @item timeclamp, tc
  18286. the value of @var{timeclamp} option.
  18287. @end table
  18288. Default value is @code{384*tc/(384+tc*f)}.
  18289. @item count
  18290. Specify the transform count for every video frame. Default value is @code{6}.
  18291. Acceptable range is @code{[1, 30]}.
  18292. @item fcount
  18293. Specify the transform count for every single pixel. Default value is @code{0},
  18294. which makes it computed automatically. Acceptable range is @code{[0, 10]}.
  18295. @item fontfile
  18296. Specify font file for use with freetype to draw the axis. If not specified,
  18297. use embedded font. Note that drawing with font file or embedded font is not
  18298. implemented with custom @var{basefreq} and @var{endfreq}, use @var{axisfile}
  18299. option instead.
  18300. @item font
  18301. Specify fontconfig pattern. This has lower priority than @var{fontfile}. The
  18302. @code{:} in the pattern may be replaced by @code{|} to avoid unnecessary
  18303. escaping.
  18304. @item fontcolor
  18305. Specify font color expression. This is arithmetic expression that should return
  18306. integer value 0xRRGGBB. It can contain variables:
  18307. @table @option
  18308. @item frequency, freq, f
  18309. the frequency where it is evaluated
  18310. @item timeclamp, tc
  18311. the value of @var{timeclamp} option
  18312. @end table
  18313. and functions:
  18314. @table @option
  18315. @item midi(f)
  18316. midi number of frequency f, some midi numbers: E0(16), C1(24), C2(36), A4(69)
  18317. @item r(x), g(x), b(x)
  18318. red, green, and blue value of intensity x.
  18319. @end table
  18320. Default value is @code{st(0, (midi(f)-59.5)/12);
  18321. st(1, if(between(ld(0),0,1), 0.5-0.5*cos(2*PI*ld(0)), 0));
  18322. r(1-ld(1)) + b(ld(1))}.
  18323. @item axisfile
  18324. Specify image file to draw the axis. This option override @var{fontfile} and
  18325. @var{fontcolor} option.
  18326. @item axis, text
  18327. Enable/disable drawing text to the axis. If it is set to @code{0}, drawing to
  18328. the axis is disabled, ignoring @var{fontfile} and @var{axisfile} option.
  18329. Default value is @code{1}.
  18330. @item csp
  18331. Set colorspace. The accepted values are:
  18332. @table @samp
  18333. @item unspecified
  18334. Unspecified (default)
  18335. @item bt709
  18336. BT.709
  18337. @item fcc
  18338. FCC
  18339. @item bt470bg
  18340. BT.470BG or BT.601-6 625
  18341. @item smpte170m
  18342. SMPTE-170M or BT.601-6 525
  18343. @item smpte240m
  18344. SMPTE-240M
  18345. @item bt2020ncl
  18346. BT.2020 with non-constant luminance
  18347. @end table
  18348. @item cscheme
  18349. Set spectrogram color scheme. This is list of floating point values with format
  18350. @code{left_r|left_g|left_b|right_r|right_g|right_b}.
  18351. The default is @code{1|0.5|0|0|0.5|1}.
  18352. @end table
  18353. @subsection Examples
  18354. @itemize
  18355. @item
  18356. Playing audio while showing the spectrum:
  18357. @example
  18358. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18359. @end example
  18360. @item
  18361. Same as above, but with frame rate 30 fps:
  18362. @example
  18363. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=fps=30:count=5 [out0]'
  18364. @end example
  18365. @item
  18366. Playing at 1280x720:
  18367. @example
  18368. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=a.mp3, asplit [a][out1]; [a] showcqt=s=1280x720:count=4 [out0]'
  18369. @end example
  18370. @item
  18371. Disable sonogram display:
  18372. @example
  18373. sono_h=0
  18374. @end example
  18375. @item
  18376. A1 and its harmonics: A1, A2, (near)E3, A3:
  18377. @example
  18378. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18379. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt [out0]'
  18380. @end example
  18381. @item
  18382. Same as above, but with more accuracy in frequency domain:
  18383. @example
  18384. ffplay -f lavfi 'aevalsrc=0.1*sin(2*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(4*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(6*PI*55*t)+0.1*sin(8*PI*55*t),
  18385. asplit[a][out1]; [a] showcqt=timeclamp=0.5 [out0]'
  18386. @end example
  18387. @item
  18388. Custom volume:
  18389. @example
  18390. bar_v=10:sono_v=bar_v*a_weighting(f)
  18391. @end example
  18392. @item
  18393. Custom gamma, now spectrum is linear to the amplitude.
  18394. @example
  18395. bar_g=2:sono_g=2
  18396. @end example
  18397. @item
  18398. Custom tlength equation:
  18399. @example
  18400. tc=0.33:tlength='st(0,0.17); 384*tc / (384 / ld(0) + tc*f /(1-ld(0))) + 384*tc / (tc*f / ld(0) + 384 /(1-ld(0)))'
  18401. @end example
  18402. @item
  18403. Custom fontcolor and fontfile, C-note is colored green, others are colored blue:
  18404. @example
  18405. fontcolor='if(mod(floor(midi(f)+0.5),12), 0x0000FF, g(1))':fontfile=myfont.ttf
  18406. @end example
  18407. @item
  18408. Custom font using fontconfig:
  18409. @example
  18410. font='Courier New,Monospace,mono|bold'
  18411. @end example
  18412. @item
  18413. Custom frequency range with custom axis using image file:
  18414. @example
  18415. axisfile=myaxis.png:basefreq=40:endfreq=10000
  18416. @end example
  18417. @end itemize
  18418. @section showfreqs
  18419. Convert input audio to video output representing the audio power spectrum.
  18420. Audio amplitude is on Y-axis while frequency is on X-axis.
  18421. The filter accepts the following options:
  18422. @table @option
  18423. @item size, s
  18424. Specify size of video. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18425. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18426. Default is @code{1024x512}.
  18427. @item mode
  18428. Set display mode.
  18429. This set how each frequency bin will be represented.
  18430. It accepts the following values:
  18431. @table @samp
  18432. @item line
  18433. @item bar
  18434. @item dot
  18435. @end table
  18436. Default is @code{bar}.
  18437. @item ascale
  18438. Set amplitude scale.
  18439. It accepts the following values:
  18440. @table @samp
  18441. @item lin
  18442. Linear scale.
  18443. @item sqrt
  18444. Square root scale.
  18445. @item cbrt
  18446. Cubic root scale.
  18447. @item log
  18448. Logarithmic scale.
  18449. @end table
  18450. Default is @code{log}.
  18451. @item fscale
  18452. Set frequency scale.
  18453. It accepts the following values:
  18454. @table @samp
  18455. @item lin
  18456. Linear scale.
  18457. @item log
  18458. Logarithmic scale.
  18459. @item rlog
  18460. Reverse logarithmic scale.
  18461. @end table
  18462. Default is @code{lin}.
  18463. @item win_size
  18464. Set window size. Allowed range is from 16 to 65536.
  18465. Default is @code{2048}
  18466. @item win_func
  18467. Set windowing function.
  18468. It accepts the following values:
  18469. @table @samp
  18470. @item rect
  18471. @item bartlett
  18472. @item hanning
  18473. @item hamming
  18474. @item blackman
  18475. @item welch
  18476. @item flattop
  18477. @item bharris
  18478. @item bnuttall
  18479. @item bhann
  18480. @item sine
  18481. @item nuttall
  18482. @item lanczos
  18483. @item gauss
  18484. @item tukey
  18485. @item dolph
  18486. @item cauchy
  18487. @item parzen
  18488. @item poisson
  18489. @item bohman
  18490. @end table
  18491. Default is @code{hanning}.
  18492. @item overlap
  18493. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  18494. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  18495. @item averaging
  18496. Set time averaging. Setting this to 0 will display current maximal peaks.
  18497. Default is @code{1}, which means time averaging is disabled.
  18498. @item colors
  18499. Specify list of colors separated by space or by '|' which will be used to
  18500. draw channel frequencies. Unrecognized or missing colors will be replaced
  18501. by white color.
  18502. @item cmode
  18503. Set channel display mode.
  18504. It accepts the following values:
  18505. @table @samp
  18506. @item combined
  18507. @item separate
  18508. @end table
  18509. Default is @code{combined}.
  18510. @item minamp
  18511. Set minimum amplitude used in @code{log} amplitude scaler.
  18512. @end table
  18513. @section showspatial
  18514. Convert stereo input audio to a video output, representing the spatial relationship
  18515. between two channels.
  18516. The filter accepts the following options:
  18517. @table @option
  18518. @item size, s
  18519. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18520. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18521. Default value is @code{512x512}.
  18522. @item win_size
  18523. Set window size. Allowed range is from @var{1024} to @var{65536}. Default size is @var{4096}.
  18524. @item win_func
  18525. Set window function.
  18526. It accepts the following values:
  18527. @table @samp
  18528. @item rect
  18529. @item bartlett
  18530. @item hann
  18531. @item hanning
  18532. @item hamming
  18533. @item blackman
  18534. @item welch
  18535. @item flattop
  18536. @item bharris
  18537. @item bnuttall
  18538. @item bhann
  18539. @item sine
  18540. @item nuttall
  18541. @item lanczos
  18542. @item gauss
  18543. @item tukey
  18544. @item dolph
  18545. @item cauchy
  18546. @item parzen
  18547. @item poisson
  18548. @item bohman
  18549. @end table
  18550. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18551. @item overlap
  18552. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0.5}.
  18553. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18554. window function currently used.
  18555. @end table
  18556. @anchor{showspectrum}
  18557. @section showspectrum
  18558. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the audio frequency
  18559. spectrum.
  18560. The filter accepts the following options:
  18561. @table @option
  18562. @item size, s
  18563. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18564. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18565. Default value is @code{640x512}.
  18566. @item slide
  18567. Specify how the spectrum should slide along the window.
  18568. It accepts the following values:
  18569. @table @samp
  18570. @item replace
  18571. the samples start again on the left when they reach the right
  18572. @item scroll
  18573. the samples scroll from right to left
  18574. @item fullframe
  18575. frames are only produced when the samples reach the right
  18576. @item rscroll
  18577. the samples scroll from left to right
  18578. @end table
  18579. Default value is @code{replace}.
  18580. @item mode
  18581. Specify display mode.
  18582. It accepts the following values:
  18583. @table @samp
  18584. @item combined
  18585. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18586. @item separate
  18587. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18588. @end table
  18589. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18590. @item color
  18591. Specify display color mode.
  18592. It accepts the following values:
  18593. @table @samp
  18594. @item channel
  18595. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18596. @item intensity
  18597. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18598. @item rainbow
  18599. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18600. @item moreland
  18601. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18602. @item nebulae
  18603. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18604. @item fire
  18605. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18606. @item fiery
  18607. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18608. @item fruit
  18609. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18610. @item cool
  18611. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18612. @item magma
  18613. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18614. @item green
  18615. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18616. @item viridis
  18617. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18618. @item plasma
  18619. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18620. @item cividis
  18621. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18622. @item terrain
  18623. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18624. @end table
  18625. Default value is @samp{channel}.
  18626. @item scale
  18627. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18628. It accepts the following values:
  18629. @table @samp
  18630. @item lin
  18631. linear
  18632. @item sqrt
  18633. square root, default
  18634. @item cbrt
  18635. cubic root
  18636. @item log
  18637. logarithmic
  18638. @item 4thrt
  18639. 4th root
  18640. @item 5thrt
  18641. 5th root
  18642. @end table
  18643. Default value is @samp{sqrt}.
  18644. @item fscale
  18645. Specify frequency scale.
  18646. It accepts the following values:
  18647. @table @samp
  18648. @item lin
  18649. linear
  18650. @item log
  18651. logarithmic
  18652. @end table
  18653. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18654. @item saturation
  18655. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18656. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18657. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18658. Default value is @code{1}.
  18659. @item win_func
  18660. Set window function.
  18661. It accepts the following values:
  18662. @table @samp
  18663. @item rect
  18664. @item bartlett
  18665. @item hann
  18666. @item hanning
  18667. @item hamming
  18668. @item blackman
  18669. @item welch
  18670. @item flattop
  18671. @item bharris
  18672. @item bnuttall
  18673. @item bhann
  18674. @item sine
  18675. @item nuttall
  18676. @item lanczos
  18677. @item gauss
  18678. @item tukey
  18679. @item dolph
  18680. @item cauchy
  18681. @item parzen
  18682. @item poisson
  18683. @item bohman
  18684. @end table
  18685. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18686. @item orientation
  18687. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18688. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18689. @item overlap
  18690. Set ratio of overlap window. Default value is @code{0}.
  18691. When value is @code{1} overlap is set to recommended size for specific
  18692. window function currently used.
  18693. @item gain
  18694. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18695. Default value is @code{1}.
  18696. @item data
  18697. Set which data to display. Can be @code{magnitude}, default or @code{phase}.
  18698. @item rotation
  18699. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18700. Default value is @code{0}.
  18701. @item start
  18702. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18703. @item stop
  18704. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18705. @item fps
  18706. Set upper frame rate limit. Default is @code{auto}, unlimited.
  18707. @item legend
  18708. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is disabled.
  18709. @end table
  18710. The usage is very similar to the showwaves filter; see the examples in that
  18711. section.
  18712. @subsection Examples
  18713. @itemize
  18714. @item
  18715. Large window with logarithmic color scaling:
  18716. @example
  18717. showspectrum=s=1280x480:scale=log
  18718. @end example
  18719. @item
  18720. Complete example for a colored and sliding spectrum per channel using @command{ffplay}:
  18721. @example
  18722. ffplay -f lavfi 'amovie=input.mp3, asplit [a][out1];
  18723. [a] showspectrum=mode=separate:color=intensity:slide=1:scale=cbrt [out0]'
  18724. @end example
  18725. @end itemize
  18726. @section showspectrumpic
  18727. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the audio frequency
  18728. spectrum.
  18729. The filter accepts the following options:
  18730. @table @option
  18731. @item size, s
  18732. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18733. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18734. Default value is @code{4096x2048}.
  18735. @item mode
  18736. Specify display mode.
  18737. It accepts the following values:
  18738. @table @samp
  18739. @item combined
  18740. all channels are displayed in the same row
  18741. @item separate
  18742. all channels are displayed in separate rows
  18743. @end table
  18744. Default value is @samp{combined}.
  18745. @item color
  18746. Specify display color mode.
  18747. It accepts the following values:
  18748. @table @samp
  18749. @item channel
  18750. each channel is displayed in a separate color
  18751. @item intensity
  18752. each channel is displayed using the same color scheme
  18753. @item rainbow
  18754. each channel is displayed using the rainbow color scheme
  18755. @item moreland
  18756. each channel is displayed using the moreland color scheme
  18757. @item nebulae
  18758. each channel is displayed using the nebulae color scheme
  18759. @item fire
  18760. each channel is displayed using the fire color scheme
  18761. @item fiery
  18762. each channel is displayed using the fiery color scheme
  18763. @item fruit
  18764. each channel is displayed using the fruit color scheme
  18765. @item cool
  18766. each channel is displayed using the cool color scheme
  18767. @item magma
  18768. each channel is displayed using the magma color scheme
  18769. @item green
  18770. each channel is displayed using the green color scheme
  18771. @item viridis
  18772. each channel is displayed using the viridis color scheme
  18773. @item plasma
  18774. each channel is displayed using the plasma color scheme
  18775. @item cividis
  18776. each channel is displayed using the cividis color scheme
  18777. @item terrain
  18778. each channel is displayed using the terrain color scheme
  18779. @end table
  18780. Default value is @samp{intensity}.
  18781. @item scale
  18782. Specify scale used for calculating intensity color values.
  18783. It accepts the following values:
  18784. @table @samp
  18785. @item lin
  18786. linear
  18787. @item sqrt
  18788. square root, default
  18789. @item cbrt
  18790. cubic root
  18791. @item log
  18792. logarithmic
  18793. @item 4thrt
  18794. 4th root
  18795. @item 5thrt
  18796. 5th root
  18797. @end table
  18798. Default value is @samp{log}.
  18799. @item fscale
  18800. Specify frequency scale.
  18801. It accepts the following values:
  18802. @table @samp
  18803. @item lin
  18804. linear
  18805. @item log
  18806. logarithmic
  18807. @end table
  18808. Default value is @samp{lin}.
  18809. @item saturation
  18810. Set saturation modifier for displayed colors. Negative values provide
  18811. alternative color scheme. @code{0} is no saturation at all.
  18812. Saturation must be in [-10.0, 10.0] range.
  18813. Default value is @code{1}.
  18814. @item win_func
  18815. Set window function.
  18816. It accepts the following values:
  18817. @table @samp
  18818. @item rect
  18819. @item bartlett
  18820. @item hann
  18821. @item hanning
  18822. @item hamming
  18823. @item blackman
  18824. @item welch
  18825. @item flattop
  18826. @item bharris
  18827. @item bnuttall
  18828. @item bhann
  18829. @item sine
  18830. @item nuttall
  18831. @item lanczos
  18832. @item gauss
  18833. @item tukey
  18834. @item dolph
  18835. @item cauchy
  18836. @item parzen
  18837. @item poisson
  18838. @item bohman
  18839. @end table
  18840. Default value is @code{hann}.
  18841. @item orientation
  18842. Set orientation of time vs frequency axis. Can be @code{vertical} or
  18843. @code{horizontal}. Default is @code{vertical}.
  18844. @item gain
  18845. Set scale gain for calculating intensity color values.
  18846. Default value is @code{1}.
  18847. @item legend
  18848. Draw time and frequency axes and legends. Default is enabled.
  18849. @item rotation
  18850. Set color rotation, must be in [-1.0, 1.0] range.
  18851. Default value is @code{0}.
  18852. @item start
  18853. Set start frequency from which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18854. @item stop
  18855. Set stop frequency to which to display spectrogram. Default is @code{0}.
  18856. @end table
  18857. @subsection Examples
  18858. @itemize
  18859. @item
  18860. Extract an audio spectrogram of a whole audio track
  18861. in a 1024x1024 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  18862. @example
  18863. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showspectrumpic=s=1024x1024 spectrogram.png
  18864. @end example
  18865. @end itemize
  18866. @section showvolume
  18867. Convert input audio volume to a video output.
  18868. The filter accepts the following options:
  18869. @table @option
  18870. @item rate, r
  18871. Set video rate.
  18872. @item b
  18873. Set border width, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 1.
  18874. @item w
  18875. Set channel width, allowed range is [80, 8192]. Default is 400.
  18876. @item h
  18877. Set channel height, allowed range is [1, 900]. Default is 20.
  18878. @item f
  18879. Set fade, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.95.
  18880. @item c
  18881. Set volume color expression.
  18882. The expression can use the following variables:
  18883. @table @option
  18884. @item VOLUME
  18885. Current max volume of channel in dB.
  18886. @item PEAK
  18887. Current peak.
  18888. @item CHANNEL
  18889. Current channel number, starting from 0.
  18890. @end table
  18891. @item t
  18892. If set, displays channel names. Default is enabled.
  18893. @item v
  18894. If set, displays volume values. Default is enabled.
  18895. @item o
  18896. Set orientation, can be horizontal: @code{h} or vertical: @code{v},
  18897. default is @code{h}.
  18898. @item s
  18899. Set step size, allowed range is [0, 5]. Default is 0, which means
  18900. step is disabled.
  18901. @item p
  18902. Set background opacity, allowed range is [0, 1]. Default is 0.
  18903. @item m
  18904. Set metering mode, can be peak: @code{p} or rms: @code{r},
  18905. default is @code{p}.
  18906. @item ds
  18907. Set display scale, can be linear: @code{lin} or log: @code{log},
  18908. default is @code{lin}.
  18909. @item dm
  18910. In second.
  18911. If set to > 0., display a line for the max level
  18912. in the previous seconds.
  18913. default is disabled: @code{0.}
  18914. @item dmc
  18915. The color of the max line. Use when @code{dm} option is set to > 0.
  18916. default is: @code{orange}
  18917. @end table
  18918. @section showwaves
  18919. Convert input audio to a video output, representing the samples waves.
  18920. The filter accepts the following options:
  18921. @table @option
  18922. @item size, s
  18923. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18924. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18925. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  18926. @item mode
  18927. Set display mode.
  18928. Available values are:
  18929. @table @samp
  18930. @item point
  18931. Draw a point for each sample.
  18932. @item line
  18933. Draw a vertical line for each sample.
  18934. @item p2p
  18935. Draw a point for each sample and a line between them.
  18936. @item cline
  18937. Draw a centered vertical line for each sample.
  18938. @end table
  18939. Default value is @code{point}.
  18940. @item n
  18941. Set the number of samples which are printed on the same column. A
  18942. larger value will decrease the frame rate. Must be a positive
  18943. integer. This option can be set only if the value for @var{rate}
  18944. is not explicitly specified.
  18945. @item rate, r
  18946. Set the (approximate) output frame rate. This is done by setting the
  18947. option @var{n}. Default value is "25".
  18948. @item split_channels
  18949. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  18950. @item colors
  18951. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  18952. @item scale
  18953. Set amplitude scale.
  18954. Available values are:
  18955. @table @samp
  18956. @item lin
  18957. Linear.
  18958. @item log
  18959. Logarithmic.
  18960. @item sqrt
  18961. Square root.
  18962. @item cbrt
  18963. Cubic root.
  18964. @end table
  18965. Default is linear.
  18966. @item draw
  18967. Set the draw mode. This is mostly useful to set for high @var{n}.
  18968. Available values are:
  18969. @table @samp
  18970. @item scale
  18971. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  18972. @item full
  18973. Draw every sample directly.
  18974. @end table
  18975. Default value is @code{scale}.
  18976. @end table
  18977. @subsection Examples
  18978. @itemize
  18979. @item
  18980. Output the input file audio and the corresponding video representation
  18981. at the same time:
  18982. @example
  18983. amovie=a.mp3,asplit[out0],showwaves[out1]
  18984. @end example
  18985. @item
  18986. Create a synthetic signal and show it with showwaves, forcing a
  18987. frame rate of 30 frames per second:
  18988. @example
  18989. aevalsrc=sin(1*2*PI*t)*sin(880*2*PI*t):cos(2*PI*200*t),asplit[out0],showwaves=r=30[out1]
  18990. @end example
  18991. @end itemize
  18992. @section showwavespic
  18993. Convert input audio to a single video frame, representing the samples waves.
  18994. The filter accepts the following options:
  18995. @table @option
  18996. @item size, s
  18997. Specify the video size for the output. For the syntax of this option, check the
  18998. @ref{video size syntax,,"Video size" section in the ffmpeg-utils manual,ffmpeg-utils}.
  18999. Default value is @code{600x240}.
  19000. @item split_channels
  19001. Set if channels should be drawn separately or overlap. Default value is 0.
  19002. @item colors
  19003. Set colors separated by '|' which are going to be used for drawing of each channel.
  19004. @item scale
  19005. Set amplitude scale.
  19006. Available values are:
  19007. @table @samp
  19008. @item lin
  19009. Linear.
  19010. @item log
  19011. Logarithmic.
  19012. @item sqrt
  19013. Square root.
  19014. @item cbrt
  19015. Cubic root.
  19016. @end table
  19017. Default is linear.
  19018. @item draw
  19019. Set the draw mode.
  19020. Available values are:
  19021. @table @samp
  19022. @item scale
  19023. Scale pixel values for each drawn sample.
  19024. @item full
  19025. Draw every sample directly.
  19026. @end table
  19027. Default value is @code{scale}.
  19028. @end table
  19029. @subsection Examples
  19030. @itemize
  19031. @item
  19032. Extract a channel split representation of the wave form of a whole audio track
  19033. in a 1024x800 picture using @command{ffmpeg}:
  19034. @example
  19035. ffmpeg -i audio.flac -lavfi showwavespic=split_channels=1:s=1024x800 waveform.png
  19036. @end example
  19037. @end itemize
  19038. @section sidedata, asidedata
  19039. Delete frame side data, or select frames based on it.
  19040. This filter accepts the following options:
  19041. @table @option
  19042. @item mode
  19043. Set mode of operation of the filter.
  19044. Can be one of the following:
  19045. @table @samp
  19046. @item select
  19047. Select every frame with side data of @code{type}.
  19048. @item delete
  19049. Delete side data of @code{type}. If @code{type} is not set, delete all side
  19050. data in the frame.
  19051. @end table
  19052. @item type
  19053. Set side data type used with all modes. Must be set for @code{select} mode. For
  19054. the list of frame side data types, refer to the @code{AVFrameSideDataType} enum
  19055. in @file{libavutil/frame.h}. For example, to choose
  19056. @code{AV_FRAME_DATA_PANSCAN} side data, you must specify @code{PANSCAN}.
  19057. @end table
  19058. @section spectrumsynth
  19059. Synthesize audio from 2 input video spectrums, first input stream represents
  19060. magnitude across time and second represents phase across time.
  19061. The filter will transform from frequency domain as displayed in videos back
  19062. to time domain as presented in audio output.
  19063. This filter is primarily created for reversing processed @ref{showspectrum}
  19064. filter outputs, but can synthesize sound from other spectrograms too.
  19065. But in such case results are going to be poor if the phase data is not
  19066. available, because in such cases phase data need to be recreated, usually
  19067. it's just recreated from random noise.
  19068. For best results use gray only output (@code{channel} color mode in
  19069. @ref{showspectrum} filter) and @code{log} scale for magnitude video and
  19070. @code{lin} scale for phase video. To produce phase, for 2nd video, use
  19071. @code{data} option. Inputs videos should generally use @code{fullframe}
  19072. slide mode as that saves resources needed for decoding video.
  19073. The filter accepts the following options:
  19074. @table @option
  19075. @item sample_rate
  19076. Specify sample rate of output audio, the sample rate of audio from which
  19077. spectrum was generated may differ.
  19078. @item channels
  19079. Set number of channels represented in input video spectrums.
  19080. @item scale
  19081. Set scale which was used when generating magnitude input spectrum.
  19082. Can be @code{lin} or @code{log}. Default is @code{log}.
  19083. @item slide
  19084. Set slide which was used when generating inputs spectrums.
  19085. Can be @code{replace}, @code{scroll}, @code{fullframe} or @code{rscroll}.
  19086. Default is @code{fullframe}.
  19087. @item win_func
  19088. Set window function used for resynthesis.
  19089. @item overlap
  19090. Set window overlap. In range @code{[0, 1]}. Default is @code{1},
  19091. which means optimal overlap for selected window function will be picked.
  19092. @item orientation
  19093. Set orientation of input videos. Can be @code{vertical} or @code{horizontal}.
  19094. Default is @code{vertical}.
  19095. @end table
  19096. @subsection Examples
  19097. @itemize
  19098. @item
  19099. First create magnitude and phase videos from audio, assuming audio is stereo with 44100 sample rate,
  19100. then resynthesize videos back to audio with spectrumsynth:
  19101. @example
  19102. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=log:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=magnitude -an -c:v rawvideo magnitude.nut
  19103. ffmpeg -i input.flac -lavfi showspectrum=mode=separate:scale=lin:overlap=0.875:color=channel:slide=fullframe:data=phase -an -c:v rawvideo phase.nut
  19104. ffmpeg -i magnitude.nut -i phase.nut -lavfi spectrumsynth=channels=2:sample_rate=44100:win_func=hann:overlap=0.875:slide=fullframe output.flac
  19105. @end example
  19106. @end itemize
  19107. @section split, asplit
  19108. Split input into several identical outputs.
  19109. @code{asplit} works with audio input, @code{split} with video.
  19110. The filter accepts a single parameter which specifies the number of outputs. If
  19111. unspecified, it defaults to 2.
  19112. @subsection Examples
  19113. @itemize
  19114. @item
  19115. Create two separate outputs from the same input:
  19116. @example
  19117. [in] split [out0][out1]
  19118. @end example
  19119. @item
  19120. To create 3 or more outputs, you need to specify the number of
  19121. outputs, like in:
  19122. @example
  19123. [in] asplit=3 [out0][out1][out2]
  19124. @end example
  19125. @item
  19126. Create two separate outputs from the same input, one cropped and
  19127. one padded:
  19128. @example
  19129. [in] split [splitout1][splitout2];
  19130. [splitout1] crop=100:100:0:0 [cropout];
  19131. [splitout2] pad=200:200:100:100 [padout];
  19132. @end example
  19133. @item
  19134. Create 5 copies of the input audio with @command{ffmpeg}:
  19135. @example
  19136. ffmpeg -i INPUT -filter_complex asplit=5 OUTPUT
  19137. @end example
  19138. @end itemize
  19139. @section zmq, azmq
  19140. Receive commands sent through a libzmq client, and forward them to
  19141. filters in the filtergraph.
  19142. @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} work as a pass-through filters. @code{zmq}
  19143. must be inserted between two video filters, @code{azmq} between two
  19144. audio filters. Both are capable to send messages to any filter type.
  19145. To enable these filters you need to install the libzmq library and
  19146. headers and configure FFmpeg with @code{--enable-libzmq}.
  19147. For more information about libzmq see:
  19148. @url{http://www.zeromq.org/}
  19149. The @code{zmq} and @code{azmq} filters work as a libzmq server, which
  19150. receives messages sent through a network interface defined by the
  19151. @option{bind_address} (or the abbreviation "@option{b}") option.
  19152. Default value of this option is @file{tcp://localhost:5555}. You may
  19153. want to alter this value to your needs, but do not forget to escape any
  19154. ':' signs (see @ref{filtergraph escaping}).
  19155. The received message must be in the form:
  19156. @example
  19157. @var{TARGET} @var{COMMAND} [@var{ARG}]
  19158. @end example
  19159. @var{TARGET} specifies the target of the command, usually the name of
  19160. the filter class or a specific filter instance name. The default
  19161. filter instance name uses the pattern @samp{Parsed_<filter_name>_<index>},
  19162. but you can override this by using the @samp{filter_name@@id} syntax
  19163. (see @ref{Filtergraph syntax}).
  19164. @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of the command for the target filter.
  19165. @var{ARG} is optional and specifies the optional argument list for the
  19166. given @var{COMMAND}.
  19167. Upon reception, the message is processed and the corresponding command
  19168. is injected into the filtergraph. Depending on the result, the filter
  19169. will send a reply to the client, adopting the format:
  19170. @example
  19171. @var{ERROR_CODE} @var{ERROR_REASON}
  19172. @var{MESSAGE}
  19173. @end example
  19174. @var{MESSAGE} is optional.
  19175. @subsection Examples
  19176. Look at @file{tools/zmqsend} for an example of a zmq client which can
  19177. be used to send commands processed by these filters.
  19178. Consider the following filtergraph generated by @command{ffplay}.
  19179. In this example the last overlay filter has an instance name. All other
  19180. filters will have default instance names.
  19181. @example
  19182. ffplay -dumpgraph 1 -f lavfi "
  19183. color=s=100x100:c=red [l];
  19184. color=s=100x100:c=blue [r];
  19185. nullsrc=s=200x100, zmq [bg];
  19186. [bg][l] overlay [bg+l];
  19187. [bg+l][r] overlay@@my=x=100 "
  19188. @end example
  19189. To change the color of the left side of the video, the following
  19190. command can be used:
  19191. @example
  19192. echo Parsed_color_0 c yellow | tools/zmqsend
  19193. @end example
  19194. To change the right side:
  19195. @example
  19196. echo Parsed_color_1 c pink | tools/zmqsend
  19197. @end example
  19198. To change the position of the right side:
  19199. @example
  19200. echo overlay@@my x 150 | tools/zmqsend
  19201. @end example
  19202. @c man end MULTIMEDIA FILTERS
  19203. @chapter Multimedia Sources
  19204. @c man begin MULTIMEDIA SOURCES
  19205. Below is a description of the currently available multimedia sources.
  19206. @section amovie
  19207. This is the same as @ref{movie} source, except it selects an audio
  19208. stream by default.
  19209. @anchor{movie}
  19210. @section movie
  19211. Read audio and/or video stream(s) from a movie container.
  19212. It accepts the following parameters:
  19213. @table @option
  19214. @item filename
  19215. The name of the resource to read (not necessarily a file; it can also be a
  19216. device or a stream accessed through some protocol).
  19217. @item format_name, f
  19218. Specifies the format assumed for the movie to read, and can be either
  19219. the name of a container or an input device. If not specified, the
  19220. format is guessed from @var{movie_name} or by probing.
  19221. @item seek_point, sp
  19222. Specifies the seek point in seconds. The frames will be output
  19223. starting from this seek point. The parameter is evaluated with
  19224. @code{av_strtod}, so the numerical value may be suffixed by an IS
  19225. postfix. The default value is "0".
  19226. @item streams, s
  19227. Specifies the streams to read. Several streams can be specified,
  19228. separated by "+". The source will then have as many outputs, in the
  19229. same order. The syntax is explained in the @ref{Stream specifiers,,"Stream specifiers"
  19230. section in the ffmpeg manual,ffmpeg}. Two special names, "dv" and "da" specify
  19231. respectively the default (best suited) video and audio stream. Default
  19232. is "dv", or "da" if the filter is called as "amovie".
  19233. @item stream_index, si
  19234. Specifies the index of the video stream to read. If the value is -1,
  19235. the most suitable video stream will be automatically selected. The default
  19236. value is "-1". Deprecated. If the filter is called "amovie", it will select
  19237. audio instead of video.
  19238. @item loop
  19239. Specifies how many times to read the stream in sequence.
  19240. If the value is 0, the stream will be looped infinitely.
  19241. Default value is "1".
  19242. Note that when the movie is looped the source timestamps are not
  19243. changed, so it will generate non monotonically increasing timestamps.
  19244. @item discontinuity
  19245. Specifies the time difference between frames above which the point is
  19246. considered a timestamp discontinuity which is removed by adjusting the later
  19247. timestamps.
  19248. @end table
  19249. It allows overlaying a second video on top of the main input of
  19250. a filtergraph, as shown in this graph:
  19251. @example
  19252. input -----------> deltapts0 --> overlay --> output
  19253. ^
  19254. |
  19255. movie --> scale--> deltapts1 -------+
  19256. @end example
  19257. @subsection Examples
  19258. @itemize
  19259. @item
  19260. Skip 3.2 seconds from the start of the AVI file in.avi, and overlay it
  19261. on top of the input labelled "in":
  19262. @example
  19263. movie=in.avi:seek_point=3.2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19264. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19265. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19266. @end example
  19267. @item
  19268. Read from a video4linux2 device, and overlay it on top of the input
  19269. labelled "in":
  19270. @example
  19271. movie=/dev/video0:f=video4linux2, scale=180:-1, setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [over];
  19272. [in] setpts=PTS-STARTPTS [main];
  19273. [main][over] overlay=16:16 [out]
  19274. @end example
  19275. @item
  19276. Read the first video stream and the audio stream with id 0x81 from
  19277. dvd.vob; the video is connected to the pad named "video" and the audio is
  19278. connected to the pad named "audio":
  19279. @example
  19280. movie=dvd.vob:s=v:0+#0x81 [video] [audio]
  19281. @end example
  19282. @end itemize
  19283. @subsection Commands
  19284. Both movie and amovie support the following commands:
  19285. @table @option
  19286. @item seek
  19287. Perform seek using "av_seek_frame".
  19288. The syntax is: seek @var{stream_index}|@var{timestamp}|@var{flags}
  19289. @itemize
  19290. @item
  19291. @var{stream_index}: If stream_index is -1, a default
  19292. stream is selected, and @var{timestamp} is automatically converted
  19293. from AV_TIME_BASE units to the stream specific time_base.
  19294. @item
  19295. @var{timestamp}: Timestamp in AVStream.time_base units
  19296. or, if no stream is specified, in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19297. @item
  19298. @var{flags}: Flags which select direction and seeking mode.
  19299. @end itemize
  19300. @item get_duration
  19301. Get movie duration in AV_TIME_BASE units.
  19302. @end table
  19303. @c man end MULTIMEDIA SOURCES